Form 10-K
Table of Contents

UNITED STATES SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

 

 

Form 10-K

ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF

THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

 

 

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2017

  Commission File Number: 001-14965

The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc.

(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

 

Delaware   13-4019460

(State or other jurisdiction of

incorporation or organization)

 

(I.R.S. Employer

Identification No.)

200 West Street   10282

New York, N.Y.

(Address of principal executive offices)

  (Zip Code)

(212) 902-1000

(Registrant’s telephone number, including area code)

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

 

Title of each class:   Name of each exchange on which registered:

Common stock, par value $.01 per share

  New York Stock Exchange

Depositary Shares, Each Representing 1/1,000th Interest in a Share of Floating Rate

Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series A

  New York Stock Exchange

Depositary Shares, Each Representing 1/1,000th Interest in a Share of 6.20%

Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series B

  New York Stock Exchange

Depositary Shares, Each Representing 1/1,000th Interest in a Share of Floating Rate

Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series C

  New York Stock Exchange

Depositary Shares, Each Representing 1/1,000th Interest in a Share of Floating Rate

Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series D

  New York Stock Exchange

Depositary Shares, Each Representing 1/1,000th Interest in a Share of 5.50%

Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series J

  New York Stock Exchange

Depositary Shares, Each Representing 1/1,000th Interest in a Share of 6.375%

Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series K

  New York Stock Exchange

Depository Shares, Each Representing 1/1,000th Interest in a Share of 6.30%

Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series N

  New York Stock Exchange

See Exhibit 99.2 for debt and trust securities registered under Section 12(b) of the Act

 

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None

 

 

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. Yes No

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Act. Yes No

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.  Yes  No

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).  Yes  No

Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of the Annual Report on Form 10-K or any amendment to the Annual Report on Form 10-K. 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, a smaller reporting company, or an emerging growth company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer,” “smaller reporting company,” and “emerging growth company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.

 

      Large accelerated filer    Accelerated filer    Non-accelerated filer (Do not check if a smaller reporting company) 
Smaller reporting company    Emerging growth company 

If an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or revised financial accounting standards provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act. 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act). Yes No

As of June 30, 2017, the aggregate market value of the common stock of the registrant held by non-affiliates of the registrant was approximately $84.9 billion.

As of February 9, 2018, there were 379,887,039 shares of the registrant’s common stock outstanding.

Documents incorporated by reference: Portions of The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc.’s Proxy Statement for its 2018 Annual Meeting of Shareholders are incorporated by reference in the Annual Report on Form 10-K in response to Part III, Items 10, 11, 12, 13 and 14.


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 10-K FOR THE FISCAL YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2017

 

INDEX

 

Form 10-K Item Number   Page No.

 

PART I

      1  

 

Item 1

 

 

Business

  1  

 

Introduction

  1  

 

Our Business Segments and Segment Operating Results

  1  

 

Investment Banking

  2  

 

Institutional Client Services

  2  

 

Investing & Lending

  4  

 

Investment Management

  4  

 

Business Continuity and Information Security

  5  

 

Employees

  5  

 

Competition

  6  

 

Regulation

  7  

 

Available Information

  21  

 

Cautionary Statement Pursuant to the U.S. Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995

  22  

 

Item 1A

 

 

Risk Factors

  23  

 

Item 1B

 

 

Unresolved Staff Comments

  42  

 

Item 2

 

 

Properties

  42  

 

Item 3

 

 

Legal Proceedings

  43  

 

Item 4

 

 

Mine Safety Disclosures

  43  

 

Executive Officers of The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc.

  43  

 

PART II

  44  

 

Item 5

 

 

Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

  44  

 

Item 6

 

 

Selected Financial Data

  44  
     Page No.

 

Item 7

 

 

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

  45  

 

Introduction

  45  

 

Executive Overview

  46  

 

Business Environment

  47  

 

Critical Accounting Policies

  48  

 

Recent Accounting Developments

  50  

 

Use of Estimates

  50  

 

Results of Operations

  51  

 

Balance Sheet and Funding Sources

  64  

 

Equity Capital Management and Regulatory Capital

  69  

 

Regulatory Matters and Developments

  75  

 

Off-Balance-Sheet Arrangements and Contractual Obligations

  75  

 

Risk Management

  77  

 

Overview and Structure of Risk Management

  77  

 

Liquidity Risk Management

  82  

 

Market Risk Management

  89  

 

Credit Risk Management

  94  

 

Operational Risk Management

  99  

 

Model Risk Management

  101  

 

Item 7A

 

 

Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk

  101  
 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

INDEX

 

     Page No.

 

Item 8

   

 

Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

  102  

 

Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting

  102  

 

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

  103  

 

Consolidated Financial Statements

  104  

 

Consolidated Statements of Earnings

  104  

 

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income

  105  

 

Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition

  106  

 

Consolidated Statements of Changes in Shareholders’ Equity

  107  

 

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

  108  

 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

  109  

 

Note 1.   Description of Business

  109  

 

Note 2.   Basis of Presentation

  109  

 

Note 3.   Significant Accounting Policies

  110  

 

Note 4.    Financial Instruments Owned and Financial Instruments Sold, But Not Yet Purchased

  117  

 

Note 5.   Fair Value Measurements

  118  

 

Note 6.   Cash Instruments

  119  

 

Note 7.   Derivatives and Hedging Activities

  125  

 

Note 8.   Fair Value Option

  136  

 

Note 9.   Loans Receivable

  142  

 

Note 10. Collateralized Agreements and Financings

  146  

 

Note 11. Securitization Activities

  150  

 

Note 12. Variable Interest Entities

  152  

 

Note 13. Other Assets

  155  

 

Note 14. Deposits

  158  

 

Note 15. Short-Term Borrowings

  159  

 

Note 16. Long-Term Borrowings

  159  

 

Note 17. Other Liabilities and Accrued Expenses

  162  

 

Note 18. Commitments, Contingencies and Guarantees

  162  

 

Note 19. Shareholders’ Equity

  166  

 

Note 20. Regulation and Capital Adequacy

  169  

 

Note 21. Earnings Per Common Share

  178  

 

Note 22. Transactions with Affiliated Funds

  178  

 

Note 23. Interest Income and Interest Expense

  179  
     Page No.

 

Note 24. Income Taxes

  179  

 

Note 25. Business Segments

  182  

 

Note 26. Credit Concentrations

  184  

 

Note 27. Legal Proceedings

  185  

 

Note 28. Employee Benefit Plans

  191  

 

Note 29. Employee Incentive Plans

  192  

 

Note 30. Parent Company

  194  

 

Supplemental Financial Information

  196  

 

Quarterly Results

  196  

 

Common Stock Price Range

  196  

 

Common Stock Performance

  196  

 

Selected Financial Data

  197  

 

Statistical Disclosures

  197  

 

Item 9

 

 

Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on  Accounting and Financial Disclosure

  203  

 

Item 9A

 

 

Controls and Procedures

  203  

 

Item 9B

 

 

Other Information

  203  

 

PART III

  203  

 

Item 10

 

 

Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

  203  

 

Item 11

 

 

Executive Compensation

  203  

 

Item 12

 

 

Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters

  204  

 

Item 13

 

 

Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence

  204  

 

Item 14

 

 

Principal Accounting Fees and Services

  204  

 

PART IV

  205  

 

Item 15

 

 

Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules

  205  

 

SIGNATURES

  210  
 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

PART I

Item 1.    Business

 

Introduction

Goldman Sachs is a leading global investment banking, securities and investment management firm that provides a wide range of financial services to a substantial and diversified client base that includes corporations, financial institutions, governments and individuals.

When we use the terms “Goldman Sachs,” “the firm,” “we,” “us” and “our,” we mean The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. (Group Inc. or parent company), a Delaware corporation, and its consolidated subsidiaries.

References to “this Form 10-K” are to our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2017. All references to 2017, 2016 and 2015 refer to our years ended, or the dates, as the context requires, December 31, 2017, December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively.

Group Inc. is a bank holding company (BHC) and a financial holding company (FHC) regulated by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (Federal Reserve Board or FRB). Our U.S. depository institution subsidiary, Goldman Sachs Bank USA (GS Bank USA), is a New York State-chartered bank.

As of December 2017, we had offices in over 30 countries and 48% of our total staff was based outside the Americas. Our clients are located worldwide and we are an active participant in financial markets around the world. In 2017, we generated 39% of our net revenues outside the Americas. For further information about our geographic results, see Note 25 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of this Form 10-K.

Our Business Segments and Segment Operating Results

We report our activities in four business segments: Investment Banking, Institutional Client Services, Investing & Lending and Investment Management.

The chart below presents our four business segments.

 

LOGO

The table below presents our segment operating results.

 

    Year Ended December     % of 2017
Net
Revenues
 
$ in millions     2017       2016       2015    

Investment Banking

       

Net revenues

    $  7,371       $  6,273       $  7,027       23%  

Operating expenses

    3,526       3,437       3,713          

Pre-tax earnings

    $  3,845       $  2,836       $  3,314          

 

Institutional Client Services

       

Net revenues

    $11,902       $14,467       $15,151       37%  

Operating expenses

    9,692       9,713       13,938          

Pre-tax earnings

    $  2,210       $  4,754       $  1,213          

 

Investing & Lending

       

Net revenues

    $  6,581       $  4,080       $  5,436       21%  

Operating expenses

    2,796       2,386       2,402          

Pre-tax earnings

    $  3,785       $  1,694       $  3,034          

 

Investment Management

       

Net revenues

    $  6,219       $  5,788       $  6,206       19%  

Operating expenses

    4,800       4,654       4,841          

Pre-tax earnings

    $  1,419       $  1,134       $  1,365          

 

Total net revenues

    $32,073       $30,608       $33,820    

Total operating expenses

    20,941       20,304       25,042          

Total pre-tax earnings

    $11,132       $10,304       $  8,778          
 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   1


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

In the table above:

 

 

Financial information related to our business segments for 2017, 2016 and 2015 is included in “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data,” which are in Part II, Items 7 and 8, respectively, of this Form 10-K. See Note 25 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of this Form 10-K for a summary of our total net revenues, pre-tax earnings and net earnings by geographic region.

 

 

Operating expenses included $3.37 billion recorded in Institutional Client Services in 2015 related to the settlement agreement with the Residential Mortgage-Backed Securities Working Group of the U.S. Financial Fraud Enforcement Task Force. See Note 27 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2015 for further information.

 

 

All operating expenses have been allocated to our segments except for charitable contributions of $127 million for 2017, $114 million for 2016 and $148 million for 2015.

Investment Banking

Investment Banking serves public and private sector clients around the world. We provide financial advisory services and help companies raise capital to strengthen and grow their businesses. We seek to develop and maintain long-term relationships with a diverse global group of institutional clients, including governments, states and municipalities. Our goal is to deliver to our institutional clients the entire resources of the firm in a seamless fashion, with investment banking serving as the main initial point of contact with Goldman Sachs.

Financial Advisory. Financial Advisory includes strategic advisory assignments with respect to mergers and acquisitions, divestitures, corporate defense activities, restructurings, spin-offs and risk management. In particular, we help clients execute large, complex transactions for which we provide multiple services, including cross-border structuring expertise. Financial Advisory also includes revenues from derivative transactions directly related to these client advisory assignments. We also assist our clients in managing their asset and liability exposures and their capital.

Underwriting. The other core activity of Investment Banking is helping companies raise capital to fund their businesses. As a financial intermediary, our job is to match the capital of our investing clients, who aim to grow the savings of millions of people, with the needs of our public and private sector clients, who need financing to generate growth, create jobs and deliver products and services. Our underwriting activities include public offerings and private placements, including local and cross-border transactions and acquisition financing, of a wide range of securities and other financial instruments, including loans. Underwriting also includes revenues from derivative transactions entered into with public and private sector clients in connection with our underwriting activities.

Equity Underwriting. We underwrite common and preferred stock and convertible and exchangeable securities. We regularly receive mandates for large, complex transactions and have held a leading position in worldwide public common stock offerings and worldwide initial public offerings for many years.

Debt Underwriting. We underwrite and originate various types of debt instruments, including investment-grade and high-yield debt, bank loans and bridge loans, including in connection with acquisition financing, and emerging- and growth-market debt, which may be issued by, among others, corporate, sovereign, municipal and agency issuers. In addition, we underwrite and originate structured securities, which include mortgage-related securities and other asset-backed securities.

Institutional Client Services

Institutional Client Services serves our clients who come to us to buy and sell financial products, raise funding and manage risk. We do this by acting as a market maker and offering market expertise on a global basis. Institutional Client Services makes markets and facilitates client transactions in fixed income, equity, currency and commodity products. In addition, we make markets in and clear client transactions on major stock, options and futures exchanges worldwide.

As a market maker, we provide prices to clients globally across thousands of products in all major asset classes and markets. At times we take the other side of transactions ourselves if a buyer or seller is not readily available and at other times we connect our clients to other parties who want to transact. Our willingness to make markets, commit capital and take risk in a broad range of products is crucial to our client relationships. Market makers provide liquidity and play a critical role in price discovery, which contributes to the overall efficiency of the capital markets.

 

 

2   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

Our clients are primarily institutions that are professional market participants, including investment entities whose ultimate clients include individual investors investing for their retirement, buying insurance or putting aside surplus cash in a deposit account.

Through our global sales force, we maintain relationships with our clients, receiving orders and distributing investment research, trading ideas, market information and analysis. Much of this connectivity between us and our clients is maintained on technology platforms and operates globally wherever and whenever markets are open for trading.

Institutional Client Services and our other businesses are supported by our Global Investment Research division, which, as of December 2017, provided fundamental research on approximately 3,000 companies worldwide and more than 40 national economies, as well as on industries, currencies and commodities.

Institutional Client Services generates revenues in the following ways:

 

 

In large, highly liquid markets (such as markets for U.S. Treasury bills, large capitalization S&P 500 stocks or certain mortgage pass-through securities), we execute a high volume of transactions for our clients;

 

 

In less liquid markets (such as mid-cap corporate bonds, growth market currencies or certain non-agency mortgage-backed securities), we execute transactions for our clients for spreads and fees that are generally somewhat larger than those charged in more liquid markets;

 

 

We also structure and execute transactions involving customized or tailor-made products that address our clients’ risk exposures, investment objectives or other complex needs (such as a jet fuel hedge for an airline);

 

 

We provide financing to our clients for their securities trading activities, as well as securities lending and other prime brokerage services; and

 

 

In connection with our market-making activities, we maintain inventory, typically for a short period of time, in response to, or in anticipation of, client demand. We also hold inventory to actively manage our risk exposures that arise from these market-making activities. We carry our inventory at fair value with changes in valuation reflected in net revenues.

Institutional Client Services activities are organized by asset class and include both “cash” and “derivative” instruments. “Cash” refers to trading the underlying instrument (such as a stock, bond or barrel of oil). “Derivative” refers to instruments that derive their value from underlying asset prices, indices, reference rates and other inputs, or a combination of these factors (such as an option, which is the right or obligation to buy or sell a certain bond or stock index on a specified date in the future at a certain price, or an interest rate swap, which is the agreement to convert a fixed rate of interest into a floating rate or vice versa).

Fixed Income, Currency and Commodities Client Execution. Includes client execution activities related to making markets in both cash and derivative instruments for interest rate products, credit products, mortgages, currencies and commodities.

 

 

Interest Rate Products. Government bonds (including inflation-linked securities) across maturities, other government-backed securities, repurchase agreements, and interest rate swaps, options and other derivatives.

 

 

Credit Products. Investment-grade corporate securities, high-yield securities, credit derivatives, exchange-traded funds, bank and bridge loans, municipal securities, emerging market and distressed debt, and trade claims.

 

 

Mortgages. Commercial mortgage-related securities, loans and derivatives, residential mortgage-related securities, loans and derivatives (including U.S. government agency-issued collateralized mortgage obligations and other securities and loans), and other asset-backed securities, loans and derivatives.

 

 

Currencies. Currency options, spot/forwards and other derivatives on G-10 currencies and emerging-market products.

 

 

Commodities. Commodity derivatives and, to a lesser extent, physical commodities, involving crude oil and petroleum products, natural gas, base, precious and other metals, electricity, coal, agricultural and other commodity products.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   3


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

Equities. Includes equities client execution, commissions and fees, and securities services.

Equities Client Execution. We make markets in equity securities and equity-related products, including exchange-traded funds, convertible securities, options, futures and over-the-counter (OTC) derivative instruments, on a global basis. As a principal, we facilitate client transactions by providing liquidity to our clients, including with large blocks of stocks or derivatives, requiring the commitment of our capital.

We also structure and make markets in derivatives on indices, industry groups, financial measures and individual company stocks. We develop strategies and provide information about portfolio hedging and restructuring and asset allocation transactions for our clients. We also work with our clients to create specially tailored instruments to enable sophisticated investors to establish or liquidate investment positions or undertake hedging strategies. We are one of the leading participants in the trading and development of equity derivative instruments.

Our exchange-based market-making activities include making markets in stocks and exchange-traded funds, futures and options on major exchanges worldwide.

Commissions and Fees. We generate commissions and fees from executing and clearing institutional client transactions on major stock, options and futures exchanges worldwide, as well as OTC transactions. We provide our clients with access to a broad spectrum of equity execution services, including electronic “low-touch” access and more complex “high-touch” execution through both traditional and electronic platforms.

Securities Services. Includes financing, securities lending and other prime brokerage services.

 

 

Financing Services. We provide financing to our clients for their securities trading activities through margin loans that are collateralized by securities, cash or other acceptable collateral. We earn a spread equal to the difference between the amount we pay for funds and the amount we receive from our client.

 

 

Securities Lending Services. We provide services that principally involve borrowing and lending securities to cover institutional clients’ short sales and borrowing securities to cover our short sales and otherwise to make deliveries into the market. In addition, we are an active participant in broker-to-broker securities lending and third-party agency lending activities.

 

Other Prime Brokerage Services. We earn fees by providing clearing, settlement and custody services globally. In addition, we provide our hedge fund and other clients with a technology platform and reporting which enables them to monitor their security portfolios and manage risk exposures.

Investing & Lending

Our investing and lending activities, which are typically longer-term, include our investing and relationship lending activities across various asset classes, primarily debt securities and loans, public and private equity securities, infrastructure and real estate. These activities include making investments, some of which are consolidated, through our merchant banking business and our special situations group. Some of these investments are made indirectly through funds that we manage. We also provide financing to corporate clients and individuals, including bank loans, personal loans and mortgages.

Equity Securities. We make corporate, real estate, infrastructure and other equity-related investments.

Debt Securities and Loans. We make corporate, real estate, infrastructure and other debt investments. In addition, we provide credit to clients through loan facilities and through secured loans, including secured loans to retail clients through our digital platform, Goldman Sachs Private Bank Select (GS Select). We also make unsecured loans to and accept deposits from retail clients through our digital platform, Marcus: by Goldman Sachs (Marcus).

Investment Management

Investment Management provides investment and wealth advisory services to help clients preserve and grow their financial assets. Our clients include institutions and high-net-worth individuals, as well as retail investors who primarily access our products through a network of third-party distributors around the world.

We manage client assets across a broad range of asset classes and investment strategies, including equity, fixed income and alternative investments. Alternative investments primarily includes hedge funds, credit funds, private equity, real estate, currencies, commodities, and asset allocation strategies. Our investment offerings include those managed on a fiduciary basis by our portfolio managers as well as strategies managed by third-party managers. We offer our investments in a variety of structures, including separately managed accounts, mutual funds, private partnerships, and other commingled vehicles.

 

 

4   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

We also provide customized investment advisory solutions designed to address our clients’ investment needs. These solutions begin with identifying clients’ objectives and continue through portfolio construction, ongoing asset allocation and risk management and investment realization. We draw from a variety of third-party managers as well as our proprietary offerings to implement solutions for clients.

We supplement our investment advisory solutions for high-net-worth clients with wealth advisory services that include income and liability management, trust and estate planning, philanthropic giving and tax planning. We also use our global securities and derivatives market-making capabilities to address clients’ specific investment needs.

Management and Other Fees. The majority of revenues in management and other fees is comprised of asset-based fees on client assets. The fees that we charge vary by asset class and distribution channel and are affected by investment performance as well as asset inflows and redemptions. Other fees we receive primarily include financial planning and counseling fees generated through our wealth advisory services provided by our subsidiary, The Ayco Company, L.P.

Assets under supervision include client assets where we earn a fee for managing assets on a discretionary basis. This includes net assets in our mutual funds, hedge funds, credit funds and private equity funds (including real estate funds), and separately managed accounts for institutional and individual investors. Assets under supervision also include client assets invested with third-party managers, bank deposits and advisory relationships where we earn a fee for advisory and other services, but do not have investment discretion. Assets under supervision do not include the self-directed brokerage assets of our clients. Long-term assets under supervision represent assets under supervision excluding liquidity products. Liquidity products represent money market and bank deposit assets.

Incentive Fees. In certain circumstances, we are also entitled to receive incentive fees based on a percentage of a fund’s or a separately managed account’s return, or when the return exceeds a specified benchmark or other performance targets. Such fees include overrides, which consist of the increased share of the income and gains derived primarily from our private equity and credit funds when the return on a fund’s investments over the life of the fund exceeds certain threshold returns.

Transaction Revenues. We receive commissions and net spreads for facilitating transactional activity in high-net-worth client accounts. In addition, we earn net interest income primarily associated with client deposits and margin lending activity undertaken by such clients.

Business Continuity and Information Security

Business continuity and information security, including cyber security, are high priorities for Goldman Sachs. Their importance has been highlighted by numerous highly publicized events in recent years, including (i) cyber attacks against financial institutions, governmental agencies, large consumer-based companies and other organizations that resulted in the unauthorized disclosure of personal information of clients and customers and other sensitive or confidential information, the theft and destruction of corporate information and requests for ransom payments, and (ii) extreme weather events.

Our Business Continuity & Technology Resilience Program has been developed to provide reasonable assurance of business continuity in the event of disruptions at our critical facilities or systems and to comply with regulatory requirements, including those of FINRA. Because we are a BHC, our Business Continuity & Technology Resilience Program is also subject to review by the FRB. The key elements of the program are crisis management, business continuity, technology resilience, business recovery, assurance and verification, and process improvement. In the area of information security, we have developed and implemented a framework of principles, policies and technology designed to protect the information provided to us by our clients and our own information from cyber attacks and other misappropriation, corruption or loss. Safeguards are designed to maintain the confidentiality, integrity and availability of information.

Employees

Management believes that a major strength and principal reason for the success of Goldman Sachs is the quality and dedication of our people and the shared sense of being part of a team. We strive to maintain a work environment that fosters professionalism, excellence, diversity, cooperation among our employees worldwide and high standards of business ethics.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   5


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

Instilling the Goldman Sachs culture in all employees is a continuous process, in which training plays an important part. All employees are offered the opportunity to participate in education and periodic seminars that we sponsor at various locations throughout the world. Another important part of instilling the Goldman Sachs culture is our employee review process. Employees are reviewed by supervisors, co-workers and employees they supervise in a 360-degree review process that is integral to our team approach, and includes an evaluation of an employee’s performance with respect to risk management, compliance and diversity. As of December 2017, we had 36,600 total staff.

Competition

The financial services industry and all of our businesses are intensely competitive, and we expect them to remain so. Our competitors are other entities that provide investment banking, securities and investment management services and retail lending and deposit-taking products, as well as those entities that make investments in securities, commodities, derivatives, real estate, loans and other financial assets. These entities include brokers and dealers, investment banking firms, commercial banks, insurance companies, investment advisers, mutual funds, hedge funds, private equity funds, merchant banks, consumer finance companies and financial technology and other internet-based companies. We compete with some entities globally and with others on a regional, product or niche basis. Our competition is based on a number of factors, including transaction execution, products and services, innovation, reputation and price.

There has been substantial consolidation and convergence among companies in the financial services industry. Moreover, we have faced, and expect to continue to face, pressure to retain market share by committing capital to businesses or transactions on terms that offer returns that may not be commensurate with their risks. In particular, corporate clients seek such commitments (such as agreements to participate in their loan facilities) from financial services firms in connection with investment banking and other assignments.

Consolidation and convergence have significantly increased the capital base and geographic reach of some of our competitors, and have also hastened the globalization of the securities and other financial services markets. As a result, we have had to commit capital to support our international operations and to execute large global transactions. To take advantage of some of our most significant opportunities, we will have to compete successfully with financial institutions that are larger and have more capital and that may have a stronger local presence and longer operating history outside the U.S.

We also compete with smaller institutions that offer more targeted services, such as independent advisory firms. Some clients may perceive these firms to be less susceptible to potential conflicts of interest than we are, and, as described below, our ability to effectively compete with them could be affected by regulations and limitations on activities that apply to us but may not apply to them.

A number of our businesses are subject to intense price competition. Efforts by our competitors to gain market share have resulted in pricing pressure in our investment banking and client execution businesses and could result in pricing pressure in other of our businesses. For example, the increasing volume of trades executed electronically, through the internet and through alternative trading systems, has increased the pressure on trading commissions, in that commissions for electronic trading are generally lower than for non-electronic trading. It appears that this trend toward low-commission trading will continue. Price competition has also led to compression in the difference between the price at which a market participant is willing to sell an instrument and the price at which another market participant is willing to buy it (i.e., bid/offer spread), which has affected our market-making businesses. In addition, we believe that we will continue to experience competitive pressures in these and other areas in the future as some of our competitors seek to obtain market share by further reducing prices, and as we enter into or expand our presence in markets that may rely more heavily on electronic trading and execution.

We also compete on the basis of the types of financial products that we and our competitors offer. In some circumstances, our competitors may offer financial products that we do not offer and our clients may prefer.

The provisions of the U.S. Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (Dodd-Frank Act), the requirements promulgated by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (Basel Committee) and other financial regulation could affect our competitive position to the extent that limitations on activities, increased fees and compliance costs or other regulatory requirements do not apply, or do not apply equally, to all of our competitors or are not implemented uniformly across different jurisdictions. For example, the provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act that prohibit proprietary trading and restrict investments in certain hedge and private equity funds differentiate between U.S.-based and non-U.S.-based banking organizations and give non-U.S.-based banking organizations greater flexibility to trade outside of the U.S. and to form and invest in funds outside the U.S.

 

 

6   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

Likewise, the obligations with respect to derivative transactions under Title VII of the Dodd-Frank Act depend, in part, on the location of the counterparties to the transaction. The impact of the Dodd-Frank Act and other regulatory developments on our competitive position will depend to a large extent on the manner in which the required rulemaking and regulatory guidance evolve, the extent of international convergence, and the development of market practice and structures under the new regulatory regimes as described further in “Regulation” below.

We also face intense competition in attracting and retaining qualified employees. Our ability to continue to compete effectively will depend upon our ability to attract new employees, retain and motivate our existing employees and to continue to compensate employees competitively amid intense public and regulatory scrutiny on the compensation practices of large financial institutions. Our pay practices and those of certain of our competitors are subject to review by, and the standards of, the FRB and other regulators inside and outside the U.S., including the Prudential Regulation Authority (PRA) and the Financial Conduct Authority (FCA) in the U.K. We also compete for employees with institutions whose pay practices are not subject to regulatory oversight. See “Regulation — Compensation Practices” below and “Risk Factors — Our businesses may be adversely affected if we are unable to hire and retain qualified employees” in Part I, Item 1A of this Form 10-K for further information about the regulation of our compensation practices.

Regulation

As a participant in the global financial services industry, we are subject to extensive regulation and supervision worldwide. The Dodd-Frank Act, and the rules thereunder, significantly altered the U.S. financial regulatory regime within which we operate and the new Markets in Financial Instruments Regulation and Markets in Financial Instruments Directive (collectively, MiFID II) have significantly revised the regulatory regime for our European operations. The capital, liquidity and leverage ratios based on the Basel Committee’s final capital framework for strengthening international capital standards (Basel III), as implemented by the FRB, the PRA and FCA and other national regulators, have also had a significant impact on our businesses. The Basel Committee is the primary global standard setter for prudential bank regulation, and its member jurisdictions implement regulations based on its standards and guidelines.

The Basel Committee’s standards are not effective in any jurisdiction until rules implementing such standards have been implemented by the relevant regulators in such jurisdiction.

The implications of such regulations for our businesses continue to depend to a large extent on their implementation by the relevant regulators globally, as well as the development of market practices and structures under the regime established by such regulations.

Other reforms have been adopted or are being considered by regulators and policy makers worldwide, as described further throughout this section. Recent developments have added additional uncertainty to the implementation, scope and timing of regulatory reforms. Such developments also include potential deregulation in some areas. In February 2017, the President of the U.S. issued an executive order identifying “core principles” for the administration’s financial services regulatory policy and directing the Secretary of the Treasury, in consultation with the heads of other financial regulatory agencies, to evaluate how the current regulatory framework promotes or inhibits the principles and what actions have been, and are being, taken to promote the principles. In response to the executive order, the U.S. Department of the Treasury issued during 2017 the first three of four reports recommending a number of comprehensive changes in the current regulatory system for U.S. depository institutions, the U.S. capital markets and the U.S. asset management and insurance industries. In addition, in February 2018, the U.S. Department of the Treasury issued a report that recommends reforming the orderly liquidation authority (OLA) under the Dodd-Frank Act and amending the U.S. Bankruptcy Code to make a bankruptcy proceeding a more effective resolution method for large financial institutions.

Goldman Sachs International (GSI) and Goldman Sachs International Bank (GSIB), our principal E.U. operating subsidiaries, are incorporated and headquartered in the U.K. and, as such, are subject to E.U. legal and regulatory requirements, based on directly binding regulations of the E.U. and the implementation of E.U. directives by the U.K. Both currently benefit from non-discriminatory access to E.U. clients and infrastructure based on E.U. treaties and E.U. legislation, including cross-border “passporting” arrangements and specific arrangements for the establishment of E.U. branches. As a result of the U.K.’s notification to the European Council of its decision to leave the E.U. (Brexit), there is considerable uncertainty as to the regulatory regime that will be applicable in the U.K. and the regulatory framework that will govern transactions and business undertaken by our U.K. subsidiaries in the remaining E.U. countries.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   7


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

Banking Supervision and Regulation

Group Inc. is a BHC under the U.S. Bank Holding Company Act of 1956 (BHC Act) and an FHC under amendments to the BHC Act effected by the U.S. Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act of 1999 (GLB Act), and is subject to supervision and examination by the FRB, as our primary regulator. In August 2017, the FRB proposed a new rating system for large financial institutions, such as us, which is intended to align with the FRB’s existing supervisory program for large financial institutions and which would include component ratings for capital planning, liquidity risk management, and governance and controls. In August 2017 and January 2018, the FRB proposed related guidance for the governance and controls component. These proposals reflect the FRB’s focus on compliance with laws and regulations related to consumer protection in its evaluations of large financial institutions.

Certain of our subsidiaries are regulated by the banking and securities regulatory authorities of the countries in which they operate.

Under the system of “functional regulation” established under the BHC Act, the primary regulators of our U.S. non-bank subsidiaries directly regulate the activities of those subsidiaries, with the FRB exercising a supervisory role. Such “functionally regulated” U.S. non-bank subsidiaries include broker-dealers registered with the SEC, such as our principal U.S. broker-dealer, Goldman Sachs & Co. LLC (GS&Co.), entities registered with or regulated by the CFTC with respect to futures-related and swaps-related activities and investment advisers registered with the SEC with respect to their investment advisory activities.

Our principal U.S. bank subsidiary, GS Bank USA, is supervised and regulated by the FRB, the FDIC, the New York State Department of Financial Services (NYDFS) and the U.S. Consumer Financial Protection Bureau. A number of our activities are conducted partially or entirely through GS Bank USA and its subsidiaries, including: origination of bank loans; personal loans and mortgages; interest rate, credit, currency and other derivatives; leveraged finance; deposit-taking; and agency lending. Our retail-oriented activities are subject to extensive regulation and supervision by federal and state regulators with regard to consumer protection laws, including laws relating to fair lending and other practices in connection with marketing and providing retail financial products.

GSI, our regulated U.K. broker-dealer subsidiary, which is a designated investment firm, and GSIB, our regulated U.K. bank and principal non-U.S. bank subsidiary, are regulated by the PRA and the FCA. GSI provides broker-dealer services in and from the U.K., and GSIB acts as a primary dealer for European government bonds and is involved in market making in European government bonds, lending (including securities lending) and deposit-taking activities.

Capital, Leverage and Liquidity Requirements. The firm and GS Bank USA are subject to consolidated regulatory capital and leverage requirements set forth by the FRB. GSI and GSIB are subject to capital requirements prescribed in the E.U. Capital Requirements Regulation (CRR) and the E.U. Fourth Capital Requirements Directive (CRD IV).

Under the FRB’s capital adequacy requirements, the firm and GS Bank USA must meet specific regulatory capital requirements that involve quantitative measures of assets, liabilities and certain off-balance-sheet items. The sufficiency of our capital levels is also subject to qualitative judgments by regulators. The firm and GS Bank USA are also subject to liquidity requirements established by the U.S. federal bank regulatory agencies, and GSI and GSIB are subject to similar requirements established by U.K. regulatory authorities.

Capital Ratios. We are subject to the FRB’s risk-based capital and leverage regulations, subject to certain transitional provisions (Capital Framework). The Capital Framework is largely based on Basel III and also implements certain provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act. Under the Capital Framework, we are an “Advanced approach” banking organization and have been designated as a global systemically important bank (G-SIB).

The Capital Framework provides for an additional capital ratio requirement that phases in over time and consists of three components: (i) for capital conservation (capital conservation buffer), (ii) as a consequence of our designation as a G-SIB (G-SIB buffer) and (iii) for countercyclicality (countercyclical capital buffer). The additional capital ratio requirement must be satisfied entirely with capital that qualifies as Common Equity Tier 1 (CET1).

 

 

8   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

The capital conservation buffer began to phase in on January 1, 2016 and will continue to do so in increments of 0.625% per year until it reaches 2.5% of risk-weighted assets (RWAs) on January 1, 2019. The G-SIB buffer also began to phase in on January 1, 2016 and will continue to do so through January 1, 2019.

The countercyclical capital buffer, of up to 2.5%, is designed to counteract systemic vulnerabilities and applies only to “Advanced approach” banking organizations. The countercyclical capital buffer is currently set at zero percent. Several other national supervisors have also started to require countercyclical capital buffers. The G-SIB and countercyclical capital buffers applicable to us could change in the future and, as a result, the minimum capital ratios to which we are subject could change.

GS Bank USA also computes its capital ratios in accordance with the Capital Framework as an “Advanced approach” banking organization.

The Basel Committee has published final guidelines for calculating incremental capital ratio requirements for banking institutions that are systemically significant from a domestic but not global perspective (D-SIBs). If these guidelines are implemented by national regulators, they will apply to, among others, certain subsidiaries of G-SIBs. These guidelines are in addition to the framework for G-SIBs, but are more principles-based. CRD IV and the CRR provide that institutions that are systemically important at the E.U. or member state level, known as other systemically important institutions (O-SIIs), may be subject to additional capital ratio requirements of up to 2% of CET1, according to their degree of systemic importance (O-SII buffers). O-SIIs are identified annually, along with their applicable buffers. The PRA has identified Goldman Sachs Group UK Limited (GSG UK), the parent company of GSI and GSIB, as an O-SII. GSG UK’s O-SII buffer is currently set at zero percent.

In January 2016, the Basel Committee finalized a revised framework for calculating minimum capital requirements for market risk, which is expected to increase market risk capital requirements for most banking organizations. In December 2017, the Basel Committee extended the implementation date for the revised market risk framework until January 1, 2022, noting that the extension would allow for a review of the calibration of the framework.

In December 2017, the Basel Committee also published standards that it described as the finalization of the Basel III post-crisis regulatory reforms. These standards introduce an aggregate output floor comparing capital requirements under the Basel Committee’s standardized and internally modeled approaches, and they also revise the Basel Committee’s standardized and model-based approaches for credit risk, provide a new standardized approach for operational risk capital and revise the frameworks for credit valuation adjustment risk and the leverage ratio. The Basel Committee has proposed that national regulators implement these standards effective on January 1, 2022, with the output floor being phased in through January 1, 2027.

The U.S. federal bank regulatory agencies have not proposed rules implementing the December 2017 standards or the revisions to the Basel Committee’s market risk framework for U.S. banking organizations. In November 2016, the European Commission proposed amendments to the CRR to implement the revisions to the market risk framework for certain E.U. financial institutions, which would be effective two years after the amendments are incorporated into the CRR.

The Basel Committee has also:

 

 

Finalized a revised standard approach for calculating RWAs for counterparty credit risk on derivatives exposures (Standardized Approach for measuring Counterparty Credit Risk exposures, known as “SA-CCR”);

 

 

Published an updated framework for the regulatory capital treatment of securitization exposures (Securitization Framework);

 

 

Published guidelines for measuring and controlling large exposures (Supervisory Framework for measuring and controlling Large Exposures); and

 

 

Issued consultation papers on, among other matters, changes to the G-SIB assessment methodology.

See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Equity Capital Management and Regulatory Capital” in Part II, Item 7 of this Form 10-K and Note 20 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of this Form 10-K for information about our, GS Bank USA’s and GSI’s capital ratios and minimum required ratios.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   9


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

As described in “Other Restrictions” below, in September 2016, the FRB issued a proposed rule that would, among other things, require FHCs to hold additional capital in connection with covered physical commodity activities.

Leverage Ratios. Under the Capital Framework, the firm and GS Bank USA are subject to Tier 1 leverage requirements established by the FRB. The Capital Framework also introduced a supplementary leverage ratio for “Advanced approach” banking organizations which became effective January 1, 2018 and implements the Basel III leverage ratio framework.

In November 2016, the European Commission proposed amendments to the CRR to implement a 3% minimum leverage ratio requirement for certain E.U. financial institutions, including GSI and GSIB, which would implement the Basel III leverage ratio framework.

See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Equity Capital Management and Regulatory Capital” in Part II, Item 7 of this Form 10-K and Note 20 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of this Form 10-K for information about the firm’s and GS Bank USA’s Tier 1 leverage ratios and supplementary leverage ratios, and GSI’s leverage ratio.

Liquidity Ratios. The Basel Committee’s international framework for liquidity risk measurement, standards and monitoring requires banking organizations to measure their liquidity against two specific liquidity tests.

The Liquidity Coverage Ratio (LCR) issued by the U.S. federal bank regulatory agencies and applicable to both the firm and GS Bank USA is generally consistent with the Basel Committee’s framework and is designed to ensure that a banking organization maintains an adequate level of unencumbered high-quality liquid assets equal to or greater than the expected net cash outflows under an acute short-term liquidity stress scenario. We disclose, on a quarterly basis, our average daily LCR over the quarter. See “Available Information” below.

The LCR rule issued by the European Commission and applicable to GSI and GSIB became effective in the U.K. on October 1, 2015, and fully phased in on January 1, 2018.

The Basel Committee’s net stable funding ratio (NSFR) is designed to promote medium- and long-term stable funding of the assets and off-balance-sheet activities of banking organizations over a one-year time horizon. The NSFR framework requires banking organizations to maintain a minimum NSFR of 100%.

In May 2016, the U.S. federal bank regulatory agencies issued a proposed rule that would implement an NSFR for large U.S. banking organizations, including the firm and GS Bank USA. The proposal would require banking organizations to ensure they have stable funding over a one-year time horizon. In November 2016, the European Commission proposed amendments to the CRR to implement the NSFR for certain E.U. financial institutions, which would be effective two years after it is incorporated into the CRR. Neither the U.S. federal bank regulatory agencies nor the European Commission have released a final rule.

The enhanced prudential standards implemented by the FRB under the Dodd-Frank Act require BHCs, including Group Inc., with $50 billion or more in total consolidated assets (covered BHCs) to comply with enhanced liquidity and overall risk management standards, including a level of highly liquid assets based on projected funding needs for 30 days, and increased involvement by boards of directors in liquidity and overall risk management. Although the liquidity requirement under these rules has some similarities to the LCR, it is a separate requirement.

See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Risk Management — Overview and Structure of Risk Management” and “— Liquidity Risk Management” in Part II, Item 7 of this Form 10-K for information about the LCR and NSFR, as well as our risk management practices and liquidity.

Stress Tests. As a covered BHC, we are subject to the Dodd-Frank Act annual supervisory stress tests conducted by the FRB and semi-annual company-run stress tests.

We publish summaries of our annual and mid-cycle stress tests results on our website as described in “Available Information” below.

Our annual stress test submission is incorporated into the annual capital plans that we submit to the FRB as part of the Comprehensive Capital Analysis and Review (CCAR) of large BHCs, which is designed to ensure that capital planning processes will permit continued operations by such institutions during times of economic and financial stress. As part of CCAR, the FRB evaluates an institution’s plan to make capital distributions, such as repurchasing or redeeming stock or increasing dividend payments, across a range of macroeconomic and firm-specific assumptions based on the institution’s and the FRB’s stress tests. If the FRB objects to an institution’s capital plan, the institution is generally prohibited from making capital distributions other than distributions to which the FRB has not objected. In addition, an institution faces limitations on capital distributions to the extent that actual capital issuances are less than the amounts indicated in its capital plan.

 

 

10   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

GS Bank USA is also required to conduct stress tests on an annual basis, to submit the results to the FRB, and to publicly disclose a summary of those results. GSI and GSIB also have their own capital planning and stress testing process, which incorporates internally designed stress tests and those required under the PRA’s Internal Capital Adequacy Assessment Process.

Dividends and Stock Repurchases. Dividend payments by Group Inc. to its shareholders and stock repurchases by Group Inc. are subject to the oversight of the FRB.

U.S. federal and state laws impose limitations on the payment of dividends by U.S. depository institutions, such as GS Bank USA. In general, the amount of dividends that may be paid by GS Bank USA is limited to the lesser of the amounts calculated under a “recent earnings” test and an “undivided profits” test. Under the recent earnings test, a dividend may not be paid if the total of all dividends declared by the entity in any calendar year is in excess of the current year’s net income combined with the retained net income of the two preceding years, unless the entity obtains prior regulatory approval. Under the undivided profits test, a dividend may not be paid in excess of the entity’s “undivided profits” (generally, accumulated net profits that have not been paid out as dividends or transferred to surplus).

The applicable U.S. banking regulators have authority to prohibit or limit the payment of dividends if, in the banking regulator’s opinion, payment of a dividend would constitute an unsafe or unsound practice in light of the financial condition of the banking organization. The BHC Act prohibits the FRB from requiring a payment by a BHC subsidiary to a depository institution if the functional regulator of that subsidiary objects to such payment. In such a case, the FRB could instead require the divestiture of the depository institution and impose operating restrictions pending the divestiture.

Source of Strength. The Dodd-Frank Act requires BHCs to act as a source of strength to their bank subsidiaries and to commit capital and financial resources to support those subsidiaries. This support may be required by the FRB at times when we might otherwise determine not to provide it. Capital loans by a BHC to a subsidiary bank are subordinate in right of payment to deposits and to certain other indebtedness of the subsidiary bank. In addition, if a BHC commits to a U.S. federal banking agency that it will maintain the capital of its bank subsidiary, whether in response to the FRB’s invoking its source-of-strength authority or in response to other regulatory measures, that commitment will be assumed by the bankruptcy trustee for the BHC and the bank will be entitled to priority payment in respect of that commitment, ahead of other creditors of the BHC.

Transactions between Affiliates. Transactions between GS Bank USA or its subsidiaries, on the one hand, and Group Inc. or its other subsidiaries and affiliates, on the other hand, are regulated by the FRB. These regulations generally limit the types and amounts of transactions (including credit extensions from GS Bank USA or its subsidiaries to Group Inc. or its other subsidiaries and affiliates) that may take place and generally require those transactions to be on market terms or better to GS Bank USA or its subsidiaries. These regulations generally do not apply to transactions between GS Bank USA and its subsidiaries. The Dodd-Frank Act expanded the coverage and scope of these regulations, including by applying them to the credit exposure arising under derivative transactions, repurchase and reverse repurchase agreements, and securities borrowing and lending transactions.

Resolution and Recovery. Group Inc. is required by the FRB and the FDIC to submit a periodic plan for its rapid and orderly resolution in the event of material financial distress or failure (resolution plan). Our resolution plan must, among other things, demonstrate that GS Bank USA is adequately protected from risks arising from our other entities. If the regulators jointly determine that an institution has failed to remediate identified shortcomings in its resolution plan and that its resolution plan, after any permitted resubmission, is not credible or would not facilitate an orderly resolution under the U.S. Bankruptcy Code, the regulators may jointly impose more stringent capital, leverage or liquidity requirements or restrictions on growth, activities or operations or may jointly order the institutions to divest assets or operations in order to facilitate orderly resolution in the event of failure. See “Risk Factors — The application of Group Inc.’s proposed resolution strategy could result in greater losses for Group Inc.’s security holders, and failure to address shortcomings in our resolution plan could subject us to increased regulatory requirements” in Part I, Item 1A of this Form 10-K and “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Regulatory Matters and Developments — Resolution and Recovery Plans” in Part II, Item 7 of this Form 10-K for further information about our resolution plan.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   11


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

We are also required by the FRB to submit, on a periodic basis, a global recovery plan that outlines the steps that management could take to reduce risk, maintain sufficient liquidity, and conserve capital in times of prolonged stress.

The FDIC has issued a rule requiring each insured depository institution with $50 billion or more in assets, such as GS Bank USA, to provide a resolution plan. Our resolution plan for GS Bank USA must, among other things, demonstrate that it is adequately protected from risks arising from our other entities.

In September 2017, the FRB issued a final rule imposing restrictions on qualified financial contracts (QFCs) entered into by G-SIBs. The rule will begin to phase in on January 1, 2019 and will be fully effective on January 1, 2020. This rule is intended to facilitate the orderly resolution of a failed G-SIB by limiting the ability of the G-SIB to enter into a QFC unless (i) the counterparty waives certain termination rights in such contracts arising upon the entry of the G-SIB or one of its affiliates into resolution, (ii) the contracts do not prohibit transfers of credit enhancement that satisfy certain standards, and (iii) the counterparty agrees that the QFCs will be subject to the special resolution regimes set forth in the Dodd-Frank Act OLA and the Federal Deposit Insurance Act of 1950 (FDIA), described below. Compliance can be achieved by adhering to the ISDA Protocol described below.

We, along with a number of other major global banking organizations, adhere to the International Swaps and Derivatives Association Resolution Stay Protocol (ISDA Protocol), which was developed and updated in coordination with the Financial Stability Board (FSB), an international body that sets standards and coordinates the work of national financial authorities and international standard-setting bodies. The ISDA Protocol imposes a stay on certain cross-default and early termination rights within standard ISDA derivative contracts and securities financing transactions between adhering parties in the event that one of them is subject to resolution in its home jurisdiction, including a resolution under the OLA or the FDIA in the U.S. The ISDA Protocol is expected to be adopted more broadly in the future, following the phase-in of QFC regulations adopted by banking regulators (including the FRB’s final rule on QFCs) that impose additional requirements in order for G-SIBs, such as us, to enter into QFCs with counterparties that do not adhere to the ISDA Protocol.

The E.U. Bank Recovery and Resolution Directive (BRRD) establishes a framework for the recovery and resolution of financial institutions in the E.U., such as GSI and GSIB. The BRRD provides national supervisory authorities with tools and powers to pre-emptively address potential financial crises in order to promote financial stability and minimize taxpayers’ exposure to losses. The BRRD requires E.U. member states to grant “bail-in” powers to E.U. resolution authorities to recapitalize a failing entity by writing down its unsecured debt or converting its unsecured debt into equity. Financial institutions in the E.U. must provide that new contracts enable such actions and also amend pre-existing contracts governed by non-E.U. law to enable such actions, if the financial institutions could incur liabilities under such pre-existing contracts.

The BRRD also subjects financial institutions to a minimum requirement for own funds and eligible liabilities (MREL) so that they can be resolved without causing financial instability and without recourse to public funds in the event of a failure. The Bank of England’s rules on MREL are described below in “Total Loss-Absorbing Capacity.”

Total Loss-Absorbing Capacity. In December 2016, the FRB adopted a final rule establishing loss-absorbency and related requirements for parent companies of U.S. G-SIBs, such as Group Inc. The rule will be effective in January 2019 with no phase-in period. The rule addresses U.S. implementation of the FSB’s total loss-absorbing capacity (TLAC) principles and term sheet on minimum TLAC requirements for G-SIBs. The rule (i) establishes minimum TLAC requirements, (ii) establishes minimum “eligible long-term debt” (i.e., debt that is unsecured, has a maturity greater than one year from issuance and satisfies certain additional criteria) requirements, (iii) prohibits certain BHC transactions and (iv) caps the amount of G-SIB liabilities that are not eligible long-term debt.

The rule also prohibits a U.S. G-SIB from (i) guaranteeing liabilities of subsidiaries that are subject to early termination provisions if the parent company of a U.S. G-SIB enters into an insolvency or receivership proceeding, subject to an exception for guarantees permitted by rules of the U.S. federal banking agencies imposing restrictions on QFCs; (ii) incurring liabilities guaranteed by subsidiaries; (iii) issuing short-term debt; or (iv) entering into derivatives and certain other financial contracts with external counterparties.

 

 

12   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

Additionally, the rule caps, at 5% of the value of the U.S. G-SIB’s eligible TLAC, the amount of unsecured non-contingent third-party liabilities that are not eligible long-term debt that could rank equally with or junior to eligible long-term debt.

In October 2016, the Basel Committee issued a final standard to implement capital deductions for banking organizations relating to TLAC holdings of other G-SIBs.

The FSB issued a final TLAC standard requiring certain material subsidiaries of a G-SIB organized outside of the G-SIB’s home country, such as GSI and GSIB, to maintain amounts of TLAC directly or indirectly from the parent company. In July 2017, the FSB issued a final set of guiding principles on the implementation of the TLAC requirements applicable to material subsidiaries.

The BRRD subjects institutions to MREL, which is generally consistent with the FSB’s TLAC standard. In October 2017, the Bank of England published a consultation paper on internal MREL, which would require a material U.K. subsidiary of an overseas banking group, such as GSI, to meet a minimum internal MREL requirement to facilitate the transfer of losses to its resolution entity, which for GSI is Group Inc. The transitional minimum internal MREL requirement would phase in from January 1, 2019, becoming fully effective from January 1, 2022.

In November 2016, the European Commission proposed amendments to the CRR and BRRD that are designed to implement the FSB’s minimum TLAC requirement for G-SIBs commencing January 1, 2019. The proposal would require subsidiaries of a non-E.U. G-SIB that account for more than 5% of its RWAs, operating income or leverage exposure, such as GSI, to meet 90% of the requirement applicable to E.U. G-SIBs.

In November 2016, the European Commission also proposed an amendment to CRD IV that would require a non-E.U. G-SIB, such as us, to establish an E.U. intermediate holding company (E.U. IHC) if the firm has two or more of certain types of E.U. financial institution subsidiaries, including broker-dealers and banks, such as GSI and GSIB. The European Commission also proposed amendments to the CRR that would require E.U. IHCs to satisfy MREL requirements and certain other prudential requirements. These proposals are subject to adoption at the E.U. level and, for the directives, implementing rulemakings by E.U. member states, which have not yet occurred.

Insolvency of an Insured Depository Institution or a Bank Holding Company. Under the FDIA, if the FDIC is appointed as conservator or receiver for an insured depository institution such as GS Bank USA, upon its insolvency or in certain other events, the FDIC has broad powers, including the power:

 

 

To transfer any of the depository institution’s assets and liabilities to a new obligor, including a newly formed “bridge” bank, without the approval of the depository institution’s creditors;

 

 

To enforce the depository institution’s contracts pursuant to their terms without regard to any provisions triggered by the appointment of the FDIC in that capacity; or

 

 

To repudiate or disaffirm any contract or lease to which the depository institution is a party, the performance of which is determined by the FDIC to be burdensome and the disaffirmance or repudiation of which is determined by the FDIC to promote the orderly administration of the depository institution.

In addition, the claims of holders of domestic deposit liabilities and certain claims for administrative expenses against an insured depository institution would be afforded a priority over other general unsecured claims, including deposits at non-U.S. branches and claims of debtholders of the institution, in the “liquidation or other resolution” of such an institution by any receiver. As a result, whether or not the FDIC ever sought to repudiate any debt obligations of GS Bank USA, the debtholders (other than depositors) would be treated differently from, and could receive, if anything, substantially less than, the depositors of GS Bank USA.

The Dodd-Frank Act created a new resolution regime (known as OLA) for BHCs and their affiliates that are systemically important and certain non-bank financial companies. Under OLA, the FDIC may be appointed as receiver for the systemically important institution and its failed non-bank subsidiaries if, upon the recommendation of applicable regulators, the U.S. Secretary of the Treasury determines, among other things, that the institution is in default or in danger of default, that the institution’s failure would have serious adverse effects on the U.S. financial system and that resolution under OLA would avoid or mitigate those effects.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   13


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

If the FDIC is appointed as receiver under OLA, then the powers of the receiver, and the rights and obligations of creditors and other parties who have dealt with the institution, would be determined under OLA, and not under the bankruptcy or insolvency law that would otherwise apply. The powers of the receiver under OLA were generally based on the powers of the FDIC as receiver for depository institutions under the FDIA.

Substantial differences in the rights of creditors exist between OLA and the U.S. Bankruptcy Code, including the right of the FDIC under OLA to disregard the strict priority of creditor claims in some circumstances, the use of an administrative claims procedure to determine creditors’ claims (as opposed to the judicial procedure utilized in bankruptcy proceedings), and the right of the FDIC to transfer claims to a “bridge” entity. In addition, OLA limits the ability of creditors to enforce certain contractual cross-defaults against affiliates of the institution in receivership. The FDIC has issued a notice that it would resolve a failed FHC by transferring its assets to a “bridge” holding company under its “single point of entry” or “SPOE” strategy pursuant to OLA.

FDIC Insurance. Deposits at GS Bank USA have the benefit of FDIC insurance up to the applicable limits. The FDIC’s Deposit Insurance Fund is funded by assessments on insured depository institutions. GS Bank USA’s assessment (subject to adjustment by the FDIC) is currently based on its average total consolidated assets less its average tangible equity during the assessment period, its supervisory ratings and specified forward-looking financial measures used to calculate the assessment rate.

The reserve ratio for the Deposit Insurance Fund is 1.35% of total insured deposits. A surcharge on the assessments of larger depository institutions (including GS Bank USA) applies through the earlier of the quarter that the reserve ratio first reaches or exceeds 1.35% and December 31, 2018. If the reserve ratio does not reach 1.35% by December 31, 2018, the FDIC will impose a shortfall assessment on larger depository institutions (including GS Bank USA).

Prompt Corrective Action. The U.S. Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act of 1991 (FDICIA) requires the U.S. federal bank regulatory agencies to take “prompt corrective action” in respect of depository institutions that do not meet specified capital requirements. FDICIA establishes five capital categories for FDIC-insured banks: well-capitalized, adequately capitalized, undercapitalized, significantly undercapitalized and critically undercapitalized.

An institution may be downgraded to, or deemed to be in, a capital category that is lower than is indicated by its capital ratios if it is determined to be in an unsafe or unsound condition or if it receives an unsatisfactory examination rating with respect to certain matters. FDICIA imposes progressively more restrictive constraints on operations, management and capital distributions, as the capital category of an institution declines. Failure to meet the capital requirements could also require a depository institution to raise capital. Ultimately, critically undercapitalized institutions are subject to the appointment of a receiver or conservator, as described in “Insolvency of an Insured Depository Institution or a Bank Holding Company” above.

The prompt corrective action regulations do not apply to BHCs. However, the FRB is authorized to take appropriate action at the BHC level, based upon the undercapitalized status of the BHC’s depository institution subsidiaries. In certain instances relating to an undercapitalized depository institution subsidiary, the BHC would be required to guarantee the performance of the undercapitalized subsidiary’s capital restoration plan and might be liable for civil money damages for failure to fulfill its commitments on that guarantee. Furthermore, in the event of the bankruptcy of the BHC, the guarantee would take priority over the BHC’s general unsecured creditors, as described in “Source of Strength” above.

Activities. The Dodd-Frank Act and the BHC Act generally restrict BHCs from engaging in business activities other than the business of banking and certain closely related activities.

Volcker Rule. The provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act referred to as the “Volcker Rule” became effective in July 2015. The Volcker Rule prohibits “proprietary trading,” but permits activities such as underwriting, market making and risk-mitigation hedging, requires an extensive compliance program and includes additional reporting and record-keeping requirements. The reporting requirements include calculating daily quantitative metrics on covered trading activities (as defined in the rule) and providing these metrics to regulators on a monthly basis.

 

 

14   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

In addition, the Volcker Rule limits the sponsorship of, and investment in, “covered funds” (as defined in the rule) by banking entities, including us. It also limits certain types of transactions between us and our sponsored funds, similar to the limitations on transactions between depository institutions and their affiliates. Covered funds include our private equity funds, certain of our credit and real estate funds, our hedge funds and certain other investment structures. The limitation on investments in covered funds requires us to reduce our investment in each such fund to 3% or less of the fund’s net asset value, and to reduce our aggregate investment in all such funds to 3% or less of our Tier 1 capital.

The FRB has extended the conformance period to July 2022 for our investments in, and relationships with, certain legacy “illiquid funds” (as defined in the Volcker Rule) that were in place prior to December 2013. See Note 6 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of this Form 10-K for further information about our investments in such funds.

Other Restrictions. FHCs generally can engage in a broader range of financial and related activities than are otherwise permissible for BHCs as long as they continue to meet the eligibility requirements for FHCs. The broader range of permissible activities for FHCs includes underwriting, dealing and making markets in securities and making investments in non-FHCs (merchant banking activities). In addition, certain FHCs are permitted under the GLB Act to engage in certain commodities activities in the U.S. that may otherwise be impermissible for BHCs, so long as the assets held pursuant to these activities do not equal 5% or more of their consolidated assets.

The FRB, however, has the authority to limit an FHC’s ability to conduct activities that would otherwise be permissible, and will likely do so if the FHC does not satisfactorily meet certain requirements of the FRB. For example, if an FHC or any of its U.S. depository institution subsidiaries ceases to maintain its status as well-capitalized or well-managed, the FRB may impose corrective capital and/or managerial requirements, as well as additional limitations or conditions. If the deficiencies persist, the FHC may be required to divest its U.S. depository institution subsidiaries or to cease engaging in activities other than the business of banking and certain closely related activities.

If any insured depository institution subsidiary of an FHC fails to maintain at least a “satisfactory” rating under the Community Reinvestment Act, the FHC would be subject to restrictions on certain new activities and acquisitions.

In addition, we are required to obtain prior FRB approval before engaging in certain banking and other financial activities both within and outside the U.S.

In September 2016, the FRB issued a proposed rule which, if adopted, would impose new requirements on the physical commodity activities and certain merchant banking activities of FHCs. The proposed rule would, among other things, (i) require FHCs to hold additional capital in connection with covered physical commodity activities, including merchant banking investments in companies engaged in physical commodity activities; (ii) tighten the quantitative limits on permissible physical trading activity; and (iii) establish new public reporting requirements on the nature and extent of FHC’s physical commodity holdings and activities. In addition, in a September 2016 report, the FRB recommended that Congress repeal (i) the authority of FHCs to engage in merchant banking activities; and (ii) the authority described above for certain FHCs to engage in certain otherwise permissible commodities activities.

In March 2016, the FRB issued a revised proposal regarding single counterparty credit limits, which would impose more stringent requirements for credit exposures among major financial institutions. Such limits (together with other provisions incorporated into the Basel III capital rules) may affect our ability to transact or hedge with other financial institutions. In addition, the FRB has proposed early remediation requirements, which are modeled on the prompt corrective action regime, described in “Prompt Corrective Action” above, but are designed to require action to begin in earlier stages of a company’s financial distress, based on a range of triggers, including capital and leverage, stress test results, liquidity and risk management.

In addition, New York State banking law imposes lending limits (which take into account credit exposure from derivative transactions) and other requirements that could impact the manner and scope of GS Bank USA’s activities.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   15


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

The U.S. federal bank regulatory agencies have issued guidance that focuses on transaction structures and risk management frameworks and that outlines high-level principles for safe-and-sound leveraged lending, including underwriting standards, valuation and stress testing. This guidance has, among other things, limited the percentage amount of debt that can be included in certain transactions. The status of this guidance is uncertain as the U.S. Government Accountability Office has determined that it is a rule subject to review under the Congressional Review Act.

Broker-Dealer and Securities Regulation

Our broker-dealer subsidiaries are subject to regulations that cover all aspects of the securities business, including sales methods, trade practices, use and safekeeping of clients’ funds and securities, capital structure, record-keeping, the financing of clients’ purchases, and the conduct of directors, officers and employees. In the U.S., the SEC is the federal agency responsible for the administration of the federal securities laws. GS&Co. is registered as a broker-dealer, a municipal advisor and an investment adviser with the SEC and as a broker-dealer in all 50 states and the District of Columbia. U.S. self-regulatory organizations, such as FINRA and the NYSE, adopt rules that apply to, and examine, broker-dealers such as GS&Co.

In addition, U.S. state securities and other U.S. regulators also have regulatory or oversight authority over GS&Co. Similarly, our businesses are also subject to regulation by various non-U.S. governmental and regulatory bodies and self-regulatory authorities in virtually all countries where we have offices, as described further below, as well as in “Other Regulation.” For a description of net capital requirements applicable to GS&Co., see Note 20 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of this Form 10-K.

In Europe, we provide broker-dealer services that are subject to oversight by national regulators. These services are regulated in accordance with national laws, many of which implement E.U. directives, and, increasingly, by directly applicable E.U. regulations. These national and E.U. laws require, among other things, compliance with certain capital adequacy standards, customer protection requirements and market conduct and trade reporting rules.

Goldman Sachs Japan Co., Ltd. (GSJCL), our regulated Japanese broker-dealer, is subject to capital requirements imposed by Japan’s Financial Services Agency. GSJCL is also regulated by the Tokyo Stock Exchange, the Osaka Exchange, the Tokyo Financial Exchange, the Japan Securities Dealers Association, the Tokyo Commodity Exchange, Securities and Exchange Surveillance Commission, Bank of Japan, the Ministry of Finance and the Ministry of Economy, Trade and Industry, among others.

Also, the Securities and Futures Commission in Hong Kong, the Monetary Authority of Singapore, the China Securities Regulatory Commission, the Korean Financial Supervisory Service, the Reserve Bank of India, the Securities and Exchange Board of India, the Australian Securities and Investments Commission and the Australian Securities Exchange, among others, regulate various of our subsidiaries and also have capital standards and other requirements comparable to the rules of the SEC. Various of our other subsidiaries are regulated by the banking and regulatory authorities in jurisdictions in which we operate, including, among others, Brazil and Dubai.

Our exchange-based market-making activities are subject to extensive regulation by a number of securities exchanges. As a market maker on exchanges, we are required to maintain orderly markets in the securities to which we are assigned.

The Dodd-Frank Act will result in additional regulation by the SEC, the CFTC and other regulators of our broker-dealer and regulated subsidiaries in a number of respects. The law calls for the imposition of expanded standards of care by market participants in dealing with clients and customers, including by providing the SEC with authority to adopt rules establishing fiduciary duties for broker-dealers and directing the SEC to examine and improve sales practices and disclosure by broker-dealers and investment advisers.

In addition, in June 2017, the U.S. Department of Labor’s conflict of interest rule under the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 (ERISA) went into effect. The rule broadens the circumstances under which a firm and/or a financial advisor is considered a fiduciary when providing certain recommendations to retirement clients and requires that such recommendations be in the best interest of clients. As a result, we have made changes to some of our services and offerings for retirement clients.

 

 

16   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

Our U.S. broker-dealer and other U.S. subsidiaries are also subject to rules adopted by U.S. federal agencies pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act that require any person who organizes or initiates certain asset-backed securities transactions to retain a portion (generally, at least five percent) of any credit risk that the person conveys to a third party. For certain securitization transactions, retention by third-party purchasers may satisfy this requirement. Securitizations would also be affected by rules proposed by the SEC to implement the Dodd-Frank Act’s prohibition against securitization participants engaging in any transaction that would involve or result in any material conflict of interest with an investor in a securitization transaction. The proposed rules would exempt bona fide market-making activities and risk-mitigating hedging activities in connection with securitization activities from the general prohibition.

The SEC, FINRA and regulators in various non-U.S. jurisdictions have imposed both conduct-based and disclosure-based requirements with respect to research reports and research analysts and may impose additional regulations.

Swaps, Derivatives and Commodities Regulation

The commodity futures, commodity options and swaps industry in the U.S. is subject to regulation under the U.S. Commodity Exchange Act (CEA). The CFTC is the U.S. federal agency charged with the administration of the CEA. In addition, the SEC is the U.S. federal agency charged with the regulation of security-based swaps. The rules and regulations of various self-regulatory organizations, such as the Chicago Mercantile Exchange, other futures exchanges and the National Futures Association, also govern commodity futures, commodity options and swaps activities.

The terms “swaps” and “security-based swaps” include a wide variety of derivative instruments in addition to those conventionally referred to as swaps (including certain forward contracts and options), and relate to a wide variety of underlying assets or obligations, including currencies, commodities, interest or other monetary rates, yields, indices, securities, credit events, loans and other financial obligations.

CFTC rules require registration of swap dealers, mandatory clearing and execution of interest rate and credit default swaps and real-time public reporting and adherence to business conduct standards for all in-scope swaps. In December 2016, the CFTC proposed revised capital regulations for swap dealers that are not subject to the capital rules of a prudential regulator, such as the FRB, as well as a liquidity requirement for those swap dealers.

SEC rules govern the registration and regulation of security-based swap dealers but compliance with such rules is not currently required. The SEC has proposed rules that would govern the design of new trading venues for security-based swaps and establish the process for determining which products must be traded on these venues.

GS&Co. is registered with the CFTC as a futures commission merchant, and several of our subsidiaries, including GS&Co., are registered with the CFTC and act as commodity pool operators and commodity trading advisors. GS&Co. and other subsidiaries, including GS Bank USA, GSI and J. Aron & Company (J. Aron), are registered with the CFTC as swap dealers. In addition, Goldman Sachs Financial Markets, L.P. is registered with the SEC as an OTC derivatives dealer.

Our affiliates registered as swap dealers are subject to the margin rules issued by the CFTC (in the case of our non-bank swap dealers) and the FRB (in the case of GS Bank USA). The rules for variation margin have become effective, and those for initial margin will phase in through September 2020 depending on certain activity levels of the swap dealer and the relevant counterparty. In contrast to the FRB margin rules, inter-affiliate transactions under the CFTC margin rules are generally exempt from initial margin requirements.

The CFTC has proposed position limit rules that will limit the size of positions that can be held by any entity, or any group of affiliates or other parties trading under common control, subject to certain exemptions, such as for bona fide hedging positions. These proposed rules would apply to positions in swaps as well as futures and options on futures.

Similar types of swap regulation have been proposed or adopted in jurisdictions outside the U.S., including in the E.U. and Japan. For example, the E.U. has established regulatory requirements relating to portfolio reconciliation and reporting, clearing certain OTC derivatives and margining for uncleared derivatives activities under the European Market Infrastructure Regulation.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   17


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

The CFTC has adopted rules relating to cross-border regulation of swaps, and has proposed cross-border business conduct and registration rules. The CFTC has entered into agreements with certain non-U.S. regulators, including in the E.U., regarding the cross-border regulation of derivatives and the mutual recognition of cross-border clearing houses, and has approved substituted compliance with certain non-U.S. regulations, including E.U. regulations, related to certain business conduct requirements and margin rules. The U.S. prudential regulators have not yet made a determination with respect to substituted compliance for transactions subject to non-U.S. margin rules. The full application of new derivatives rules across different regulatory jurisdictions has not yet occurred and the full impact will not be known until the rules are implemented and market practices and structures develop under such rules.

J. Aron is authorized by the U.S. Federal Energy Regulatory Commission (FERC) to sell wholesale physical power at market-based rates. As a FERC-authorized power marketer, J. Aron is subject to regulation under the U.S. Federal Power Act and FERC regulations and to the oversight of FERC. As a result of our investing activities, Group Inc. is also an “exempt holding company” under the U.S. Public Utility Holding Company Act of 2005 and applicable FERC rules.

In addition, as a result of our power-related and commodities activities, we are subject to energy, environmental and other governmental laws and regulations, as described in “Risk Factors — Our commodities activities, particularly our physical commodities activities, subject us to extensive regulation and involve certain potential risks, including environmental, reputational and other risks that may expose us to significant liabilities and costs” in Part I, Item 1A of this Form 10-K.

Investment Management Regulation

Our investment management business is subject to significant regulation in numerous jurisdictions around the world relating to, among other things, the safeguarding of client assets, offerings of funds, marketing activities, transactions among affiliates and our management of client funds.

The SEC has adopted rules currently anticipated to become effective in December 2018 relating to liquidity risk management that will require registered open-end funds to classify and review the liquidity of their portfolio assets. In addition, the rules require funds to make disclosures relating to their liquidity risk management program and report to the SEC instances when a fund’s percentage of illiquid investments exceeds certain thresholds or when certain funds experience shortfalls in their highly liquid investments.

Certain of our European subsidiaries, including Goldman Sachs Asset Management International, are subject to the Alternative Investment Fund Managers Directive and related regulations, which govern the approval, organizational, marketing and reporting requirements of E.U.-based alternative investment managers and the ability of alternative investment fund managers located outside the E.U. to access the E.U. market.

The E.U. legislative institutions have reached provisional agreement on an E.U. regulation relating to money market funds, including provisions prescribing minimum levels of daily and weekly liquidity, clear labeling of money market funds and internal credit risk assessments. The regulation was published on June 30, 2017 and will be effective on July 21, 2018.

Compensation Practices

Our compensation practices are subject to oversight by the FRB and, with respect to some of our subsidiaries and employees, by other regulatory bodies worldwide. The scope and content of compensation regulation in the financial industry are continuing to develop, and we expect that these regulations and resulting market practices will evolve over a number of years.

 

 

18   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

The U.S. federal bank regulatory agencies have provided guidance designed to ensure that incentive compensation arrangements at banking organizations take into account risk and are consistent with safe and sound practices. The guidance sets forth the following three key principles with respect to incentive compensation arrangements: (i) the arrangements should provide employees with incentives that appropriately balance risk and financial results in a manner that does not encourage employees to expose their organizations to imprudent risk; (ii) the arrangements should be compatible with effective controls and risk management; and (iii) the arrangements should be supported by strong corporate governance. The guidance provides that supervisory findings with respect to incentive compensation will be incorporated, as appropriate, into the organization’s supervisory ratings, which can affect its ability to make acquisitions or perform other actions. The guidance also provides that enforcement actions may be taken against a banking organization if its incentive compensation arrangements or related risk management, control or governance processes pose a risk to the organization’s safety and soundness.

The FSB has released standards for local regulators to implement certain compensation principles for banks and other financial companies designed to encourage sound compensation practices. In the E.U., the CRR and CRD IV include compensation provisions designed to implement the FSB’s compensation standards. These rules have been implemented by E.U. member states and, among other things, limit the ratio of variable to fixed compensation of certain employees, including those identified as having a material impact on the risk profile of E.U.-regulated entities, including GSI.

The E.U. has also introduced rules regulating compensation for certain persons providing services to certain investment funds. These requirements are in addition to the guidance issued by U.S. financial regulators described above and the Dodd-Frank Act provision described below.

The Dodd-Frank Act requires the U.S. financial regulators, including the FRB and SEC, to adopt rules on incentive-based payment arrangements at specified regulated entities having at least $1 billion in total assets (including Group Inc. and some of its depository institution, broker-dealer and investment adviser subsidiaries). The U.S. financial regulators proposed revised rules in 2016, which have not been finalized.

In October 2016, the NYDFS issued guidance emphasizing that its regulated banking institutions, including GS Bank USA, must ensure that any incentive compensation arrangements tied to employee performance indicators are subject to effective risk management, oversight and control.

Anti-Money Laundering and Anti-Bribery Rules and Regulations

The U.S. Bank Secrecy Act (BSA), as amended by the USA PATRIOT Act of 2001 (PATRIOT Act), contains anti-money laundering and financial transparency laws and mandated the implementation of various regulations applicable to all financial institutions, including standards for verifying client identification at account opening, and obligations to monitor client transactions and report suspicious activities. Through these and other provisions, the BSA and the PATRIOT Act seek to promote the identification of parties that may be involved in terrorism, money laundering or other suspicious activities. Anti-money laundering laws outside the U.S. contain some similar provisions.

In addition, we are subject to laws and regulations worldwide, including the U.S. Foreign Corrupt Practices Act and the U.K. Bribery Act, relating to corrupt and illegal payments to, and hiring practices with regard to, government officials and others. The scope of the types of payments or other benefits covered by these laws is very broad and regulators are frequently using enforcement proceedings to define the scope of these laws. The obligation of financial institutions, including Goldman Sachs, to identify their clients, to monitor for and report suspicious transactions, to monitor direct and indirect payments to government officials, to respond to requests for information by regulatory authorities and law enforcement agencies, and to share information with other financial institutions, has required the implementation and maintenance of internal practices, procedures and controls.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   19


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

Privacy and Cyber Security Regulation

Certain of our businesses are subject to laws and regulations enacted by U.S. federal and state governments, the E.U. or other non-U.S. jurisdictions and/or enacted by various regulatory organizations or exchanges relating to the privacy of the information of clients, employees or others, including the GLB Act, the E.U. Data Protection Directive, the Japanese Personal Information Protection Act, the Hong Kong Personal Data (Privacy) Ordinance, the Australian Privacy Act and the Brazilian Bank Secrecy Law. Effective May 25, 2018, the E.U. Data Protection Directive will be replaced by a more extensive General Data Protection Regulation (GDPR). Compared to the current directive, the GDPR will, among other things, increase compliance obligations, have a significant impact on our businesses’ collection, processing and retention of personal data and reporting of data breaches, and provide for significantly increased penalties for non-compliance.

The NYDFS also requires financial institutions regulated by the NYDFS, including GS Bank USA, to, among other things, (i) establish and maintain a cyber security program designed to ensure the confidentiality, integrity and availability of their information systems; (ii) implement and maintain a written cyber security policy setting forth policies and procedures for the protection of their information systems and nonpublic information; and (iii) designate a Chief Information Security Officer. In addition, in October 2016, the U.S. federal bank regulatory agencies issued an advance notice of proposed rulemaking on potential enhanced cyber risk management standards for large financial institutions.

Other Regulation

U.S. and non-U.S. government agencies, regulatory bodies and self-regulatory organizations, as well as state securities commissions and other state regulators in the U.S., are empowered to conduct administrative proceedings that can result in censure, fine, the issuance of cease-and-desist orders, or the suspension or expulsion of a regulated entity or its directors, officers or employees. In particular, state attorneys general have become much more active in seeking fines and penalties in enforcement led by the federal regulators. In addition, a number of our other activities require us to obtain licenses, adhere to applicable regulations and be subject to the oversight of various regulators in the jurisdictions in which we conduct these activities.

MiFID II, which became effective on January 3, 2018, includes extensive market structure reforms, such as the establishment of new trading venue categories for the purposes of discharging the obligation to trade OTC derivatives on a trading platform and enhanced pre- and post-trade transparency covering a wider range of financial instruments. In equities, MiFID II introduced volume caps on non-transparent liquidity trading for trading venues, limited the use of broker-dealer crossing networks and created a new regime for systematic internalizers, which are investment firms that execute client transactions outside a trading venue.

Additional controls were introduced for algorithmic trading, high frequency trading and direct electronic access. Commodities trading firms are required to calculate their positions and adhere to specific limits. Other reforms introduced enhanced transaction reporting, the publication of best execution data by investment firms and trading venues, transparency on costs and charges of service to investors, changes to the way investment managers can pay for the receipt of investment research and mandatory unbundling for broker-dealers between execution and other major services.

On October 26, 2017, the SEC staff issued guidance permitting U.S. broker-dealers to comply with MiFID II without being subject to conflicting U.S. regulation or other adverse U.S. regulatory effects.

The E.U. and national financial legislators and regulators in the E.U. have proposed or adopted numerous further market reforms that may impact our businesses, including heightened corporate governance standards for financial institutions, rules on key information documents for packaged retail and insurance-based investment products and rules on indices that are used as benchmarks for financial instruments or funds. In addition, the European Commission, ESMA and the European Banking Authority have announced or are formulating regulatory standards and other measures which will impact our European operations. Certain of our European subsidiaries are also regulated by the securities, derivatives and commodities exchanges of which they are members.

As described above, many of our subsidiaries are subject to regulatory capital requirements in jurisdictions throughout the world. Subsidiaries not subject to separate regulation may hold capital to satisfy local tax guidelines, rating agency requirements or internal policies, including policies concerning the minimum amount of capital a subsidiary should hold based upon its underlying risk.

 

 

20   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

Available Information

 

Our internet address is www.gs.com and the investor relations section of our website is located at www.gs.com/shareholders. We make available free of charge through the investor relations section of our website, annual reports on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q and current reports on Form 8-K and amendments to those reports filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the U.S. Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (Exchange Act), as well as proxy statements, as soon as reasonably practicable after we electronically file such material with, or furnish it to, the SEC.

Also posted on our website, and available in print upon request of any shareholder to our Investor Relations Department, are our certificate of incorporation and by-laws, charters for our Audit Committee, Risk Committee, Compensation Committee, Corporate Governance and Nominating Committee, and Public Responsibilities Committee, our Policy Regarding Director Independence Determinations, our Policy on Reporting of Concerns Regarding Accounting and Other Matters, our Corporate Governance Guidelines and our Code of Business Conduct and Ethics governing our directors, officers and employees. Within the time period required by the SEC, we will post on our website any amendment to the Code of Business Conduct and Ethics and any waiver applicable to any executive officer, director or senior financial officer.

In addition, our website includes information concerning:

 

 

Purchases and sales of our equity securities by our executive officers and directors;

 

 

Disclosure relating to certain non-GAAP financial measures (as defined in the SEC’s Regulation G) that we may make public orally, telephonically, by webcast, by broadcast or by other means from time to time;

 

 

Dodd-Frank Act stress test results;

 

 

The public portion of our resolution plan submission;

 

 

Our risk management practices and regulatory capital ratios, as required under the disclosure-related provisions of the Capital Framework, which are based on the third pillar of Basel III; and

 

 

Our quarterly average LCR.

Our Investor Relations Department can be contacted at The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc., 200 West Street, 29th Floor, New York, New York 10282, Attn: Investor Relations, telephone: 212-902-0300, e-mail: gs-investor-relations@gs.com.

From time to time, we use our website, our Twitter account (twitter.com/GoldmanSachs) and other social media channels as additional means of disclosing public information to investors, the media and others interested in Goldman Sachs. It is possible that certain information we post on our website and on social media could be deemed to be material information, and we encourage investors, the media and others interested in Goldman Sachs to review the business and financial information we post on our website and on the social media channels identified above. The information on our website and our social media channels is not incorporated by reference into this Form 10-K.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   21


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

Cautionary Statement Pursuant to the U.S. Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995

    

 

We have included or incorporated by reference in this Form 10-K, and from time to time our management may make, statements that may constitute “forward-looking statements” within the meaning of the safe harbor provisions of the U.S. Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. Forward-looking statements are not historical facts, but instead represent only our beliefs regarding future events, many of which, by their nature, are inherently uncertain and outside our control.

These statements include statements other than historical information or statements of current conditions and may relate to our future plans and objectives and results, among other things, and may also include statements about the effect of changes to the capital, leverage, liquidity, long-term debt and total loss-absorbing capacity rules applicable to banks and BHCs, the impact of the Dodd-Frank Act on our businesses and operations, and various legal proceedings, governmental investigations or mortgage-related contingencies as set forth in Notes 27 and 18, respectively, to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of this Form 10-K, as well as statements about the results of our Dodd-Frank Act and firm stress tests, statements about the objectives and effectiveness of our business continuity plan, information security program, risk management and liquidity policies, statements about our resolution plan and resolution strategy and their implications for our debtholders and other stakeholders, statements about the design and effectiveness of our resolution capital and liquidity models and our triggers and alerts framework, statements about trends in or growth opportunities for our businesses, statements about our future status, activities or reporting under U.S. or non-U.S. banking and financial regulation, statements about our investment banking transaction backlog, statements about the estimated effects of the Tax Cuts and Jobs Act (Tax Legislation), statements about our average LCR and statements about our strategic growth initiatives.

By identifying these statements for you in this manner, we are alerting you to the possibility that our actual results and financial condition may differ, possibly materially, from the anticipated results and financial condition indicated in these forward-looking statements. Important factors that could cause our actual results and financial condition to differ from those indicated in these forward-looking statements include, among others, those described below and in “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of this Form 10-K.

Statements about our investment banking transaction backlog are subject to the risk that the terms of these transactions may be modified or that they may not be completed at all; therefore, the net revenues, if any, that we actually earn from these transactions may differ, possibly materially, from those currently expected. Important factors that could result in a modification of the terms of a transaction or a transaction not being completed include, in the case of underwriting transactions, a decline or continued weakness in general economic conditions, outbreak of hostilities, volatility in the securities markets generally or an adverse development with respect to the issuer of the securities and, in the case of financial advisory transactions, a decline in the securities markets, an inability to obtain adequate financing, an adverse development with respect to a party to the transaction or a failure to obtain a required regulatory approval. For information about other important factors that could adversely affect our investment banking transactions, see “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of this Form 10-K.

Statements about the estimated effects of Tax Legislation are based on our current calculations, as well as our current interpretations, assumptions and expectations relating to Tax Legislation, which are subject to further guidance and change. The impact of Tax Legislation may differ from our estimates, possibly materially, due to, among other things, (i) refinement of our calculations based on updated information, (ii) changes in interpretations and assumptions, (iii) guidance that may be issued and (iv) actions we may take as a result of Tax Legislation.

Statements about our strategic growth initiatives are subject to the risk that our businesses may be unable to generate incremental revenues or pre-tax earnings or take advantage of growth opportunities. It is possible that our actual results, including the incremental revenues and pre-tax earnings, if any, from such initiatives, and financial condition, may differ, possibly materially, from the anticipated results, financial condition and incremental revenues and pre-tax earnings indicated in these forward-looking statements.

 

 

22   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

We have provided in this filing information regarding our capital, liquidity and leverage ratios, including our NSFR. The statements with respect to these ratios are forward-looking statements, based on our current interpretation, expectations and understandings of the relevant regulatory rules, guidance and proposals, and reflect significant assumptions concerning the treatment of various assets and liabilities and the manner in which the ratios are calculated. As a result, the methods used to calculate these ratios may differ, possibly materially, from those used in calculating our and, where applicable, GS Bank USA’s capital, liquidity and leverage ratios for any future disclosures. The ultimate methods of calculating the ratios will depend on, among other things, implementation guidance or further rulemaking from the U.S. federal bank regulatory agencies and the development of market practices and standards.

Item 1A.    Risk Factors

We face a variety of risks that are substantial and inherent in our businesses, including market, liquidity, credit, operational, legal, regulatory and reputational risks. The following are some of the more important factors that could affect our businesses.

Our businesses have been and may continue to be adversely affected by conditions in the global financial markets and economic conditions generally.

Our businesses, by their nature, do not produce predictable earnings, and all of our businesses are materially affected by conditions in the global financial markets and economic conditions generally, both directly and through their impact on client activity levels. These conditions can change suddenly and negatively.

Our financial performance is highly dependent on the environment in which our businesses operate. A favorable business environment is generally characterized by, among other factors, high global gross domestic product growth, regulatory and market conditions which result in transparent, liquid and efficient capital markets, low inflation, high business and investor confidence, stable geopolitical conditions, clear regulations and strong business earnings.

Unfavorable or uncertain economic and market conditions can be caused by: concerns about sovereign defaults; uncertainty concerning fiscal or monetary policy, government debt ceilings or funding; the extent of and uncertainty about tax and other regulatory changes; declines in economic growth, business activity or investor or business confidence; limitations on the availability or increases in the cost of credit and capital; illiquid markets; increases in inflation, interest rates, exchange rate or basic commodity price volatility or default rates; outbreaks of domestic or international tensions or hostilities, terrorism, nuclear proliferation, cybersecurity threats or attacks and other forms of disruption to or curtailment of global communication, energy transmission or transportation networks or other geopolitical instability or uncertainty, such as Brexit; corporate, political or other scandals that reduce investor confidence in capital markets; extreme weather events or other natural disasters or pandemics; or a combination of these or other factors.

The financial services industry and the securities markets have been materially and adversely affected in the past by significant declines in the values of nearly all asset classes and by a serious lack of liquidity. In addition, concerns about European sovereign debt risk and its impact on the European banking system, about the impact of Brexit, and about changes in interest rates and other market conditions or actual changes in interest rates and other market conditions, including market conditions in China, have resulted, at times, in significant volatility while negatively impacting the levels of client activity.

General uncertainty about economic, political and market activities, and the scope, timing and impact of regulatory reform, as well as weak consumer, investor and CEO confidence resulting in large part from such uncertainty, continues to negatively impact client activity, which adversely affects many of our businesses. Periods of low volatility and periods of high volatility combined with a lack of liquidity, have at times had an unfavorable impact on our market-making businesses.

Our revenues and profitability and those of our competitors have been and will continue to be impacted by requirements relating to capital, additional loss-absorbing capacity, leverage, minimum liquidity and long-term funding levels, requirements related to resolution and recovery planning, derivatives clearing and margin rules and levels of regulatory oversight, as well as limitations on which and, if permitted, how certain business activities may be carried out by financial institutions.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   23


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

Although interest rates are still near historically low levels, financial institution returns in many countries have also been negatively impacted by increased funding costs due in part to the withdrawal of perceived government support of such institutions in the event of future financial crises. In addition, liquidity in the financial markets has also been negatively impacted as market participants and market practices and structures continue to adjust to new regulations.

The degree to which these and other changes resulting from the financial crisis will have a long-term impact on the profitability of financial institutions will depend on the implementation of recently adopted and new regulations, the manner in which markets, market participants and financial institutions adapt to these regulations, and the prevailing economic and financial market conditions. However, there is a significant risk that such changes will, at least in the near term, continue to negatively impact the absolute level of revenues, profitability and return on equity at our firm and at other financial institutions.

Our businesses and those of our clients are subject to extensive and pervasive regulation around the world.

As a participant in the financial services industry and a systemically important financial institution, we are subject to extensive regulation in jurisdictions around the world. We face the risk of significant intervention by law enforcement, regulatory and taxing authorities, as well as private litigation, in all jurisdictions in which we conduct our businesses. In many cases, our activities may be subject to overlapping and divergent regulation in different jurisdictions. Among other things, as a result of law enforcement authorities, regulators or private parties challenging our compliance with existing laws and regulations, we or our employees could be fined or criminally sanctioned, prohibited from engaging in some of our business activities, subject to limitations or conditions on our business activities, including higher capital requirements, or subjected to new or substantially higher taxes or other governmental charges in connection with the conduct of our businesses or with respect to our employees. Such limitations or conditions may limit our business activities and negatively impact our profitability.

In addition to the impact on the scope and profitability of our business activities, day-to-day compliance with existing laws and regulations, in particular those adopted since 2008, has involved and will, except to the extent that some of such regulations are eventually modified or otherwise repealed, continue to involve significant amounts of time, including that of our senior leaders and that of a large number of dedicated compliance and other reporting and operational personnel, all of which may negatively impact our profitability.

If there are new laws or regulations or changes in the enforcement of existing laws or regulations applicable to our businesses or those of our clients, including capital, liquidity, leverage, long-term debt, total loss-absorbing capacity and margin requirements, restrictions on leveraged lending or other business practices, reporting requirements, requirements relating to recovery and resolution planning, tax burdens and compensation restrictions, that are imposed on a limited subset of financial institutions (either based on size, activities, geography or other criteria), compliance with these new laws or regulations, or changes in the enforcement of existing laws or regulations, could adversely affect our ability to compete effectively with other institutions that are not affected in the same way. In addition, regulation imposed on financial institutions or market participants generally, such as taxes on financial transactions, could adversely impact levels of market activity more broadly, and thus impact our businesses.

These developments could impact our profitability in the affected jurisdictions, or even make it uneconomic for us to continue to conduct all or certain of our businesses in such jurisdictions, or could cause us to incur significant costs associated with changing our business practices, restructuring our businesses, moving all or certain of our businesses and our employees to other locations or complying with applicable capital requirements, including liquidating assets or raising capital in a manner that adversely increases our funding costs or otherwise adversely affects our shareholders and creditors.

U.S. and non-U.S. regulatory developments, in particular the Dodd-Frank Act and Basel III, have significantly altered the regulatory framework within which we operate and have adversely affected and may in the future affect our profitability.

Among the aspects of the Dodd-Frank Act that have affected or may in the future affect our businesses are: increased capital, liquidity and reporting requirements; limitations on activities in which we may engage; increased regulation of and restrictions on OTC derivatives markets and transactions; limitations on incentive compensation; limitations on affiliate transactions; requirements to reorganize or limit activities in connection with recovery and resolution planning; increased deposit insurance assessments; and increased standards of care for broker-dealers and investment advisers in dealing with clients. The implementation of higher capital requirements, the LCR, the NSFR, requirements relating to long-term debt and total loss-absorbing capacity and the prohibition on proprietary trading and the sponsorship of, or investment in, covered funds by the Volcker Rule may continue to adversely affect our profitability and competitive position, particularly if these requirements do not apply equally to our competitors or are not implemented uniformly across jurisdictions.

 

 

24   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

As described in “Business — Regulation — Banking Supervision and Regulation” in Part I, Item 1 of this Form 10-K, Group Inc.’s proposed capital actions and capital plan are reviewed by the FRB as part of the CCAR process. If the FRB objects to our proposed capital actions in our capital plan, Group Inc. could be prohibited from taking some or all of the proposed capital actions, including increasing or paying dividends on common or preferred stock or repurchasing common stock or other capital securities. Our inability to carry out our proposed capital actions could, among other things, prevent us from returning capital to our shareholders and impact our return on equity.

We are also subject to laws and regulations relating to the privacy of the information of clients, employees or others, and any failure to comply with these laws and regulations could expose us to liability and/or reputational damage. As new privacy-related laws and regulations, such as the GDPR, are implemented, the time and resources needed for us to comply with such laws and regulations, as well as our potential liability for non-compliance and reporting obligations in the case of data breaches, may significantly increase.

In addition, our businesses are increasingly subject to laws and regulations relating to surveillance, encryption and data on-shoring in the jurisdictions in which we operate. Compliance with these laws and regulations may require us to change our policies, procedures and technology for information security, which could, among other things, make us more vulnerable to cyber attacks and misappropriation, corruption or loss of information or technology.

We have recently entered new retail-oriented deposit-taking and lending businesses, and we currently expect to expand the product and geographic scope of our offerings. Entering into such new businesses, as with any new business, subjects us to numerous additional regulations in the jurisdictions in which these businesses operate. Not only are these regulations extensive, but they involve types of regulations and supervision, as well as regulatory compliance risks, that we have not previously encountered. The level of regulatory scrutiny and the scope of regulations affecting financial interactions with retail clients is often much greater than that associated with doing business with institutions and high-net-worth clients. Complying with such new regulations is time-consuming, costly and presents new and increased risks.

Increasingly, regulators and courts have sought to hold financial institutions liable for the misconduct of their clients where such regulators and courts have determined that the financial institution should have detected that the client was engaged in wrongdoing, even though the financial institution had no direct knowledge of the activities engaged in by its client. Regulators and courts have also increasingly found liability as a “control person” for activities of entities in which financial institutions or funds controlled by financial institutions have an investment, but which they do not actively manage. In addition, regulators and courts continue to seek to establish “fiduciary” obligations to counterparties to which no such duty had been assumed to exist. To the extent that such efforts are successful, the cost of, and liabilities associated with, engaging in brokerage, clearing, market-making, prime brokerage, investing and other similar activities could increase significantly. To the extent that we have fiduciary obligations in connection with acting as a financial adviser, investment adviser or in other roles for individual, institutional, sovereign or investment fund clients, any breach, or even an alleged breach, of such obligations could have materially negative legal, regulatory and reputational consequences.

For information about the extensive regulation to which our businesses are subject, see “Business — Regulation” in Part I, Item 1 of this Form 10-K.

Our businesses have been and may be adversely affected by declining asset values. This is particularly true for those businesses in which we have net “long” positions, receive fees based on the value of assets managed, or receive or post collateral.

Many of our businesses have net “long” positions in debt securities, loans, derivatives, mortgages, equities (including private equity and real estate) and most other asset classes. These include positions we take when we act as a principal to facilitate our clients’ activities, including our exchange-based market-making activities, or commit large amounts of capital to maintain positions in interest rate and credit products, as well as through our currencies, commodities, equities and mortgage-related activities. In addition, we invest in similar asset classes. Substantially all of our investing and market-making positions and a portion of our loans are marked-to-market on a daily basis and declines in asset values directly and immediately impact our earnings, unless we have effectively “hedged” our exposures to such declines.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   25


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

In certain circumstances (particularly in the case of credit products, including leveraged loans, and private equities or other securities that are not freely tradable or lack established and liquid trading markets), it may not be possible or economic to hedge such exposures and to the extent that we do so the hedge may be ineffective or may greatly reduce our ability to profit from increases in the values of the assets. Sudden declines and significant volatility in the prices of assets may substantially curtail or eliminate the trading markets for certain assets, which may make it difficult to sell, hedge or value such assets. The inability to sell or effectively hedge assets reduces our ability to limit losses in such positions and the difficulty in valuing assets may negatively affect our capital, liquidity or leverage ratios, increase our funding costs and generally require us to maintain additional capital.

In our exchange-based market-making activities, we are obligated by stock exchange rules to maintain an orderly market, including by purchasing securities in a declining market. In markets where asset values are declining and in volatile markets, this results in losses and an increased need for liquidity.

We receive asset-based management fees based on the value of our clients’ portfolios or investment in funds managed by us and, in some cases, we also receive incentive fees based on increases in the value of such investments. Declines in asset values reduce the value of our clients’ portfolios or fund assets, which in turn reduce the fees we earn for managing such assets.

We post collateral to support our obligations and receive collateral to support the obligations of our clients and counterparties in connection with our client execution businesses. When the value of the assets posted as collateral or the credit ratings of the party posting collateral decline, the party posting the collateral may need to provide additional collateral or, if possible, reduce its trading position. An example of such a situation is a “margin call” in connection with a brokerage account. Therefore, declines in the value of asset classes used as collateral mean that either the cost of funding positions is increased or the size of positions is decreased.

If we are the party providing collateral, this can increase our costs and reduce our profitability and if we are the party receiving collateral, this can also reduce our profitability by reducing the level of business done with our clients and counterparties. In addition, volatile or less liquid markets increase the difficulty of valuing assets, which can lead to costly and time-consuming disputes over asset values and the level of required collateral, as well as increased credit risk to the recipient of the collateral due to delays in receiving adequate collateral. In cases where we foreclose on collateral, sudden declines in the value or liquidity of such collateral may, despite credit monitoring, over-collateralization, the ability to call for additional collateral or the ability to force repayment of the underlying obligation, result in significant losses to us, especially where there is a single type of collateral supporting the obligation. In addition, we have been, and may in the future be, subject to claims that the foreclosure was not permitted under the legal documents, was conducted in an improper manner or caused a client or counterparty to go out of business.

Our businesses have been and may be adversely affected by disruptions in the credit markets, including reduced access to credit and higher costs of obtaining credit.

Widening credit spreads, as well as significant declines in the availability of credit, have in the past adversely affected our ability to borrow on a secured and unsecured basis and may do so in the future. We fund ourselves on an unsecured basis by issuing long-term debt, by accepting deposits at our bank subsidiaries, by issuing hybrid financial instruments or by obtaining loans or lines of credit from commercial or other banking entities. We seek to finance many of our assets on a secured basis. Any disruptions in the credit markets may make it harder and more expensive to obtain funding for our businesses. If our available funding is limited or we are forced to fund our operations at a higher cost, these conditions may require us to curtail our business activities and increase our cost of funding, both of which could reduce our profitability, particularly in our businesses that involve investing, lending and market making.

Our clients engaging in mergers, acquisitions and other types of strategic transactions often rely on access to the secured and unsecured credit markets to finance their transactions. A lack of available credit or an increased cost of credit can adversely affect the size, volume and timing of our clients’ merger and acquisition transactions, particularly large transactions, and adversely affect our financial advisory and underwriting businesses.

 

 

26   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

Our credit businesses have been and may in the future be negatively affected by a lack of liquidity in credit markets. A lack of liquidity reduces price transparency, increases price volatility and decreases transaction volumes and size, all of which can increase transaction risk or decrease the profitability of such businesses.

Our market-making activities have been and may be affected by changes in the levels of market volatility.

Certain of our market-making activities depend on market volatility to provide trading and arbitrage opportunities to our clients, and decreases in volatility have reduced and may continue to reduce these opportunities and the level of client activity associated with them and adversely affect the results of these activities. On the other hand, increased volatility, while it can increase trading volumes and spreads, also increases risk as measured by Value-at-Risk (VaR) and may expose us to increased risks in connection with our market-making activities or cause us to reduce our market-making inventory in order to avoid increasing our VaR. Limiting the size of our market-making positions can adversely affect our profitability. In periods when volatility is increasing, but asset values are declining significantly, it may not be possible to sell assets at all or it may only be possible to do so at steep discounts. In such circumstances we may be forced to either take on additional risk or to realize losses in order to decrease our VaR. In addition, increases in volatility increase the level of our RWAs, which increases our capital requirements.

Our investment banking, client execution and investment management businesses have been adversely affected and may in the future be adversely affected by market uncertainty or lack of confidence among investors and CEOs due to general declines in economic activity and other unfavorable economic, geopolitical or market conditions.

Our investment banking business has been, and may in the future be, adversely affected by market conditions. Poor economic conditions and other adverse geopolitical conditions can adversely affect and have in the past adversely affected investor and CEO confidence, resulting in significant industry-wide declines in the size and number of underwritings and of financial advisory transactions, which could have an adverse effect on our revenues and our profit margins. In particular, because a significant portion of our investment banking revenues is derived from our participation in large transactions, a decline in the number of large transactions would adversely affect our investment banking business.

In certain circumstances, market uncertainty or general declines in market or economic activity may affect our client execution businesses by decreasing levels of overall activity or by decreasing volatility, but at other times market uncertainty and even declining economic activity may result in higher trading volumes or higher spreads or both.

Market uncertainty, volatility and adverse economic conditions, as well as declines in asset values, may cause our clients to transfer their assets out of our funds or other products or their brokerage accounts and result in reduced net revenues, principally in our investment management business. To the extent that clients do not withdraw their funds, they may invest them in products that generate less fee income.

Our investment management business may be affected by the poor investment performance of our investment products or a client preference for products other than those which we offer or for products that generate lower fees.

Poor investment returns in our investment management business, due to either general market conditions or underperformance (relative to our competitors or to benchmarks) by funds or accounts that we manage or investment products that we design or sell, affects our ability to retain existing assets and to attract new clients or additional assets from existing clients. This could affect the management and incentive fees that we earn on assets under supervision or the commissions and net spreads that we earn for selling other investment products, such as structured notes or derivatives. To the extent that our clients choose to invest in products that we do not currently offer, we will suffer outflows and a loss of management fees. Further, if, due to changes in investor sentiment or the relative performance of certain asset classes or otherwise, clients invest in products that generate lower fees, our investment management business could be adversely affected.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   27


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

We may incur losses as a result of ineffective risk management processes and strategies.

We seek to monitor and control our risk exposure through a risk and control framework encompassing a variety of separate but complementary financial, credit, operational, compliance and legal reporting systems, internal controls, management review processes and other mechanisms. Our risk management process seeks to balance our ability to profit from market-making, investing or lending positions, and underwriting activities, with our exposure to potential losses. While we employ a broad and diversified set of risk monitoring and risk mitigation techniques, those techniques and the judgments that accompany their application cannot anticipate every economic and financial outcome or the specifics and timing of such outcomes. Thus, we may, in the course of our activities, incur losses. Market conditions in recent years have involved unprecedented dislocations and highlight the limitations inherent in using historical data to manage risk.

The models that we use to assess and control our risk exposures reflect assumptions about the degrees of correlation or lack thereof among prices of various asset classes or other market indicators. In times of market stress or other unforeseen circumstances, such as those that occurred during 2008 and early 2009, and to some extent since 2011, previously uncorrelated indicators may become correlated, or conversely previously correlated indicators may move in different directions. These types of market movements have at times limited the effectiveness of our hedging strategies and have caused us to incur significant losses, and they may do so in the future. These changes in correlation can be exacerbated where other market participants are using risk or trading models with assumptions or algorithms that are similar to ours. In these and other cases, it may be difficult to reduce our risk positions due to the activity of other market participants or widespread market dislocations, including circumstances where asset values are declining significantly or no market exists for certain assets.

In addition, the use of models in connection with risk management and numerous other critical activities presents risks that such models may be ineffective, either because of poor design or ineffective testing, improper or flawed inputs, as well as unpermitted access to such models resulting in unapproved or malicious changes to the model or its inputs.

To the extent that we have positions through our market-making or origination activities or we make investments directly through our investing activities, including private equity, that do not have an established liquid trading market or are otherwise subject to restrictions on sale or hedging, we may not be able to reduce our positions and therefore reduce our risk associated with such positions. In addition, to the extent permitted by applicable law and regulation, we invest our own capital in private equity, credit, real estate and hedge funds that we manage and limitations on our ability to withdraw some or all of our investments in these funds, whether for legal, reputational or other reasons, may make it more difficult for us to control the risk exposures relating to these investments.

Prudent risk management, as well as regulatory restrictions, may cause us to limit our exposure to counterparties, geographic areas or markets, which may limit our business opportunities and increase the cost of our funding or hedging activities.

As we have recently expanded and intend to continue to expand the product and geographic scope of our offerings of credit products to retail clients, we are presented with different credit risks and must expand and adapt our credit risk monitoring and mitigation activities to account for these new business activities. A failure to adequately assess and control such risk exposures could result in losses to us.

For further information about our risk management policies and procedures, see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Risk Management” in Part II, Item 7 of this Form 10-K.

Our liquidity, profitability and businesses may be adversely affected by an inability to access the debt capital markets or to sell assets or by a reduction in our credit ratings or by an increase in our credit spreads.

Liquidity is essential to our businesses. Our liquidity may be impaired by an inability to access secured and/or unsecured debt markets, an inability to access funds from our subsidiaries or otherwise allocate liquidity optimally across our firm, an inability to sell assets or redeem our investments, or unforeseen outflows of cash or collateral. This situation may arise due to circumstances that we may be unable to control, such as a general market disruption or an operational problem that affects third parties or us, or even by the perception among market participants that we, or other market participants, are experiencing greater liquidity risk.

 

 

28   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

We employ structured products to benefit our clients and hedge our own risks. The financial instruments that we hold and the contracts to which we are a party are often complex, and these complex structured products often do not have readily available markets to access in times of liquidity stress. Our investing and lending activities may lead to situations where the holdings from these activities represent a significant portion of specific markets, which could restrict liquidity for our positions.

Further, our ability to sell assets may be impaired if there is not generally a liquid market for such assets, as well as in circumstances where other market participants are seeking to sell similar otherwise generally liquid assets at the same time, as is likely to occur in a liquidity or other market crisis or in response to changes to rules or regulations. In addition, financial institutions with which we interact may exercise set-off rights or the right to require additional collateral, including in difficult market conditions, which could further impair our liquidity.

Our credit ratings are important to our liquidity. A reduction in our credit ratings could adversely affect our liquidity and competitive position, increase our borrowing costs, limit our access to the capital markets or trigger our obligations under certain provisions in some of our trading and collateralized financing contracts. Under these provisions, counterparties could be permitted to terminate contracts with us or require us to post additional collateral. Termination of our trading and collateralized financing contracts could cause us to sustain losses and impair our liquidity by requiring us to find other sources of financing or to make significant cash payments or securities movements.

As of December 2017, in the event of a one-notch and two-notch downgrade of our credit ratings our counterparties could have called for additional collateral or termination payments related to our net derivative liabilities under bilateral agreements in an aggregate amount of $358 million and $1.86 billion, respectively. A downgrade by any one rating agency, depending on the agency’s relative ratings of us at the time of the downgrade, may have an impact which is comparable to the impact of a downgrade by all rating agencies. For further information about our credit ratings, see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Risk Management — Liquidity Risk Management — Credit Ratings” in Part II, Item 7 of this Form 10-K.

Our cost of obtaining long-term unsecured funding is directly related to our credit spreads (the amount in excess of the interest rate of U.S. Treasury securities (or other benchmark securities) of the same maturity that we need to pay to our debt investors). Increases in our credit spreads can significantly increase our cost of this funding. Changes in credit spreads are continuous, market-driven, and subject at times to unpredictable and highly volatile movements. Our credit spreads are also influenced by market perceptions of our creditworthiness. In addition, our credit spreads may be influenced by movements in the costs to purchasers of credit default swaps referenced to our long-term debt. The market for credit default swaps has proven to be extremely volatile and at times has lacked a high degree of transparency or liquidity.

Regulatory changes relating to liquidity may also negatively impact our results of operations and competitive position. Recently, numerous regulations have been adopted or proposed to introduce more stringent liquidity requirements for large financial institutions. These regulations address, among other matters, liquidity stress testing, minimum liquidity requirements, wholesale funding, limitations on the issuance of short-term debt and structured notes and prohibitions on parent guarantees that are subject to certain cross-defaults. New and prospective liquidity-related regulations may overlap with, and be impacted by, other regulatory changes, including new rules relating to minimum long-term debt requirements and TLAC, guidance on the treatment of brokered deposits and the capital, leverage and resolution and recovery frameworks applicable to large financial institutions. Given the overlap and complex interactions among these new and prospective regulations, they may have unintended cumulative effects, and their full impact will remain uncertain until implementation of post-financial crisis regulatory reform is complete.

A failure to appropriately identify and address potential conflicts of interest could adversely affect our businesses.

Due to the broad scope of our businesses and our client base, we regularly address potential conflicts of interest, including situations where our services to a particular client or our own investments or other interests conflict, or are perceived to conflict, with the interests of another client, as well as situations where one or more of our businesses have access to material non-public information that may not be shared with our other businesses and situations where we may be a creditor of an entity with which we also have an advisory or other relationship.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   29


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

In addition, our status as a BHC subjects us to heightened regulation and increased regulatory scrutiny by the FRB with respect to transactions between GS Bank USA and entities that are or could be viewed as affiliates of ours and, under the Volcker Rule, transactions between Goldman Sachs and certain covered funds.

We have extensive procedures and controls that are designed to identify and address conflicts of interest, including those designed to prevent the improper sharing of information among our businesses. However, appropriately identifying and dealing with conflicts of interest is complex and difficult, and our reputation, which is one of our most important assets, could be damaged and the willingness of clients to enter into transactions with us may be affected if we fail, or appear to fail, to identify, disclose and deal appropriately with conflicts of interest. In addition, potential or perceived conflicts could give rise to litigation or regulatory enforcement actions.

A failure in our operational systems or infrastructure, or those of third parties, as well as human error, could impair our liquidity, disrupt our businesses, result in the disclosure of confidential information, damage our reputation and cause losses.

Our businesses are highly dependent on our ability to process and monitor, on a daily basis, a very large number of transactions, many of which are highly complex and occur at high volumes and frequencies, across numerous and diverse markets in many currencies. These transactions, as well as the information technology services we provide to clients, often must adhere to client-specific guidelines, as well as legal and regulatory standards.

Many rules and regulations worldwide govern our obligations to report transactions and other information to regulators, exchanges and investors. Compliance with these legal and reporting requirements can be challenging, and we have been, and may in the future be, subject to regulatory fines and penalties for failing to report timely, accurate and complete information. As reporting requirements expand, compliance with these rules and regulations has become more challenging.

As our client base and our geographical reach expand and the volume, speed, frequency and complexity of transactions, especially electronic transactions (as well as the requirements to report such transactions on a real-time basis to clients, regulators and exchanges) increase, developing and maintaining our operational systems and infrastructure becomes more challenging, and the risk of systems or human error in connection with such transactions increases, as well as the potential consequences of such errors due to the speed and volume of transactions involved and the potential difficulty associated with discovering such errors quickly enough to limit the resulting consequences.

Our financial, accounting, data processing or other operational systems and facilities may fail to operate properly or become disabled as a result of events that are wholly or partially beyond our control, such as a spike in transaction volume, adversely affecting our ability to process these transactions or provide these services. We must continuously update these systems to support our operations and growth and to respond to changes in regulations and markets, and invest heavily in systemic controls and training to ensure that such transactions do not violate applicable rules and regulations or, due to errors in processing such transactions, adversely affect markets, our clients and counterparties or us.

Enhancements and updates to systems, as well as the requisite training, including in connection with the integration of new businesses, entail significant costs and create risks associated with implementing new systems and integrating them with existing ones.

The use of computing devices and phones is critical to the work done by our employees and the operation of our systems and businesses and those of our clients and our third-party service providers and vendors. It has been reported that there are some fundamental security flaws in computer chips found in many types of these computing devices and phones. Addressing this issue could be costly and affect the performance of these businesses and systems, and operational risks may be incurred in applying fixes and there may still be residual security risks.

Additionally, although the prevalence and scope of applications of distributed ledger technology and similar technologies is growing, the technology is also nascent and may be vulnerable to cyber attacks or have other inherent weaknesses. We may be, or may become, exposed to risks related to distributed ledger technology through our facilitation of clients’ activities involving financial products linked to distributed ledger technology, such as blockchain or cryptocurrencies, our investments in companies that seek to develop platforms based on distributed ledger technology, and the use of distributed ledger technology by third-party vendors, clients, counterparties, clearing houses and other financial intermediaries.

 

 

30   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

Notwithstanding the proliferation of technology and technology-based risk and control systems, our businesses ultimately rely on people as our greatest resource, and, from time-to-time, they make mistakes that are not always caught immediately by our technological processes or by our other procedures which are intended to prevent and detect such errors. These can include calculation errors, mistakes in addressing emails, errors in software or model development or implementation, or simple errors in judgment. We strive to eliminate such human errors through training, supervision, technology and by redundant processes and controls. Human errors, even if promptly discovered and remediated, can result in material losses and liabilities for us.

In addition, we face the risk of operational failure, termination or capacity constraints of any of the clearing agents, exchanges, clearing houses or other financial intermediaries we use to facilitate our securities and derivatives transactions, and as our interconnectivity with our clients grows, we increasingly face the risk of operational failure with respect to our clients’ systems.

In recent years, there has been significant consolidation among clearing agents, exchanges and clearing houses and an increasing number of derivative transactions are now or in the near future will be cleared on exchanges, which has increased our exposure to operational failure, termination or capacity constraints of the particular financial intermediaries that we use and could affect our ability to find adequate and cost-effective alternatives in the event of any such failure, termination or constraint. Industry consolidation, whether among market participants or financial intermediaries, increases the risk of operational failure as disparate complex systems need to be integrated, often on an accelerated basis.

Furthermore, the interconnectivity of multiple financial institutions with central agents, exchanges and clearing houses, and the increased centrality of these entities, increases the risk that an operational failure at one institution or entity may cause an industry-wide operational failure that could materially impact our ability to conduct business. Any such failure, termination or constraint could adversely affect our ability to effect transactions, service our clients, manage our exposure to risk or expand our businesses or result in financial loss or liability to our clients, impairment of our liquidity, disruption of our businesses, regulatory intervention or reputational damage.

Despite the resiliency plans and facilities we have in place, our ability to conduct business may be adversely impacted by a disruption in the infrastructure that supports our businesses and the communities in which we are located. This may include a disruption involving electrical, satellite, undersea cable or other communications, internet, transportation or other services facilities used by us, our employees or third parties with which we conduct business, including cloud service providers. These disruptions may occur as a result of events that affect only our buildings or systems or those of such third parties, or as a result of events with a broader impact globally, regionally or in the cities where those buildings or systems are located, including, but not limited to, natural disasters, war, civil unrest, terrorism, economic or political developments, pandemics and weather events.

In addition, although we seek to diversify our third-party vendors to increase our resiliency, we are also exposed to the risk that a disruption or other information technology event at a common service provider to our vendors could impede their ability to provide products or services to us. We may not be able to effectively monitor or mitigate operational risks relating to our vendors’ use of common service providers.

Nearly all of our employees in our primary locations, including the New York metropolitan area, London, Bengaluru, Hong Kong, Tokyo and Salt Lake City, work in close proximity to one another, in one or more buildings. Notwithstanding our efforts to maintain business continuity, given that our headquarters and the largest concentration of our employees are in the New York metropolitan area, and our two principal office buildings in the New York area both are located on the waterfront of the Hudson River, depending on the intensity and longevity of the event, a catastrophic event impacting our New York metropolitan area offices, including a terrorist attack, extreme weather event or other hostile or catastrophic event, could negatively affect our business. If a disruption occurs in one location and our employees in that location are unable to occupy our offices or communicate with or travel to other locations, our ability to service and interact with our clients may suffer, and we may not be able to successfully implement contingency plans that depend on communication or travel.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   31


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

A failure to protect our computer systems, networks and information, and our clients’ information, against cyber attacks and similar threats could impair our ability to conduct our businesses, result in the disclosure, theft or destruction of confidential information, damage our reputation and cause losses.

Our operations rely on the secure processing, storage and transmission of confidential and other information in our computer systems and networks. There have been a number of highly publicized cases involving financial services companies, consumer-based companies, governmental agencies and other organizations reporting the unauthorized disclosure of client, customer or other confidential information in recent years, as well as cyber attacks involving the dissemination, theft and destruction of corporate information or other assets, as a result of failure to follow procedures by employees or contractors or as a result of actions by third parties, including actions by foreign governments. There have also been several highly publicized cases where hackers have requested “ransom” payments in exchange for not disclosing customer information or for restoring access to information or systems.

We are regularly the target of attempted cyber attacks, including denial-of-service attacks, and must continuously monitor and develop our systems to protect our technology infrastructure and data from misappropriation or corruption. We may face an increasing number of attempted cyber attacks as we expand our mobile- and other internet-based products and services, as well as our usage of mobile and cloud technologies and as we provide more of these services to a greater number of individual retail customers. The increasing migration of firm communication and other platforms from firm-provided devices to employee-owned devices presents additional risks of cyber attacks. In addition, due to our interconnectivity with third-party vendors (and their respective service providers), central agents, exchanges, clearing houses and other financial institutions, we could be adversely impacted if any of them is subject to a successful cyber attack or other information security event. These effects could include the loss of access to information or services from the third party subject to the cyber attack or other information security event, which could, in turn, interrupt certain of our businesses.

Despite our efforts to ensure the integrity of our systems and information, we may not be able to anticipate, detect or implement effective preventive measures against all cyber threats, especially because the techniques used are increasingly sophisticated, change frequently and are often not recognized until launched. Cyber attacks can originate from a variety of sources, including third parties who are affiliated with foreign governments or are involved with organized crime or terrorist organizations. Third parties may also attempt to place individuals within the firm or induce employees, clients or other users of our systems to disclose sensitive information or provide access to our data or that of our clients, and these types of risks may be difficult to detect or prevent.

Although we take protective measures and endeavor to modify them as circumstances warrant, our computer systems, software and networks may be vulnerable to unauthorized access, misuse, computer viruses or other malicious code and other events that could have a security impact. Due to the complexity and interconnectedness of our systems, the process of enhancing our protective measures can itself create a risk of systems disruptions and security issues.

If one or more of such events occur, this potentially could jeopardize our or our clients’ or counterparties’ confidential and other information processed and stored in, and transmitted through, our computer systems and networks, or otherwise cause interruptions or malfunctions in our, our clients’, our counterparties’ or third parties’ operations, which could impact their ability to transact with us or otherwise result in legal or regulatory action, significant losses or reputational damage.

The increased use of mobile and cloud technologies can heighten these and other operational risks. We expect to expend significant additional resources on an ongoing basis to modify our protective measures and to investigate and remediate vulnerabilities or other exposures, but these measures may be ineffective and we may be subject to legal or regulatory action, and financial losses that are either not insured against or not fully covered through any insurance maintained by us. Certain aspects of the security of such technologies are unpredictable or beyond our control, and the failure by mobile technology and cloud service providers to adequately safeguard their systems and prevent cyber attacks could disrupt our operations and result in misappropriation, corruption or loss of confidential and other information. In addition, there is a risk that encryption and other protective measures, despite their sophistication, may be defeated, particularly to the extent that new computing technologies vastly increase the speed and computing power available.

 

 

32   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

We routinely transmit and receive personal, confidential and proprietary information by email and other electronic means. We have discussed and worked with clients, vendors, service providers, counterparties and other third parties to develop secure transmission capabilities and protect against cyber attacks, but we do not have, and may be unable to put in place, secure capabilities with all of our clients, vendors, service providers, counterparties and other third parties and we may not be able to ensure that these third parties have appropriate controls in place to protect the confidentiality of the information. An interception, misuse or mishandling of personal, confidential or proprietary information being sent to or received from a client, vendor, service provider, counterparty or other third party could result in legal liability, regulatory action and reputational harm.

Group Inc. is a holding company and is dependent for liquidity on payments from its subsidiaries, many of which are subject to restrictions.

Group Inc. is a holding company and, therefore, depends on dividends, distributions and other payments from its subsidiaries to fund dividend payments and to fund all payments on its obligations, including debt obligations. Many of our subsidiaries, including our broker-dealer and bank subsidiaries, are subject to laws that restrict dividend payments or authorize regulatory bodies to block or reduce the flow of funds from those subsidiaries to Group Inc.

In addition, our broker-dealer and bank subsidiaries are subject to restrictions on their ability to lend or transact with affiliates and to minimum regulatory capital and other requirements, as well as restrictions on their ability to use funds deposited with them in brokerage or bank accounts to fund their businesses. Additional restrictions on related-party transactions, increased capital and liquidity requirements and additional limitations on the use of funds on deposit in bank or brokerage accounts, as well as lower earnings, can reduce the amount of funds available to meet the obligations of Group Inc., including under the FRB’s source of strength requirement, and even require Group Inc. to provide additional funding to such subsidiaries. Restrictions or regulatory action of that kind could impede access to funds that Group Inc. needs to make payments on its obligations, including debt obligations, or dividend payments. In addition, Group Inc.’s right to participate in a distribution of assets upon a subsidiary’s liquidation or reorganization is subject to the prior claims of the subsidiary’s creditors.

There has been a trend towards increased regulation and supervision of our subsidiaries by the governments and regulators in the countries in which those subsidiaries are located or do business. Concerns about protecting clients and creditors of financial institutions that are controlled by persons or entities located outside of the country in which such entities are located or do business have caused or may cause a number of governments and regulators to take additional steps to “ring fence” or require internal total loss-absorbing capacity at such entities in order to protect clients and creditors of such entities in the event of financial difficulties involving such entities. The result has been and may continue to be additional limitations on our ability to efficiently move capital and liquidity among our affiliated entities, thereby increasing the overall level of capital and liquidity required by us on a consolidated basis.

Furthermore, Group Inc. has guaranteed the payment obligations of certain of its subsidiaries, including GS&Co. and GS Bank USA, subject to certain exceptions. In addition, Group Inc. guarantees many of the obligations of its other consolidated subsidiaries on a transaction-by-transaction basis, as negotiated with counterparties. These guarantees may require Group Inc. to provide substantial funds or assets to its subsidiaries or their creditors or counterparties at a time when Group Inc. is in need of liquidity to fund its own obligations.

The requirements for Group Inc. and GS Bank USA to develop and submit recovery and resolution plans to regulators, and the incorporation of feedback received from regulators, may require us to increase capital or liquidity levels or issue additional long-term debt at Group Inc. or particular subsidiaries or otherwise incur additional or duplicative operational or other costs at multiple entities, and may reduce our ability to provide Group Inc. guarantees of the obligations of our subsidiaries or raise debt at Group Inc. Resolution planning may also impair our ability to structure our intercompany and external activities in a manner that we may otherwise deem most operationally efficient. Furthermore, arrangements to facilitate our resolution planning may cause us to be subject to additional taxes. Any such limitations or requirements would be in addition to the legal and regulatory restrictions described above on our ability to engage in capital actions or make intercompany dividends or payments.

See “Business — Regulation” in Part I, Item 1 of this Form 10-K for further information about regulatory restrictions.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   33


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

The application of regulatory strategies and requirements in the U.S. and non-U.S. jurisdictions to facilitate the orderly resolution of large financial institutions could create greater risk of loss for Group Inc.’s security holders.

As described in “Business — Regulation — Banking Supervision and Regulation — Insolvency of an Insured Depository Institution or a Bank Holding Company,” if the FDIC is appointed as receiver under OLA, the rights of Group Inc.’s creditors would be determined under OLA, and substantial differences exist in the rights of creditors between OLA and the U.S. Bankruptcy Code, including the right of the FDIC under OLA to disregard the strict priority of creditor claims in some circumstances, which could have a material adverse effect on debtholders.

The FDIC has announced that a single point of entry strategy may be a desirable strategy under OLA to resolve a large financial institution such as Group Inc. in a manner that would, among other things, impose losses on shareholders, debtholders and other creditors of the top-tier BHC (in our case, Group Inc.), while the BHC’s subsidiaries may continue to operate. It is possible that the application of the single point of entry strategy under OLA, in which Group Inc. would be the only entity to enter resolution proceedings (and its material broker-dealer, bank and other operating entities would not enter resolution proceedings), would result in greater losses to Group Inc.’s security holders (including holders of our fixed rate, floating rate and indexed debt securities), than the losses that would result from the application of a bankruptcy proceeding or a different resolution strategy, such as a multiple point of entry resolution strategy for Group Inc. and certain of its material subsidiaries.

Assuming Group Inc. entered resolution proceedings and that support from Group Inc. to its subsidiaries was sufficient to enable the subsidiaries to remain solvent, losses at the subsidiary level would be transferred to Group Inc. and ultimately borne by Group Inc.’s security holders, third-party creditors of Group Inc.’s subsidiaries would receive full recoveries on their claims, and Group Inc.’s security holders (including our shareholders, debtholders and other unsecured creditors) could face significant and possibly complete losses. In that case, Group Inc.’s security holders would face losses while the third-party creditors of Group Inc.’s subsidiaries would incur no losses because the subsidiaries would continue to operate and would not enter resolution or bankruptcy proceedings. In addition, holders of Group Inc.’s eligible long-term debt and holders of Group Inc.’s other debt securities could face losses ahead of its other similarly situated creditors in a resolution under OLA if the FDIC exercised its right, described above, to disregard the priority of creditor claims.

OLA also provides the FDIC with authority to cause creditors and shareholders of the financial company such as Group Inc. in receivership to bear losses before taxpayers are exposed to such losses, and amounts owed to the U.S. government would generally receive a statutory payment priority over the claims of private creditors, including senior creditors.

In addition, under OLA, claims of creditors (including debtholders) could be satisfied through the issuance of equity or other securities in a bridge entity to which Group Inc.’s assets are transferred. If such a securities-for-claims exchange were implemented, there can be no assurance that the value of the securities of the bridge entity would be sufficient to repay or satisfy all or any part of the creditor claims for which the securities were exchanged. While the FDIC has issued regulations to implement OLA, not all aspects of how the FDIC might exercise this authority are known and additional rulemaking is likely.

In addition, certain jurisdictions, including the U.K. and the E.U., have implemented, or are considering, changes to resolution regimes to provide resolution authorities with the ability to recapitalize a failing entity by writing down its unsecured debt or converting its unsecured debt into equity. Such “bail-in” powers are intended to enable the recapitalization of a failing institution by allocating losses to its shareholders and unsecured debtholders. U.S. regulators are considering and non-U.S. authorities have proposed requirements that certain subsidiaries of large financial institutions maintain minimum amounts of total loss-absorbing capacity that would pass losses up from the subsidiaries to the top-tier BHC and, ultimately, to security holders of the top-tier BHC in the event of failure.

 

 

34   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

The application of Group Inc.’s proposed resolution strategy could result in greater losses for Group Inc.’s security holders, and failure to address shortcomings in our resolution plan could subject us to increased regulatory requirements.

In our resolution plan, Group Inc. would be resolved under the U.S. Bankruptcy Code. The strategy described in our resolution plan is a variant of the single point of entry strategy: Group Inc. and Goldman Sachs Funding LLC (Funding IHC), a wholly-owned, direct subsidiary of Group Inc., would recapitalize and provide liquidity to certain major subsidiaries, including through the forgiveness of intercompany indebtedness, the extension of the maturities of intercompany indebtedness and the extension of additional intercompany loans. If this strategy were successful, creditors of some or all of Group Inc.’s major subsidiaries would receive full recoveries on their claims, while Group Inc.’s security holders could face significant and possibly complete losses.

To facilitate the execution of our resolution plan, we formed Funding IHC, a wholly-owned, direct subsidiary of Group Inc. In exchange for an unsecured subordinated funding note and equity interest, Group Inc. has transferred certain intercompany receivables and substantially all of its global core liquid assets (GCLA) to Funding IHC, and has agreed to transfer additional GCLA above prescribed thresholds.

We also put in place a Capital and Liquidity Support Agreement (CLSA) among Group Inc., Funding IHC and our major subsidiaries. Under the CLSA, Funding IHC has provided Group Inc. with a committed line of credit that allows Group Inc. to draw sufficient funds to meet its cash needs during the ordinary course of business. In addition, if our financial resources deteriorate so severely that resolution may be imminent, (i) the committed line of credit will automatically terminate and the unsecured subordinated funding note will automatically be forgiven, (ii) all intercompany receivables owed by the major subsidiaries to Group Inc. will be transferred to Funding IHC or their maturities will be extended to five years, (iii) Group Inc. will be obligated to transfer substantially all of its remaining intercompany receivables and GCLA (other than an amount to fund anticipated bankruptcy expenses) to Funding IHC, and (iv) Funding IHC will be obligated to provide capital and liquidity support to the major subsidiaries. Group Inc.’s and Funding IHC’s obligations under the CLSA are secured pursuant to a related security agreement. Such actions would materially and adversely affect Group Inc.’s liquidity. As a result, during a period of severe stress, Group Inc. might commence bankruptcy proceedings at an earlier time than it otherwise would if the CLSA and related security agreement had not been implemented.

If Group Inc.’s proposed resolution strategy were successful, Group Inc.’s security holders could face losses while the third-party creditors of Group Inc.’s major subsidiaries would incur no losses because those subsidiaries would continue to operate and not enter resolution or bankruptcy proceedings. As part of the strategy, Group Inc. could also seek to elevate the priority of its guarantee obligations relating to its major subsidiaries’ derivative contracts or transfer them to another entity so that cross-default and early termination rights would be stayed under the ISDA Protocol, which would result in holders of Group Inc.’s eligible long-term debt and holders of Group Inc.’s other debt securities incurring losses ahead of the beneficiaries of those guarantee obligations. It is also possible that holders of Group Inc.’s eligible long-term debt and other debt securities could incur losses ahead of other similarly situated creditors.

If Group Inc.’s proposed resolution strategy were not successful, Group Inc.’s financial condition would be adversely impacted and Group Inc.’s security holders, including debtholders, may as a consequence be in a worse position than if the strategy had not been implemented. In all cases, any payments to debtholders are dependent on our ability to make such payments and are therefore subject to our credit risk.

As a result of our recovery and resolution planning processes, including incorporating feedback from our regulators, we may incur increased operational, funding or other costs and face limitations on our ability to structure our internal organization or engage in internal or external activities in a manner that we may otherwise deem most operationally efficient.

Our businesses, profitability and liquidity may be adversely affected by deterioration in the credit quality of, or defaults by, third parties who owe us money, securities or other assets or whose securities or obligations we hold.

We are exposed to the risk that third parties that owe us money, securities or other assets will not perform their obligations. These parties may default on their obligations to us due to bankruptcy, lack of liquidity, operational failure or other reasons. A failure of a significant market participant, or even concerns about a default by such an institution, could lead to significant liquidity problems, losses or defaults by other institutions, which in turn could adversely affect us.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   35


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

We are also subject to the risk that our rights against third parties may not be enforceable in all circumstances. In addition, deterioration in the credit quality of third parties whose securities or obligations we hold, including a deterioration in the value of collateral posted by third parties to secure their obligations to us under derivative contracts and loan agreements, could result in losses and/or adversely affect our ability to rehypothecate or otherwise use those securities or obligations for liquidity purposes.

A significant downgrade in the credit ratings of our counterparties could also have a negative impact on our results. While in many cases we are permitted to require additional collateral from counterparties that experience financial difficulty, disputes may arise as to the amount of collateral we are entitled to receive and the value of pledged assets. The termination of contracts and the foreclosure on collateral may subject us to claims for the improper exercise of our rights. Default rates, downgrades and disputes with counterparties as to the valuation of collateral increase significantly in times of market stress and illiquidity.

As part of our clearing and prime brokerage activities, we finance our clients’ positions, and we could be held responsible for the defaults or misconduct of our clients. Although we regularly review credit exposures to specific clients and counterparties and to specific industries, countries and regions that we believe may present credit concerns, default risk may arise from events or circumstances that are difficult to detect or foresee.

Concentration of risk increases the potential for significant losses in our market-making, underwriting, investing and lending activities.

Concentration of risk increases the potential for significant losses in our market-making, underwriting, investing and lending activities. The number and size of such transactions may affect our results of operations in a given period. Moreover, because of concentration of risk, we may suffer losses even when economic and market conditions are generally favorable for our competitors. Disruptions in the credit markets can make it difficult to hedge these credit exposures effectively or economically. In addition, we extend large commitments as part of our credit origination activities.

Rules adopted under the Dodd-Frank Act, and similar rules adopted in other jurisdictions, require issuers of certain asset-backed securities and any person who organizes and initiates certain asset-backed securities transactions to retain economic exposure to the asset, which has affected the cost of and structures used in connection with these securitization activities. Our inability to reduce our credit risk by selling, syndicating or securitizing these positions, including during periods of market stress, could negatively affect our results of operations due to a decrease in the fair value of the positions, including due to the insolvency or bankruptcy of the borrower, as well as the loss of revenues associated with selling such securities or loans.

In the ordinary course of business, we may be subject to a concentration of credit risk to a particular counterparty, borrower, issuer, including sovereign issuers, or geographic area or group of related countries, such as the E.U., and a failure or downgrade of, or default by, such entity could negatively impact our businesses, perhaps materially, and the systems by which we set limits and monitor the level of our credit exposure to individual entities, industries and countries may not function as we have anticipated. Regulatory reform, including the Dodd-Frank Act, has led to increased centralization of trading activity through particular clearing houses, central agents or exchanges, which has significantly increased our concentration of risk with respect to these entities. While our activities expose us to many different industries, counterparties and countries, we routinely execute a high volume of transactions with counterparties engaged in financial services activities, including brokers and dealers, commercial banks, clearing houses, exchanges and investment funds. This has resulted in significant credit concentration with respect to these counterparties.

The financial services industry is both highly competitive and interrelated.

The financial services industry and all of our businesses are intensely competitive, and we expect them to remain so. We compete on the basis of a number of factors, including transaction execution, our products and services, innovation, reputation, creditworthiness and price. There has been substantial consolidation and convergence among companies in the financial services industry. This consolidation and convergence has hastened the globalization of the securities and other financial services markets. As a result, we have had to commit capital to support our international operations and to execute large global transactions. To the extent we expand into new business areas and new geographic regions, we will face competitors with more experience and more established relationships with clients, regulators and industry participants in the relevant market, which could adversely affect our ability to expand.

 

 

36   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

Governments and regulators have recently adopted regulations, imposed taxes, adopted compensation restrictions or otherwise put forward various proposals that have or may impact our ability to conduct certain of our businesses in a cost-effective manner or at all in certain or all jurisdictions, including proposals relating to restrictions on the type of activities in which financial institutions are permitted to engage. These or other similar rules, many of which do not apply to all our U.S. or non-U.S. competitors, could impact our ability to compete effectively.

Pricing and other competitive pressures in our businesses have continued to increase, particularly in situations where some of our competitors may seek to increase market share by reducing prices. For example, in connection with investment banking and other assignments, we have experienced pressure to extend and price credit at levels that may not always fully compensate us for the risks we take.

The financial services industry is highly interrelated in that a significant volume of transactions occur among a limited number of members of that industry. Many transactions are syndicated to other financial institutions and financial institutions are often counterparties in transactions. This has led to claims by other market participants and regulators that such institutions have colluded in order to manipulate markets or market prices, including allegations that antitrust laws have been violated. While we have extensive procedures and controls that are designed to identify and prevent such activities, allegations of such activities, particularly by regulators, can have a negative reputational impact and can subject us to large fines and settlements, and potentially significant penalties, including treble damages.

We face enhanced risks as new business initiatives lead us to transact with a broader array of clients and counterparties and expose us to new asset classes and new markets.

A number of our recent and planned business initiatives and expansions of existing businesses may bring us into contact, directly or indirectly, with individuals and entities that are not within our traditional client and counterparty base and expose us to new asset classes and new markets. For example, we continue to transact business and invest in new regions, including a wide range of emerging and growth markets. Furthermore, in a number of our businesses, including where we make markets, invest and lend, we directly or indirectly own interests in, or otherwise become affiliated with the ownership and operation of public services, such as airports, toll roads and shipping ports, as well as physical commodities and commodities infrastructure components, both within and outside the U.S.

We have recently increased and intend to further increase our retail-oriented deposit-taking and lending activities. To the extent we engage in such activities or similar retail-oriented activities, we could face additional compliance, legal and regulatory risk, increased reputational risk and increased operational risk due to, among other things, higher transaction volumes and significantly increased retention and transmission of customer and client information. As a result of a recent information security event involving a credit reporting agency, identity fraud may increase and industry practices may change in a manner that makes it more difficult for financial institutions, such as us, to evaluate the creditworthiness of retail customers.

New business initiatives expose us to new and enhanced risks, including risks associated with dealing with governmental entities, reputational concerns arising from dealing with less sophisticated clients, counterparties and investors, greater regulatory scrutiny of these activities, increased credit-related, market, sovereign and operational risks, risks arising from accidents or acts of terrorism, and reputational concerns with the manner in which these assets are being operated or held or in which we interact with these counterparties.

Our results may be adversely affected by the composition of our client base.

Our client base is not the same as that of our major competitors. Our businesses may have a higher or lower percentage of clients in certain industries or markets than some or all of our competitors. Therefore, unfavorable industry developments or market conditions affecting certain industries or markets may result in our businesses underperforming relative to similar businesses of a competitor if our businesses have a higher concentration of clients in such industries or markets. For example, our market-making businesses have a higher percentage of clients with actively managed assets than our competitors and such clients have been disproportionately affected by the low levels of volatility.

Correspondingly, favorable or simply less adverse developments or market conditions involving industries or markets in a business where we have a lower concentration of clients in such industry or market may also result in our underperforming relative to a similar business of a competitor that has a higher concentration of clients in such industry or market. For example, we have a smaller corporate client base in our market-making businesses than many of our peers and therefore such competitors may benefit more from increased activity by corporate clients.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   37


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

Derivative transactions and delayed settlements may expose us to unexpected risk and potential losses.

We are party to a large number of derivative transactions, including credit derivatives. Many of these derivative instruments are individually negotiated and non-standardized, which can make exiting, transferring or settling positions difficult. Many credit derivatives require that we deliver to the counterparty the underlying security, loan or other obligation in order to receive payment. In a number of cases, we do not hold the underlying security, loan or other obligation and may not be able to obtain the underlying security, loan or other obligation. This could cause us to forfeit the payments due to us under these contracts or result in settlement delays with the attendant credit and operational risk as well as increased costs to us.

Derivative transactions may also involve the risk that documentation has not been properly executed, that executed agreements may not be enforceable against the counterparty, or that obligations under such agreements may not be able to be “netted” against other obligations with such counterparty. In addition, counterparties may claim that such transactions were not appropriate or authorized.

As a signatory to the ISDA Protocol and being subject to the FRB’s and FDIC’s rules on QFCs and similar rules in other jurisdictions, we may not be able to exercise remedies against counterparties and, as this new regime has not yet been tested, we may suffer risks or losses that we would not have expected to suffer if we could immediately close out transactions upon a termination event. Various non-U.S. regulators have also proposed regulations contemplated by the ISDA Protocol, and those implementing regulations may result in additional limitations on our ability to exercise remedies against counterparties. The impact of the ISDA Protocol and these rules and regulations will depend on the development of market practices and structures.

Derivative contracts and other transactions, including secondary bank loan purchases and sales, entered into with third parties are not always confirmed by the counterparties or settled on a timely basis. While the transaction remains unconfirmed or during any delay in settlement, we are subject to heightened credit and operational risk and in the event of a default may find it more difficult to enforce our rights.

In addition, as new complex derivative products are created, covering a wider array of underlying credit and other instruments, disputes about the terms of the underlying contracts could arise, which could impair our ability to effectively manage our risk exposures from these products and subject us to increased costs. The provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act requiring central clearing of credit derivatives and other OTC derivatives, or a market shift toward standardized derivatives, could reduce the risk associated with such transactions, but under certain circumstances could also limit our ability to develop derivatives that best suit the needs of our clients and to hedge our own risks, and could adversely affect our profitability and increase our credit exposure to such platform.

Certain of our businesses and our funding may be adversely affected by changes in the reference rates, currencies, indexes, baskets or ETFs to which products we offer or funding that we raise are linked.

All of our floating rate funding pays interest by reference to a rate, such as LIBOR or Federal Funds. In addition, many of the products that we own or that we offer, such as structured notes, warrants, swaps or security-based swaps, pay interest or determine the principal amount to be paid at maturity or in the event of default by reference to similar rates or by reference to an index, currency, basket, ETF or other financial metric (the underlier). In the event that the composition of the underlier is significantly changed, by reference to rules governing such underlier or otherwise, or the underlier ceases to exist (for example, in the event that LIBOR is discontinued, a country withdraws from the Euro or links its currency to or delinks its currency from another currency or benchmark, or an index or ETF sponsor materially alters the composition of an index or ETF), there may be uncertainty as to the calculation of the amounts to be paid to the lender, investor or counterparty, depending on the terms of the governing instrument.

Such changes in an underlier or underliers could result in our hedges being ineffective or otherwise result in losses on a product or having to pay more or receive less on securities that we own or have issued. In addition, such uncertainty could result in lengthy and costly litigation.

 

 

38   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

Our businesses may be adversely affected if we are unable to hire and retain qualified employees.

Our performance is largely dependent on the talents and efforts of highly skilled people; therefore, our continued ability to compete effectively in our businesses, to manage our businesses effectively and to expand into new businesses and geographic areas depends on our ability to attract new talented and diverse employees and to retain and motivate our existing employees. Factors that affect our ability to attract and retain such employees include our compensation and benefits, and our reputation as a successful business with a culture of fairly hiring, training and promoting qualified employees. As a significant portion of the compensation that we pay to our employees is in the form of year-end discretionary compensation, a significant portion of which is in the form of deferred equity-related awards, declines in our profitability, or in the outlook for our future profitability, as well as regulatory limitations on compensation levels and terms, can negatively impact our ability to hire and retain highly qualified employees.

Competition from within the financial services industry and from businesses outside the financial services industry, including the technology industry, for qualified employees has often been intense. Recently, we have experienced increased competition in hiring and retaining employees to address the demands of new regulatory requirements, expanding retail-oriented businesses and our technology initiatives. This is also the case in emerging and growth markets, where we are often competing for qualified employees with entities that have a significantly greater presence or more extensive experience in the region.

Changes in law or regulation in jurisdictions in which our operations are located that affect taxes on our employees’ income, or the amount or composition of compensation, may also adversely affect our ability to hire and retain qualified employees in those jurisdictions.

As described further in “Business — Regulation —Compensation Practices” in Part I, Item 1 of this Form 10-K, our compensation practices are subject to review by, and the standards of, the FRB. As a large global financial and banking institution, we are subject to limitations on compensation practices (which may or may not affect our competitors) by the FRB, the PRA, the FCA, the FDIC and other regulators worldwide. These limitations, including any imposed by or as a result of future legislation or regulation, may require us to alter our compensation practices in ways that could adversely affect our ability to attract and retain talented employees.

We may be adversely affected by increased governmental and regulatory scrutiny or negative publicity.

Governmental scrutiny from regulators, legislative bodies and law enforcement agencies with respect to matters relating to compensation, our business practices, our past actions and other matters has increased dramatically in the past several years. The financial crisis and the current political and public sentiment regarding financial institutions has resulted in a significant amount of adverse press coverage, as well as adverse statements or charges by regulators or other government officials. Press coverage and other public statements that assert some form of wrongdoing (including, in some cases, press coverage and public statements that do not directly involve us) often result in some type of investigation by regulators, legislators and law enforcement officials or in lawsuits.

Responding to these investigations and lawsuits, regardless of the ultimate outcome of the proceeding, is time-consuming and expensive and can divert the time and effort of our senior management from our business. Penalties and fines sought by regulatory authorities have increased substantially over the last several years, and certain regulators have been more likely in recent years to commence enforcement actions or to advance or support legislation targeted at the financial services industry. Adverse publicity, governmental scrutiny and legal and enforcement proceedings can also have a negative impact on our reputation and on the morale and performance of our employees, which could adversely affect our businesses and results of operations.

Substantial legal liability or significant regulatory action against us could have material adverse financial effects or cause us significant reputational harm, which in turn could seriously harm our business prospects.

We face significant legal risks in our businesses, and the volume of claims and amount of damages and penalties claimed in litigation and regulatory proceedings against financial institutions remain high. See Notes 18 and 27 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of this Form 10-K for information about certain legal and regulatory proceedings and investigations in which we are involved. Our experience has been that legal claims by customers and clients increase in a market downturn and that employment-related claims increase following periods in which we have reduced our staff. Additionally, governmental entities have been and are plaintiffs in certain of the legal proceedings in which we are involved, and we may face future actions or claims by the same or other governmental entities, as well as follow-on civil litigation that is often commenced after regulatory settlements.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   39


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

Significant settlements by several large financial institutions, including, in some cases, us, with governmental entities have been publicly announced. The trend of large settlements with governmental entities may adversely affect the outcomes for other financial institutions in similar actions, especially where governmental officials have announced that the large settlements will be used as the basis or a template for other settlements. The uncertain regulatory enforcement environment makes it difficult to estimate probable losses, which can lead to substantial disparities between legal reserves and subsequent actual settlements or penalties.

Recently, claims of collusion or anti-competitive conduct have become more common. Civil cases have been brought against financial institutions (including us) alleging bid rigging, group boycotts or other anti-competitive practices. Antitrust laws generally provide for joint and several liability and treble damages. These claims have in the past, and may in the future, result in significant settlements.

We are subject to laws and regulations worldwide, including the U.S. Foreign Corrupt Practices Act and the U.K. Bribery Act, relating to corrupt and illegal payments to, and hiring practices with regard to, government officials and others. Violation of such laws and regulations could result in significant monetary penalties, severe restrictions on our activities and damage to our reputation.

Certain law enforcement authorities have recently required admissions of wrongdoing, and, in some cases, criminal pleas, as part of the resolutions of matters brought by them against financial institutions. Any such resolution of a matter involving us could lead to increased exposure to civil litigation, could adversely affect our reputation, could result in penalties or limitations on our ability to do business in certain jurisdictions and could have other negative effects.

In addition, the U.S. Department of Justice has announced a policy of requiring companies to provide investigators with all relevant facts relating to the individuals responsible for the alleged misconduct in order to qualify for any cooperation credit in civil and criminal investigations of corporate wrongdoing, which may result in our incurring increased fines and penalties if the Department of Justice determines that we have not provided sufficient information about applicable individuals in connection with an investigation, as well as increased costs in responding to Department of Justice investigations. It is possible that other governmental authorities will adopt similar policies.

The growth of electronic trading and the introduction of new trading technology may adversely affect our business and may increase competition.

Technology is fundamental to our business and our industry. The growth of electronic trading and the introduction of new technologies is changing our businesses and presenting us with new challenges. Securities, futures and options transactions are increasingly occurring electronically, both on our own systems and through other alternative trading systems, and it appears that the trend toward alternative trading systems will continue. Some of these alternative trading systems compete with us, particularly our exchange-based market-making activities, and we may experience continued competitive pressures in these and other areas. In addition, the increased use by our clients of low-cost electronic trading systems and direct electronic access to trading markets could cause a reduction in commissions and spreads. As our clients increasingly use our systems to trade directly in the markets, we may incur liabilities as a result of their use of our order routing and execution infrastructure. We have invested significant resources into the development of electronic trading systems and expect to continue to do so, but there is no assurance that the revenues generated by these systems will yield an adequate return on our investment, particularly given the generally lower commissions arising from electronic trades.

Our commodities activities, particularly our physical commodities activities, subject us to extensive regulation and involve certain potential risks, including environmental, reputational and other risks that may expose us to significant liabilities and costs.

As part of our commodities business, we purchase and sell certain physical commodities, arrange for their storage and transport, and engage in market making of commodities. The commodities involved in these activities may include crude oil, refined oil products, natural gas, liquefied natural gas, electric power, agricultural products, metals (base and precious), minerals (including unenriched uranium), emission credits, coal, freight and related products and indices.

In our investing and lending businesses, we make investments in and finance entities that engage in the production, storage and transportation of numerous commodities, including many of the commodities referenced above.

 

 

40   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

These activities subject us and/or the entities in which we invest to extensive and evolving federal, state and local energy, environmental, antitrust and other governmental laws and regulations worldwide, including environmental laws and regulations relating to, among others, air quality, water quality, waste management, transportation of hazardous substances, natural resources, site remediation and health and safety. Additionally, rising climate change concerns may lead to additional regulation that could increase the operating costs and profitability of our investments.

There may be substantial costs in complying with current or future laws and regulations relating to our commodities-related activities and investments. Compliance with these laws and regulations could require significant commitments of capital toward environmental monitoring, renovation of storage facilities or transport vessels, payment of emission fees and carbon or other taxes, and application for, and holding of, permits and licenses.

Commodities involved in our intermediation activities and investments are also subject to the risk of unforeseen or catastrophic events, which are likely to be outside of our control, including those arising from the breakdown or failure of transport vessels, storage facilities or other equipment or processes or other mechanical malfunctions, fires, leaks, spills or release of hazardous substances, performance below expected levels of output or efficiency, terrorist attacks, extreme weather events or other natural disasters or other hostile or catastrophic events. In addition, we rely on third-party suppliers or service providers to perform their contractual obligations and any failure on their part, including the failure to obtain raw materials at reasonable prices or to safely transport or store commodities, could expose us to costs or losses. Also, while we seek to insure against potential risks, we may not be able to obtain insurance to cover some of these risks and the insurance that we have may be inadequate to cover our losses.

The occurrence of any of such events may prevent us from performing under our agreements with clients, may impair our operations or financial results and may result in litigation, regulatory action, negative publicity or other reputational harm.

We may also be required to divest or discontinue certain of these activities for regulatory or legal reasons. For example, the FRB has proposed regulations that could impose significant additional capital requirements on certain commodity-related activities. If that occurs, we may receive a value that is less than the then carrying value, as we may be unable to exit these activities in an orderly transaction.

In conducting our businesses around the world, we are subject to political, economic, legal, operational and other risks that are inherent in operating in many countries.

In conducting our businesses and maintaining and supporting our global operations, we are subject to risks of possible nationalization, expropriation, price controls, capital controls, exchange controls and other restrictive governmental actions, as well as the outbreak of hostilities or acts of terrorism. For example, sanctions have been imposed by the U.S. and the E.U. on certain individuals and companies in Russia. In many countries, the laws and regulations applicable to the securities and financial services industries and many of the transactions in which we are involved are uncertain and evolving, and it may be difficult for us to determine the exact requirements of local laws in every market. Any determination by local regulators that we have not acted in compliance with the application of local laws in a particular market or our failure to develop effective working relationships with local regulators could have a significant and negative effect not only on our businesses in that market, but also on our reputation generally. Further, in some jurisdictions a failure to comply with laws and regulations may subject us and our personnel not only to civil actions, but also criminal actions. We are also subject to the enhanced risk that transactions we structure might not be legally enforceable in all cases.

In March 2017, the U.K. notified the European Council of its decision to leave the E.U. (Brexit). The exit of the U.K. from the E.U. will likely change the arrangements by which U.K. firms are able to provide services into the E.U., which may materially adversely affect the manner in which we operate certain of our businesses in Europe and could require us to restructure certain of our operations. The outcome of the negotiations between the U.K. and the E.U. in connection with Brexit is highly uncertain. Such uncertainty may result in market volatility and may negatively impact the confidence of investors and clients. Additionally, depending on the outcome, Brexit could have a disproportionate effect on our operations in the E.U. compared to some of our competitors who have more extensive pre-existing operations in the E.U. outside of the U.K.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   41


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

Our businesses and operations are increasingly expanding throughout the world, including in emerging and growth markets, and we expect this trend to continue. Various emerging and growth market countries have experienced severe economic and financial disruptions, including significant devaluations of their currencies, defaults or threatened defaults on sovereign debt, capital and currency exchange controls, and low or negative growth rates in their economies, as well as military activity, civil unrest or acts of terrorism. The possible effects of any of these conditions include an adverse impact on our businesses and increased volatility in financial markets generally.

While business and other practices throughout the world differ, our principal entities are subject in their operations worldwide to rules and regulations relating to corrupt and illegal payments, hiring practices and money laundering, as well as laws relating to doing business with certain individuals, groups and countries, such as the U.S. Foreign Corrupt Practices Act, the USA PATRIOT Act and U.K. Bribery Act. While we have invested and continue to invest significant resources in training and in compliance monitoring, the geographical diversity of our operations, employees, clients and customers, as well as the vendors and other third parties that we deal with, greatly increases the risk that we may be found in violation of such rules or regulations and any such violation could subject us to significant penalties or adversely affect our reputation.

In addition, there have been a number of highly publicized cases around the world, involving actual or alleged fraud or other misconduct by employees in the financial services industry in recent years, and we run the risk that employee misconduct could occur. This misconduct has included and may include in the future the theft of proprietary information, including proprietary software. It is not always possible to deter or prevent employee misconduct and the precautions we take to prevent and detect this activity have not been and may not be effective in all cases.

We may incur losses as a result of unforeseen or catastrophic events, including the emergence of a pandemic, terrorist attacks, extreme weather events or other natural disasters.

The occurrence of unforeseen or catastrophic events, including the emergence of a pandemic, such as the Ebola or Zika viruses, or other widespread health emergency (or concerns over the possibility of such an emergency), terrorist attacks, extreme terrestrial or solar weather events or other natural disasters, could create economic and financial disruptions, and could lead to operational difficulties (including travel limitations) that could impair our ability to manage our businesses.

Item 1B.    Unresolved Staff Comments

There are no material unresolved written comments that were received from the SEC staff 180 days or more before the end of our fiscal year relating to our periodic or current reports under the Exchange Act.

Item 2.    Properties

Our principal executive offices are located at 200 West Street, New York, New York and comprise approximately 2.1 million square feet. The building is located on a parcel leased from Battery Park City Authority pursuant to a ground lease. Under the lease, Battery Park City Authority holds title to all improvements, including the office building, subject to Goldman Sachs’ right of exclusive possession and use until June 2069, the expiration date of the lease. Under the terms of the ground lease, we made a lump sum ground rent payment in June 2007 of $161 million for rent through the term of the lease.

We have offices at 30 Hudson Street in Jersey City, New Jersey, which we own and which include approximately 1.6 million square feet of office space.

We have additional offices and commercial space in the U.S. and elsewhere in the Americas, which together comprise approximately 2.9 million square feet of leased and owned space.

In Europe, the Middle East and Africa, we have offices that total approximately 1.6 million square feet of leased and owned space. Our European headquarters is located in London at Peterborough Court, pursuant to a lease that we can terminate in 2021. In total, we have offices with approximately 1.2 million square feet in London, relating to various properties. We are currently constructing a 1.1 million square foot office in London. We expect initial occupancy during 2019.

In Asia, Australia and New Zealand, we have offices with approximately 1.9 million square feet. Our headquarters in this region are in Tokyo, at the Roppongi Hills Mori Tower, and in Hong Kong, at the Cheung Kong Center. In Japan, we currently have offices with approximately 219,000 square feet, the majority of which have leases that will expire in 2023. In Hong Kong, we currently have offices with approximately 308,000 square feet, the majority of which will also expire in 2023.

In the preceding paragraphs, square footage figures are provided only for properties that are used in the operation of our businesses.

 

 

42   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

Our occupancy expenses include costs associated with office space held in excess of our current requirements. This excess space, the cost of which is charged to earnings as incurred, is being held for potential growth or to replace currently occupied space that we may exit in the future. We regularly evaluate our space capacity in relation to current and projected staffing levels. We may incur exit costs in the future if we (i) reduce our space capacity or (ii) commit to, or occupy, new properties in locations in which we operate and dispose of existing space that had been held for potential growth. These exit costs may be material to our operating results in a given period.

Item 3.    Legal Proceedings

We are involved in a number of judicial, regulatory and arbitration proceedings concerning matters arising in connection with the conduct of our businesses. Many of these proceedings are in early stages, and many of these cases seek an indeterminate amount of damages. However, we believe, based on currently available information, that the results of such proceedings, in the aggregate, will not have a material adverse effect on our financial condition, but may be material to our operating results in a given period. Given the range of litigation and investigations presently under way, our litigation expenses can be expected to remain high. See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Use of Estimates” in Part II, Item 7 of this Form 10-K. See Notes 18 and 27 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of this Form 10-K for information about certain judicial, regulatory and legal proceedings.

Item 4.    Mine Safety Disclosures

Not applicable.

Executive Officers of The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc.

Set forth below are the name, age, present title, principal occupation and certain biographical information for our executive officers. Our executive officers have been appointed by and serve at the pleasure of our board of directors.

Lloyd C. Blankfein, 63

Mr. Blankfein has been Chairman and Chief Executive Officer since June 2006, and a director since April 2003.

R. Martin Chavez, 53

Mr. Chavez has been an Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer since May 2017. He had previously served as Chief Information Officer since 2014. From 2012 to 2014, he was Global co-Chief Operating Officer of the Equities business.

Richard J. Gnodde, 57

Mr. Gnodde has been a Vice Chairman since January 2017, and Chief Executive Officer or co-Chief Executive Officer of Goldman Sachs International since 2006. He previously served as co-head of the Investment Banking Division from 2011 to May 2017.

Dane E. Holmes, 47

Mr. Holmes has been an Executive Vice President and Global Head of Human Capital Management since January 2018 and Global Head of Pine Street, our leadership development program, since 2016. He had previously served as Global Head of Investor Relations since 2007.

Gregory K. Palm, 69

Mr. Palm has been General Counsel and Head or Co-Head of the Legal Department since 1992, and an Executive Vice President and Secretary since 1999.

John F.W. Rogers, 61

Mr. Rogers has been an Executive Vice President since April 2011 and Chief of Staff and Secretary to the Board of Directors of Goldman Sachs since December 2001.

Pablo J. Salame, 52

Mr. Salame has been a Vice Chairman since January 2017 and global co-head of the Securities Division since 2008.

Harvey M. Schwartz, 53

Mr. Schwartz has been President and co-Chief Operating Officer since January 2017. He also served as Chief Financial Officer from January 2013 through April 2017. From February 2008 to January 2013, he was global co-head of the Securities Division.

Karen P. Seymour, 56

Ms. Seymour has been an Executive Vice President, General Counsel and Secretary, and Co-Head of the Legal Department since January 2018. From 2000 through January 2002 and 2005 through 2017, she was a partner at Sullivan & Cromwell LLP, a global law firm, including serving as a member of its management committee from April 2015 to December 2017 and as the co-managing partner of its litigation group from December 2012 to April 2015.

Sarah E. Smith, 58

Ms. Smith has been an Executive Vice President and Global Head of Compliance since March 2017. She had previously served as Controller and Chief Accounting Officer since 2002.

David M. Solomon, 56

Mr. Solomon has been President and co-Chief Operating Officer since January 2017. He had previously served as co-head of the Investment Banking Division since July 2006.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   43


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

PART II

 

Item 5.    Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

The principal market on which our common stock is traded is the NYSE. Information relating to the high and low sales prices per share of our common stock, as reported by the Consolidated Tape Association, for each full quarterly period during 2015, 2016 and 2017 is set forth in “Supplemental Financial Information — Common Stock Price Range” in Part II, Item 8 of this Form 10-K. As of February 9, 2018, there were 7,652 holders of record of our common stock.

The table below presents dividends declared by Group Inc. during 2017 and 2016.

 

      Date of Declaration       
Dividend Declared
Per Common Share
 
 

2017

    

First Quarter

    January 17, 2017        $0.65  

Second Quarter

    April 17, 2017        $0.75  

Third Quarter

    July 17, 2017        $0.75  

Fourth Quarter

    October 16, 2017        $0.75  

2016

    

First Quarter

    January 19, 2016        $0.65  

Second Quarter

    April 18, 2016        $0.65  

Third Quarter

    July 18, 2016        $0.65  

Fourth Quarter

    October 17, 2016        $0.65  

The declaration of dividends by Group Inc. is subject to the discretion of the Board of Directors of Group Inc. (Board). Our Board will take into account such matters as general business conditions, our financial results, capital requirements, contractual, legal and regulatory restrictions on the payment of dividends by us to our shareholders or by our subsidiaries to us, the effect on our debt ratings and such other factors as our Board may deem relevant. The holders of our common stock share proportionately on a per share basis in all dividends and other distributions on common stock declared by our Board. See “Business — Regulation” in Part I, Item 1 of this Form 10-K for information about potential regulatory limitations on our receipt of funds from our regulated subsidiaries and our payment of dividends to shareholders of Group Inc. Prior to the payment of dividends, we must receive confirmation that the FRB does not object to such payment.

The table below presents purchases made by or on behalf of Group Inc. or any “affiliated purchaser” (as defined in Rule 10b-18(a)(3) under the Exchange Act) of our common stock during the fourth quarter of 2017. Information relating to compensation plans under which our equity securities are authorized for issuance is presented in Part III, Item 12 of this Form 10-K.

 

     

Total
Shares
Purchased
 
 
 
    

Average
Price Paid
Per Share
 
 
 
    




Total Shares
Purchased
as Part of
a Publicly
Announced
Program
 
 
 
 
 
 
    




Maximum
Shares That
May Yet Be
Purchased
Under the
Program
 
 
 
 
 
 

October 2017

    3,021,930        $241.88        3,021,930        51,180,272  

November 2017

    3,424,899        $240.23        3,424,899        47,755,373  

December 2017

    128,943        $247.68        128,943        47,626,430  

Total

    6,575,772                 6,575,772           

Since March 2000, our Board has approved a repurchase program authorizing repurchases of up to 555 million shares of our common stock. The repurchase program is effected primarily through regular open-market purchases (which may include repurchase plans designed to comply with Rule 10b5-1), the amounts and timing of which are determined primarily by our current and projected capital position, but which may also be influenced by general market conditions and the prevailing price and trading volumes of our common stock. The repurchase program has no set expiration or termination date. Prior to repurchasing common stock, we must receive confirmation that the FRB does not object to such capital action.

Item 6.    Selected Financial Data

The Selected Financial Data table is set forth in Part II, Item 8 of this Form 10-K.

 

 

44   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

Item 7.    Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

    

Introduction

 

The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. (Group Inc. or parent company), a Delaware corporation, together with its consolidated subsidiaries, is a leading global investment banking, securities and investment management firm that provides a wide range of financial services to a substantial and diversified client base that includes corporations, financial institutions, governments and individuals. Founded in 1869, we are headquartered in New York and maintain offices in all major financial centers around the world.

When we use the terms “the firm,” “we,” “us” and “our,” we mean Group Inc. and its consolidated subsidiaries. We report our activities in four business segments: Investment Banking, Institutional Client Services, Investing & Lending and Investment Management. See “Results of Operations” below for further information about our business segments.

References to “this Form 10-K” are to our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2017. All references to “the consolidated financial statements” or “Supplemental Financial Information” are to Part II, Item 8 of this Form 10-K. All references to 2017, 2016 and 2015 refer to our years ended, or the dates, as the context requires, December 31, 2017, December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively. Any reference to a future year refers to a year ending on December 31 of that year. Certain reclassifications have been made to previously reported amounts to conform to the current presentation.

In this discussion and analysis of our financial condition and results of operations, we have included information that may constitute “forward-looking statements” within the meaning of the safe harbor provisions of the U.S. Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. Forward-looking statements are not historical facts, but instead represent only our beliefs regarding future events, many of which, by their nature, are inherently uncertain and outside our control.

These statements include statements other than historical information or statements of current conditions and may relate to our future plans and objectives and results, among other things, and may also include statements about the effect of changes to the capital, leverage, liquidity, long-term debt and total loss-absorbing capacity rules applicable to banks and bank holding companies (BHCs), the impact of the U.S. Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (Dodd-Frank Act) on our businesses and operations, and various legal proceedings, governmental investigations or mortgage-related contingencies as set forth in Notes 27 and 18, respectively, to the consolidated financial statements, as well as statements about the results of our Dodd-Frank Act and firm stress tests, statements about the objectives and effectiveness of our business continuity plan, information security program, risk management and liquidity policies, statements about our resolution plan and resolution strategy and their implications for our debtholders and other stakeholders, statements about the design and effectiveness of our resolution capital and liquidity models and our triggers and alerts framework, statements about trends in or growth opportunities for our businesses, statements about our future status, activities or reporting under U.S. or non-U.S. banking and financial regulation, statements about our investment banking transaction backlog, statements about the estimated effects of the Tax Cuts and Jobs Act (Tax Legislation), statements about our average Liquidity Coverage Ratio (LCR) and statements about our strategic growth initiatives.

By identifying these statements for you in this manner, we are alerting you to the possibility that our actual results and financial condition may differ, possibly materially, from the anticipated results and financial condition indicated in these forward-looking statements. Important factors that could cause our actual results and financial condition to differ from those indicated in these forward-looking statements include, among others, those described in “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of this Form 10-K and “Cautionary Statement Pursuant to the U.S. Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995” in Part I, Item 1 of this Form 10-K.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   45


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

Executive Overview

 

2017 versus 2016. We generated net earnings of $4.29 billion and diluted earnings per common share of $9.01 for 2017, a decrease of 42% and 45%, respectively, compared with $7.40 billion and $16.29 per share for 2016. Return on average common shareholders’ equity was 4.9% for 2017, compared with 9.4% for 2016. Book value per common share was $181.00 as of December 2017, 0.8% lower compared with December 2016.

In the fourth quarter of 2017, we recorded $4.40 billion of estimated income tax expense related to Tax Legislation. Excluding this expense, diluted earnings per common share were $19.76 and return on average common shareholders’ equity was 10.8% for 2017. See “Results of Operations — Financial Overview” below for further information about these non-GAAP measures, including the calculation of diluted earnings per common share and return on average common shareholders’ equity, excluding the estimated impact of Tax Legislation. See “Results of Operations — Provision for Taxes” below for further information about Tax Legislation.

Net revenues were $32.07 billion for 2017, 5% higher than 2016, due to significantly higher net revenues in Investing & Lending and higher net revenues in both Investment Banking and Investment Management. These increases were partially offset by lower net revenues in Institutional Client Services, primarily reflecting significantly lower net revenues in Fixed Income, Currency and Commodities Client Execution (FICC Client Execution).

Operating expenses were $20.94 billion for 2017, 3% higher than 2016, due to slightly higher non-compensation expenses and compensation and benefits expenses.

We returned $7.90 billion of capital to common shareholders during 2017, including $6.72 billion of common share repurchases and $1.18 billion in common stock dividends. Our Common Equity Tier 1 (CET1) ratio as calculated in accordance with the Standardized approach and the Basel III Advanced approach, in each case reflecting the applicable transitional provisions, was 12.1% and 10.9%, respectively, as of December 2017. See Note 20 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about our capital ratios.

In 2017, we announced strategic growth initiatives with an emphasis on growing earnings and returns. To accomplish these initiatives, we will continue to make investments in our businesses, including in technology and talent, while exploring new opportunities. We estimate these initiatives could generate $5 billion of incremental net revenues and $2.5 billion of incremental pre-tax earnings in 2020.

2016 versus 2015. We generated net earnings of $7.40 billion and diluted earnings per common share of $16.29 for 2016, an increase of 22% and 34%, respectively, compared with $6.08 billion and $12.14 per share for 2015. Return on average common shareholders’ equity was 9.4% for 2016, compared with 7.4% for 2015. Book value per common share was $182.47 as of December 2016, 6.7% higher compared with December 2015.

Net revenues were $30.61 billion for 2016, 9% lower than 2015, due to significantly lower net revenues in Investing & Lending and lower net revenues in Investment Banking, Institutional Client Services and Investment Management. These results reflected the impact of a challenging operating environment during the first half of 2016, particularly during the first quarter, although the environment improved during the second half of the year.

Operating expenses were $20.30 billion for 2016, 19% lower than 2015, primarily due to significantly lower non-compensation expenses, primarily reflecting significantly lower net provisions for mortgage-related litigation and regulatory matters, as 2015 included provisions related to the settlement agreement with the Residential Mortgage-Backed Securities Working Group of the U.S. Financial Fraud Enforcement Task Force (RMBS Working Group), as well as lower market development expenses and professional fees, reflecting expense savings initiatives. Compensation and benefits expenses were also lower, reflecting a decrease in net revenues and the impact of expense savings initiatives.

We returned $7.20 billion of capital to common shareholders during 2016, including $6.07 billion of common share repurchases and $1.13 billion in common stock dividends. Our CET1 ratio as calculated in accordance with the Standardized approach and the Basel III Advanced approach, in each case reflecting the applicable transitional provisions, was 14.5% and 13.1%, respectively, as of December 2016. See Note 20 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about our capital ratios.

 

 

46   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

Business Environment

 

Global

During 2017, real gross domestic product (GDP) growth appeared to generally increase compared to 2016 in both advanced and emerging market economies. In advanced economies, real GDP growth was higher in the U.S., the Euro area and Japan, but decreased slightly in the U.K. In emerging markets, real GDP growth increased slightly in China and appeared to decrease in India. Real GDP appeared to grow in Russia and Brazil compared with contractions in 2016. Broadly, global macroeconomic data remained strong throughout 2017, and volatility in equity, fixed income, currency and commodity markets was low. Major elections were held in France, the U.K., Germany and China, but none of these events resulted in significant volatility across markets. Major central banks continued to gradually tighten their stance on monetary policy, as the U.S. Federal Reserve increased its target interest rate three times and began the process of balance sheet normalization. In investment banking, industry-wide announced and completed mergers and acquisitions transactions remained solid during 2017, although volumes declined compared with 2016. Industry-wide offerings in equity underwriting increased significantly compared with 2016, and industry-wide debt underwriting offerings remained strong, particularly in leveraged finance activity.

United States

In the U.S., real GDP increased by 2.3% in 2017, compared with an increase of 1.5% in 2016, as growth in business fixed investment increased. Measures of consumer confidence were stronger on average compared with the prior year, and the unemployment rate declined to 4.1% as of December 2017. Housing starts, sales and prices increased compared with 2016, while measures of inflation were mixed. The U.S. Federal Reserve increased its target rate for the federal funds rate by 25 basis points at each of the March, June and December meetings to end the year at a target range of 1.25% to 1.50%. In September, the U.S. Federal Reserve formally announced the process of balance sheet normalization. Previously, the U.S. Federal Reserve reinvested all proceeds from the maturity of bonds on its balance sheet, but since October 2017, $6 billion of U.S. Treasury securities and $4 billion of agency debt and mortgage-backed securities matured each month without reinvestment of the proceeds. These monthly allowances are expected to rise gradually over time to peak levels of $30 billion and $20 billion, respectively. The yield on the 10-year U.S. Treasury note decreased by 5 basis points during 2017 to 2.40%. The price of natural gas decreased by 21% compared to the end of 2016 to $2.95 per million British thermal units and the price of crude oil (WTI) increased by 12% to approximately $60 per barrel. In equity markets, the NASDAQ Composite Index, the Dow Jones Industrial Average and the S&P 500 Index increased by 28%, 25% and 19%, respectively, during 2017.

Europe

In the Euro area, real GDP increased by 2.5% in 2017, compared with an increase of 1.7% in 2016. Net exports improved, while growth in consumer spending and fixed investment slowed slightly. Measures of inflation remained subdued, prompting the European Central Bank (ECB) to announce an extension of its asset purchase program in the fourth quarter of 2017, although the pace of its monthly asset purchases decreased from €60 billion to €30 billion beginning in January 2018. The ECB maintained its main refinancing operations rate at 0.00% and its deposit rate at (0.40%). The Euro appreciated by 14% against the U.S. dollar. Yields on 10-year government bonds in the Euro area generally increased during the year. In equity markets, the DAX Index, CAC 40 Index and Euro Stoxx 50 Index increased by 13%, 9% and 6%, respectively, during 2017. During 2017, the process of negotiating an arrangement for the withdrawal of the U.K. from the E.U. began, resulting in an agreement on certain issues in December as negotiations shifted to transitional arrangements. In the U.K., real GDP increased by 1.7% in 2017, compared with an increase of 1.9% in 2016. Inflation increased materially in 2017 prompting the Bank of England to raise the official bank rate by 25 basis points in November. The British pound appreciated by 10% against the U.S. dollar during 2017. Yields on 10-year government bonds in the U.K. decreased slightly during the year and, in equity markets, the FTSE 100 Index increased by 8% during 2017.

Asia

In Japan, real GDP increased by 1.6% in 2017, compared with an increase of 0.9% in 2016. The Bank of Japan maintained its negative interest rate policy and continued to target a yield on 10-year Japanese government bonds of approximately 0%. The yield on 10-year Japanese government bonds was essentially unchanged, the U.S. dollar depreciated by 4% against the Japanese yen and the Nikkei 225 Index increased by 19% in 2017. In China, real GDP increased by 6.9% in 2017, compared with an increase of 6.7% in 2016. The People’s Bank of China slightly tightened its stance on monetary policy in early 2017. Measures of inflation decreased and the U.S. dollar depreciated by 6% against the Chinese yuan. In equity markets, the Hang Seng Index and the Shanghai Composite Index increased by 36% and 7%, respectively, during 2017. In India, real GDP appeared to increase by 6.2% in 2017, compared with an increase of 7.9% in 2016, and the rate of inflation decreased compared with 2016. The U.S. dollar depreciated by 6% against the Indian rupee and the BSE Sensex Index increased by 28% during 2017.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   47


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

Other Markets

In Brazil, real GDP appeared to increase by 1.1% in 2017, compared with a contraction of 3.5% in 2016. The U.S. dollar appreciated by 2% against the Brazilian real and the Bovespa Index increased by 27%. In Russia, real GDP appeared to increase by 1.5% in 2017, compared with a contraction of 0.2% in 2016. The U.S. dollar depreciated by 6% against the Russian ruble and the MICEX Index decreased by 6% during 2017.

Critical Accounting Policies

Fair Value

Fair Value Hierarchy. Financial instruments owned and financial instruments sold, but not yet purchased (i.e., inventory), as well as certain other financial assets and financial liabilities, are included in our consolidated statements of financial condition at fair value (i.e., marked-to-market), with related gains or losses generally recognized in our consolidated statements of earnings. The use of fair value to measure financial instruments is fundamental to our risk management practices and is our most critical accounting policy.

The fair value of a financial instrument is the amount that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date. We measure certain financial assets and financial liabilities as a portfolio (i.e., based on its net exposure to market and/or credit risks). In determining fair value, the hierarchy under U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (U.S. GAAP) gives (i) the highest priority to unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical, unrestricted assets or liabilities (level 1 inputs), (ii) the next priority to inputs other than level 1 inputs that are observable, either directly or indirectly (level 2 inputs), and (iii) the lowest priority to inputs that cannot be observed in market activity (level 3 inputs). In evaluating the significance of a valuation input, we consider, among other factors, a portfolio’s net risk exposure to that input. Assets and liabilities are classified in their entirety based on the lowest level of input that is significant to their fair value measurement.

The fair values for substantially all of our financial assets and financial liabilities are based on observable prices and inputs and are classified in levels 1 and 2 of the fair value hierarchy. Certain level 2 and level 3 financial assets and financial liabilities may require appropriate valuation adjustments that a market participant would require to arrive at fair value for factors such as counterparty and our credit quality, funding risk, transfer restrictions, liquidity and bid/offer spreads.

Instruments classified in level 3 of the fair value hierarchy are those which require one or more significant inputs that are not observable. As of December 2017 and December 2016, level 3 financial assets represented 2.1% and 2.7%, respectively, of our total assets. See Notes 5 through 8 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about level 3 financial assets, including changes in level 3 financial assets and related fair value measurements. Absent evidence to the contrary, instruments classified in level 3 of the fair value hierarchy are initially valued at transaction price, which is considered to be the best initial estimate of fair value. Subsequent to the transaction date, we use other methodologies to determine fair value, which vary based on the type of instrument. Estimating the fair value of level 3 financial instruments requires judgments to be made. These judgments include:

 

 

Determining the appropriate valuation methodology and/or model for each type of level 3 financial instrument;

 

 

Determining model inputs based on an evaluation of all relevant empirical market data, including prices evidenced by market transactions, interest rates, credit spreads, volatilities and correlations; and

 

 

Determining appropriate valuation adjustments, including those related to illiquidity or counterparty credit quality.

Regardless of the methodology, valuation inputs and assumptions are only changed when corroborated by substantive evidence.

Controls Over Valuation of Financial Instruments. Market makers and investment professionals in our revenue-producing units are responsible for pricing our financial instruments. Our control infrastructure is independent of the revenue-producing units and is fundamental to ensuring that all of our financial instruments are appropriately valued at market-clearing levels. In the event that there is a difference of opinion in situations where estimating the fair value of financial instruments requires judgment (e.g., calibration to market comparables or trade comparison, as described below), the final valuation decision is made by senior managers in control and support functions. This independent price verification is critical to ensuring that our financial instruments are properly valued.

 

 

48   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

Price Verification. All financial instruments at fair value classified in levels 1, 2 and 3 of the fair value hierarchy are subject to our independent price verification process. The objective of price verification is to have an informed and independent opinion with regard to the valuation of financial instruments under review. Instruments that have one or more significant inputs which cannot be corroborated by external market data are classified in level 3 of the fair value hierarchy. Price verification strategies utilized by our independent control and support functions include:

 

 

Trade Comparison. Analysis of trade data (both internal and external, where available) is used to determine the most relevant pricing inputs and valuations.

 

 

External Price Comparison. Valuations and prices are compared to pricing data obtained from third parties (e.g., brokers or dealers, Markit, Bloomberg, IDC, TRACE). Data obtained from various sources is compared to ensure consistency and validity. When broker or dealer quotations or third-party pricing vendors are used for valuation or price verification, greater priority is generally given to executable quotations.

 

 

Calibration to Market Comparables. Market-based transactions are used to corroborate the valuation of positions with similar characteristics, risks and components.

 

 

Relative Value Analyses. Market-based transactions are analyzed to determine the similarity, measured in terms of risk, liquidity and return, of one instrument relative to another or, for a given instrument, of one maturity relative to another.

 

 

Collateral Analyses. Margin calls on derivatives are analyzed to determine implied values, which are used to corroborate our valuations.

 

 

Execution of Trades. Where appropriate, trading desks are instructed to execute trades in order to provide evidence of market-clearing levels.

 

 

Backtesting. Valuations are corroborated by comparison to values realized upon sales.

See Notes 5 through 8 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about fair value measurements.

Review of Net Revenues. Independent control and support functions ensure adherence to our pricing policy through a combination of daily procedures, including the explanation and attribution of net revenues based on the underlying factors. Through this process, we independently validate net revenues, identify and resolve potential fair value or trade booking issues on a timely basis and seek to ensure that risks are being properly categorized and quantified.

Review of Valuation Models. Our independent model risk management group (Model Risk Management), consisting of quantitative professionals who are separate from model developers, performs an independent model review and validation process of our valuation models. New or changed models are reviewed and approved prior to being put into use. Models are evaluated and re-approved annually to assess the impact of any changes in the product or market and any market developments in pricing theories. See “Risk Management — Model Risk Management” for further information about the review and validation of our valuation models.

Goodwill and Identifiable Intangible Assets

Goodwill. Goodwill is the cost of acquired companies in excess of the fair value of net assets, including identifiable intangible assets, at the acquisition date.

Goodwill is assessed for impairment annually in the fourth quarter or more frequently if events occur or circumstances change that indicate an impairment may exist. When assessing goodwill for impairment, first, qualitative factors are assessed to determine whether it is more likely than not that the estimated fair value of a reporting unit is less than its estimated carrying value. If the results of the qualitative assessment are not conclusive, a quantitative goodwill test is performed by comparing the estimated fair value of each reporting unit with its estimated carrying value.

In the fourth quarter of 2017, we assessed goodwill for impairment for each of our reporting units by performing a qualitative assessment. The qualitative assessment required management to make judgments and to evaluate several factors, which included, but were not limited to, performance indicators, firm and industry events, macroeconomic indicators and fair value indicators. Based on our evaluation of these factors, we determined that it was more likely than not that the estimated fair value of each of the reporting units exceeded its respective estimated carrying value. Therefore, we determined that goodwill for each reporting unit was not impaired and that a quantitative goodwill test was not required.

See Note 13 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about our goodwill.

Estimating the fair value of our reporting units requires management to make judgments. Critical inputs to the fair value estimates include projected earnings and attributed equity. There is inherent uncertainty in the projected earnings. The estimated net book value of each reporting unit reflects an allocation of total shareholders’ equity and represents the estimated amount of total shareholders’ equity required to support the activities of the reporting unit under currently applicable regulatory capital requirements. See “Equity Capital Management and Regulatory Capital” for further information about our capital requirements.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   49


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

If we experience a prolonged or severe period of weakness in the business environment, financial markets or our performance, or additional increases in capital requirements, our goodwill could be impaired in the future. In addition, significant changes to other inputs of the quantitative goodwill test could cause the estimated fair value of our reporting units to decline, which could result in an impairment of goodwill in the future.

Identifiable Intangible Assets. We amortize our identifiable intangible assets over their estimated useful lives generally using the straight-line method. Identifiable intangible assets are tested for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances suggest that an asset’s or asset group’s carrying value may not be fully recoverable.

A prolonged or severe period of market weakness, or significant changes in regulation, could adversely impact our businesses and impair the value of our identifiable intangible assets. In addition, certain events could indicate a potential impairment of our identifiable intangible assets, including weaker business performance resulting in a decrease in our customer base and decreases in revenues from customer contracts and relationships. Management judgment is required to evaluate whether indications of potential impairment have occurred, and to test intangible assets for impairment, if required.

An impairment, generally calculated as the difference between the estimated fair value and the carrying value of an asset or asset group, is recognized if the total of the estimated undiscounted cash flows relating to the asset or asset group is less than the corresponding carrying value.

See Note 13 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about our identifiable intangible assets.

Recent Accounting Developments

See Note 3 to the consolidated financial statements for information about Recent Accounting Developments.

Use of Estimates

U.S. GAAP requires management to make certain estimates and assumptions. In addition to the estimates we make in connection with fair value measurements and the accounting for goodwill and identifiable intangible assets, the use of estimates and assumptions is also important in determining income tax expense related to Tax Legislation, provisions for losses that may arise from litigation and regulatory proceedings (including governmental investigations), the allowance for losses on loans receivable and lending commitments held for investment, and provisions for losses that may arise from tax audits.

We estimate and provide for potential losses that may arise out of litigation and regulatory proceedings to the extent that such losses are probable and can be reasonably estimated. In addition, we estimate the upper end of the range of reasonably possible aggregate loss in excess of the related reserves for litigation and regulatory proceedings where we believe the risk of loss is more than slight. See Notes 18 and 27 to the consolidated financial statements for information about certain judicial, litigation and regulatory proceedings.

Significant judgment is required in making these estimates and our final liabilities may ultimately be materially different. Our total estimated liability in respect of litigation and regulatory proceedings is determined on a case-by-case basis and represents an estimate of probable losses after considering, among other factors, the progress of each case, proceeding or investigation, our experience and the experience of others in similar cases, proceedings or investigations, and the opinions and views of legal counsel.

In accounting for income taxes, we recorded an estimated impact of Tax Legislation. We have made assumptions and judgments regarding interpretations of Tax Legislation. In addition, in accounting for income taxes, we recognize tax positions in the financial statements only when it is more likely than not that the position will be sustained on examination by the relevant taxing authority based on the technical merits of the position. See Note 24 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about income taxes.

We also estimate and record an allowance for losses related to our loans receivable and lending commitments held for investment. Management’s estimate of loan losses entails judgment about loan collectability at the reporting dates, and there are uncertainties inherent in those judgments. See Note 9 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about the allowance for losses on loans receivable and lending commitments held for investment.

 

 

50   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

Results of Operations

 

The composition of our net revenues has varied over time as financial markets and the scope of our operations have changed. The composition of net revenues can also vary over the shorter term due to fluctuations in U.S. and global economic and market conditions. See “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of this Form 10-K for further information about the impact of economic and market conditions on our results of operations.

Financial Overview

The table below presents an overview of our financial results and selected financial ratios.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions, except per share amounts     2017       2016       2015  

Net revenues

    $32,073       $30,608       $33,820  

Pre-tax earnings

    $11,132       $10,304       $  8,778  

Net earnings

    $  4,286       $  7,398       $  6,083  

Net earnings applicable to common shareholders

    $  3,685       $  7,087       $  5,568  

Diluted earnings per common share

    $    9.01       $  16.29       $  12.14  

Return on average common shareholders’ equity

    4.9%       9.4%       7.4%  

Net earnings to average total assets

    0.5%       0.8%       0.7%  

Return on average total shareholders’ equity

    5.0%       8.5%       7.0%  

Total average shareholders’ equity to average total assets

    9.5%       9.8%       9.9%  

Dividend payout ratio

    32.2%       16.0%       21.0%  

In the table above:

 

 

Dividend payout ratio is calculated by dividing dividends declared per common share by diluted earnings per common share.

 

 

Net earnings applicable to common shareholders for 2016 included a benefit of $266 million, reflected in preferred stock dividends, related to the exchange of APEX for shares of Series E and Series F Preferred Stock. See Note 19 to the consolidated financial statements for further information.

 

 

Return on average common shareholders’ equity is calculated by dividing net earnings applicable to common shareholders by average monthly common shareholders’ equity. Return on average total shareholders’ equity is calculated by dividing net earnings by average monthly total shareholders’ equity. The table below presents our average common and total shareholders’ equity.

 

    Average for the Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017        2016        2015  

Total shareholders’ equity

    $ 85,959        $ 86,658        $ 86,314  

Preferred stock

    (11,238      (11,304      (10,585

Common shareholders’ equity

    $ 74,721        $ 75,354        $ 75,729  
 

In 2017, we recorded $4.40 billion of estimated income tax expense related to Tax Legislation. Excluding this expense, diluted earnings per common share were $19.76 and return on average common shareholders’ equity was 10.8% for 2017. We believe that presenting our results excluding Tax Legislation is meaningful as excluding this item increases the comparability of period-to-period results. See “Results of Operations — Provision for Taxes” below for further information about Tax Legislation. Diluted earnings per common share and return on average common shareholders’ equity, excluding the estimated impact of Tax Legislation, are non-GAAP measures and may not be comparable to similar non-GAAP measures used by other companies. The tables below present the calculation of net earnings applicable to common shareholders, diluted earnings per common share and average common shareholders’ equity, excluding the estimated impact of Tax Legislation.

 

in millions, except per share amounts    
Year Ended
December 2017
 
 

Net earnings applicable to common shareholders, as reported

    $  3,685  

Estimated impact of Tax Legislation

    4,400  

Net earnings applicable to common shareholders, excluding the estimated impact of Tax Legislation

    $  8,085  

Divided by average diluted common shares

    409.1  

Diluted earnings per common share, excluding the estimated impact of Tax Legislation

    $  19.76  

 

$ in millions    
Average for the
Year Ended December 2017
 
 

Common shareholders’ equity, as reported

    $74,721  

Estimated impact of Tax Legislation

    338  

Common shareholders’ equity, excluding the estimated impact of Tax Legislation

    $75,059  

 

 

In 2017, as required, we adopted ASU No. 2016-09, “Compensation — Stock Compensation (Topic 718) — Improvements to Employee Share-Based Payment Accounting.” The impact of adoption was a reduction to our provision for taxes of $719 million for 2017, which increased diluted earnings per common share by approximately $1.75 and return on average common shareholders’ equity by approximately 1.0 percentage points. See Note 3 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about this ASU.

 

 

In 2015, we recorded provisions of $3.37 billion related to the settlement agreement with the RMBS Working Group, which reduced diluted earnings per common share by $6.53 and return on average common shareholders’ equity by 3.8 percentage points for 2015. See Note 27 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2015 for further information.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   51


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

Net Revenues

The table below presents our net revenues by line item in the consolidated statements of earnings.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017        2016        2015  

Investment banking

    $  7,371        $  6,273        $  7,027  

Investment management

    5,803        5,407        5,868  

Commissions and fees

    3,051        3,208        3,320  

Market making

    7,660        9,933        9,523  

Other principal transactions

    5,256        3,200        5,018  

Total non-interest revenues

    29,141        28,021        30,756  

Interest income

    13,113        9,691        8,452  

Interest expense

    10,181        7,104        5,388  

Net interest income

    2,932        2,587        3,064  

Total net revenues

    $32,073        $30,608        $33,820  

In the table above:

 

 

Investment banking consists of revenues (excluding net interest) from financial advisory and underwriting assignments, as well as derivative transactions directly related to these assignments. These activities are included in our Investment Banking segment.

 

 

Investment management consists of revenues (excluding net interest) from providing investment management services to a diverse set of clients, as well as wealth advisory services and certain transaction services to high-net-worth individuals and families. These activities are included in our Investment Management segment.

 

 

Commissions and fees consists of revenues from executing and clearing client transactions on major stock, options and futures exchanges worldwide, as well as over-the-counter (OTC) transactions. These activities are included in our Institutional Client Services and Investment Management segments.

 

 

Market making consists of revenues (excluding net interest) from client execution activities related to making markets in interest rate products, credit products, mortgages, currencies, commodities and equity products. These activities are included in our Institutional Client Services segment.

 

 

Other principal transactions consists of revenues (excluding net interest) from our investing activities and the origination of loans to provide financing to clients. In addition, other principal transactions includes revenues related to our consolidated investments. These activities are included in our Investing & Lending segment.

Operating Environment. During 2017, generally higher asset prices and tighter credit spreads were supportive of industry-wide underwriting activities, investment management performance and other principal transactions. However, low levels of volatility in equity, fixed income, currency and commodity markets continued to negatively affect our market-making activities, particularly in fixed income, currency and commodity products. The price of natural gas decreased significantly during 2017, while the price of oil increased compared with the end of 2016.

If the trend of low volatility continues over the long term and market-making activity levels remain low, or if investment banking activity levels, asset prices or assets under supervision decline, net revenues would likely be negatively impacted. See “Segment Operating Results” below for further information about the operating environment and material trends and uncertainties that may impact our results of operations.

The first half of 2016 included challenging trends in the operating environment for our business activities including concerns and uncertainties about global economic growth, central bank activity and the political uncertainty and economic implications surrounding the potential exit of the U.K. from the E.U. During the second half of 2016, the operating environment improved, as global equity markets steadily increased and investment grade and high-yield credit spreads tightened. These trends provided a more favorable backdrop for our business activities.

2017 versus 2016

Net revenues in the consolidated statements of earnings were $32.07 billion for 2017, 5% higher than 2016, due to significantly higher other principal transactions revenues, and higher investment banking revenues, investment management revenues and net interest income. These increases were partially offset by significantly lower market making revenues and lower commissions and fees.

Non-Interest Revenues. Investment banking revenues in the consolidated statements of earnings were $7.37 billion for 2017, 18% higher than 2016. Revenues in financial advisory were higher compared with 2016, reflecting an increase in completed mergers and acquisitions transactions. Revenues in underwriting were significantly higher compared with 2016, due to significantly higher revenues in both debt underwriting, primarily reflecting an increase in industry-wide leveraged finance activity, and equity underwriting, reflecting an increase in industry-wide secondary offerings.

 

 

52   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

Investment management revenues in the consolidated statements of earnings were $5.80 billion for 2017, 7% higher than 2016, due to higher management and other fees, reflecting higher average assets under supervision, and higher transaction revenues.

Commissions and fees in the consolidated statements of earnings were $3.05 billion for 2017, 5% lower than 2016, reflecting a decline in our listed cash equity volumes in the U.S. Market volumes in the U.S. also declined.

Market making revenues in the consolidated statements of earnings were $7.66 billion for 2017, 23% lower than 2016, due to significantly lower revenues in commodities, currencies, credit products, interest rate products and equity derivative products. These results were partially offset by significantly higher revenues in equity cash products and significantly improved results in mortgages.

Other principal transactions revenues in the consolidated statements of earnings were $5.26 billion for 2017, 64% higher than 2016, primarily reflecting a significant increase in net gains from private equities, which were positively impacted by company-specific events and corporate performance. In addition, net gains from public equities were significantly higher, as global equity prices increased during the year.

Net Interest Income. Net interest income in the consolidated statements of earnings was $2.93 billion for 2017, 13% higher than 2016, reflecting an increase in interest income primarily due to the impact of higher interest rates on collateralized agreements, higher interest income from loans receivable due to higher yields and an increase in total average loans receivable, an increase in total average financial instruments owned, and the impact of higher interest rates on other interest-earning assets and deposits with banks. The increase in interest income was partially offset by higher interest expense primarily due to the impact of higher interest rates on other interest-bearing liabilities, an increase in total average long-term borrowings, and the impact of higher interest rates on interest-bearing deposits, short-term borrowings and collateralized financings. See “Statistical Disclosures — Distribution of Assets, Liabilities and Shareholders’ Equity” for further information about our sources of net interest income.

2016 versus 2015

Net revenues in the consolidated statements of earnings were $30.61 billion for 2016, 9% lower than 2015, reflecting the impact of a challenging operating environment during the first half of 2016, particularly during the first quarter, although the environment improved during the second half of the year. The decrease in net revenues was primarily due to significantly lower other principal transactions revenues and lower investment banking revenues, net interest income and investment management revenues. In addition, commissions and fees were slightly lower. These results were partially offset by slightly higher market making revenues.

Non-Interest Revenues. Investment banking revenues in the consolidated statements of earnings were $6.27 billion for 2016, 11% lower compared with a strong 2015. Revenues in financial advisory were lower compared with a strong 2015, reflecting a decrease in industry-wide transactions. Revenues in underwriting were lower compared with a strong 2015, due to significantly lower revenues in equity underwriting, reflecting a decrease in industry-wide volumes. Revenues in debt underwriting were significantly higher, reflecting significantly higher revenues from asset-backed activity and higher revenues from leveraged finance activity.

Investment management revenues in the consolidated statements of earnings were $5.41 billion for 2016, 8% lower than 2015, primarily reflecting significantly lower incentive fees compared with a strong 2015. In addition, management and other fees were slightly lower, reflecting shifts in the mix of client assets and strategies, partially offset by the impact of higher average assets under supervision.

Commissions and fees in the consolidated statements of earnings were $3.21 billion for 2016, 3% lower than 2015, reflecting lower listed cash equity volumes in Asia and Europe, consistent with market volumes in these regions.

Market making revenues in the consolidated statements of earnings were $9.93 billion for 2016, 4% higher than 2015, due to significantly higher revenues in interest rate products and credit products. These results were partially offset by significantly lower revenues in equity cash products and lower revenues in currencies, mortgages, equity derivative products and commodities.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   53


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

Other principal transactions revenues in the consolidated statements of earnings were $3.20 billion for 2016, 36% lower than 2015, primarily due to significantly lower revenues from investments in equities, primarily reflecting a significant decrease in net gains from private equities, driven by company-specific events and corporate performance. In addition, revenues in debt securities and loans were significantly lower compared with 2015, reflecting significantly lower revenues related to relationship lending activities, due to the impact of changes in credit spreads on economic hedges. Losses related to these hedges were $596 million in 2016, compared with gains of $329 million in 2015. This decrease was partially offset by higher net gains from investments in debt instruments. See Note 9 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about economic hedges related to our relationship lending activities.

Net Interest Income. Net interest income in the consolidated statements of earnings was $2.59 billion for 2016, 16% lower than 2015, reflecting an increase in interest expense primarily due to the impact of higher interest rates on other interest-bearing liabilities, interest-bearing deposits and collateralized financings, and increases in total average long-term borrowings and total average interest-bearing deposits. The increase in interest expense was partially offset by higher interest income related to collateralized agreements, reflecting the impact of higher interest rates, and loans receivable, reflecting an increase in total average balances and the impact of higher interest rates. See “Statistical Disclosures — Distribution of Assets, Liabilities and Shareholders’ Equity” for further information about our sources of net interest income.

Operating Expenses

Our operating expenses are primarily influenced by compensation, headcount and levels of business activity. Compensation and benefits includes salaries, discretionary compensation, amortization of equity awards and other items such as benefits. Discretionary compensation is significantly impacted by, among other factors, the level of net revenues, overall financial performance, prevailing labor markets, business mix, the structure of our share-based compensation programs and the external environment. In addition, see “Use of Estimates” for further information about expenses that may arise from litigation and regulatory proceedings.

In the context of the challenging environment, we completed an initiative during 2016 that identified areas where we can operate more efficiently, resulting in a reduction of approximately $900 million in annual run rate compensation. For 2016, net savings from this initiative, after severance and other related costs, were approximately $500 million.

The table below presents our operating expenses and total staff (including employees, consultants and temporary staff).

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017        2016        2015  

Compensation and benefits

    $11,853        $11,647        $12,678  

 

Brokerage, clearing, exchange and distribution fees

    2,540        2,555        2,576  

Market development

    588        457        557  

Communications and technology

    897        809        806  

Depreciation and amortization

    1,152        998        991  

Occupancy

    733        788        772  

Professional fees

    965        882        963  

Other expenses

    2,213        2,168        5,699  

Total non-compensation expenses

    9,088        8,657        12,364  

Total operating expenses

    $20,941        $20,304        $25,042  

 

Total staff at period-end

    36,600        34,400        36,800  

In the table above, other expenses for 2015 included $3.37 billion recorded for the settlement agreement with the RMBS Working Group. See Note 27 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2015 for further information.

2017 versus 2016. Operating expenses in the consolidated statements of earnings were $20.94 billion for 2017, 3% higher than 2016. Compensation and benefits expenses in the consolidated statements of earnings were $11.85 billion for 2017, 2% higher than 2016. The ratio of compensation and benefits to net revenues for 2017 was 37.0% compared with 38.1% for 2016.

Non-compensation expenses in the consolidated statements of earnings were $9.09 billion for 2017, 5% higher than 2016, primarily driven by our investments to fund growth. The increase compared with 2016 reflected higher expenses related to consolidated investments and our digital lending and deposit platform, Marcus: by Goldman Sachs (Marcus). These increases were primarily included in depreciation and amortization expenses, market development expenses and other expenses. In addition, technology expenses increased, reflecting higher expenses related to cloud-based services and software depreciation, and professional fees increased, primarily related to consulting costs. These increases were partially offset by lower net provisions for litigation and regulatory proceedings, and lower occupancy expenses (primarily related to exit costs in 2016).

Net provisions for litigation and regulatory proceedings for 2017 were $188 million compared with $396 million for 2016. 2017 included a $127 million charitable contribution to Goldman Sachs Gives, our donor-advised fund. Compensation was reduced to fund this charitable contribution to Goldman Sachs Gives. We ask our participating managing directors to make recommendations regarding potential charitable recipients for this contribution.

 

 

54   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

As of December 2017, total staff increased 6% compared with December 2016, reflecting investments in technology and Marcus, and support of our regulatory efforts.

2016 versus 2015. Operating expenses in the consolidated statements of earnings were $20.30 billion for 2016, 19% lower than 2015. Compensation and benefits expenses in the consolidated statements of earnings were $11.65 billion for 2016, 8% lower than 2015, reflecting a decrease in net revenues and the impact of expense savings initiatives. The ratio of compensation and benefits to net revenues for 2016 was 38.1% compared with 37.5% for 2015.

Non-compensation expenses in the consolidated statements of earnings were $8.66 billion for 2016, 30% lower than 2015, primarily due to significantly lower net provisions for mortgage-related litigation and regulatory matters, which are included in other expenses. In addition, market development expenses and professional fees were lower compared with 2015, reflecting expense savings initiatives. Net provisions for litigation and regulatory proceedings for 2016 were $396 million compared with $4.01 billion for 2015 (2015 primarily related to net provisions for mortgage-related matters). 2016 included a $114 million charitable contribution to Goldman Sachs Gives. Compensation was reduced to fund this charitable contribution to Goldman Sachs Gives. We ask our participating managing directors to make recommendations regarding potential charitable recipients for this contribution.

As of December 2016, total staff decreased 7% compared with December 2015, due to expense savings initiatives.

Provision for Taxes

The effective income tax rate for 2017 was 61.5%, up from 28.2% for 2016. The increase compared with 2016 reflected the estimated impact of Tax Legislation, which was enacted on December 22, 2017 and, among other things, lowers U.S. corporate income tax rates as of January 1, 2018, implements a territorial tax system and imposes a repatriation tax on deemed repatriated earnings of foreign subsidiaries. The estimated impact of Tax Legislation was an increase in income tax expense of $4.40 billion, of which $3.32 billion was due to the repatriation tax and $1.08 billion was due to the effects of the implementation of the territorial tax system and the remeasurement of U.S. deferred tax assets at lower enacted corporate tax rates.

The impact of Tax Legislation may differ from this estimate, possibly materially, due to, among other things, (i) refinement of our calculations based on updated information, (ii) changes in interpretations and assumptions, (iii) guidance that may be issued and (iv) actions we may take as a result of Tax Legislation.

Excluding the estimated impact of Tax Legislation, the effective income tax rate for 2017 was 22.0%, down from 28.2% for 2016. This decrease was primarily due to tax benefits on the settlement of employee share-based awards in accordance with ASU No. 2016-09. The impact of these settlements in 2017 was a reduction to our provision for taxes of $719 million and a reduction in our effective income tax rate of 6.4 percentage points. See Note 3 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about this ASU.

The effective income tax rate, excluding the estimated impact of Tax Legislation, is a non-GAAP measure and may not be comparable to similar non-GAAP measures used by other companies. We believe that presenting our effective income tax rate, excluding the estimated impact of Tax Legislation is meaningful, as excluding this item increases the comparability of period-to-period results.

The table below presents the calculation of the effective income tax rate, excluding the estimated impact of Tax Legislation.

 

    Year Ended December 2017  
$ in millions    
Pre-tax
earnings

 
   
Provision
for taxes
 
 
   
Effective income
tax rate

 

As reported

    $11,132       $6,846       61.5%  

Estimated impact of Tax Legislation

          4,400        

Excluding the estimated impact of Tax Legislation

    $11,132       $2,446       22.0%  

The effective income tax rate for 2016 was 28.2%, down from 30.7% for 2015. The decline compared with 2015 was primarily due to the impact of non-deductible provisions for mortgage-related litigation and regulatory matters in 2015, partially offset by the impact of changes in tax law on deferred tax assets, the mix of earnings and an increase related to higher enacted tax rates impacting certain of our U.K. subsidiaries in 2016.

Effective January 1, 2018, Tax Legislation reduced the U.S. corporate tax rate to 21 percent, eliminated tax deductions for certain expenses and enacted two new taxes, Base Erosion and Anti-Abuse Tax (BEAT) and Global Intangible Low Taxed Income (GILTI). BEAT is an alternative minimum tax that applies to banks that pay more than 2 percent of total deductible expenses to certain foreign subsidiaries. GILTI is a 10.5 percent tax, before allowable credits for foreign taxes paid, on the annual earnings and profits of certain foreign subsidiaries. Based on our current understanding of these rules, the impact of BEAT and GILTI is not expected to be material to our effective income tax rate.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   55


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

Segment Operating Results

The table below presents the net revenues, operating expenses and pre-tax earnings of our segments.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017        2016        2015  

Investment Banking

       

Net revenues

    $  7,371        $  6,273        $  7,027  

Operating expenses

    3,526        3,437        3,713  

Pre-tax earnings

    $  3,845        $  2,836        $  3,314  

 

Institutional Client Services

       

Net revenues

    $11,902        $14,467        $15,151  

Operating expenses

    9,692        9,713        13,938  

Pre-tax earnings

    $  2,210        $  4,754        $  1,213  

 

Investing & Lending

       

Net revenues

    $  6,581        $  4,080        $  5,436  

Operating expenses

    2,796        2,386        2,402  

Pre-tax earnings

    $  3,785        $  1,694        $  3,034  

 

Investment Management

       

Net revenues

    $  6,219        $  5,788        $  6,206  

Operating expenses

    4,800        4,654        4,841  

Pre-tax earnings

    $  1,419        $  1,134        $  1,365  

 

Total net revenues

    $32,073        $30,608        $33,820  

Total operating expenses

    20,941        20,304        25,042  

Total pre-tax earnings

    $11,132        $10,304        $  8,778  

In the table above:

 

 

Operating expenses included $3.37 billion recorded in Institutional Client Services in 2015 related to the settlement agreement with the RMBS Working Group. See Note 27 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2015 for further information.

 

 

All operating expenses have been allocated to our segments except for charitable contributions of $127 million for 2017, $114 million for 2016 and $148 million for 2015.

Net revenues in our segments include allocations of interest income and interest expense to specific securities, commodities and other positions in relation to the cash generated by, or funding requirements of, such underlying positions. See Note 25 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about our business segments.

Our cost drivers taken as a whole, compensation, headcount and levels of business activity, are broadly similar in each of our business segments. Compensation and benefits expenses within our segments reflect, among other factors, our overall performance, as well as the performance of individual businesses. Consequently, pre-tax margins in one segment of our business may be significantly affected by the performance of our other business segments. A description of segment operating results follows.

Investment Banking

Our Investment Banking segment consists of:

Financial Advisory. Includes strategic advisory assignments with respect to mergers and acquisitions, divestitures, corporate defense activities, restructurings, spin-offs, risk management and derivative transactions directly related to these client advisory assignments.

Underwriting. Includes public offerings and private placements, including local and cross-border transactions and acquisition financing, of a wide range of securities and other financial instruments, including loans, and derivative transactions directly related to these client underwriting activities.

The table below presents the operating results of our Investment Banking segment.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017        2016        2015  

Financial Advisory

    $3,188        $2,932        $3,470  

 

Equity underwriting

    1,243        891        1,546  

Debt underwriting

    2,940        2,450        2,011  

Total Underwriting

    4,183        3,341        3,557  

Total net revenues

    7,371        6,273        7,027  

Operating expenses

    3,526        3,437        3,713  

Pre-tax earnings

    $3,845        $2,836        $3,314  

The table below presents our financial advisory and underwriting transaction volumes.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in billions     2017        2016        2015  

Announced mergers and acquisitions

    $1,016        $   969        $1,530  

Completed mergers and acquisitions

    $   933        $1,215        $1,241  

Equity and equity-related offerings

    $     68        $     49        $     73  

Debt offerings

    $   279        $   266        $   244  
 

 

56   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

In the table above:

 

 

Volumes are per Dealogic. Prior periods have been conformed to reflect volumes per Dealogic.

 

 

Announced and completed mergers and acquisitions volumes are based on full credit to each of the advisors in a transaction. Equity and equity-related offerings and debt offerings are based on full credit for single book managers and equal credit for joint book managers. Transaction volumes may not be indicative of net revenues in a given period. In addition, transaction volumes for prior periods may vary from amounts previously reported due to the subsequent withdrawal or a change in the value of a transaction.

 

 

Equity and equity-related offerings includes Rule 144A and public common stock offerings, convertible offerings and rights offerings.

 

 

Debt offerings includes non-convertible preferred stock, mortgage-backed securities, asset-backed securities and taxable municipal debt. Includes publicly registered and Rule 144A issues. Excludes leveraged loans.

Operating Environment. During 2017, industry-wide announced and completed mergers and acquisitions transactions remained solid, increasing slightly compared with 2016, although volumes declined compared with the prior year.

In underwriting, generally higher equity prices and tighter credit spreads during 2017 continued to contribute to a relatively favorable financing environment. Industry-wide debt underwriting offerings remained strong, particularly in leveraged finance activity. Industry-wide equity underwriting offerings increased significantly during 2017 compared with the weak backdrop for new issuances during 2016.

In the future, if industry-wide mergers and acquisitions transactions decline or volumes continue to decline, or if industry-wide activity levels in debt underwriting or equity underwriting decline, net revenues in Investment Banking would likely be negatively impacted.

During 2016, Investment Banking operated in an environment characterized by robust industry-wide mergers and acquisitions activity. Industry-wide equity underwriting volumes decreased significantly compared with strong levels in 2015, while industry-wide debt underwriting volumes increased compared with 2015.

2017 versus 2016. Net revenues in Investment Banking were $7.37 billion for 2017, 18% higher than 2016.

Net revenues in Financial Advisory were $3.19 billion, 9% higher than 2016, reflecting an increase in completed mergers and acquisitions transactions. Net revenues in Underwriting were $4.18 billion, 25% higher than 2016, due to significantly higher net revenues in both debt underwriting, primarily reflecting an increase in industry-wide leveraged finance activity, and equity underwriting, reflecting an increase in industry-wide secondary offerings.

Operating expenses were $3.53 billion for 2017, 3% higher than 2016, due to increased compensation and benefits expenses, reflecting higher net revenues. Pre-tax earnings were $3.85 billion in 2017, 36% higher than 2016.

As of December 2017, our investment banking transaction backlog increased compared with the end of 2016, due to significantly higher estimated net revenues from potential debt underwriting transactions and significantly higher estimated net revenues from potential equity underwriting transactions, primarily in initial public offerings. These increases were partially offset by lower estimated net revenues from potential advisory transactions, principally related to mergers and acquisitions.

Our investment banking transaction backlog represents an estimate of our future net revenues from investment banking transactions where we believe that future revenue realization is more likely than not. We believe changes in our investment banking transaction backlog may be a useful indicator of client activity levels which, over the long term, impact our net revenues. However, the time frame for completion and corresponding revenue recognition of transactions in our backlog varies based on the nature of the assignment, as certain transactions may remain in our backlog for longer periods of time and others may enter and leave within the same reporting period. In addition, our transaction backlog is subject to certain limitations, such as assumptions about the likelihood that individual client transactions will occur in the future. Transactions may be cancelled or modified, and transactions not included in the estimate may also occur.

2016 versus 2015. Net revenues in Investment Banking were $6.27 billion for 2016, 11% lower compared with a strong 2015.

Net revenues in Financial Advisory were $2.93 billion, 16% lower compared with a strong 2015, reflecting a decrease in industry-wide transactions. Net revenues in Underwriting were $3.34 billion, 6% lower compared with a strong 2015, due to significantly lower net revenues in equity underwriting, reflecting a decrease in industry-wide volumes. Net revenues in debt underwriting were significantly higher, reflecting significantly higher net revenues from asset-backed activity and higher net revenues from leveraged finance activity.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   57


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

Operating expenses were $3.44 billion for 2016, 7% lower than 2015, due to decreased compensation and benefits expenses, reflecting lower net revenues. Pre-tax earnings were $2.84 billion in 2016, 14% lower than 2015.

As of December 2016, our investment banking transaction backlog was lower compared with a strong level of backlog at the end of 2015, primarily due to lower estimated net revenues from potential advisory transactions and significantly lower estimated net revenues from potential debt underwriting transactions, principally reflecting decreases in mergers and acquisitions activity and acquisition-related financing, respectively. Estimated net revenues from potential equity underwriting transactions were slightly lower compared with the end of 2015.

Institutional Client Services

Our Institutional Client Services segment consists of:

Fixed Income, Currency and Commodities Client Execution. Includes client execution activities related to making markets in both cash and derivative instruments for interest rate products, credit products, mortgages, currencies and commodities.

 

 

Interest Rate Products. Government bonds (including inflation-linked securities) across maturities, other government-backed securities, repurchase agreements, and interest rate swaps, options and other derivatives.

 

 

Credit Products. Investment-grade corporate securities, high-yield securities, credit derivatives, exchange-traded funds, bank and bridge loans, municipal securities, emerging market and distressed debt, and trade claims.

 

 

Mortgages. Commercial mortgage-related securities, loans and derivatives, residential mortgage-related securities, loans and derivatives (including U.S. government agency-issued collateralized mortgage obligations and other securities and loans), and other asset-backed securities, loans and derivatives.

 

 

Currencies. Currency options, spot/forwards and other derivatives on G-10 currencies and emerging-market products.

 

 

Commodities. Commodity derivatives and, to a lesser extent, physical commodities, involving crude oil and petroleum products, natural gas, base, precious and other metals, electricity, coal, agricultural and other commodity products.

Equities. Includes client execution activities related to making markets in equity products and commissions and fees from executing and clearing institutional client transactions on major stock, options and futures exchanges worldwide, as well as OTC transactions. Equities also includes our securities services business, which provides financing, securities lending and other prime brokerage services to institutional clients, including hedge funds, mutual funds, pension funds and foundations, and generates revenues primarily in the form of interest rate spreads or fees.

Market-Making Activities

As a market maker, we facilitate transactions in both liquid and less liquid markets, primarily for institutional clients, such as corporations, financial institutions, investment funds and governments, to assist clients in meeting their investment objectives and in managing their risks. In this role, we seek to earn the difference between the price at which a market participant is willing to sell an instrument to us and the price at which another market participant is willing to buy it from us, and vice versa (i.e., bid/offer spread). In addition, we maintain inventory, typically for a short period of time, in response to, or in anticipation of, client demand. We also hold inventory to actively manage our risk exposures that arise from these market-making activities. Our market-making inventory is recorded in financial instruments owned (long positions) or financial instruments sold, but not yet purchased (short positions) in our consolidated statements of financial condition.

Our results are influenced by a combination of interconnected drivers, including (i) client activity levels and transactional bid/offer spreads (collectively, client activity), and (ii) changes in the fair value of our inventory and interest income and interest expense related to the holding, hedging and funding of our inventory (collectively, market-making inventory changes). Due to the integrated nature of our market-making activities, disaggregation of net revenues into client activity and market-making inventory changes is judgmental and has inherent complexities and limitations.

The amount and composition of our net revenues vary over time as these drivers are impacted by multiple interrelated factors affecting economic and market conditions, including volatility and liquidity in the market, changes in interest rates, currency exchange rates, credit spreads, equity prices and commodity prices, investor confidence, and other macroeconomic concerns and uncertainties.

 

 

58   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

In general, assuming all other market-making conditions remain constant, increases in client activity levels or bid/offer spreads tend to result in increases in net revenues, and decreases tend to have the opposite effect. However, changes in market-making conditions can materially impact client activity levels and bid/offer spreads, as well as the fair value of our inventory. For example, a decrease in liquidity in the market could have the impact of (i) increasing our bid/offer spread, (ii) decreasing investor confidence and thereby decreasing client activity levels, and (iii) wider credit spreads on our inventory positions.

The table below presents the operating results of our Institutional Client Services segment.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017        2016        2015  

FICC Client Execution

    $  5,299        $  7,556        $  7,322  

 

Equities client execution

    2,046        2,194        3,028  

Commissions and fees

    2,920        3,078        3,156  

Securities services

    1,637        1,639        1,645  

Total Equities

    6,603        6,911        7,829  

Total net revenues

    11,902        14,467        15,151  

Operating expenses

    9,692        9,713        13,938  

Pre-tax earnings

    $  2,210        $  4,754        $  1,213  

The table below presents net revenues of our Institutional Client Services segment by line item in the consolidated statements of earnings. See “Net Revenues” above for further information about market making revenues, commissions and fees, and net interest income.

 

$ in millions    
FICC Client
Execution
 
 
    
Total
Equities
 
 
    

Institutional
Client
Services
 
 
 

Year Ended December 2017

       

Market making

    $  4,403        $  3,257        $  7,660  

Commissions and fees

           2,920        2,920  

Net interest income

    896        426        1,322  

Total net revenues

    $  5,299        $  6,603        $11,902  

 

Year Ended December 2016

       

Market making

    $  6,803        $  3,130        $  9,933  

Commissions and fees

           3,078        3,078  

Net interest income

    753        703        1,456  

Total net revenues

    $  7,556        $  6,911        $14,467  

 

Year Ended December 2015

       

Market making

    $  5,893        $  3,630        $  9,523  

Commissions and fees

           3,156        3,156  

Net interest income

    1,429        1,043        2,472  

Total net revenues

    $  7,322        $  7,829        $15,151  

In the table above:

 

 

The difference between commissions and fees and those in the consolidated statements of earnings represents commissions and fees included in our Investment Management segment.

 

 

See Note 25 to the consolidated financial statements for net interest income by business segment.

 

 

The primary driver of net revenues for FICC Client Execution, for the periods in the table above, was client activity.

Operating Environment. Low volatility levels in equity, fixed income, currency and commodity markets were a consistent theme during 2017, impacting the operating environment for Institutional Client Services throughout the year. During 2017, average VIX declined to 11.10 compared with 15.84 in 2016, U.S. and European interest rates experienced historically low volatility levels, and volatility in G-10 currencies were near 10-year lows. This continued to negatively affect client activity across businesses, particularly in FICC Client Execution for 2017.

Although market-making conditions remained challenging, including the price of natural gas decreasing by 21% compared to the end of 2016 to $2.95 per million British thermal units, there were some positives in the financial markets. Global equity markets continued to increase, with the MSCI World Index up 22% during 2017, and credit spreads continued to generally tighten in 2017. In addition, the price of oil increased by 12% compared to the end of 2016 to approximately $60 per barrel (WTI).

If the trend of low volatility continues over the long term and activity levels remain low, net revenues in Institutional Client Services would likely continue to be negatively impacted. See “Business Environment” above for further information about economic and market conditions in the global operating environment during the year.

The first half of 2016 included challenging trends in the operating environment for Institutional Client Services including concerns and uncertainties about global economic growth, central bank activity and the political uncertainty and economic implications surrounding the potential exit of the U.K. from the E.U. During the second half of 2016, the operating environment improved, as global equity markets steadily increased and investment grade and high-yield credit spreads tightened. These trends drove improved client sentiment and market-making conditions during the second half of 2016.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   59


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

2017 versus 2016. Net revenues in Institutional Client Services were $11.90 billion for 2017, 18% lower than 2016.

Net revenues in FICC Client Execution were $5.30 billion for 2017, 30% lower than 2016, reflecting significantly lower client activity. Approximately one-third of the decline in FICC Client Execution net revenues was due to significantly lower results in commodities.

The following provides details of our FICC Client Execution net revenues by business, compared with 2016 results:

 

 

Net revenues in commodities were significantly lower, reflecting the impact of challenging market-making conditions on our inventory.

 

 

Net revenues in interest rate products were significantly lower, reflecting lower client activity.

 

 

Net revenues in currencies were significantly lower, reflecting lower client activity and the impact of challenging market-making conditions on our inventory.

 

 

Net revenues in credit products were significantly lower, reflecting lower client activity.

 

 

Net revenues in mortgages were significantly higher, reflecting the impact of favorable market-making conditions on our inventory, including generally tighter spreads, compared with a challenging 2016.

Net revenues in Equities were $6.60 billion, 4% lower than 2016, primarily due to lower commissions and fees, reflecting a decline in our listed cash equity volumes in the U.S. Market volumes in the U.S. also declined. In addition, net revenues in equities client execution were lower, reflecting lower net revenues in derivatives, partially offset by higher net revenues in cash products. Net revenues in securities services were essentially unchanged.

Operating expenses were $9.69 billion for 2017, essentially unchanged compared with 2016, due to decreased compensation and benefits expenses, reflecting lower net revenues, largely offset by increased technology expenses, reflecting higher expenses related to cloud-based services and software depreciation, and increased consulting costs. Pre-tax earnings were $2.21 billion in 2017, 54% lower than 2016.

2016 versus 2015. Net revenues in Institutional Client Services were $14.47 billion for 2016, 5% lower than 2015.

Net revenues in FICC Client Execution were $7.56 billion for 2016, 3% higher than 2015. This increase was primarily driven by the impact of changes in market- making conditions on our inventory.

The following provides details of our FICC Client Execution net revenues by business, compared with 2015 results:

 

 

Net revenues in credit products were significantly higher, reflecting improved market-making conditions, including generally tighter spreads, and higher client activity levels compared with low activity in 2015.

 

 

Net revenues in interest rate products were higher, reflecting higher client activity levels.

 

 

Net revenues in mortgages were significantly lower, reflecting less favorable market-making conditions, including generally wider spreads.

 

 

Net revenues in currencies were lower, reflecting less favorable market-making conditions in emerging markets products compared with 2015, which included a strong first quarter of 2015.

 

 

Net revenues in commodities were lower, reflecting significantly lower client activity.

Net revenues in Equities were $6.91 billion, 12% lower than 2015, primarily due to significantly lower net revenues in equities client execution, reflecting significantly lower net revenues in cash products, primarily in Asia, as well as lower net revenues in derivatives. Commissions and fees were slightly lower, reflecting lower listed cash equity volumes in Asia and Europe, consistent with market volumes in these regions, and net revenues in securities services were essentially unchanged compared with 2015.

We elect the fair value option for certain unsecured borrowings. For 2015, the fair value net gain attributable to the impact of changes in our credit spreads on these borrowings was $255 million ($214 million and $41 million related to FICC Client Execution and equities client execution, respectively). For 2016, we adopted the requirement in ASU No. 2016-01 to present separately such gains and losses in other comprehensive income. The amount included in accumulated other comprehensive loss for 2016 was a loss of $844 million ($544 million, net of tax). See Note 3 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about ASU No. 2016-01.

Operating expenses were $9.71 billion for 2016, 30% lower than 2015, primarily due to significantly lower net provisions for mortgage-related litigation and regulatory matters, and decreased compensation and benefits expenses, reflecting lower net revenues. Pre-tax earnings were $4.75 billion in 2016 compared with $1.21 billion in 2015.

 

 

60   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

Investing & Lending

Investing & Lending includes our investing activities and the origination of loans, including our relationship lending activities, to provide financing to clients. These investments and loans are typically longer-term in nature. We make investments, some of which are consolidated, including through our merchant banking business and our special situations group, in debt securities and loans, public and private equity securities, infrastructure and real estate entities. Some of these investments are made indirectly through funds that we manage. We also make unsecured and secured loans to retail clients through our digital platforms, Marcus and Goldman Sachs Private Bank Select (GS Select), respectively.

The table below presents the operating results of our Investing & Lending segment.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017        2016        2015  

Equity securities

    $4,578        $2,573        $3,781  

Debt securities and loans

    2,003        1,507        1,655  

Total net revenues

    6,581        4,080        5,436  

Operating expenses

    2,796        2,386        2,402  

Pre-tax earnings

    $3,785        $1,694        $3,034  

Operating Environment. During 2017, generally higher global equity prices and tighter credit spreads contributed to a favorable environment for our equity and debt investments. Results also reflected net gains from company-specific events, including sales, and corporate performance. This environment contrasts with 2016, where, in the first quarter of 2016, market conditions were difficult and corporate performance, particularly in the energy sector, was impacted by a challenging macroeconomic environment. However, market conditions improved during the rest of 2016 as macroeconomic concerns moderated. If macroeconomic concerns negatively affect company-specific events or corporate performance, or if global equity markets decline or credit spreads widen, net revenues in Investing & Lending would likely be negatively impacted.

2017 versus 2016. Net revenues in Investing & Lending were $6.58 billion for 2017, 61% higher than 2016. Net revenues in equity securities were $4.58 billion, including $3.82 billion of net gains from private equities and $762 million in net gains from public equities. Net revenues in equity securities were 78% higher than 2016, primarily reflecting a significant increase in net gains from private equities, which were positively impacted by company-specific events and corporate performance. In addition, net gains from public equities were significantly higher, as global equity prices increased during the year. Of the $4.58 billion of net revenues in equity securities, approximately 60% was driven by net gains from company-specific events, such as sales, and public equities. Net revenues in debt securities and loans were $2.00 billion, 33% higher than 2016, reflecting significantly higher net interest income (2017 included approximately $1.80 billion of net interest income). Net revenues in debt securities and loans for 2017 also included an impairment of approximately $130 million on a secured loan.

Operating expenses were $2.80 billion for 2017, 17% higher than 2016, due to increased compensation and benefits expenses, reflecting higher net revenues, increased expenses related to consolidated investments, and increased expenses related to Marcus. Pre-tax earnings were $3.79 billion in 2017 compared with $1.69 billion in 2016.

2016 versus 2015. Net revenues in Investing & Lending were $4.08 billion for 2016, 25% lower than 2015. Net revenues in equity securities were $2.57 billion, including $2.17 billion of net gains from private equities and $402 million in net gains from public equities. Net revenues in equity securities were 32% lower than 2015, primarily reflecting a significant decrease in net gains from private equities, driven by company-specific events and corporate performance. Net revenues in debt securities and loans were $1.51 billion, 9% lower than 2015, reflecting significantly lower net revenues related to relationship lending activities, due to the impact of changes in credit spreads on economic hedges. Losses related to these hedges were $596 million in 2016, compared with gains of $329 million in 2015. This decrease was partially offset by higher net gains from investments in debt instruments and higher net interest income. See Note 9 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about economic hedges related to our relationship lending activities.

Operating expenses were $2.39 billion for 2016, essentially unchanged compared with 2015. Pre-tax earnings were $1.69 billion in 2016, 44% lower than 2015.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   61


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

Investment Management

Investment Management provides investment management services and offers investment products (primarily through separately managed accounts and commingled vehicles, such as mutual funds and private investment funds) across all major asset classes to a diverse set of institutional and individual clients. Investment Management also offers wealth advisory services provided by our subsidiary, The Ayco Company, L.P., including portfolio management and financial planning and counseling, and brokerage and other transaction services to high-net-worth individuals and families.

Assets under supervision (AUS) include client assets where we earn a fee for managing assets on a discretionary basis. This includes net assets in our mutual funds, hedge funds, credit funds and private equity funds (including real estate funds), and separately managed accounts for institutional and individual investors. Assets under supervision also include client assets invested with third-party managers, bank deposits and advisory relationships where we earn a fee for advisory and other services, but do not have investment discretion. Assets under supervision do not include the self-directed brokerage assets of our clients. Long-term assets under supervision represent assets under supervision excluding liquidity products. Liquidity products represent money market and bank deposit assets.

Assets under supervision typically generate fees as a percentage of net asset value, which vary by asset class and distribution channel and are affected by investment performance as well as asset inflows and redemptions. Asset classes such as alternative investment and equity assets typically generate higher fees relative to fixed income and liquidity product assets. The average effective management fee (which excludes non-asset-based fees) we earned on our assets under supervision was 35 basis points for both 2017 and 2016, and 39 basis points for 2015.

In certain circumstances, we are also entitled to receive incentive fees based on a percentage of a fund’s or a separately managed account’s return, or when the return exceeds a specified benchmark or other performance targets.

The table below presents the operating results of our Investment Management segment.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017        2016        2015  

Management and other fees

    $5,144        $4,798        $4,887  

Incentive fees

    417        421        780  

Transaction revenues

    658        569        539  

Total net revenues

    6,219        5,788        6,206  

Operating expenses

    4,800        4,654        4,841  

Pre-tax earnings

    $1,419        $1,134        $1,365  

The table below presents our period-end assets under supervision by asset class.

 

    As of December  
$ in billions     2017        2016        2015  

Alternative investments

    $   168        $   154        $   148  

Equity

    321        266        252  

Fixed income

    660        601        546  

Total long-term AUS

    1,149        1,021        946  

Liquidity products

    345        358        306  

Total AUS

    $1,494        $1,379        $1,252  

In the table above, alternative investments primarily includes hedge funds, credit funds, private equity, real estate, currencies, commodities and asset allocation strategies.

The table below presents our period-end assets under supervision by distribution channel.

 

    As of December  
$ in billions     2017        2016        2015  

Institutional

    $   576        $   511        $   471  

High-net-worth individuals

    458        413        369  

Third-party distributed

    460        455        412  

Total

    $1,494        $1,379        $1,252  

The table below presents a summary of the changes in our assets under supervision.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in billions     2017       2016       2015  

Beginning balance

    $1,379       $1,252       $1,178  

Net inflows/(outflows):

     

Alternative investments

    15       5       7  

Equity

    2       (3     23  

Fixed income

    25       40       41  

Total long-term AUS net inflows/(outflows)

    42       42       71  

Liquidity products

    (13     52       23  

Total AUS net inflows/(outflows) 

    29       94       94  

Net market appreciation/(depreciation)

    86       33       (20

Ending balance

    $1,494       $1,379       $1,252  

In the table above:

 

 

Total AUS net inflows/(outflows) for 2017 included $23 billion of inflows ($20 billion in total long-term AUS and $3 billion in liquidity products) in connection with the acquisition of a portion of Verus Investors’ outsourced chief investment officer business (Verus acquisition) and $5 billion of equity asset outflows in connection with the divestiture of our local Australian-focused investment capabilities and fund platform (Australian divestiture).

 

 

Total long-term AUS net inflows/(outflows) for 2015 included $18 billion of fixed income, equity and alternative investments asset inflows in connection with our acquisition of Pacific Global Advisors’ solutions business.

 

 

62   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

The table below presents our average monthly assets under supervision by asset class.

 

   

Average for the

Year Ended December

 
$ in billions     2017        2016        2015  

Alternative investments

    $   162        $   149        $   145  

Equity

    292        256        247  

Fixed income

    633        578        530  

Total long-term AUS

    1,087        983        922  

Liquidity products

    330        326        272  

Total AUS

    $1,417        $1,309        $1,194  

Operating Environment. During 2017, Investment Management operated in an environment characterized by generally higher asset prices, resulting in appreciation in both equity and fixed income assets. In addition, our long-term assets under supervision increased from net inflows primarily in fixed income and alternative investment assets. These increases were partially offset by net outflows in liquidity products. As a result, the mix of average assets under supervision during 2017 shifted slightly from liquidity products to long-term assets under supervision as compared to the mix at the end of 2016. In the future, if asset prices decline, or investors favor assets that typically generate lower fees or investors withdraw their assets, net revenues in Investment Management would likely be negatively impacted.

Following a challenging first quarter of 2016, market conditions improved during the remainder of 2016 with higher asset prices resulting in full year appreciation in both equity and fixed income assets. Also, our assets under supervision increased during 2016 from net inflows, primarily in fixed income assets, and liquidity products. The mix of our average assets under supervision shifted slightly compared with 2015 from long-term assets under supervision to liquidity products. Management fees were impacted by many factors, including inflows to advisory services and outflows from actively-managed mutual funds.

2017 versus 2016. Net revenues in Investment Management were $6.22 billion for 2017, 7% higher than 2016, due to higher management and other fees, reflecting higher average assets under supervision, and higher transaction revenues. During the year, total assets under supervision increased $115 billion to $1.49 trillion. Long-term assets under supervision increased $128 billion, including net market appreciation of $86 billion, primarily in equity and fixed income assets, and net inflows of $42 billion (which includes $20 billion of inflows in connection with the Verus acquisition and $5 billion of equity asset outflows in connection with the Australian divestiture), primarily in fixed income and alternative investment assets. Liquidity products decreased $13 billion (which includes $3 billion of inflows in connection with the Verus acquisition).

Operating expenses were $4.80 billion for 2017, 3% higher than 2016, primarily due to increased compensation and benefits expenses, reflecting higher net revenues. Pre-tax earnings were $1.42 billion in 2017, 25% higher than 2016.

2016 versus 2015. Net revenues in Investment Management were $5.79 billion for 2016, 7% lower than 2015. This decrease primarily reflected significantly lower incentive fees compared with a strong 2015. In addition, management and other fees were slightly lower, reflecting shifts in the mix of client assets and strategies, partially offset by the impact of higher average assets under supervision. During 2016, total assets under supervision increased $127 billion to $1.38 trillion. Long-term assets under supervision increased $75 billion, including net inflows of $42 billion, primarily in fixed income assets, and net market appreciation of $33 billion, primarily in equity and fixed income assets. In addition, liquidity products increased $52 billion.

Operating expenses were $4.65 billion for 2016, 4% lower than 2015, due to decreased compensation and benefits expenses, reflecting lower net revenues. Pre-tax earnings were $1.13 billion in 2016, 17% lower than 2015.

Geographic Data

See Note 25 to the consolidated financial statements for a summary of our total net revenues, pre-tax earnings and net earnings by geographic region.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   63


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

Balance Sheet and Funding Sources

Balance Sheet Management

One of our risk management disciplines is our ability to manage the size and composition of our balance sheet. While our asset base changes due to client activity, market fluctuations and business opportunities, the size and composition of our balance sheet also reflects factors including (i) our overall risk tolerance, (ii) the amount of equity capital we hold and (iii) our funding profile, among other factors. See “Equity Capital Management and Regulatory Capital — Equity Capital Management” for information about our equity capital management process.

Although our balance sheet fluctuates on a day-to-day basis, our total assets at quarter-end and year-end dates are generally not materially different from those occurring within our reporting periods.

In order to ensure appropriate risk management, we seek to maintain a sufficiently liquid balance sheet and have processes in place to dynamically manage our assets and liabilities which include (i) balance sheet planning, (ii) balance sheet limits, (iii) monitoring of key metrics and (iv) scenario analyses.

Balance Sheet Planning. We prepare a balance sheet plan that combines our projected total assets and composition of assets with our expected funding sources over a three-year time horizon. This plan is reviewed quarterly and may be adjusted in response to changing business needs or market conditions. The objectives of this planning process are:

 

 

To develop our balance sheet projections, taking into account the general state of the financial markets and expected business activity levels, as well as regulatory requirements;

 

 

To allow business risk managers and managers from our independent control and support functions to objectively evaluate balance sheet limit requests from business managers in the context of our overall balance sheet constraints, including our liability profile and equity capital levels, and key metrics; and

 

 

To inform the target amount, tenor and type of funding to raise, based on our projected assets and contractual maturities.

Business risk managers and managers from our independent control and support functions along with business managers review current and prior period information and expectations for the year to prepare our balance sheet plan. The specific information reviewed includes asset and liability size and composition, limit utilization, risk and performance measures, and capital usage.

Our consolidated balance sheet plan, including our balance sheets by business, funding projections, and projected key metrics, is reviewed and approved by the Firmwide Finance Committee. See “Risk Management — Overview and Structure of Risk Management” for an overview of our risk management structure.

Balance Sheet Limits. The Firmwide Finance Committee has the responsibility of reviewing and approving balance sheet limits. These limits are set at levels which are close to actual operating levels, rather than at levels which reflect our maximum risk appetite, in order to ensure prompt escalation and discussion among business managers and managers in our independent control and support functions on a routine basis. The Firmwide Finance Committee reviews and approves balance sheet limits on a quarterly basis and may also approve changes in limits on a more frequent basis in response to changing business needs or market conditions. In addition, the Risk Governance Committee sets aged inventory limits for certain financial instruments as a disincentive to hold inventory over longer periods of time. Requests for changes in limits are evaluated after giving consideration to their impact on our key metrics. Compliance with limits is monitored on a daily basis by business risk managers, as well as managers in our independent control and support functions.

Monitoring of Key Metrics. We monitor key balance sheet metrics daily both by business and on a consolidated basis, including asset and liability size and composition, limit utilization and risk measures. We allocate assets to businesses and review and analyze movements resulting from new business activity, as well as market fluctuations.

Scenario Analyses. We conduct various scenario analyses including as part of the Comprehensive Capital Analysis and Review (CCAR) and Dodd-Frank Act Stress Tests (DFAST), as well as our resolution and recovery planning. See “Equity Capital Management and Regulatory Capital — Equity Capital Management” below for further information about these scenario analyses. These scenarios cover short-term and long-term time horizons using various macroeconomic and firm-specific assumptions, based on a range of economic scenarios. We use these analyses to assist us in developing our longer-term balance sheet management strategy, including the level and composition of assets, funding and equity capital. Additionally, these analyses help us develop approaches for maintaining appropriate funding, liquidity and capital across a variety of situations, including a severely stressed environment.

 

 

64   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

Balance Sheet Allocation

In addition to preparing our consolidated statements of financial condition in accordance with U.S. GAAP, we prepare a balance sheet that generally allocates assets to our businesses, which is a non-GAAP presentation and may not be comparable to similar non-GAAP presentations used by other companies. We believe that presenting our assets on this basis is meaningful because it is consistent with the way management views and manages risks associated with our assets and better enables investors to assess the liquidity of our assets.

The table below presents our balance sheet allocation.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

GCLA, segregated assets and other

    $285,270        $280,563  

 

Secured client financing

    164,123        153,978  

 

Inventory

    216,883        206,988  

Secured financing agreements

    64,991        65,606  

Receivables

    36,750        29,592  

Institutional Client Services

    318,624        302,186  

 

Public equity

    2,072        3,224  

Private equity

    20,253        18,224  

Total equity

    22,325        21,448  

Loans receivable

    65,933        49,672  

Loans, at fair value

    14,877        14,230  

Total loans

    80,810        63,902  

Debt securities

    8,797        7,445  

Other

    8,481        5,162  

Investing & Lending

    120,413        97,957  

 

Total inventory and related assets

    439,037        400,143  

 

Other assets

    28,346        25,481  

Total assets

    $916,776        $860,165  

In 2017, we aggregated global core liquid assets (GCLA) and other with cash and securities segregated for regulatory and other purposes related to client activity (previously included in secured client financing). Previously reported amounts have been conformed to the current presentation.

The following is a description of the captions in the table above:

 

 

GCLA, Segregated Assets and Other. We maintain liquidity to meet a broad range of potential cash outflows and collateral needs in a stressed environment. See “Risk Management — Liquidity Risk Management” below for details on the composition and sizing of our GCLA. We also segregate cash and securities for regulatory and other purposes related to client activity. Securities are segregated from our own inventory, as well as from collateral obtained through securities borrowed or resale agreements. In addition, we maintain other unrestricted operating cash balances, primarily for use in specific currencies, entities, or jurisdictions where we do not have immediate access to parent company liquidity.

 

Secured Client Financing. We provide collateralized financing for client positions, including margin loans secured by client collateral, securities borrowed, and resale agreements primarily collateralized by government obligations. Our secured client financing arrangements, which are generally short-term, are accounted for at fair value or at amounts that approximate fair value, and include daily margin requirements to mitigate counterparty credit risk.

 

 

Institutional Client Services. In Institutional Client Services, we maintain inventory positions to facilitate market making in fixed income, equity, currency and commodity products. Additionally, as part of market-making activities, we enter into resale or securities borrowing arrangements to obtain securities or use our own inventory to cover transactions in which we or our clients have sold securities that have not yet been purchased. The receivables in Institutional Client Services primarily relate to securities transactions.

 

 

Investing & Lending. In Investing & Lending, we make investments and originate loans to provide financing to clients. We also make unsecured and secured loans to retail clients. These investments and loans are typically longer-term in nature. In addition, we make investments, directly and indirectly through funds that we manage, in debt securities, loans, public and private equity securities, infrastructure, real estate entities and other investments. As of December 2017, total equity included $2.07 billion of private equity securities that were acquired during 2017. The regional composition of total equity was approximately 54% and 55% in the Americas, 18% and 18% in Europe, Middle East and Africa (EMEA), and 28% and 27% in Asia as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively. Other Investing & Lending primarily includes receivables from customers and counterparties.

 

 

The table below presents details about loans.

 

    As of December 2017  
$ in millions    
Loans
Receivable
 
 
    
Loans, at
Fair Value
 
 
     Total  

Corporate loans

    $30,749        $  3,924        $34,673  

Loans to Private Wealth

       

Management clients

    16,591        7,102        23,693  

Loans backed by:

       

Commercial real estate

    7,987        1,825        9,812  

Residential real estate

    6,234        1,043        7,277  

Marcus loans

    1,912               1,912  

Other loans

    3,263        983        4,246  

Allowance for loan losses

    (803             (803

Total

    $65,933        $14,877        $80,810  

 

 

Loans receivable consists of loans held for investment that are accounted for at amortized cost net of allowance for loan losses. See Note 9 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about loans receivable.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   65


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

Other Assets. Other assets are generally less liquid, nonfinancial assets, including property, leasehold improvements and equipment, goodwill and identifiable intangible assets, income tax-related receivables and miscellaneous receivables.

The table below presents the reconciliation of this balance sheet allocation to our U.S. GAAP balance sheet.

 

$ in millions    


GCLA,
Segregated
Assets
and Other
 
 

 
   

Secured
Client
Financing
 
 
 
   

Institutional
Client
Services
 
 
 
   

Investing
&
Lending
 
 
 
    Total  

As of December 2017

 

       

Cash and cash equivalents

    $110,051       $           –       $           –       $           –       $110,051  

Securities purchased under agreements to resell

    73,277       26,202       20,931       412       120,822  

Securities borrowed

    49,242       97,546       44,060             190,848  

Receivables from brokers, dealers and clearing organizations

          7,712       16,945       19       24,676  

Receivables from customers and counterparties

          32,663       19,805       7,644       60,112  

Loans receivable

                      65,933       65,933  

Financial instruments owned

    52,700             216,883       46,405       315,988  

Subtotal

    $285,270       $164,123       $318,624       $120,413       $888,430  

Other assets

                                    28,346  

Total assets

                                    $916,776  

 

As of December 2016

 

       

Cash and cash equivalents

    $121,711       $           –       $           –       $           –       $121,711  

Securities purchased under agreements to resell

    71,561       25,458       18,844       1,062       116,925  

Securities borrowed

    42,144       95,694       46,762             184,600  

Receivables from brokers, dealers and clearing organizations

          6,540       11,504             18,044  

Receivables from customers and counterparties

          26,286       18,088       3,406       47,780  

Loans receivable

                      49,672       49,672  

Financial instruments owned

    45,147             206,988       43,817       295,952  

Subtotal

    $280,563       $153,978       $302,186       $  97,957       $834,684  

Other assets

                                    25,481  

Total assets

                                    $860,165  

In the table above:

 

 

Total assets for Institutional Client Services and Investing & Lending represent inventory and related assets. These amounts differ from total assets by business segment disclosed in Note 25 to the consolidated financial statements because total assets disclosed in Note 25 include allocations of our GCLA, segregated assets and other, secured client financing and other assets.

 

 

See “Balance Sheet Analysis and Metrics” for explanations on the changes in our balance sheet from December 2016 to December 2017.

Balance Sheet Analysis and Metrics

As of December 2017, total assets in our consolidated statements of financial condition were $916.78 billion, an increase of $56.61 billion from December 2016, primarily reflecting increases in financial instruments owned of $20.04 billion, loans receivable of $16.26 billion and receivables from customers and counterparties of $12.33 billion. The increase in financial instruments owned primarily reflected higher client activity and an increase in available-for-sale securities in U.S. government and agency obligations and corporate loans and debt securities, partially offset by the impact of currency movements on derivative valuations. The increase in loans receivable primarily reflected an increase in loans to corporate borrowers and loans backed by real estate. The increase in receivables from customers and counterparties reflected client activity.

As of December 2017, total liabilities in our consolidated statements of financial condition were $834.53 billion, an increase of $61.26 billion from December 2016, primarily reflecting increases in unsecured long-term borrowings of $28.60 billion, collateralized financings of $23.44 billion and deposits of $14.51 billion, partially offset by a decrease in payables to customers and counterparties of $12.57 billion. The increase in unsecured long-term borrowings was primarily due to net new issuances. The increase in collateralized financings reflected the impact of client and firm activity. The increase in deposits reflected increases in institutional deposits and Marcus deposits. The decrease in payables to customers and counterparties reflected client activity.

As of December 2017 and December 2016, our total securities sold under agreements to repurchase, accounted for as collateralized financings, were $84.72 billion and $71.82 billion, respectively, which were 2% lower and 5% lower than the daily average amount of repurchase agreements during the quarters ended December 2017 and December 2016, respectively, and 1% lower and 9% lower than the daily average amount of repurchase agreements during the years ended December 2017 and December 2016, respectively. The decrease in our repurchase agreements relative to the daily averages during 2017 and 2016 resulted from the impact of firm and client activity at the end of both years.

The table below presents information about our balance sheet and our leverage ratios.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Total assets

    $916,776        $860,165  

Unsecured long-term borrowings

    $217,687        $189,086  

Total shareholders’ equity

    $  82,243        $  86,893  

Leverage ratio

    11.1x        9.9x  

Debt to equity ratio

    2.6x        2.2x  
 

 

66   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

In the table above:

 

 

The leverage ratio equals total assets divided by total shareholders’ equity and measures the proportion of equity and debt we use to finance assets. This ratio is different from the Tier 1 leverage ratio included in Note 20 to the consolidated financial statements.

 

 

The debt to equity ratio equals unsecured long-term borrowings divided by total shareholders’ equity.

The table below presents information about our shareholders’ equity and book value per common share, including the reconciliation of total shareholders’ equity to tangible common shareholders’ equity.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions, except per share amounts     2017        2016  

Total shareholders’ equity

    $ 82,243        $ 86,893  

Preferred stock

    (11,853      (11,203

Common shareholders’ equity

    70,390        75,690  

Goodwill and identifiable intangible assets

    (4,038      (4,095

Tangible common shareholders’ equity

    $ 66,352        $ 71,595  

 

Book value per common share

    $ 181.00        $ 182.47  

Tangible book value per common share

    $ 170.61        $ 172.60  

In the table above:

 

 

Tangible common shareholders’ equity equals total shareholders’ equity less preferred stock, goodwill and identifiable intangible assets. We believe that tangible common shareholders’ equity is meaningful because it is a measure that we and investors use to assess capital adequacy. Tangible common shareholders’ equity is a non-GAAP measure and may not be comparable to similar non-GAAP measures used by other companies.

 

 

Book value per common share and tangible book value per common share as of December 2017 were both reduced by $11.31 due to the estimated impact of Tax Legislation. See “Results of Operations — Financial Overview” and “— Provision for Taxes” above for further information about the enactment of Tax Legislation.

 

 

Book value per common share and tangible book value per common share are based on common shares outstanding and restricted stock units granted to employees with no future service requirements (collectively, basic shares) of 388.9 million and 414.8 million as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively. We believe that tangible book value per common share (tangible common shareholders’ equity divided by basic shares) is meaningful because it is a measure that we and investors use to assess capital adequacy. Tangible book value per common share is a non-GAAP measure and may not be comparable to similar non-GAAP measures used by other companies.

Funding Sources

Our primary sources of funding are secured financings, unsecured long-term and short-term borrowings, and deposits. We seek to maintain broad and diversified funding sources globally across products, programs, markets, currencies and creditors to avoid funding concentrations.

We raise funding through a number of different products, including:

 

 

Collateralized financings, such as repurchase agreements, securities loaned and other secured financings;

 

 

Long-term unsecured debt (including structured notes) through syndicated U.S. registered offerings, U.S. registered and Rule 144A medium-term note programs, offshore medium-term note offerings and other debt offerings;

 

 

Savings, demand and time deposits through internal and third-party broker-dealers, as well as from retail and institutional clients; and

 

 

Short-term unsecured debt at the subsidiary level through U.S. and non-U.S. hybrid financial instruments and other methods.

Our funding is primarily raised in U.S. dollar, Euro, British pound and Japanese yen. We generally distribute our funding products through our own sales force and third-party distributors to a large, diverse creditor base in a variety of markets in the Americas, Europe and Asia. We believe that our relationships with our creditors are critical to our liquidity. Our creditors include banks, governments, securities lenders, corporations, pension funds, insurance companies, mutual funds and individuals. We have imposed various internal guidelines to monitor creditor concentration across our funding programs.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   67


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

Secured Funding. We fund a significant amount of inventory on a secured basis, including repurchase agreements, securities loaned and other secured financings. As of December 2017 and December 2016, secured funding included in collateralized financings in the consolidated statements of financial condition was $124.30 billion and $100.86 billion, respectively. We may also pledge our inventory as collateral for securities borrowed under a securities lending agreement or as collateral for derivative transactions. We also use our own inventory to cover transactions in which we or our clients have sold securities that have not yet been purchased. Secured funding is less sensitive to changes in our credit quality than unsecured funding, due to our posting of collateral to our lenders. Nonetheless, we continually analyze the refinancing risk of our secured funding activities, taking into account trade tenors, maturity profiles, counterparty concentrations, collateral eligibility and counterparty rollover probabilities. We seek to mitigate our refinancing risk by executing term trades with staggered maturities, diversifying counterparties, raising excess secured funding, and pre-funding residual risk through our GCLA.

We seek to raise secured funding with a term appropriate for the liquidity of the assets that are being financed, and we seek longer maturities for secured funding collateralized by asset classes that may be harder to fund on a secured basis, especially during times of market stress. Our secured funding, excluding funding collateralized by liquid government and agency obligations, is primarily executed for tenors of one month or greater and is primarily executed through term repurchase agreements and securities loaned contracts.

The weighted average maturity of our secured funding included in collateralized financings in the consolidated statements of financial condition, excluding funding that was collateralized by liquid government and agency obligations, exceeded 120 days as of December 2017.

Assets that may be harder to fund on a secured basis during times of market stress include certain financial instruments in the following categories: mortgage and other asset-backed loans and securities, non-investment-grade corporate debt securities, equity securities and emerging market securities. Assets that are classified in level 3 of the fair value hierarchy are generally funded on an unsecured basis. See Notes 5 and 6 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about the classification of financial instruments in the fair value hierarchy and “Unsecured Long-Term Borrowings” below for further information about the use of unsecured long-term borrowings as a source of funding.

We also raise financing through other types of collateralized financings, such as secured loans and notes. Goldman Sachs Bank USA (GS Bank USA) has access to funding from the Federal Home Loan Bank. As of December 2017 and December 2016, our outstanding borrowings against the Federal Home Loan Bank were $3.40 billion and $2.43 billion, respectively.

GS Bank USA also has access to funding through the Federal Reserve Bank discount window. While we do not rely on this funding in our liquidity planning and stress testing, we maintain policies and procedures necessary to access this funding and test discount window borrowing procedures.

Unsecured Long-Term Borrowings. We issue unsecured long-term borrowings as a source of funding for inventory and other assets and to finance a portion of our GCLA. We issue in different tenors, currencies and products to maximize the diversification of our investor base.

The table below presents our quarterly unsecured long-term borrowings maturity profile as of December 2017.

 

$ in millions    
First
Quarter
 
 
    
Second
Quarter
 
 
    
Third
Quarter
 
 
    
Fourth
Quarter
 
 
    Total  

2019

    $8,354        $6,927        $3,806        $11,418       $  30,505  

2020

    $5,264        $8,071        $6,039        $  3,746       23,120  

2021

    $2,772        $3,651        $7,757        $  7,601       21,781  

2022

    $5,998        $5,991        $4,869        $  5,744       22,602  

2023 - thereafter

                                       119,679  

Total

                                       $217,687  

The weighted average maturity of our unsecured long-term borrowings as of December 2017 was approximately eight years. To mitigate refinancing risk, we seek to limit the principal amount of debt maturing on any one day or during any week or year. We enter into interest rate swaps to convert a portion of our unsecured long-term borrowings into floating-rate obligations to manage our exposure to interest rates. See Note 16 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about our unsecured long-term borrowings.

Deposits. Our deposits provide us with a diversified source of funding and reduce our reliance on wholesale funding. A growing source of our deposit base consists of retail deposits. Deposits are primarily used to finance lending activity, other inventory and a portion of our GCLA. We raise deposits primarily through GS Bank USA and Goldman Sachs International Bank (GSIB). As of December 2017 and December 2016, our deposits were $138.60 billion and $124.10 billion, respectively. See Note 14 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about our deposits.

 

 

68   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

Unsecured Short-Term Borrowings. A significant portion of our unsecured short-term borrowings was originally long-term debt that is scheduled to mature within one year of the reporting date. We use unsecured short-term borrowings, including hybrid financial instruments, to finance liquid assets and for other cash management purposes. In light of regulatory developments, Group Inc. no longer issues debt with an original maturity of less than one year, other than to its subsidiaries.

As of December 2017 and December 2016, our unsecured short-term borrowings, including the current portion of unsecured long-term borrowings, were $46.92 billion and $39.27 billion, respectively. See Note 15 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about our unsecured short-term borrowings.

Equity Capital Management and Regulatory Capital

Capital adequacy is of critical importance to us. We have in place a comprehensive capital management policy that provides a framework, defines objectives and establishes guidelines to assist us in maintaining the appropriate level and composition of capital in both business-as-usual and stressed conditions.

Equity Capital Management

We determine the appropriate level and composition of our equity capital by considering multiple factors including our current and future consolidated regulatory capital requirements, the results of our capital planning and stress testing process, resolution capital models and other factors, such as rating agency guidelines, subsidiary capital requirements, the business environment and conditions in the financial markets. We manage our capital requirements and the levels of our capital usage principally by setting limits on balance sheet assets and/or limits on risk, in each case at both the consolidated and business levels.

We principally manage the level and composition of our equity capital through issuances and repurchases of our common stock. We may also, from time to time, issue or repurchase our preferred stock, junior subordinated debt issued to trusts, and other subordinated debt or other forms of capital as business conditions warrant. Prior to any repurchases, we must receive confirmation that the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (Federal Reserve Board or FRB) does not object to such capital action. See Notes 16 and 19 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about our preferred stock, junior subordinated debt issued to trusts and other subordinated debt.

Capital Planning and Stress Testing Process. As part of capital planning, we project sources and uses of capital given a range of business environments, including stressed conditions. Our stress testing process is designed to identify and measure material risks associated with our business activities including market risk, credit risk and operational risk, as well as our ability to generate revenues.

The following is a description of our capital planning and stress testing process:

 

 

Capital Planning. Our capital planning process incorporates an internal capital adequacy assessment with the objective of ensuring that we are appropriately capitalized relative to the risks in our businesses. We incorporate stress scenarios into our capital planning process with a goal of holding sufficient capital to ensure we remain adequately capitalized after experiencing a severe stress event. Our assessment of capital adequacy is viewed in tandem with our assessment of liquidity adequacy and is integrated into our overall risk management structure, governance and policy framework.

 

 

Our capital planning process also includes an internal risk-based capital assessment. This assessment incorporates market risk, credit risk and operational risk. Market risk is calculated by using Value-at-Risk (VaR) calculations supplemented by risk-based add-ons which include risks related to rare events (tail risks). Credit risk utilizes assumptions about our counterparties’ probability of default and the size of our losses in the event of a default. Operational risk is calculated based on scenarios incorporating multiple types of operational failures, as well as considering internal and external actual loss experience. Backtesting for market risk and credit risk is used to gauge the effectiveness of models at capturing and measuring relevant risks.

 

 

Stress Testing. Our stress tests incorporate our internally designed stress scenarios, including our internally developed severely adverse scenario, and those required under CCAR and DFAST, and are designed to capture our specific vulnerabilities and risks. We provide further information about our stress test processes and a summary of the results on our website as described in “Business — Available Information” in Part I, Item 1 of this Form 10-K.

As required by the FRB’s annual CCAR rules, we submit a capital plan for review by the FRB. The purpose of the FRB’s review is to ensure that we have a robust, forward-looking capital planning process that accounts for our unique risks and that permits continued operation during times of economic and financial stress.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   69


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

The FRB evaluates us based, in part, on whether we have the capital necessary to continue operating under the baseline and stress scenarios provided by the FRB and those developed internally. This evaluation also takes into account our process for identifying risk, our controls and governance for capital planning, and our guidelines for making capital planning decisions. In addition, the FRB evaluates our plan to make capital distributions (i.e., dividend payments and repurchases or redemptions of stock, subordinated debt or other capital securities) and issue capital, across a range of macroeconomic scenarios and firm-specific assumptions.

In addition, the DFAST rules require us to conduct stress tests on a semi-annual basis and publish a summary of certain results. The FRB also conducts its own annual stress tests and publishes a summary of certain results.

With respect to our 2017 CCAR submission, the FRB informed us that it did not object to our capital actions. These capital actions included the potential to repurchase outstanding common stock of up to $8.70 billion, and the potential to issue and redeem other capital securities over the twelve-month period beginning July 2017, and the potential to increase our common stock dividend by up to $0.05 per share in the second quarter of 2018. However, we do not expect that we will utilize our entire share repurchase authorization by June 2018. The amount and timing of our capital actions will be based on, among other things, our current and projected capital position, and capital deployment opportunities. We published a summary of our annual DFAST results in June 2017. See “Business — Available Information” in Part I, Item 1 of this Form 10-K.

In October 2017, we submitted our semi-annual DFAST results to the FRB and published a summary of the results of our internally developed severely adverse scenario. See “Business — Available Information” in Part I, Item 1 of this Form 10-K.

We are required to submit our 2018 CCAR results to the FRB by April 5, 2018.

In addition, the rules adopted by the FRB under the Dodd-Frank Act require GS Bank USA to conduct stress tests on an annual basis and publish a summary of certain results. GS Bank USA submitted its 2017 annual DFAST results to the FRB in April 2017 and published a summary of its annual DFAST results in June 2017. See “Business — Available Information” in Part I, Item 1 of this Form 10-K.

Goldman Sachs International (GSI) and GSIB also have their own capital planning and stress testing process, which incorporates internally designed stress tests and those required under the Prudential Regulation Authority’s (PRA) Internal Capital Adequacy Assessment Process.

Contingency Capital Plan. As part of our comprehensive capital management policy, we maintain a contingency capital plan. Our contingency capital plan provides a framework for analyzing and responding to a perceived or actual capital deficiency, including, but not limited to, identification of drivers of a capital deficiency, as well as mitigants and potential actions. It outlines the appropriate communication procedures to follow during a crisis period, including internal dissemination of information, as well as timely communication with external stakeholders.

Capital Attribution. We assess each of our businesses’ capital usage based upon our internal assessment of risks, which incorporates an attribution of all of our relevant regulatory capital requirements. These regulatory capital requirements are allocated using our attributed equity framework, which takes into consideration our binding capital constraints. We also attribute risk-weighted assets (RWAs) to our business segments. As of December 2017, approximately 60% and 55% of RWAs calculated in accordance with the Standardized Capital Rules and the Basel III Advanced Rules, respectively, subject to transitional provisions, were attributed to our Institutional Client Services segment and substantially all of the remaining RWAs were attributed to our Investing & Lending segment. We manage the levels of our capital usage based upon balance sheet and risk limits, as well as capital return analyses of our businesses based on our capital attribution.

Share Repurchase Program. We use our share repurchase program to help maintain the appropriate level of common equity. The repurchase program is effected primarily through regular open-market purchases (which may include repurchase plans designed to comply with Rule 10b5-1), the amounts and timing of which are determined primarily by our current and projected capital position and our capital plan submitted to the FRB as part of CCAR. The amounts and timing of the repurchases may also be influenced by general market conditions and the prevailing price and trading volumes of our common stock.

 

 

70   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

As of December 2017, the remaining share authorization under our existing repurchase program was 47.6 million shares; however, we are only permitted to make repurchases to the extent that such repurchases have not been objected to by the FRB. See “Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities” in Part II, Item 5 of this Form 10-K and Note 19 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about our share repurchase program, and see above for information about our capital planning and stress testing process.

Resolution Capital Models. In connection with our resolution planning efforts, we have established a Resolution Capital Adequacy and Positioning (RCAP) framework, which is designed to ensure that our major subsidiaries (GS Bank USA, Goldman Sachs & Co. LLC (GS&Co.), GSI, GSIB, Goldman Sachs Japan Co., Ltd. (GSJCL), Goldman Sachs Asset Management, L.P. and Goldman Sachs Asset Management International) have access to sufficient loss-absorbing capacity (in the form of equity, subordinated debt and unsecured senior debt) so that they are able to wind-down following a Group Inc. bankruptcy filing in accordance with our preferred resolution strategy.

In addition, we have established a triggers and alerts framework which is designed to provide the Board of Directors of Group Inc. (Board) with information needed to make an informed decision on whether and when to commence bankruptcy proceedings for Group Inc.

Rating Agency Guidelines

The credit rating agencies assign credit ratings to the obligations of Group Inc., which directly issues or guarantees substantially all of our senior unsecured debt obligations. GS&Co. and GSI have been assigned long- and short-term issuer ratings by certain credit rating agencies. GS Bank USA and GSIB have also been assigned long- and short-term issuer ratings, as well as ratings on their long-term and short-term bank deposits. In addition, credit rating agencies have assigned ratings to debt obligations of certain other subsidiaries of Group Inc.

The level and composition of our equity capital are among the many factors considered in determining our credit ratings. Each agency has its own definition of eligible capital and methodology for evaluating capital adequacy, and assessments are generally based on a combination of factors rather than a single calculation. See “Risk Management — Liquidity Risk Management — Credit Ratings” for further information about credit ratings of Group Inc., GS Bank USA, GSIB, GS&Co. and GSI.

Consolidated Regulatory Capital

We are subject to the FRB’s risk-based capital and leverage regulations, subject to certain transitional provisions (Capital Framework). These regulations are largely based on the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision’s (Basel Committee) capital framework for strengthening international capital standards (Basel III) and also implement certain provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act. Under the Capital Framework, we are an “Advanced approach” banking organization and have been designated as a global systemically important bank (G-SIB).

We calculate our CET1, Tier 1 capital and Total capital ratios in accordance with (i) the Standardized approach and market risk rules set out in the Capital Framework (together, the Standardized Capital Rules) and (ii) the Advanced approach and market risk rules set out in the Capital Framework (together, the Basel III Advanced Rules) as described in Note 20 to the consolidated financial statements.

The lower of each capital ratio calculated in (i) and (ii) is the ratio against which our compliance with minimum ratio requirements is assessed. Each of the capital ratios calculated in accordance with the Basel III Advanced Rules was lower than that calculated in accordance with the Standardized Capital Rules and therefore the Basel III Advanced ratios were the ratios that applied to us as of both December 2017 and December 2016.

See Note 20 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about our capital ratios as of both December 2017 and December 2016, and for further information about the Capital Framework.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   71


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

Minimum Capital Ratios and Capital Buffers

The table below presents our minimum required ratios.

 

     
December 2017
Minimum Ratio
 
 

CET1 ratio

    7.000%  

Tier 1 capital ratio

    8.500%  

Total capital ratio

    10.500%  

Tier 1 leverage ratio

    4.000%  

In the table above:

 

 

The minimum capital ratios as of December 2017 reflect (i) the 50% phase-in of the capital conservation buffer of 2.5%, (ii) the 50% phase-in of the G-SIB buffer of 2.5% (based on 2015 financial data) and (iii) the countercyclical capital buffer of zero percent.

 

 

Tier 1 leverage ratio is defined as Tier 1 capital divided by quarterly average adjusted total assets (which includes adjustments for goodwill and identifiable intangible assets, and certain investments in nonconsolidated financial institutions).

The minimum capital ratios applicable to us as of January 2019 will reflect the fully phased-in capital conservation buffer, the countercyclical capital buffer, if any, determined by the FRB and the fully phased-in G-SIB buffer. The G-SIB buffer applicable to us as of January 2019 is 2.5% based on financial data as of or for the year ended December 2017. The G-SIB and countercyclical buffers in the future may differ due to additional guidance from our regulators and/or positional changes.

Our minimum required supplementary leverage ratio is 5.0% as of January 1, 2018. See “Supplementary Leverage Ratio” below for further information.

See Note 20 to the consolidated financial statements for information about our capital buffers.

Fully Phased-in Capital Ratios

The table below presents our capital ratios calculated in accordance with the Standardized Capital Rules and the Basel III Advanced Rules on a fully phased-in basis.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017       2016  

Common shareholders’ equity

    $  70,390       $  75,690  

Deduction for goodwill and identifiable intangible assets, net of deferred tax liabilities

    (3,334     (3,015

Deduction for investments in nonconsolidated financial institutions

          (765

Other adjustments

    (63     (799

Common Equity Tier 1

    66,993       71,111  

Preferred stock

    11,853       11,203  

Deduction for investments in covered funds

    (590     (445

Other adjustments

    (29     (61

Tier 1 capital

    $  78,227       $  81,808  

 

Standardized Tier 2 and Total capital

   

Tier 1 capital

    $  78,227       $  81,808  

Qualifying subordinated debt

    13,360       14,566  

Allowance for losses on loans and lending commitments

    1,078       722  

Other adjustments

    (28     (6

Standardized Tier 2 capital

    14,410       15,282  

Standardized Total capital

    $  92,637       $  97,090  

 

Basel III Advanced Tier 2 and Total capital

   

Tier 1 capital

    $  78,227       $  81,808  

Standardized Tier 2 capital

    14,410       15,282  

Allowance for losses on loans and lending commitments

    (1,078     (722

Basel III Advanced Tier 2 capital

    13,332       14,560  

Basel III Advanced Total capital

    $  91,559       $  96,368  

 

RWAs

   

Credit RWAs

    $476,594       $422,544  

Market RWAs

    87,381       85,263  

Standardized RWAs

    $563,975       $507,807  

 

Credit RWAs

    $421,763       $361,223  

Market RWAs

    86,854       84,475  

Operational RWAs

    117,475       115,088  

Basel III Advanced RWAs

    $626,092       $560,786  

 

CET1 ratio

   

Standardized

    11.9%       14.0%  

Basel III Advanced

    10.7%       12.7%  

 

Tier 1 capital ratio

   

Standardized

    13.9%       16.1%  

Basel III Advanced

    12.5%       14.6%  

 

Total capital ratio

   

Standardized

    16.4%       19.1%  

Basel III Advanced

    14.6%       17.2%  

Although the deductions from and adjustments to regulatory capital in the table above were not fully phased-in until January 2018, we believe that the fully phased-in capital ratios are meaningful because they are measures that we, our regulators and investors use to assess our ability to meet future regulatory capital requirements. These fully phased-in capital ratios are non-GAAP measures and may not be comparable to similar non-GAAP measures used by other companies.

 

 

72   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

In the table above:

 

 

Deduction for goodwill and identifiable intangible assets, net of deferred tax liabilities, included goodwill of $3.67 billion as of both December 2017 and December 2016, and identifiable intangible assets of $373 million and $429 million as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively, net of associated deferred tax liabilities of $704 million and $1.08 billion as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively.

 

 

Deduction for investments in nonconsolidated financial institutions represents the amount by which our investments in the capital of nonconsolidated financial institutions exceed certain prescribed thresholds. The decrease from December 2016 to December 2017 primarily reflects reductions in our fund investments.

 

 

Deduction for investments in covered funds represents our aggregate investments in applicable covered funds, excluding investments that are subject to an extended conformance period. This deduction was not subject to a transition period. See “Business — Regulation” in Part I, Item 1 of this Form 10-K for further information about the Volcker Rule.

 

 

Other adjustments within CET1 primarily include the overfunded portion of our defined benefit pension plan obligation net of associated deferred tax liabilities, disallowed deferred tax assets, credit valuation adjustments on derivative liabilities, debt valuation adjustments and other required credit risk-based deductions.

 

 

Qualifying subordinated debt is subordinated debt issued by Group Inc. with an original maturity of five years or greater. The outstanding amount of subordinated debt qualifying for Tier 2 capital is reduced upon reaching a remaining maturity of five years. See Note 16 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about our subordinated debt.

See Note 20 to the consolidated financial statements for information about our transitional capital ratios, which represent the ratios that are applicable to us as of both December 2017 and December 2016.

Supplementary Leverage Ratio

The Capital Framework includes a supplementary leverage ratio requirement for Advanced approach banking organizations. Under amendments to the Capital Framework, the U.S. federal bank regulatory agencies approved a final rule that implements the supplementary leverage ratio aligned with the definition of leverage established by the Basel Committee. The supplementary leverage ratio compares Tier 1 capital to a measure of leverage exposure, which consists of daily average total assets for the quarter and certain off-balance-sheet exposures, less certain balance sheet deductions. The Capital Framework requires a minimum supplementary leverage ratio of 5.0% (consisting of the minimum requirement of 3.0% and a 2.0% buffer) for U.S. BHCs deemed to be G-SIBs, effective on January 1, 2018.

The table below presents our supplementary leverage ratio, calculated on a fully phased-in basis.

 

   

For the Three Months

Ended or as of December

 
$ in millions     2017       2016  

Tier 1 capital

    $     78,227       $     81,808  

 

Average total assets

    $   937,424       $   883,515  

Deductions from Tier 1 capital

    (4,572     (4,897

Average adjusted total assets

    932,852       878,618  

Off-balance-sheet exposures

    408,164       391,555  

Total supplementary leverage exposure

    $1,341,016       $1,270,173  

 

Supplementary leverage ratio

    5.8%       6.4%  

In the table above, the off-balance-sheet exposures consists of derivatives, securities financing transactions, commitments and guarantees.

Subsidiary Capital Requirements

Many of our subsidiaries, including GS Bank USA and our broker-dealer subsidiaries, are subject to separate regulation and capital requirements of the jurisdictions in which they operate.

GS Bank USA. GS Bank USA is subject to regulatory capital requirements that are calculated in substantially the same manner as those applicable to BHCs and calculates its capital ratios in accordance with the risk-based capital and leverage requirements applicable to state member banks, which are based on the Capital Framework. See Note 20 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about the Capital Framework as it relates to GS Bank USA, including GS Bank USA’s capital ratios and required minimum ratios.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   73


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

In addition, under FRB rules, commencing on January 1, 2018, in order to be considered a “well-capitalized” depository institution, GS Bank USA must have a supplementary leverage ratio of 6.0% or greater. The supplementary leverage ratio compares Tier 1 capital to a measure of leverage exposure, defined as daily average total assets for the quarter and certain off-balance-sheet exposures, less certain balance sheet deductions.

The table below presents GS Bank USA’s supplementary leverage ratio, calculated on a fully phased-in basis.

 

   

For the Three Months

Ended or as of December

 
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Tier 1 capital

    $  25,341        $  24,479  

 

Average total assets

    $168,854        $169,721  

Deductions from Tier 1 capital

    (14      (20

Average adjusted total assets

    168,840        169,701  

Off-balance-sheet exposures

    176,892        163,464  

Total supplementary leverage exposure

    $345,732        $333,165  

 

Supplementary leverage ratio

    7.3%        7.3%  

In the table above, the off-balance-sheet exposures consists of derivatives, securities financing transactions, commitments and guarantees.

GSI. Our regulated U.K. broker-dealer, GSI, is one of our principal non-U.S. regulated subsidiaries and is regulated by the PRA and the Financial Conduct Authority. GSI is subject to the capital framework for E.U.-regulated financial institutions prescribed in the E.U. Fourth Capital Requirements Directive (CRD IV) and the E.U. Capital Requirements Regulation (CRR). These capital regulations are largely based on Basel III.

The table below presents GSI’s minimum required capital ratios.

 

     
December 2017
Minimum Ratio
 
 
    
December 2016
Minimum Ratio
 
 

CET1 ratio

    7.165%        6.549%  

Tier 1 capital ratio

    9.143%        8.530%  

Total capital ratio

    11.771%        11.163%  

The minimum capital ratios in the table above incorporate capital guidance received from the PRA and could change in the future. GSI’s future capital requirements may also be impacted by developments such as the introduction of capital buffers as described above in “Minimum Capital Ratios and Capital Buffers.”

As of December 2017, GSI had a CET1 ratio of 11.0%, a Tier 1 capital ratio of 13.6% and a Total capital ratio of 16.0%. Each of these ratios included approximately 67 basis points attributable to amounts which will be finalized upon the issuance of GSI’s 2017 annual audited financial statements. As of December 2016, GSI had a CET1 ratio of 12.9%, a Tier 1 capital ratio of 12.9% and a Total capital ratio of 17.2%.

In November 2016, the European Commission proposed amendments to the CRR to implement a 3% minimum leverage ratio requirement for certain E.U. financial institutions. This leverage ratio compares the CRR’s definition of Tier 1 capital to a measure of leverage exposure, defined as the sum of certain assets plus certain off-balance-sheet exposures (which include a measure of derivatives, securities financing transactions, commitments and guarantees), less Tier 1 capital deductions. Any required minimum leverage ratio is expected to become effective for GSI no earlier than January 1, 2021. As of December 2017 and December 2016, GSI had a leverage ratio of 4.1% and 3.8%, respectively. The ratio as of December 2017 included approximately 20 basis points attributable to amounts which will be finalized upon the issuance of GSI’s 2017 annual audited financial statements. This leverage ratio is based on our current interpretation and understanding of this rule and may evolve as we discuss the interpretation and application of this rule with GSI’s regulators.

Other Subsidiaries. The capital requirements of several of our subsidiaries may increase in the future due to the various developments arising from the Basel Committee, the Dodd-Frank Act, and other governmental entities and regulators. See Note 20 to the consolidated financial statements for information about the capital requirements of our other regulated subsidiaries.

Subsidiaries not subject to separate regulatory capital requirements may hold capital to satisfy local tax and legal guidelines, rating agency requirements (for entities with assigned credit ratings) or internal policies, including policies concerning the minimum amount of capital a subsidiary should hold based on its underlying level of risk. In certain instances, Group Inc. may be limited in its ability to access capital held at certain subsidiaries as a result of regulatory, tax or other constraints. As of December 2017 and December 2016, Group Inc.’s equity investment in subsidiaries was $93.88 billion and $92.77 billion, respectively, compared with its total shareholders’ equity of $82.24 billion and $86.89 billion, respectively.

Our capital invested in non-U.S. subsidiaries is generally exposed to foreign exchange risk, substantially all of which is managed through a combination of derivatives and non-U.S. denominated debt. See Note 7 to the consolidated financial statements for information about our net investment hedges, which are used to hedge this risk.

Guarantees of Subsidiaries. Group Inc. has guaranteed the payment obligations of GS&Co. and GS Bank USA, in each case subject to certain exceptions.

 

 

74   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

Regulatory Matters and Developments

Our businesses are subject to significant and evolving regulation. The Dodd-Frank Act, enacted in July 2010, significantly altered the financial regulatory regime within which we operate. In addition, other reforms have been adopted or are being considered by regulators and policy makers worldwide. Given that many of the new and proposed rules are highly complex, the full impact of regulatory reform will not be known until the rules are implemented and market practices develop under the final regulations. See “Business — Regulation” in Part I, Item 1 of this Form 10-K for further information about the laws, rules and regulations and proposed laws, rules and regulations that apply to us and our operations. In addition, see Note 20 to the consolidated financial statements for information about regulatory developments as they relate to our regulatory capital and leverage ratios.

Resolution and Recovery Plans

We are required by the FRB and the FDIC to submit a periodic plan that describes our strategy for a rapid and orderly resolution in the event of material financial distress or failure (resolution plan). We are also required by the FRB to submit a periodic recovery plan that outlines the steps that management could take to reduce risk, maintain sufficient liquidity, and conserve capital in times of prolonged stress.

In December 2017, the FRB and the FDIC provided feedback on our 2017 resolution plan and determined that it satisfactorily addressed the shortcomings identified in our prior submissions. The FRB and the FDIC did not identify deficiencies in our 2017 resolution plan, but the FRB and the FDIC did note one shortcoming that must be addressed in our next resolution plan submission. The FRB and the FDIC have extended the next resolution plan filing deadline by one year to July 1, 2019. See “Business — Available Information” in Part I, Item 1 of this Form 10-K.

As part of our resolution planning efforts, we put in place a Capital and Liquidity Support Agreement (CLSA) among Group Inc., Goldman Sachs Funding LLC (Funding IHC) and our major subsidiaries. See “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of this Form 10-K for further information about the CLSA. Additionally, as part of our preferred resolution strategy, we have established RCAP, Resolution Liquidity Adequacy and Positioning (RLAP), Resolution Liquidity Execution Need (RLEN), and triggers and alerts frameworks. See “Equity Capital Management and Regulatory Capital — Equity Capital Management” for further information about RCAP, and triggers and alerts frameworks, and see “Liquidity Risk Management — Liquidity Stress Tests” for further information about RLAP, RLEN, and triggers and alerts frameworks.

In addition, GS Bank USA is required to submit periodic resolution plans to the FDIC. GS Bank USA’s next resolution plan is due on July 1, 2018.

Off-Balance-Sheet Arrangements and Contractual Obligations

Off-Balance-Sheet Arrangements

We have various types of off-balance-sheet arrangements that we enter into in the ordinary course of business. Our involvement in these arrangements can take many different forms, including:

 

 

Purchasing or retaining residual and other interests in special purpose entities such as mortgage-backed and other asset-backed securitization vehicles;

 

 

Holding senior and subordinated debt, interests in limited and general partnerships, and preferred and common stock in other nonconsolidated vehicles;

 

 

Entering into interest rate, foreign currency, equity, commodity and credit derivatives, including total return swaps;

 

 

Entering into operating leases; and

 

 

Providing guarantees, indemnifications, commitments, letters of credit and representations and warranties.

We enter into these arrangements for a variety of business purposes, including securitizations. The securitization vehicles that purchase mortgages, corporate bonds, and other types of financial assets are critical to the functioning of several significant investor markets, including the mortgage-backed and other asset-backed securities markets, since they offer investors access to specific cash flows and risks created through the securitization process.

We also enter into these arrangements to underwrite client securitization transactions; provide secondary market liquidity; make investments in performing and nonperforming debt, distressed loans, power-related assets, equity securities, real estate and other assets; provide investors with credit-linked and asset-repackaged notes; and receive or provide letters of credit to satisfy margin requirements and to facilitate the clearance and settlement process.

Our financial interests in, and derivative transactions with, such nonconsolidated entities are generally accounted for at fair value, in the same manner as our other financial instruments, except in cases where we apply the equity method of accounting.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   75


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

The table below presents where information about our various off-balance-sheet arrangements may be found in this Form 10-K. In addition, see Note 3 to the consolidated financial statements for information about our consolidation policies.

 

Type of Off-Balance-Sheet Arrangement       Disclosure in Form 10-K

Variable interests and other obligations, including contingent obligations, arising from variable interests in nonconsolidated variable interest entities (VIEs)

 

     

See Note 12 to the consolidated financial statements.

 

Leases

     

 

See “Contractual Obligations” below and Note 18 to the consolidated financial statements.

 

 

Guarantees, letters of credit, and lending and other commitments

     

 

See Note 18 to the consolidated financial statements.

 

 

Derivatives

     

 

See “Risk Management — Credit Risk Management — Credit Exposures — OTC Derivatives” below and Notes 4, 5, 7 and 18 to the consolidated financial statements.

 

Contractual Obligations

We have certain contractual obligations which require us to make future cash payments. These contractual obligations include our time deposits, secured long-term financings, unsecured long-term borrowings, contractual interest payments, subordinated liabilities of consolidated VIEs and minimum rental payments under noncancelable leases.

Our obligations to make future cash payments also include our commitments and guarantees related to off-balance-sheet arrangements, which are excluded from the table below. See Note 18 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about such commitments and guarantees.

Due to the uncertainty of the timing and amounts that will ultimately be paid, our liability for unrecognized tax benefits has been excluded from the table below. See Note 24 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about our unrecognized tax benefits.

The table below presents our contractual obligations by type.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Time deposits

    $  30,075        $  27,394  

Secured long-term financings 

    $    9,892        $    8,405  

Unsecured long-term borrowings

    $217,687        $189,086  

Contractual interest payments

    $  54,489        $  54,552  

Subordinated liabilities of consolidated VIEs

    $         19        $       584  

Minimum rental payments

    $    1,964        $    1,941  

The table below presents our contractual obligations by period of expiration.

 

    As of December 2017  
$ in millions     2018       
2019 -
2020
 
 
    
2021 -
2022
 
 
    
2023 -
Thereafter
 
 

Time deposits

    $       –        $15,630        $  8,610        $    5,835  

Secured long-term financings 

    $       –        $  4,994        $  3,019        $    1,879  

Unsecured long-term borrowings

    $       –        $53,625        $44,383        $119,679  

Contractual interest payments

    $6,497        $11,562        $  8,515        $  27,915  

Subordinated liabilities of consolidated VIEs

    $       –        $         –        $         –        $         19  

Minimum rental payments

    $   299        $     544        $     350        $       771  

In the table above:

 

 

Obligations maturing within one year of our financial statement date or redeemable within one year of our financial statement date at the option of the holders are excluded as they are treated as short-term obligations. See Note 15 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about our short-term borrowings.

 

 

Obligations that are repayable prior to maturity at our option are reflected at their contractual maturity dates and obligations that are redeemable prior to maturity at the option of the holders are reflected at the earliest dates such options become exercisable.

 

 

As of December 2017, unsecured long-term borrowings had maturities extending to 2057, consisted principally of senior borrowings, and included $5.61 billion of adjustments to the carrying value of certain unsecured long-term borrowings resulting from the application of hedge accounting. See Note 16 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about our unsecured long-term borrowings.

 

 

As of December 2017, the difference between the aggregate contractual principal amount and the related fair value of long-term other secured financings for which the fair value option was elected was not material.

 

 

As of December 2017, the aggregate contractual principal amount of unsecured long-term borrowings for which the fair value option was elected exceeded the related fair value by $1.69 billion.

 

 

Contractual interest payments represents estimated future interest payments related to unsecured long-term borrowings, secured long-term financings and time deposits based on applicable interest rates as of December 2017, and includes stated coupons, if any, on structured notes.

 

 

Future minimum rental payments are net of minimum sublease rentals under noncancelable leases. These lease commitments for office space expire on various dates through 2069. Certain agreements are subject to periodic escalation provisions for increases in real estate taxes and other charges. See Note 18 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about our leases.

 

 

76   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

Risk Management

Risks are inherent in our businesses and include liquidity, market, credit, operational, model, legal, compliance, conduct, regulatory and reputational risks. For further information about our risk management processes, see “Overview and Structure of Risk Management” below. Our risks include the risks across our risk categories, regions or global businesses, as well as those which have uncertain outcomes and have the potential to materially impact our financial results, our liquidity and our reputation. For further information about our areas of risk, see “Liquidity Risk Management,” “Market Risk Management,” “Credit Risk Management,” “Operational Risk Management” and “Model Risk Management” below and “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of this Form 10-K.

Overview and Structure of Risk Management

Overview

We believe that effective risk management is of primary importance to our success. Accordingly, we have established an Enterprise Risk Management (ERM) framework that employs a comprehensive, integrated approach to risk management, and is designed to enable comprehensive risk management processes through which we identify, assess, monitor and manage the risks we assume in conducting our activities. These risks include liquidity, market, credit, operational, model, legal, compliance, conduct, regulatory and reputational risk exposures. Our risk management structure is built around three core components: governance, processes and people.

Governance. Risk management governance starts with the Board, which both directly and through its committees, including its Risk Committee, oversees our risk management policies and practices implemented through the ERM framework. The Board is also responsible for the annual review and approval of our risk appetite statement. The risk appetite statement describes the levels and types of risk we are willing to accept or to avoid, in order to achieve our strategic business objectives, while remaining in compliance with regulatory requirements.

The Board receives regular briefings on firmwide risks, including liquidity risk, market risk, credit risk, operational risk and model risk from our independent control and support functions, including the chief risk officer, and on compliance risk and conduct risk from the head of Compliance, on legal and regulatory matters from the general counsel, and on other matters impacting our reputation from the chair of our Firmwide Client and Business Standards Committee. The chief risk officer, as part of the review of the firmwide risk portfolio, regularly advises the Risk Committee of the Board of relevant risk metrics and material exposures, including risk limits and thresholds established in our risk appetite statement.

Next, at our most senior levels, our leaders are experienced risk managers, with a sophisticated and detailed understanding of the risks we take. Our senior management, and senior managers in our revenue-producing units and independent control and support functions, lead and participate in risk-oriented committees. Independent control and support functions include Compliance, the Conflicts Resolution Group (Conflicts), Controllers, Credit Risk Management, Human Capital Management, Legal, Liquidity Risk Management and Analysis (Liquidity Risk Management), Market Risk Management and Analysis (Market Risk Management), Model Risk Management, Operations, Operational Risk Management and Analysis (Operational Risk Management), Tax, Technology and Treasury.

Our governance structure provides the protocol and responsibility for decision-making on risk management issues and ensures implementation of those decisions. We make extensive use of risk-related committees that meet regularly and serve as an important means to facilitate and foster ongoing discussions to identify, manage and mitigate risks.

We maintain strong communication about risk and we have a culture of collaboration in decision-making among the revenue-producing units, independent control and support functions, committees and senior management. While our revenue-producing units are responsible for management of their risk, we dedicate extensive resources to independent control and support functions in order to ensure a strong oversight structure and an appropriate segregation of duties. We regularly reinforce our strong culture of escalation and accountability across all functions.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   77


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

Processes. We maintain various processes and procedures that are critical components of our risk management framework, including identifying, assessing, monitoring and limiting our risks.

To effectively assess and monitor our risks, we maintain a daily discipline of marking substantially all of our inventory to current market levels. We carry our inventory at fair value, with changes in valuation reflected immediately in our risk management systems and in net revenues. We do so because we believe this discipline is one of the most effective tools for assessing and managing risk and that it provides transparent and realistic insight into our inventory exposures.

We also apply a rigorous framework of limits and thresholds to control and monitor risk across transactions, products, businesses and markets. The Board, directly or indirectly, through its Risk Committee, approves limits and thresholds, included in our risk appetite statement, at firmwide, business and product levels. In addition, the Firmwide Risk Committee is responsible for approving our risk limits framework, subject to the overall limits approved by the Risk Committee of the Board, at a variety of levels and monitoring these limits on a daily basis. The Risk Governance Committee (through delegated authority from the Firmwide Risk Committee) is responsible for approving limits at firmwide, business and product levels. Certain limits may be set at levels that will require periodic adjustment, rather than at levels which reflect our maximum risk appetite. This fosters an ongoing dialogue on risk among revenue-producing units, independent control and support functions, committees and senior management, as well as rapid escalation of risk-related matters. See “Liquidity Risk Management,” “Market Risk Management” and “Credit Risk Management” for further information about our risk limits.

Active management of our positions is another important process. Proactive mitigation of our market and credit exposures minimizes the risk that we will be required to take outsized actions during periods of stress.

Effective risk reporting and risk decision-making depends on our ability to get the right information to the right people at the right time. As such, we focus on the rigor and effectiveness of our risk systems, with the objective of ensuring that our risk management technology systems are comprehensive, reliable and timely. We devote significant time and resources to our risk management technology to ensure that it consistently provides us with complete, accurate and timely information.

People. Even the best technology serves only as a tool for helping to make informed decisions in real time about the risks we are taking. Ultimately, effective risk management requires our people to interpret our risk data on an ongoing and timely basis and adjust risk positions accordingly. In both our revenue-producing units and our independent control and support functions, the experience of our professionals, and their understanding of the nuances and limitations of each risk measure, guide us in assessing exposures and maintaining them within prudent levels.

We reinforce a culture of effective risk management, consistent with our risk appetite statement, in our training and development programs, as well as the way we evaluate performance, and recognize and reward our people. Our training and development programs, including certain sessions led by our most senior leaders, are focused on the importance of risk management, client relationships and reputational excellence. As part of our annual performance review process, we assess reputational excellence including how an employee exercises good risk management and reputational judgment, and adheres to our code of conduct and compliance policies. Our review and reward processes are designed to communicate and reinforce to our professionals the link between behavior and how people are recognized, the need to focus on our clients and our reputation, and the need to always act in accordance with our highest standards.

Structure

Ultimate oversight of risk is the responsibility of our Board. The Board oversees risk both directly and through its committees, including its Risk Committee. We have a series of committees with specific risk management mandates that have oversight or decision-making responsibilities for risk management activities. Committee membership generally consists of senior managers from both our revenue-producing units and our independent control and support functions. We have established procedures for these committees to ensure that appropriate information barriers are in place. Our primary risk committees, most of which also have additional sub-committees or working groups, are described below. In addition to these committees, we have other risk-oriented committees which provide oversight for different businesses, activities, products, regions and entities. All of our committees have responsibility for considering the impact of transactions and activities, which they oversee, on our reputation.

Membership of our risk committees is reviewed regularly and updated to reflect changes in the responsibilities of the committee members. Accordingly, the length of time that members serve on the respective committees varies as determined by the committee chairs and based on the responsibilities of the members.

 

 

78   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

In addition, independent control and support functions, which report to the chief executive officer, the presidents and co-chief operating officers, the chief financial officer or the chief risk officer, are responsible for day-to-day oversight or monitoring of risk, as illustrated in the chart below and as described in greater detail in the following sections. Internal Audit, which reports to the Audit Committee of the Board and includes professionals with a broad range of audit and industry experience, including risk management expertise, is responsible for independently assessing and validating key controls within the risk management framework.

The chart below presents an overview of our risk management governance structure, including the reporting relationships of our independent control and support functions.

 

LOGO

Management Committee. The Management Committee oversees our global activities, including all of our independent control and support functions. It provides this oversight directly and through authority delegated to committees it has established. This committee consists of our most senior leaders, and is chaired by our chief executive officer. Most members of the Management Committee are also members of other committees. The following are the committees that are principally involved in firmwide risk management.

Firmwide Client and Business Standards Committee. The Firmwide Client and Business Standards Committee assesses and makes determinations regarding business standards and practices, reputational risk management, client relationships and client service, is chaired by one of our presidents and co-chief operating officers, who is appointed as chair by the chief executive officer, and reports to the Management Committee. This committee periodically updates and receives guidance from the Public Responsibilities Committee of the Board. This committee has also established certain committees that report to it, including divisional Client and Business Standards Committees and risk-related committees. The following are the risk-related committees that report to the Firmwide Client and Business Standards Committee:

 

 

Firmwide Reputational Risk Committee. The Firmwide Reputational Risk Committee is responsible for assessing reputational risks arising from transactions that have been identified as requiring mandatory escalation to the Firmwide Reputational Risk Committee or that otherwise have potential heightened reputational risk. This committee is chaired by one of our presidents and co-chief operating officers, who is appointed as chair by the chief executive officer, and the vice-chairs are the head of Compliance and the head of the Conflicts Resolution Group, who are appointed as vice-chairs by the chair of the Firmwide Client and Business Standards Committee.

 

 

Firmwide Suitability Committee. The Firmwide Suitability Committee is responsible for setting standards and policies for product, transaction and client suitability and providing a forum for consistency across functions, regions and products on suitability assessments. This committee also reviews suitability matters escalated from other committees. This committee is co-chaired by the deputy head of Compliance, and the co-chief operating officer of Fixed Income, Currency and Commodities, who are appointed as co-chairs by the chair of the Firmwide Client and Business Standards Committee.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   79


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

Firmwide Risk Committee. The Firmwide Risk Committee is globally responsible for the ongoing monitoring and management of our financial risks. The Firmwide Risk Committee approves our financial risk limits framework, metrics and methodologies, and reviews results of stress tests and scenario analyses. This committee is co-chaired by our chief financial officer and our chief risk officer, who are appointed as co-chairs by the chief executive officer, and reports to the Management Committee. The following are the primary committees that report to the Firmwide Risk Committee:

 

 

Firmwide Finance Committee. The Firmwide Finance Committee has oversight responsibility for liquidity risk, the size and composition of our balance sheet and capital base, and credit ratings. This committee regularly reviews our liquidity, balance sheet, funding position and capitalization, approves related policies, and makes recommendations as to any adjustments to be made in light of current events, risks, exposures and regulatory requirements. As a part of such oversight, among other things, this committee reviews and approves balance sheet limits and the size of our GCLA. This committee is co-chaired by our chief risk officer and our global treasurer, who are appointed as co-chairs by the Firmwide Risk Committee.

 

 

Firmwide Investment Policy Committee. The Firmwide Investment Policy Committee reviews, approves, sets policies, and provides oversight for certain illiquid principal investments, including review of risk management and controls for these types of investments. This committee is co-chaired by the head of our Merchant Banking Division, a co-head of our Securities Division and a deputy general counsel, who are appointed as co-chairs by our presidents and co-chief operating officers and our chief financial officer.

 

 

Firmwide Volcker Oversight Committee. The Firmwide Volcker Oversight Committee is responsible for the oversight and periodic review of the implementation of our Volcker Rule compliance program, as approved by the Board, and other Volcker Rule-related matters. This committee is co-chaired by a deputy chief risk officer and the deputy head of Compliance, who are appointed as co-chairs by the co-chairs of the Firmwide Risk Committee.

 

 

Risk Governance Committee. The Risk Governance Committee (through delegated authority from the Firmwide Risk Committee) is globally responsible for the ongoing approval and monitoring of risk frameworks, policies, parameters and limits, at firmwide, business and product levels. This committee is chaired by our chief risk officer, who is appointed as chair by the co-chairs of the Firmwide Risk Committee.

The following committees report jointly to the Firmwide Risk Committee and the Firmwide Client and Business Standards Committee:

 

 

Firmwide Capital Committee. The Firmwide Capital Committee provides approval and oversight of debt-related transactions, including principal commitments of our capital. This committee aims to ensure that business and reputational standards for underwritings and capital commitments are maintained on a global basis. This committee is co-chaired by the head of Americas Credit Risk Management, and the head of the EMEA Financing Group. The co-chairs of the Firmwide Capital Committee are appointed by the co-chairs of the Firmwide Risk Committee.

 

 

Firmwide Commitments Committee. The Firmwide Commitments Committee reviews our underwriting and distribution activities with respect to equity and equity-related product offerings, and sets and maintains policies and procedures designed to ensure that legal, reputational, regulatory and business standards are maintained on a global basis. In addition to reviewing specific transactions, this committee periodically conducts general strategic reviews of sectors and products and establishes policies in connection with transaction practices. This committee is co-chaired by the co-head of the Industrials group in our Investment Banking Division, our chief underwriting officer, and a managing director in Risk Management, who are appointed as co-chairs by the chair of the Firmwide Client and Business Standards Committee.

Firmwide Enterprise Risk Committee. The Firmwide Enterprise Risk Committee is responsible for the ongoing review, approval and monitoring of the ERM framework and for providing oversight of our aggregate financial and nonfinancial risks. This committee is co-chaired by one of our presidents and co-chief operating officers and our chief risk officer, who are appointed as co-chairs by our chief executive officer, and reports to the Management Committee. The following are the primary committees that report to the Firmwide Enterprise Risk Committee:

 

 

Firmwide New Activity Committee. The Firmwide New Activity Committee is responsible for reviewing new activities and for establishing a process to identify and review previously approved activities that are significant and that have changed in complexity and/or structure or present different reputational and suitability concerns over time to consider whether these activities remain appropriate. This committee is co-chaired by the head of regulatory control and the co-head of EMEA FICC sales, who are appointed as co-chairs by the chairs of the Firmwide Enterprise Risk Committee.

 

 

80   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

 

Firmwide Model Risk Control Committee. The Firmwide Model Risk Control Committee is responsible for oversight of the development and implementation of model risk controls, which includes governance, policies and procedures related to our reliance on financial models. This committee is chaired by a deputy chief risk officer, who is appointed as chair by the chairs of the Firmwide Enterprise Risk Committee.

 

 

Firmwide Conduct and Operational Risk Committee. The Firmwide Conduct and Operational Risk Committee is globally responsible for the ongoing approval and monitoring of the frameworks, policies, parameters and limits which govern our conduct and operational risks. This committee is co-chaired by a managing director in Global Compliance and the head of Operational Risk Management, who are appointed as co-chairs by the chairs of the Firmwide Enterprise Risk Committee.

 

 

Firmwide Technology Risk Committee. The Firmwide Technology Risk Committee reviews matters related to the design, development, deployment and use of technology. This committee oversees cyber security matters, as well as technology risk management frameworks and methodologies, and monitors their effectiveness. This committee is co-chaired by our chief information officer and the head of Global Investment Research, who are appointed as co-chairs by the chairs of the Firmwide Enterprise Risk Committee.

 

 

Global Business Resilience Committee. The Global Business Resilience Committee is responsible for oversight of business resilience initiatives, promoting increased levels of security and resilience, and reviewing certain operating risks related to business resilience. This committee is chaired by our chief administrative officer, who is appointed as chair by the chairs of the Firmwide Enterprise Risk Committee.

Conflicts Management

Conflicts of interest and our approach to dealing with them are fundamental to our client relationships, our reputation and our long-term success. The term “conflict of interest” does not have a universally accepted meaning, and conflicts can arise in many forms within a business or between businesses. The responsibility for identifying potential conflicts, as well as complying with our policies and procedures, is shared by the entire firm.

We have a multilayered approach to resolving conflicts and addressing reputational risk. Our senior management oversees policies related to conflicts resolution, and, in conjunction with Conflicts, Legal and Compliance, the Firmwide Client and Business Standards Committee, and other internal committees, formulates policies, standards and principles, and assists in making judgments regarding the appropriate resolution of particular conflicts. Resolving potential conflicts necessarily depends on the facts and circumstances of a particular situation and the application of experienced and informed judgment.

As a general matter, Conflicts reviews financing and advisory assignments in Investment Banking and certain of our investing, lending and other activities. In addition, we have various transaction oversight committees, such as the Firmwide Capital, Commitments and Suitability Committees and other committees that also review new underwritings, loans, investments and structured products. These groups and committees work with internal and external counsel and Compliance to evaluate and address any actual or potential conflicts. Conflicts reports to one of our presidents and co-chief operating officers.

We regularly assess our policies and procedures that address conflicts of interest in an effort to conduct our business in accordance with the highest ethical standards and in compliance with all applicable laws, rules and regulations.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   81


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

Liquidity Risk Management

 

Overview

Liquidity risk is the risk that we will be unable to fund the firm or meet our liquidity needs in the event of firm-specific, broader industry, or market liquidity stress events. Liquidity is of critical importance to us, as most of the failures of financial institutions have occurred in large part due to insufficient liquidity. Accordingly, we have in place a comprehensive and conservative set of liquidity and funding policies. Our principal objective is to be able to fund the firm and to enable our core businesses to continue to serve clients and generate revenues, even under adverse circumstances.

Treasury has the primary responsibility for assessing, monitoring and managing our liquidity and funding strategy. Treasury is independent of the revenue-producing units and reports to our chief financial officer.

Liquidity Risk Management is an independent risk management function responsible for control and oversight of our liquidity risk management framework, including stress testing and limit governance. Liquidity Risk Management is independent of the revenue-producing units and Treasury, and reports to our chief risk officer.

Liquidity Risk Management Principles

We manage liquidity risk according to three principles (i) hold sufficient excess liquidity in the form of GCLA to cover outflows during a stressed period, (ii) maintain appropriate Asset-Liability Management and (iii) maintain a viable Contingency Funding Plan.

Global Core Liquid Assets. GCLA is liquidity that we maintain to meet a broad range of potential cash outflows and collateral needs in a stressed environment. Our most important liquidity policy is to pre-fund our estimated potential cash and collateral needs during a liquidity crisis and hold this liquidity in the form of unencumbered, highly liquid securities and cash. We believe that the securities held in our GCLA would be readily convertible to cash in a matter of days, through liquidation, by entering into repurchase agreements or from maturities of resale agreements, and that this cash would allow us to meet immediate obligations without needing to sell other assets or depend on additional funding from credit-sensitive markets.

Our GCLA reflects the following principles:

 

 

The first days or weeks of a liquidity crisis are the most critical to a company’s survival;

 

Focus must be maintained on all potential cash and collateral outflows, not just disruptions to financing flows. Our businesses are diverse, and our liquidity needs are determined by many factors, including market movements, collateral requirements and client commitments, all of which can change dramatically in a difficult funding environment;

 

 

During a liquidity crisis, credit-sensitive funding, including unsecured debt, certain deposits and some types of secured financing agreements, may be unavailable, and the terms (e.g., interest rates, collateral provisions and tenor) or availability of other types of secured financing may change and certain deposits may be withdrawn; and

 

 

As a result of our policy to pre-fund liquidity that we estimate may be needed in a crisis, we hold more unencumbered securities and have larger debt balances than our businesses would otherwise require. We believe that our liquidity is stronger with greater balances of highly liquid unencumbered securities, even though it increases our total assets and our funding costs.

We maintain our GCLA across Group Inc., Funding IHC and Group Inc.’s major broker-dealer and bank subsidiaries, asset types, and clearing agents to provide us with sufficient operating liquidity to ensure timely settlement in all major markets, even in a difficult funding environment. In addition to the GCLA, we maintain cash balances and securities in several of our other entities, primarily for use in specific currencies, entities, or jurisdictions where we do not have immediate access to parent company liquidity.

We believe that our GCLA provides us with a resilient source of funds that would be available in advance of potential cash and collateral outflows and gives us significant flexibility in managing through a difficult funding environment.

Asset-Liability Management. Our liquidity risk management policies are designed to ensure we have a sufficient amount of financing, even when funding markets experience persistent stress. We manage the maturities and diversity of our funding across markets, products and counterparties, and seek to maintain a diversified funding profile with an appropriate tenor, taking into consideration the characteristics and liquidity profile of our assets.

Our approach to asset-liability management includes:

 

 

Conservatively managing the overall characteristics of our funding book, with a focus on maintaining long-term, diversified sources of funding in excess of our current requirements. See “Balance Sheet and Funding Sources — Funding Sources” for further details;

 

 

82   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

 

Actively managing and monitoring our asset base, with particular focus on the liquidity, holding period and our ability to fund assets on a secured basis. We assess our funding requirements and our ability to liquidate assets in a stressed environment while appropriately managing risk. This enables us to determine the most appropriate funding products and tenors. See “Balance Sheet and Funding Sources — Balance Sheet Management” for further details on our balance sheet management process and “— Funding Sources — Secured Funding” for further details on asset classes that may be harder to fund on a secured basis; and

 

 

Raising secured and unsecured financing that has a long tenor relative to the liquidity profile of our assets. This reduces the risk that our liabilities will come due in advance of our ability to generate liquidity from the sale of our assets. Because we maintain a highly liquid balance sheet, the holding period of certain of our assets may be materially shorter than their contractual maturity dates.

Our goal is to ensure that we maintain sufficient liquidity to fund our assets and meet our contractual and contingent obligations in normal times, as well as during periods of market stress. Through our dynamic balance sheet management process, we use actual and projected asset balances to determine secured and unsecured funding requirements. Funding plans are reviewed and approved by the Firmwide Finance Committee on a quarterly basis. In addition, senior managers in our independent control and support functions regularly analyze, and the Firmwide Finance Committee reviews, our consolidated total capital position (unsecured long-term borrowings plus total shareholders’ equity) so that we maintain a level of long-term funding that is sufficient to meet our long-term financing requirements. In a liquidity crisis, we would first use our GCLA in order to avoid reliance on asset sales (other than our GCLA). However, we recognize that orderly asset sales may be prudent or necessary in a severe or persistent liquidity crisis.

Subsidiary Funding Policies

The majority of our unsecured funding is raised by Group Inc., which lends the necessary funds to Funding IHC and other subsidiaries, some of which are regulated, to meet their asset financing, liquidity and capital requirements. In addition, Group Inc. provides its regulated subsidiaries with the necessary capital to meet their regulatory requirements. The benefits of this approach to subsidiary funding are enhanced control and greater flexibility to meet the funding requirements of our subsidiaries. Funding is also raised at the subsidiary level through a variety of products, including deposits, secured funding and unsecured borrowings.

Our intercompany funding policies assume that a subsidiary’s funds or securities are not freely available to its parent, Funding IHC or other subsidiaries unless (i) legally provided for and (ii) there are no additional regulatory, tax or other restrictions. In particular, many of our subsidiaries are subject to laws that authorize regulatory bodies to block or reduce the flow of funds from those subsidiaries to Group Inc. or Funding IHC. Regulatory action of that kind could impede access to funds that Group Inc. needs to make payments on its obligations. Accordingly, we assume that the capital provided to our regulated subsidiaries is not available to Group Inc. or other subsidiaries and any other financing provided to our regulated subsidiaries is not available to Group Inc. or Funding IHC until the maturity of such financing.

Group Inc. has provided substantial amounts of equity and subordinated indebtedness, directly or indirectly, to its regulated subsidiaries. For example, as of December 2017, Group Inc. had $29.60 billion of equity and subordinated indebtedness invested in GS&Co., its principal U.S. registered broker-dealer; $37.19 billion invested in GSI, a regulated U.K. broker-dealer; $2.69 billion invested in GSJCL, a regulated Japanese broker-dealer; $27.56 billion invested in GS Bank USA, a regulated New York State-chartered bank; and $3.86 billion invested in GSIB, a regulated U.K. bank. Group Inc. also provided, directly or indirectly, $114.98 billion of unsubordinated loans (including secured loans of $50.59 billion), and $13.38 billion of collateral and cash deposits to these entities, substantially all of which was to GS&Co., GSI, GSJCL and GS Bank USA, as of December 2017. In addition, as of December 2017, Group Inc. had significant amounts of capital invested in and loans to its other regulated subsidiaries.

Contingency Funding Plan. We maintain a contingency funding plan to provide a framework for analyzing and responding to a liquidity crisis situation or periods of market stress. Our contingency funding plan outlines a list of potential risk factors, key reports and metrics that are reviewed on an ongoing basis to assist in assessing the severity of, and managing through, a liquidity crisis and/or market dislocation. The contingency funding plan also describes in detail our potential responses if our assessments indicate that we have entered a liquidity crisis, which include pre-funding for what we estimate will be our potential cash and collateral needs, as well as utilizing secondary sources of liquidity. Mitigants and action items to address specific risks which may arise are also described and assigned to individuals responsible for execution.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   83


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

The contingency funding plan identifies key groups of individuals to foster effective coordination, control and distribution of information, all of which are critical in the management of a crisis or period of market stress. The contingency funding plan also details the responsibilities of these groups and individuals, which include making and disseminating key decisions, coordinating all contingency activities throughout the duration of the crisis or period of market stress, implementing liquidity maintenance activities and managing internal and external communication.

Liquidity Stress Tests

In order to determine the appropriate size of our GCLA, we use an internal liquidity model, referred to as the Modeled Liquidity Outflow, which captures and quantifies our liquidity risks. We also consider other factors including, but not limited to, an assessment of our potential intraday liquidity needs through an additional internal liquidity model, referred to as the Intraday Liquidity Model, the results of our long-term stress testing models, our resolution liquidity models and other applicable regulatory requirements and a qualitative assessment of our condition, as well as the financial markets. The results of the Modeled Liquidity Outflow, the Intraday Liquidity Model, the long-term stress testing models and the resolution liquidity models are reported to senior management on a regular basis.

Modeled Liquidity Outflow. Our Modeled Liquidity Outflow is based on conducting multiple scenarios that include combinations of market-wide and firm-specific stress. These scenarios are characterized by the following qualitative elements:

 

 

Severely challenged market environments, including low consumer and corporate confidence, financial and political instability, adverse changes in market values, including potential declines in equity markets and widening of credit spreads; and

 

 

A firm-specific crisis potentially triggered by material losses, reputational damage, litigation, executive departure, and/or a ratings downgrade.

The following are the critical modeling parameters of the Modeled Liquidity Outflow:

 

 

Liquidity needs over a 30-day scenario;

 

 

A two-notch downgrade of our long-term senior unsecured credit ratings;

 

 

A combination of contractual outflows, such as upcoming maturities of unsecured debt, and contingent outflows (e.g., actions though not contractually required, we may deem necessary in a crisis). We assume that most contingent outflows will occur within the initial days and weeks of a crisis;

 

No issuance of equity or unsecured debt;

 

 

No support from additional government funding facilities. Although we have access to various central bank funding programs, we do not assume reliance on additional sources of funding in a liquidity crisis; and

 

 

No asset liquidation, other than the GCLA.

The potential contractual and contingent cash and collateral outflows covered in our Modeled Liquidity Outflow include:

Unsecured Funding

 

 

Contractual: All upcoming maturities of unsecured long-term debt, commercial paper, and other unsecured funding products. We assume that we will be unable to issue new unsecured debt or rollover any maturing debt.

 

 

Contingent: Repurchases of our outstanding long-term debt, commercial paper and hybrid financial instruments in the ordinary course of business as a market maker.

Deposits

 

 

Contractual: All upcoming maturities of term deposits. We assume that we will be unable to raise new term deposits or rollover any maturing term deposits.

 

 

Contingent: Partial withdrawals of deposits that have no contractual maturity. The withdrawal assumptions reflect, among other factors, the type of deposit, whether the deposit is insured or uninsured, and our relationship with the depositor.

Secured Funding

 

 

Contractual: A portion of upcoming contractual maturities of secured funding due to either the inability to refinance or the ability to refinance only at wider haircuts (i.e., on terms which require us to post additional collateral). Our assumptions reflect, among other factors, the quality of the underlying collateral, counterparty roll probabilities (our assessment of the counterparty’s likelihood of continuing to provide funding on a secured basis at the maturity of the trade) and counterparty concentration.

 

 

Contingent: Adverse changes in the value of financial assets pledged as collateral for financing transactions, which would necessitate additional collateral postings under those transactions.

OTC Derivatives

 

 

Contingent: Collateral postings to counterparties due to adverse changes in the value of our OTC derivatives, excluding those that are cleared and settled through central counterparties (OTC-cleared).

 

 

84   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

 

Contingent: Other outflows of cash or collateral related to OTC derivatives, excluding OTC-cleared, including the impact of trade terminations, collateral substitutions, collateral disputes, loss of rehypothecation rights, collateral calls or termination payments required by a two-notch downgrade in our credit ratings, and collateral that has not been called by counterparties, but is available to them.

Exchange-Traded and OTC-cleared Derivatives

 

 

Contingent: Variation margin postings required due to adverse changes in the value of our outstanding exchange-traded and OTC-cleared derivatives.

 

 

Contingent: An increase in initial margin and guaranty fund requirements by derivative clearing houses.

Customer Cash and Securities

 

 

Contingent: Liquidity outflows associated with our prime brokerage business, including withdrawals of customer credit balances, and a reduction in customer short positions, which may serve as a funding source for long positions.

Securities

 

 

Contingent: Liquidity outflows associated with a reduction or composition change in our short positions, which may serve as a funding source for long positions.

Unfunded Commitments

 

 

Contingent: Draws on our unfunded commitments. Draw assumptions reflect, among other things, the type of commitment and counterparty.

Other

 

 

Other upcoming large cash outflows, such as tax payments.

Intraday Liquidity Model. Our Intraday Liquidity Model measures our intraday liquidity needs using a scenario analysis characterized by the same qualitative elements as our Modeled Liquidity Outflow. The model assesses the risk of increased intraday liquidity requirements during a scenario where access to sources of intraday liquidity may become constrained.

The following are key modeling elements of the Intraday Liquidity Model:

 

 

Liquidity needs over a one-day settlement period;

 

 

Delays in receipt of counterparty cash payments;

 

 

A reduction in the availability of intraday credit lines at our third-party clearing agents; and

 

 

Higher settlement volumes due to an increase in activity.

Long-Term Stress Testing. We utilize longer-term stress tests to take a forward view on our liquidity position through prolonged stress periods in which we experience a severe liquidity stress and recover in an environment that continues to be challenging. We are focused on ensuring conservative asset-liability management to prepare for a prolonged period of potential stress, seeking to maintain a diversified funding profile with an appropriate tenor, taking into consideration the characteristics and liquidity profile of our assets.

We also perform stress tests on a regular basis as part of our routine risk management processes and conduct tailored stress tests on an ad hoc or product-specific basis in response to market developments.

Resolution Liquidity Models. In connection with our resolution planning efforts, we have established our RLAP framework, which estimates liquidity needs of our major subsidiaries in a stressed environment. The liquidity needs are measured using our Modeled Liquidity Outflow assumptions and include certain additional inter-affiliate exposures. We have also established our RLEN framework, which measures the liquidity needs of our major subsidiaries to stabilize and wind-down following a Group Inc. bankruptcy filing in accordance with our preferred resolution strategy.

In addition, we have established a triggers and alerts framework which is designed to provide the Board with information needed to make an informed decision on whether and when to commence bankruptcy proceedings for Group Inc.

Model Review and Validation

Treasury regularly refines our Modeled Liquidity Outflow, Intraday Liquidity Model and our other stress testing models to reflect changes in market or economic conditions and our business mix. Any changes, including model assumptions, are assessed and approved by Liquidity Risk Management.

Model Risk Management is responsible for the independent review and validation of our liquidity models. See “Model Risk Management” for further information about the review and validation of these models.

Limits

We use liquidity limits at various levels and across liquidity risk types to manage the size of our liquidity exposures. Limits are measured relative to acceptable levels of risk given our liquidity risk tolerance. The purpose of the firmwide limits is to assist senior management in monitoring and controlling our overall liquidity profile.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   85


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

The Risk Committee of the Board and the Firmwide Finance Committee approve liquidity risk limits at the firmwide level. Limits are reviewed frequently and amended, with required approvals, on a permanent and temporary basis, as appropriate, to reflect changing market or business conditions.

Our liquidity risk limits are monitored by Treasury and Liquidity Risk Management. Treasury is responsible for identifying and escalating, on a timely basis, instances where limits have been exceeded.

GCLA and Unencumbered Metrics

GCLA. Based on the results of our internal liquidity risk models, described above, as well as our consideration of other factors including, but not limited to, an assessment of our potential intraday liquidity needs and a qualitative assessment of our condition, as well as the financial markets, we believe our liquidity position as of both December 2017 and December 2016 was appropriate. We strictly limit our GCLA to a narrowly defined list of securities and cash because they are highly liquid, even in a difficult funding environment. We do not include other potential sources of excess liquidity in our GCLA, such as less liquid unencumbered securities or committed credit facilities.

The table below presents the average fair value of the securities and certain overnight cash deposits that are included in our GCLA.

 

   

Average for the

Year Ended December

 
$ in millions     2017        2016  

U.S. dollar-denominated

    $155,020        $155,123  

Non-U.S. dollar-denominated

    63,528        55,980  

Total

    $218,548        $211,103  

The table below presents the average fair value of our GCLA by asset class.

 

   

Average for the

Year Ended December

 
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Overnight cash deposits

    $  93,617        $  92,336  

U.S. government obligations

    75,108        68,708  

U.S. agency obligations

    11,813        13,645  

Non-U.S. government obligations

    38,010        36,414  

Total

    $218,548        $211,103  

In the tables above:

 

 

The U.S. dollar-denominated GCLA consists of (i) unencumbered U.S. government and agency obligations (including highly liquid U.S. agency mortgage-backed obligations), all of which are eligible as collateral in Federal Reserve open market operations and (ii) certain overnight U.S. dollar cash deposits.

 

 

The non-U.S. dollar-denominated GCLA consists of non-U.S. government obligations (only unencumbered German, French, Japanese and U.K. government obligations) and certain overnight cash deposits in highly liquid currencies.

The table below presents the average GCLA of Group Inc. and Funding IHC, and Group Inc.’s major broker-dealer and bank subsidiaries.

 

   

Average for the

Year Ended December

 
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Group Inc. and Funding IHC

    $  37,507        $  43,638  

Major broker-dealer subsidiaries

    98,160        86,519  

Major bank subsidiaries

    82,881        80,946  

Total

    $218,548        $211,103  

We maintain our GCLA to enable us to meet current and potential liquidity requirements of our parent company, Group Inc., and its subsidiaries. Our Modeled Liquidity Outflow and Intraday Liquidity Model incorporate a consolidated requirement for Group Inc., as well as a standalone requirement for each of our major broker-dealer and bank subsidiaries. During the second quarter of 2017, in connection with our resolution plan, Group Inc. transferred substantially all of its GCLA to Funding IHC. Funding IHC is required to provide the necessary liquidity to Group Inc. during the ordinary course of business, and is also obligated to provide capital and liquidity support to major subsidiaries in the event of our material financial distress or failure. Liquidity held directly in each of our major broker-dealer and bank subsidiaries is intended for use only by that subsidiary to meet its liquidity requirements and is assumed not to be available to Group Inc. or Funding IHC unless (i) legally provided for and (ii) there are no additional regulatory, tax or other restrictions. In addition, the Modeled Liquidity Outflow and Intraday Liquidity Model also incorporate a broader assessment of standalone liquidity requirements for other subsidiaries and we hold a portion of our GCLA directly at Group Inc. or Funding IHC to support such requirements.

Other Unencumbered Assets. In addition to our GCLA, we have a significant amount of other unencumbered cash and financial instruments, including other government obligations, high-grade money market securities, corporate obligations, marginable equities, loans and cash deposits not included in our GCLA. The fair value of our unencumbered assets averaged $158.41 billion and $142.33 billion for 2017 and 2016, respectively. We do not consider these assets liquid enough to be eligible for our GCLA.

 

 

86   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

Liquidity Regulatory Framework

As a BHC, we are subject to the U.S. federal bank regulatory agencies’ LCR rule. The LCR rule requires organizations to maintain an adequate ratio of eligible high-quality liquid assets (HQLA) to expected net cash outflows under an acute short-term liquidity stress scenario. Eligible HQLA excludes HQLA held by subsidiaries that is in excess of their minimum requirement and is subject to transfer restrictions. We are required to maintain a minimum LCR of 100%.

The table below presents information about our average daily LCR.

 

$ in millions    
Average for the Three Months
Ended December 2017
 
 

Total HQLA

    $219,108  

Eligible HQLA

    $162,829  

Net cash outflows

    $123,518  

 

LCR

    132%  

We expect that fluctuations in client activity, business mix and the overall market environment will impact our average LCR in the future.

In addition, the U.S. federal bank regulatory agencies have issued a proposed rule that calls for a net stable funding ratio (NSFR) for large U.S. banking organizations. The proposal would require banking organizations to ensure they have access to stable funding over a one-year time horizon. The proposed rule includes quarterly disclosure of the ratio, as well as a description of the banking organization’s stable funding sources. The U.S. federal bank regulatory agencies have not released the final rule. We expect that we will be compliant with the NSFR requirement by the effective date of the final rule.

The following is information on our subsidiary liquidity regulatory requirements:

 

 

GS Bank USA. GS Bank USA is subject to minimum liquidity standards under the LCR rule approved by the U.S. federal bank regulatory agencies. As of December 2017, GS Bank USA’s LCR exceeded the minimum requirement. The U.S. federal bank regulatory agencies’ proposed NSFR requirement described above would also apply to GS Bank USA.

 

 

GSI. The LCR rule issued by the U.K. regulatory authorities became effective in the U.K. on October 1, 2015, with a phase-in period whereby certain financial institutions, including GSI, were required to have an 80% minimum ratio initially, increasing to 90% on January 1, 2017 and 100% on January 1, 2018. GSI’s average monthly LCR for the trailing twelve-month period ended December 2017 exceeded the minimum requirement.

 

Other Subsidiaries. We monitor the local regulatory liquidity requirements of our subsidiaries to ensure compliance. For many of our subsidiaries, these requirements either have changed or are likely to change in the future due to the implementation of the Basel Committee’s framework for liquidity risk measurement, standards and monitoring, as well as other regulatory developments.

The implementation of these rules, and any amendments adopted by the applicable regulatory authorities, could impact our liquidity and funding requirements and practices in the future.

Credit Ratings

We rely on the short-term and long-term debt capital markets to fund a significant portion of our day-to-day operations and the cost and availability of debt financing is influenced by our credit ratings. Credit ratings are also important when we are competing in certain markets, such as OTC derivatives, and when we seek to engage in longer-term transactions. See “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of this Form 10-K for information about the risks associated with a reduction in our credit ratings.

The table below presents the unsecured credit ratings and outlook of Group Inc. by DBRS, Inc. (DBRS), Fitch, Inc. (Fitch), Moody’s Investors Service (Moody’s), Rating and Investment Information, Inc. (R&I), and Standard & Poor’s Ratings Services (S&P).

 

    As of December 2017  
      DBRS       Fitch       Moody’s       R&I       S&P  

Short-term debt

    R-1 (middle     F1       P-2       a-1       A-2  

Long-term debt

    A (high     A       A3       A       BBB+  

Subordinated debt

    A       A-       Baa2       A-       BBB-  

Trust preferred

    A       BBB-       Baa3       N/A       BB  

Preferred stock

    BBB (high     BB+       Ba1       N/A       BB  

Ratings outlook

    Stable       Stable       Stable       Stable       Stable  

In the table above:

 

 

The ratings for trust preferred relate to the guaranteed preferred beneficial interests issued by Goldman Sachs Capital I.

 

 

The DBRS, Fitch, Moody’s and S&P ratings for preferred stock include the APEX issued by Goldman Sachs Capital II and Goldman Sachs Capital III.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   87


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

The table below presents the unsecured credit ratings and outlook of GS Bank USA, GSIB, GS&Co. and GSI, by Fitch, Moody’s and S&P.

 

    As of December 2017  
      Fitch        Moody’s        S&P  

GS Bank USA

       

Short-term debt

    F1        P-1        A-1  

Long-term debt

    A+        A1        A+  

Short-term bank deposits

    F1+        P-1        N/A  

Long-term bank deposits

    AA-        A1        N/A  

Ratings outlook

    Stable        Stable        Stable  

GSIB

       

Short-term debt

    F1        P-1        A-1  

Long-term debt

    A        A1        A+  

Short-term bank deposits

    F1        P-1        N/A  

Long-term bank deposits

    A        A1        N/A  

Ratings outlook

    Stable        Stable        Stable  

GS&Co.

       

Short-term debt

    F1        N/A        A-1  

Long-term debt

    A+        N/A        A+  

Ratings outlook

    Stable        N/A        Stable  

GSI

       

Short-term debt

    F1        P-1        A-1  

Long-term debt

    A        A1        A+  

Ratings outlook

    Stable        Stable        Stable  

We believe our credit ratings are primarily based on the credit rating agencies’ assessment of:

 

 

Our liquidity, market, credit and operational risk management practices;

 

 

The level and variability of our earnings;

 

 

Our capital base;

 

 

Our franchise, reputation and management;

 

 

Our corporate governance; and

 

 

The external operating and economic environment, including, in some cases, the assumed level of government support or other systemic considerations, such as potential resolution.

Certain of our derivatives have been transacted under bilateral agreements with counterparties who may require us to post collateral or terminate the transactions based on changes in our credit ratings. We manage our GCLA to ensure we would, among other potential requirements, be able to make the additional collateral or termination payments that may be required in the event of a two-notch reduction in our long-term credit ratings, as well as collateral that has not been called by counterparties, but is available to them.

See Note 7 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about derivatives with credit-related contingent features and the additional collateral or termination payments related to our net derivative liabilities under bilateral agreements that could have been called by counterparties in the event of a one-notch and two-notch downgrade in our credit ratings.

Cash Flows

As a global financial institution, our cash flows are complex and bear little relation to our net earnings and net assets. Consequently, we believe that traditional cash flow analysis is less meaningful in evaluating our liquidity position than the liquidity and asset-liability management policies described above. Cash flow analysis may, however, be helpful in highlighting certain macro trends and strategic initiatives in our businesses.

Year Ended December 2017. Our cash and cash equivalents decreased by $11.66 billion to $110.05 billion at the end of 2017. We used $17.74 billion in net cash for operating activities, reflecting a decrease in the net liability for receivables and payables due to client activity. We used $29.12 billion in net cash for investing activities, primarily to fund loans receivable to corporate borrowers and loans backed by real estate and investments in U.S. government and agency obligations accounted for as available-for-sale securities. We generated $35.20 billion in net cash from financing activities, primarily from net issuances of unsecured long-term borrowings and increases in institutional deposits and Marcus deposits, partially offset by repurchases of common stock.

Year Ended December 2016. Our cash and cash equivalents increased by $28.27 billion to $121.71 billion at the end of 2016. We generated $9.27 billion in net cash from investing activities, primarily from net cash acquired in business acquisitions. We generated $19.00 billion in net cash from financing activities and operating activities, primarily from increases in deposits and from net issuances of unsecured long-term borrowings, partially offset by repurchases of common stock.

Year Ended December 2015. Our cash and cash equivalents increased by $18.41 billion to $93.44 billion at the end of 2015. We used $18.57 billion in net cash for investing activities, primarily due to funding of loans receivable. We generated $36.99 billion in net cash from financing activities and operating activities primarily from net issuances of long-term borrowings and bank deposits, partially offset by repurchases of common stock.

 

 

88   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

Market Risk Management

 

Overview

Market risk is the risk of loss in the value of our inventory, as well as certain other financial assets and financial liabilities, due to changes in market conditions. We employ a variety of risk measures, each described in the respective sections below, to monitor market risk. We hold inventory primarily for market making for our clients and for our investing and lending activities. Our inventory therefore changes based on client demands and our investment opportunities. Our inventory is accounted for at fair value and therefore fluctuates on a daily basis, with the related gains and losses included in market making and other principal transactions. Categories of market risk include the following:

 

 

Interest rate risk: results from exposures to changes in the level, slope and curvature of yield curves, the volatilities of interest rates, prepayment speeds and credit spreads;

 

 

Equity price risk: results from exposures to changes in prices and volatilities of individual equities, baskets of equities and equity indices;

 

 

Currency rate risk: results from exposures to changes in spot prices, forward prices and volatilities of currency rates; and

 

 

Commodity price risk: results from exposures to changes in spot prices, forward prices and volatilities of commodities, such as crude oil, petroleum products, natural gas, electricity, and precious and base metals.

Market Risk Management, which is independent of the revenue-producing units and reports to our chief risk officer, has primary responsibility for assessing, monitoring and managing our market risk. We monitor and control risks through strong firmwide oversight and independent control and support functions across our global businesses.

Managers in revenue-producing units and Market Risk Management discuss market information, positions and estimated risk and loss scenarios on an ongoing basis. Managers in revenue-producing units are accountable for managing risk within prescribed limits. These managers have in-depth knowledge of their positions, markets and the instruments available to hedge their exposures.

Market Risk Management Process

We manage our market risk by diversifying exposures, controlling position sizes and establishing economic hedges in related securities or derivatives. This process includes:

 

 

Accurate and timely exposure information incorporating multiple risk metrics;

 

 

A dynamic limit setting framework; and

 

 

Constant communication among revenue-producing units, risk managers and senior management.

Risk Measures

Market Risk Management produces risk measures and monitors them against established market risk limits. These measures reflect an extensive range of scenarios and the results are aggregated at product, business and firmwide levels.

We use a variety of risk measures to estimate the size of potential losses for both moderate and more extreme market moves over both short-term and long-term time horizons. Our primary risk measures are VaR, which is used for shorter-term periods, and stress tests. Our risk reports detail key risks, drivers and changes for each desk and business, and are distributed daily to senior management of both our revenue-producing units and our independent control and support functions.

Value-at-Risk. VaR is the potential loss in value due to adverse market movements over a defined time horizon with a specified confidence level. For assets and liabilities included in VaR, see “Financial Statement Linkages to Market Risk Measures.” We typically employ a one-day time horizon with a 95% confidence level. We use a single VaR model which captures risks including interest rates, equity prices, currency rates and commodity prices. As such, VaR facilitates comparison across portfolios of different risk characteristics. VaR also captures the diversification of aggregated risk at the firmwide level.

We are aware of the inherent limitations to VaR and therefore use a variety of risk measures in our market risk management process. Inherent limitations to VaR include:

 

 

VaR does not estimate potential losses over longer time horizons where moves may be extreme;

 

 

VaR does not take account of the relative liquidity of different risk positions; and

 

 

Previous moves in market risk factors may not produce accurate predictions of all future market moves.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   89


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

When calculating VaR, we use historical simulations with full valuation of approximately 70,000 market factors. VaR is calculated at a position level based on simultaneously shocking the relevant market risk factors for that position. We sample from five years of historical data to generate the scenarios for our VaR calculation. The historical data is weighted so that the relative importance of the data reduces over time. This gives greater importance to more recent observations and reflects current asset volatilities, which improves the accuracy of our estimates of potential loss. As a result, even if our positions included in VaR were unchanged, our VaR would increase with increasing market volatility and vice versa.

Given its reliance on historical data, VaR is most effective in estimating risk exposures in markets in which there are no sudden fundamental changes or shifts in market conditions.

Our VaR measure does not include:

 

 

Positions that are best measured and monitored using sensitivity measures; and

 

 

The impact of changes in counterparty and our own credit spreads on derivatives, as well as changes in our own credit spreads on financial liabilities for which the fair value option was elected.

We perform daily backtesting of our VaR model (i.e., comparing daily net revenues for positions included in VaR to the VaR measure calculated as of the prior business day) at the firmwide level and for each of our businesses and major regulated subsidiaries.

Stress Testing. Stress testing is a method of determining the effect of various hypothetical stress scenarios. We use stress testing to examine risks of specific portfolios, as well as the potential impact of our significant risk exposures. We use a variety of stress testing techniques to calculate the potential loss from a wide range of market moves on our portfolios, including sensitivity analysis, scenario analysis and firmwide stress tests. The results of our various stress tests are analyzed together for risk management purposes.

Sensitivity analysis is used to quantify the impact of a market move in a single risk factor across all positions (e.g., equity prices or credit spreads) using a variety of defined market shocks, ranging from those that could be expected over a one-day time horizon up to those that could take many months to occur. We also use sensitivity analysis to quantify the impact of the default of any single entity, which captures the risk of large or concentrated exposures.

Scenario analysis is used to quantify the impact of a specified event, including how the event impacts multiple risk factors simultaneously. For example, for sovereign stress testing we calculate potential direct exposure associated with our sovereign inventory, as well as the corresponding debt, equity and currency exposures associated with our non-sovereign inventory that may be impacted by the sovereign distress. When conducting scenario analysis, we typically consider a number of possible outcomes for each scenario, ranging from moderate to severely adverse market impacts. In addition, these stress tests are constructed using both historical events and forward-looking hypothetical scenarios.

Firmwide stress testing combines market, credit, operational and liquidity risks into a single combined scenario. Firmwide stress tests are primarily used to assess capital adequacy as part of our capital planning and stress testing process; however, firmwide stress testing is also integrated into our risk governance framework. This includes selecting appropriate scenarios to use for our capital planning and stress testing process. See “Equity Capital Management and Regulatory Capital — Equity Capital Management” above for further information.

Unlike VaR measures, which have an implied probability because they are calculated at a specified confidence level, there is generally no implied probability that our stress test scenarios will occur. Instead, stress tests are used to model both moderate and more extreme moves in underlying market factors. When estimating potential loss, we generally assume that our positions cannot be reduced or hedged (although experience demonstrates that we are generally able to do so).

Stress test scenarios are conducted on a regular basis as part of our routine risk management process and on an ad hoc basis in response to market events or concerns. Stress testing is an important part of our risk management process because it allows us to quantify our exposure to tail risks, highlight potential loss concentrations, undertake risk/reward analysis, and assess and mitigate our risk positions.

Limits. We use risk limits at various levels (including firmwide, business and product) to govern our risk appetite by controlling the size of our exposures to market risk. Limits are set based on VaR and on a range of stress tests relevant to our exposures. Limits are reviewed frequently and amended on a permanent or temporary basis to reflect changing market conditions, business conditions or tolerance for risk.

 

 

90   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

The Risk Committee of the Board and the Risk Governance Committee (through delegated authority from the Firmwide Risk Committee) approve market risk limits and sub-limits at firmwide, business and product levels, consistent with our risk appetite statement. In addition, Market Risk Management (through delegated authority from the Risk Governance Committee) sets market risk limits and sub-limits at certain product and desk levels.

The purpose of the firmwide limits is to assist senior management in controlling our overall risk profile. Sub-limits are set below the approved level of risk limits. Sub-limits set the desired maximum amount of exposure that may be managed by any particular business on a day-to-day basis without additional levels of senior management approval, effectively leaving day-to-day decisions to individual desk managers and traders. Accordingly, sub-limits are a management tool designed to ensure appropriate escalation rather than to establish maximum risk tolerance. Sub-limits also distribute risk among various businesses in a manner that is consistent with their level of activity and client demand, taking into account the relative performance of each area.

Our market risk limits are monitored daily by Market Risk Management, which is responsible for identifying and escalating, on a timely basis, instances where limits have been exceeded.

When a risk limit has been exceeded (e.g., due to positional changes or changes in market conditions, such as increased volatilities or changes in correlations), it is escalated to senior managers in Market Risk Management and/or the appropriate risk committee. Such instances are remediated by an inventory reduction and/or a temporary or permanent increase to the risk limit.

Model Review and Validation

Our VaR and stress testing models are regularly reviewed by Market Risk Management and enhanced in order to incorporate changes in the composition of positions included in our market risk measures, as well as variations in market conditions. Prior to implementing significant changes to our assumptions and/or models, Model Risk Management performs model validations. Significant changes to our VaR and stress testing models are reviewed with our chief risk officer and chief financial officer, and approved by the Firmwide Risk Committee.

See “Model Risk Management” for further information about the review and validation of these models.

Systems

We have made a significant investment in technology to monitor market risk including:

 

 

An independent calculation of VaR and stress measures;

 

 

Risk measures calculated at individual position levels;

 

 

Attribution of risk measures to individual risk factors of each position;

 

 

The ability to report many different views of the risk measures (e.g., by desk, business, product type or entity); and

 

 

The ability to produce ad hoc analyses in a timely manner.

Metrics

We analyze VaR at the firmwide level and a variety of more detailed levels, including by risk category, business, and region. The tables below present average daily VaR and period-end VaR, as well as the high and low VaR for the period. Diversification effect in the tables below represents the difference between total VaR and the sum of the VaRs for the four risk categories. This effect arises because the four market risk categories are not perfectly correlated.

The table below presents average daily VaR by risk category.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017        2016        2015  

Interest rates

    $ 40        $ 45        $ 47  

Equity prices

    24        25        26  

Currency rates

    12        21        30  

Commodity prices

    13        17        20  

Diversification effect

    (35      (45      (47

Total

    $ 54        $ 63        $ 76  

Our average daily VaR decreased to $54 million in 2017 from $63 million in 2016, due to reductions across all risk categories, partially offset by a decrease in the diversification effect. The overall decrease was primarily due to lower levels of volatility.

Our average daily VaR decreased to $63 million in 2016 from $76 million in 2015, due to reductions across all risk categories, partially offset by a decrease in the diversification effect. The overall decrease was primarily due to reduced exposures.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   91


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

The table below presents period-end VaR by risk category.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016        2015  

Interest rates

    $ 48        $ 45        $ 43  

Equity prices

    31        34        24  

Currency rates

    7        23        31  

Commodity prices

    9        19        17  

Diversification effect

    (30      (39      (48

Total

    $ 65        $ 82        $ 67  

Our daily VaR decreased to $65 million as of December 2017 from $82 million as of December 2016, primarily due to reductions in the currency rates, commodity prices and equity prices categories, partially offset by a decrease in the diversification effect and an increase in the interest rates category. The overall decrease was primarily due to lower levels of volatility.

Our daily VaR increased to $82 million as of December 2016 from $67 million as of December 2015, primarily due to an increase in the equity prices category and a decrease in the diversification effect, partially offset by a decrease in the currency rates category. The overall increase was primarily due to increased exposures.

During 2017 and 2016, the firmwide VaR risk limit was not exceeded, raised or reduced. During 2015, the firmwide VaR risk limit was temporarily raised on two occasions in order to facilitate client transactions. Separately, in March 2015, the firmwide VaR risk limit was reduced, reflecting lower risk utilization over the prior year.

The table below presents high and low VaR by risk category.

 

    Year Ended
December 2017
 
$ in millions     High          Low  

Interest rates

    $57          $29  

Equity prices

    $38          $17  

Currency rates

    $28          $  6  

Commodity prices

    $27          $  7  

The high and low total VaR was $86 million and $37 million, respectively, for the year ended December 2017.

The chart below reflects our daily VaR over the last four quarters.

 

LOGO

The chart below presents the frequency distribution of our daily net revenues for positions included in VaR for 2017.

 

LOGO

Daily net revenues for positions included in VaR are compared with VaR calculated as of the end of the prior business day. Net losses incurred on a single day for such positions did not exceed our 95% one-day VaR during 2017, 2016 and 2015 (i.e., a VaR exception).

During periods in which we have significantly more positive net revenue days than net revenue loss days, we expect to have fewer VaR exceptions because, under normal conditions, our business model generally produces positive net revenues. In periods in which our franchise revenues are adversely affected, we generally have more loss days, resulting in more VaR exceptions. The daily net revenues for positions included in VaR used to determine VaR exceptions reflect the impact of any intraday activity, including bid/offer net revenues, which are more likely than not to be positive by their nature.

 

 

92   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

Sensitivity Measures

Certain portfolios and individual positions are not included in VaR because VaR is not the most appropriate risk measure. Other sensitivity measures we use to analyze market risk are described below.

10% Sensitivity Measures. The table below presents market risk for positions, accounted for at fair value, that are not included in VaR by asset category.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016        2015  

Equity

    $2,096        $2,085        $2,157  

Debt

    1,606        1,702        1,479  

Total

    $3,702        $3,787        $3,636  

In the table above:

 

 

The market risk of these positions is determined by estimating the potential reduction in net revenues of a 10% decline in the value of these positions.

 

 

Equity positions relate to private and restricted public equity securities, including interests in funds that invest in corporate equities and real estate and interests in hedge funds.

 

 

Debt positions include interests in funds that invest in corporate mezzanine and senior debt instruments, loans backed by commercial and residential real estate, corporate bank loans and other corporate debt, including acquired portfolios of distressed loans.

 

 

Equity and debt funded positions are included in our consolidated statements of financial condition in financial instruments owned. See Note 6 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about cash instruments.

 

 

These measures do not reflect the diversification effect across asset categories or across other market risk measures.

Credit Spread Sensitivity on Derivatives and Financial Liabilities. VaR excludes the impact of changes in counterparty and our own credit spreads on derivatives, as well as changes in our own credit spreads (debt valuation adjustment) on financial liabilities for which the fair value option was elected. The estimated sensitivity to a one basis point increase in credit spreads (counterparty and our own) on derivatives was a gain of $3 million and $2 million (including hedges) as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively. In addition, the estimated sensitivity to a one basis point increase in our own credit spreads on financial liabilities for which the fair value option was elected was a gain of $35 million and $25 million as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively. However, the actual net impact of a change in our own credit spreads is also affected by the liquidity, duration and convexity (as the sensitivity is not linear to changes in yields) of those financial liabilities for which the fair value option was elected, as well as the relative performance of any hedges undertaken.

Interest Rate Sensitivity. Loans receivable as of December 2017 and December 2016 were $65.93 billion and $49.67 billion, respectively, substantially all of which had floating interest rates. As of December 2017 and December 2016, the estimated sensitivity to a 100 basis point increase in interest rates on such loans was $527 million and $405 million, respectively, of additional interest income over a twelve-month period, which does not take into account the potential impact of an increase in costs to fund such loans. See Note 9 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about loans receivable.

Other Market Risk Considerations

As of December 2017 and December 2016, we had commitments and held loans for which we have obtained credit loss protection from Sumitomo Mitsui Financial Group, Inc. See Note 18 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about such lending commitments.

In addition, we make investments in securities that are accounted for as available-for-sale and included in financial instruments owned in the consolidated statements of financial condition. See Note 6 to the consolidated financial statements for further information.

We also make investments accounted for under the equity method and we also make direct investments in real estate, both of which are included in other assets. Direct investments in real estate are accounted for at cost less accumulated depreciation. See Note 13 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about other assets.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   93


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

Financial Statement Linkages to Market Risk Measures

We employ a variety of risk measures, each described in the respective sections above, to monitor market risk across the consolidated statements of financial condition and consolidated statements of earnings. The related gains and losses on these positions are included in market making, other principal transactions, interest income and interest expense in the consolidated statements of earnings, and debt valuation adjustment in the consolidated statements of comprehensive income.

The table below presents certain categories in our consolidated statements of financial condition and the market risk measures used to assess those assets and liabilities. Certain categories in the consolidated statements of financial condition are incorporated in more than one risk measure.

 

Categories in the Consolidated Statements

of Financial Condition

  Market Risk Measures

 

Collateralized agreements

 

VaR

 

Receivables

 

 

VaR

Interest Rate Sensitivity

 

Financial instruments owned

 

 

VaR

10% Sensitivity Measures Credit Spread Sensitivity — Derivatives

 

Deposits, at fair value

 

 

Credit Spread Sensitivity — Financial Liabilities

 

Collateralized financings

 

VaR

 

Financial instruments sold, but not yet

purchased

 

 

VaR

Credit Spread Sensitivity — Derivatives

 

Unsecured short-term and long-term

borrowings, at fair value

 

 

VaR

Credit Spread Sensitivity — Financial Liabilities

Credit Risk Management

Overview

Credit risk represents the potential for loss due to the default or deterioration in credit quality of a counterparty (e.g., an OTC derivatives counterparty or a borrower) or an issuer of securities or other instruments we hold. Our exposure to credit risk comes mostly from client transactions in OTC derivatives and loans and lending commitments. Credit risk also comes from cash placed with banks, securities financing transactions (i.e., resale and repurchase agreements and securities borrowing and lending activities) and receivables from brokers, dealers, clearing organizations, customers and counterparties.

Credit Risk Management, which is independent of the revenue-producing units and reports to our chief risk officer, has primary responsibility for assessing, monitoring and managing credit risk. The Firmwide Risk Committee and the Risk Governance Committee establish and review credit policies and parameters. In addition, we hold other positions that give rise to credit risk (e.g., bonds held in our inventory and secondary bank loans). These credit risks are captured as a component of market risk measures, which are monitored and managed by Market Risk Management, consistent with other inventory positions. We also enter into derivatives to manage market risk exposures. Such derivatives also give rise to credit risk, which is monitored and managed by Credit Risk Management.

Credit Risk Management Process

Effective management of credit risk requires accurate and timely information, a high level of communication and knowledge of customers, countries, industries and products. Our process for managing credit risk includes:

 

 

Approving transactions and setting and communicating credit exposure limits;

 

 

Establishing or approving underwriting standards;

 

 

Monitoring compliance with established credit exposure limits;

 

 

Assessing the likelihood that a counterparty will default on its payment obligations;

 

 

Measuring our current and potential credit exposure and losses resulting from counterparty default;

 

 

Reporting of credit exposures to senior management, the Board and regulators;

 

 

Using credit risk mitigants, including collateral and hedging; and

 

 

Communicating and collaborating with other independent control and support functions such as operations, legal and compliance.

As part of the risk assessment process, Credit Risk Management performs credit reviews, which include initial and ongoing analyses of our counterparties. For substantially all of our credit exposures, the core of our process is an annual counterparty credit review. A credit review is an independent analysis of the capacity and willingness of a counterparty to meet its financial obligations, resulting in an internal credit rating. The determination of internal credit ratings also incorporates assumptions with respect to the nature of and outlook for the counterparty’s industry, and the economic environment. Senior personnel within Credit Risk Management, with expertise in specific industries, inspect and approve credit reviews and internal credit ratings.

 

 

94   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

Our risk assessment process may also include, where applicable, reviewing certain key metrics, such as delinquency status, collateral values, FICO credit scores and other risk factors.

Our global credit risk management systems capture credit exposure to individual counterparties and on an aggregate basis to counterparties and their subsidiaries (economic groups). These systems also provide management with comprehensive information on our aggregate credit risk by product, internal credit rating, industry, country and region.

Risk Measures and Limits

We measure our credit risk based on the potential loss in the event of non-payment by a counterparty using current and potential exposure. For derivatives and securities financing transactions, current exposure represents the amount presently owed to us after taking into account applicable netting and collateral arrangements, while potential exposure represents our estimate of the future exposure that could arise over the life of a transaction based on market movements within a specified confidence level. Potential exposure also takes into account netting and collateral arrangements. For loans and lending commitments, the primary measure is a function of the notional amount of the position.

We use credit limits at various levels (e.g., counterparty, economic group, industry and country), as well as underwriting standards to control the size and nature of our credit exposures. Limits for counterparties and economic groups are reviewed regularly and revised to reflect changing risk appetites for a given counterparty or group of counterparties. Limits for industries and countries are based on our risk tolerance and are designed to allow for regular monitoring, review, escalation and management of credit risk concentrations.

The Risk Committee of the Board and the Risk Governance Committee (through delegated authority from the Firmwide Risk Committee) approve credit risk limits at firmwide, business and product levels, consistent with our risk appetite statement. Credit Risk Management (through delegated authority from the Risk Governance Committee) sets credit limits for individual counterparties, economic groups, industries and countries. Policies authorized by the Firmwide Risk Committee and the Risk Governance Committee prescribe the level of formal approval required for us to assume credit exposure to a counterparty across all product areas, taking into account any applicable netting provisions, collateral or other credit risk mitigants.

Stress Tests

We use regular stress tests to calculate the credit exposures, including potential concentrations that would result from applying shocks to counterparty credit ratings or credit risk factors (e.g., currency rates, interest rates, equity prices). These shocks include a wide range of moderate and more extreme market movements. Some of our stress tests include shocks to multiple risk factors, consistent with the occurrence of a severe market or economic event. In the case of sovereign default, we estimate the direct impact of the default on our sovereign credit exposures, changes to our credit exposures arising from potential market moves in response to the default, and the impact of credit market deterioration on corporate borrowers and counterparties that may result from the sovereign default. Unlike potential exposure, which is calculated within a specified confidence level, with a stress test there is generally no assumed probability of these events occurring.

We perform stress tests on a regular basis as part of our routine risk management processes and conduct tailored stress tests on an ad hoc basis in response to market developments. Stress tests are conducted jointly with our market and liquidity risk functions.

Model Review and Validation

Our potential credit exposure and stress testing models, and any changes to such models or assumptions, are reviewed by Model Risk Management. See “Model Risk Management” for further information about the review and validation of these models.

Risk Mitigants

To reduce our credit exposures on derivatives and securities financing transactions, we may enter into netting agreements with counterparties that permit us to offset receivables and payables with such counterparties. We may also reduce credit risk with counterparties by entering into agreements that enable us to obtain collateral from them on an upfront or contingent basis and/or to terminate transactions if the counterparty’s credit rating falls below a specified level. We monitor the fair value of the collateral on a daily basis to ensure that our credit exposures are appropriately collateralized. We seek to minimize exposures where there is a significant positive correlation between the creditworthiness of our counterparties and the market value of collateral we receive.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   95


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

For loans and lending commitments, depending on the credit quality of the borrower and other characteristics of the transaction, we employ a variety of potential risk mitigants. Risk mitigants include collateral provisions, guarantees, covenants, structural seniority of the bank loan claims and, for certain lending commitments, provisions in the legal documentation that allow us to adjust loan amounts, pricing, structure and other terms as market conditions change. The type and structure of risk mitigants employed can significantly influence the degree of credit risk involved in a loan or lending commitment.

When we do not have sufficient visibility into a counterparty’s financial strength or when we believe a counterparty requires support from its parent, we may obtain third-party guarantees of the counterparty’s obligations. We may also mitigate our credit risk using credit derivatives or participation agreements.

Credit Exposures

As of December 2017, our aggregate credit exposure increased as compared with December 2016, primarily reflecting an increase in loans and lending commitments. The percentage of our credit exposures arising from non-investment-grade counterparties (based on our internally determined public rating agency equivalents) increased as compared with December 2016, primarily reflecting an increase in non-investment-grade loans and lending commitments. Our credit exposure to counterparties that defaulted during 2017 was higher as compared with our credit exposure to counterparties that defaulted during the prior year, and substantially all of such exposure related to loans and lending commitments. Our credit exposure to counterparties that defaulted during 2017 remained low, representing less than 0.5% of our total credit exposure, and estimated losses, while higher compared with the prior year, were still not material. Our credit exposures are described further below.

Cash and Cash Equivalents. Our credit exposure on cash and cash equivalents arises from our unrestricted cash, and includes both interest-bearing and non-interest-bearing deposits. To mitigate the risk of credit loss, we place substantially all of our deposits with highly-rated banks and central banks.

The table below presents our credit exposure related to unrestricted cash and cash equivalents by industry, region and credit quality.

 

    Cash as of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Credit Exposure by Industry

    

Funds

    $         –        $       138  

Financial Institutions

    15,609        11,836  

Sovereign

    76,000        95,092  

Total

    $91,609        $107,066  

Credit Exposure by Region

 

Americas

    $58,300        $  80,381  

EMEA

    20,625        16,099  

Asia

    12,684        10,586  

Total

    $91,609        $107,066  

Credit Exposure by Credit Quality (Credit Rating Equivalent)

 

AAA

    $65,972        $  83,899  

AA

    7,939        8,784  

A

    16,422        13,344  

BBB

    1,060        971  

BB or lower

    216        68  

Total

    $91,609        $107,066  

The table above excludes cash segregated for regulatory and other purposes of $18.44 billion and $14.65 billion as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively.

OTC Derivatives. Our credit exposure on OTC derivatives arises primarily from our market-making activities. As a market maker, we enter into derivative transactions to provide liquidity to clients and to facilitate the transfer and hedging of their risks. We also enter into derivatives to manage market risk exposures. We manage our credit exposure on OTC derivatives using the credit risk process, measures, limits and risk mitigants described above.

Derivatives are reported on a net-by-counterparty basis (i.e., the net payable or receivable for derivative assets and liabilities for a given counterparty) when a legal right of setoff exists under an enforceable netting agreement (counterparty netting). Derivatives are accounted for at fair value, net of cash collateral received or posted under enforceable credit support agreements (cash collateral netting). We generally enter into OTC derivatives transactions under bilateral collateral arrangements that require the daily exchange of collateral. As credit risk is an essential component of fair value, we include a credit valuation adjustment (CVA) in the fair value of derivatives to reflect counterparty credit risk, as described in Note 7 to the consolidated financial statements. CVA is a function of the present value of expected exposure, the probability of counterparty default and the assumed recovery upon default.

 

 

96   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

The table below presents our credit exposure related to OTC derivatives by industry and region.

 

   

OTC Derivatives

as of December

 
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Credit Exposure by Industry

    

Funds

    $11,288        $13,294  

Financial Institutions

    10,997        14,116  

Consumer, Retail & Healthcare

    823        773  

Sovereign

    7,668        7,019  

Municipalities & Nonprofit

    2,696        2,959  

Natural Resources & Utilities

    4,344        3,707  

Real Estate

    293        85  

Technology, Media & Telecommunications

    2,074        4,188  

Diversified Industrials

    2,225        2,529  

Other (including Special Purpose Vehicles)

    2,628        2,455  

Total

    $45,036        $51,125  

Credit Exposure by Region

    

Americas

    $15,101        $19,629  

EMEA

    26,447        26,536  

Asia

    3,488        4,960  

Total

    $45,036        $51,125  

The table below presents the distribution of our credit exposure to OTC derivatives by tenor, both before and after the effect of collateral and netting agreements.

 

$ in millions    
Investment-
Grade
 
 
   
Non-Investment-
Grade / Unrated
 
 
     Total  

As of December 2017

      

Less than 1 year

    $  16,232       $  4,854        $   21,086  

1 - 5 years

    23,817       5,465        29,282  

Greater than 5 years

    62,103       4,441        66,544  

Total

    102,152       14,760        116,912  

Netting

    (65,039     (6,837      (71,876

OTC derivative assets

    $  37,113       $  7,923        $   45,036  

 

Net credit exposure

    $  22,366       $  7,248        $   29,614  

 

As of December 2016

      

Less than 1 year

    $  24,840       $  3,983        $   28,823  

1 - 5 years

    30,801       3,676        34,477  

Greater than 5 years

    85,951       4,599        90,550  

Total

    141,592       12,258        153,850  

Netting

    (96,493     (6,232      (102,725

OTC derivative assets

    $  45,099       $  6,026        $   51,125  

 

Net credit exposure

    $  28,879       $  4,922        $   33,801  

In the table above:

 

 

Tenor is based on expected duration for mortgage-related credit derivatives and generally on remaining contractual maturity for other derivatives.

 

 

Counterparty netting within the same tenor category is included within such tenor category. Counterparty netting across tenor categories, as well as cash collateral received under enforceable credit support agreements, is included in netting.

 

Net credit exposure represents OTC derivative assets, included in financial instruments owned, less cash collateral and the fair value of securities collateral, primarily U.S. government and agency obligations and non-U.S. government and agency obligations, received under credit support agreements, which management considers when determining credit risk, but such collateral is not eligible for netting under U.S. GAAP.

The tables below present the distribution of our credit exposure to OTC derivatives by tenor and our internally determined public rating agency equivalents.

 

    Investment-Grade  
$ in millions     AAA       AA       A       BBB       Total  

As of December 2017

         

Less than 1 year

    $    663       $   3,028       $   7,806       $   4,735       $  16,232  

1 - 5 years

    1,231       4,770       11,975       5,841       23,817  

Greater than 5 years

    3,263       16,990       21,857       19,993       62,103  

Total

    5,157       24,788       41,638       30,569       102,152  

Netting

    (2,678     (11,131     (32,143     (19,087     (65,039

OTC derivative assets

    $ 2,479       $ 13,657       $   9,495       $ 11,482       $  37,113  

 

Net credit exposure

    $ 2,245       $   8,140       $   5,077       $   6,904       $  22,366  

 

As of December 2016

         

Less than 1 year

    $    332       $   4,907       $ 12,595       $   7,006       $  24,840  

1 - 5 years

    862       6,898       12,814       10,227       30,801  

Greater than 5 years

    3,182       42,400       19,682       20,687       85,951  

Total

    4,376       54,205       45,091       37,920       141,592  

Netting

    (1,860     (40,095     (31,644     (22,894     (96,493

OTC derivative assets

    $ 2,516       $ 14,110       $ 13,447       $ 15,026       $  45,099  

 

Net credit exposure

    $ 2,283       $   8,366       $   8,401       $   9,829       $  28,879  

 

    Non-Investment-Grade / Unrated  
$ in millions     BB or lower        Unrated        Total  

As of December 2017

       

Less than 1 year

    $  4,603        $251        $  4,854  

1 - 5 years

    5,458        7        5,465  

Greater than 5 years

    4,401        40        4,441  

Total

    14,462        298        14,760  

Netting

    (6,814      (23      (6,837

OTC derivative assets

    $  7,648        $275        $  7,923  

 

Net credit exposure

    $  7,044        $204        $  7,248  

 

As of December 2016

       

Less than 1 year

    $  3,661        $322        $  3,983  

1 - 5 years

    3,653        23        3,676  

Greater than 5 years

    4,437        162        4,599  

Total

    11,751        507        12,258  

Netting

    (6,207      (25      (6,232

OTC derivative assets

    $  5,544        $482        $  6,026  

 

Net credit exposure

    $  4,569        $353        $  4,922  

Lending Activities. We manage our lending activities using the credit risk process, measures, limits and risk mitigants described above. Other lending positions, including secondary trading positions, are risk-managed as a component of market risk.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   97


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

 

Commercial Lending. Our commercial lending activities include lending to investment-grade and non-investment-grade corporate borrowers. Loans and lending commitments associated with these activities are principally used for operating liquidity and general corporate purposes or in connection with contingent acquisitions. Corporate loans may be secured or unsecured, depending on the loan purpose, the risk profile of the borrower and other factors. Our commercial lending activities also include extending loans to borrowers that are secured by commercial and other real estate.

 

 

The table below presents our credit exposure related to commercial loans and lending commitments by industry, region and credit quality.

 

   

Loans and Lending
Commitments

as of December

 
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Credit Exposure by Industry

    

Funds

    $    5,823        $    3,854  

Financial Institutions

    14,255        13,630  

Consumer, Retail & Healthcare

    44,558        30,007  

Sovereign

    1,020        902  

Municipalities & Nonprofit

    804        709  

Natural Resources & Utilities

    27,196        25,694  

Real Estate

    23,540        13,034  

Technology, Media & Telecommunications

    37,282        33,232  

Diversified Industrials

    25,686        20,847  

Other (including Special Purpose Vehicles)

    17,848        12,301  

Total

    $198,012        $154,210  

Credit Exposure by Region

    

Americas

    $143,668        $115,145  

EMEA

    48,239        35,044  

Asia

    6,105        4,021  

Total

    $198,012        $154,210  

Credit Exposure by Credit Quality (Credit Rating Equivalent)

 

AAA

    $    3,193        $    3,135  

AA

    8,799        8,375  

A

    33,055        29,227  

BBB

    63,225        43,151  

BB or lower

    89,243        69,745  

Unrated

    497        577  

Total

    $198,012        $154,210  

 

 

Private Wealth Management and Retail Lending. We extend loans and lending commitments to our Private Wealth Management clients that are primarily secured by residential real estate, securities or other assets. The fair value of the collateral received against such loans and lending commitments generally exceeds their carrying value. The gross exposure related to such loans and lending commitments was $24.86 billion and $22.51 billion as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively. Our regional net credit exposure related to these activities was approximately 90% and 92% in the Americas, approximately 5% and 5% in EMEA, and approximately 5% and 3% in Asia as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively.

 

In addition, we extend unsecured loans to retail clients through Marcus. The gross exposure related to such loans was $1.91 billion and $208 million as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively. See Note 9 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about the credit quality indicators of such loans.

 

 

We also purchase and have commitments to purchase loans (including distressed loans) and securities. Such loans and securities are primarily backed by residential real estate. The gross exposure related to such loans and lending commitments was $10.24 billion and $5.38 billion as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively. Our regional net credit exposure related to these activities was approximately 74% and 79% in the Americas and approximately 26% and 21% in EMEA as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively.

Securities Financing Transactions. We enter into securities financing transactions in order to, among other things, facilitate client activities, invest excess cash, acquire securities to cover short positions and finance certain activities. We bear credit risk related to resale agreements and securities borrowed only to the extent that cash advanced or the value of securities pledged or delivered to the counterparty exceeds the value of the collateral received. We also have credit exposure on repurchase agreements and securities loaned to the extent that the value of securities pledged or delivered to the counterparty for these transactions exceeds the amount of cash or collateral received. Securities collateral obtained for securities financing transactions primarily includes U.S. government and agency obligations and non-U.S. government and agency obligations. We had $29.07 billion and $28.64 billion as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively, of credit exposure related to securities financing transactions reflecting both netting agreements and collateral that management considers when determining credit risk. As of both December 2017 and December 2016, substantially all of our credit exposure related to securities financing transactions was with investment-grade financial institutions, funds, governments and municipalities and nonprofits, primarily located in the Americas and EMEA.

 

 

98   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

Other Credit Exposures. We are exposed to credit risk from our receivables from brokers, dealers and clearing organizations and customers and counterparties. Receivables from brokers, dealers and clearing organizations primarily consist of initial margin placed with clearing organizations and receivables related to sales of securities which have traded, but not yet settled. These receivables generally have minimal credit risk due to the low probability of clearing organization default and the short-term nature of receivables related to securities settlements. Receivables from customers and counterparties generally consist of collateralized receivables related to customer securities transactions and generally have minimal credit risk due to both the value of the collateral received and the short-term nature of these receivables. Our net credit exposure related to these activities was $34.32 billion and $31.39 billion as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively, and primarily consisted of initial margin (both cash and securities) placed with investment-grade clearing organizations. Our regional net credit exposure related to these activities was approximately 41% and 44% in the Americas, approximately 49% and 42% in EMEA, and approximately 10% and 14% in Asia as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively.

Selected Exposures

We have credit and market exposures, as described below, that have had heightened focus due to recent events and broad market concerns. Credit exposure represents the potential for loss due to the default or deterioration in credit quality of a counterparty or borrower. Market exposure represents the potential for loss in value of our long and short inventory due to changes in market prices.

The debt crisis in Mozambique has resulted in credit rating downgrades and Venezuela has delayed payments on its sovereign debt. Our total credit and market exposure to each of Mozambique and Venezuela as of December 2017 was not material.

We have a comprehensive framework to monitor, measure and assess our country exposures and to determine our risk appetite. We determine the country of risk by the location of the counterparty, issuer or underlier’s assets, where they generate revenue, the country in which they are headquartered, the jurisdiction where a claim against them could be enforced, and/or the government whose policies affect their ability to repay their obligations. We monitor our credit exposure to a specific country both at the individual counterparty level, as well as at the aggregate country level.

We use regular stress tests, described above, to calculate the credit exposures, including potential concentrations that would result from applying shocks to counterparty credit ratings or credit risk factors. To supplement these regular stress tests, we also conduct tailored stress tests on an ad hoc basis in response to specific market events that we deem significant. These stress tests are designed to estimate the direct impact of the event on our credit and market exposures resulting from shocks to risk factors including, but not limited to, currency rates, interest rates, and equity prices. We also utilize these stress tests to estimate the indirect impact of certain hypothetical events on our country exposures, such as the impact of credit market deterioration on corporate borrowers and counterparties along with the shocks to the risk factors described above. The parameters of these shocks vary based on the scenario reflected in each stress test. We review estimated losses produced by the stress tests in order to understand their magnitude, highlight potential loss concentrations, and assess and mitigate our exposures where necessary.

See “Stress Tests” above, “Liquidity Risk Management — Liquidity Stress Tests” and “Market Risk Management — Market Risk Management Process — Stress Testing” for further information about stress tests.

Operational Risk Management

Overview

Operational risk is the risk of an adverse outcome resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes, people, systems or from external events. Our exposure to operational risk arises from routine processing errors, as well as extraordinary incidents, such as major systems failures or legal and regulatory matters.

Potential types of loss events related to internal and external operational risk include:

 

 

Clients, products and business practices;

 

 

Execution, delivery and process management;

 

 

Business disruption and system failures;

 

 

Employment practices and workplace safety;

 

 

Damage to physical assets;

 

 

Internal fraud; and

 

 

External fraud.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   99


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

We maintain a comprehensive control framework designed to provide a well-controlled environment to minimize operational risks. The Firmwide Conduct and Operational Risk Committee is globally responsible for the ongoing approval and monitoring of the frameworks, policies, parameters and limits which govern our operational risks. Operational Risk Management is a risk management function independent of our revenue-producing units, reports to our chief risk officer, and is responsible for developing and implementing policies, methodologies and a formalized framework for operational risk management with the goal of maintaining our exposure to operational risk at levels that are within our risk appetite.

Operational Risk Management Process

Managing operational risk requires timely and accurate information, as well as a strong control culture. We seek to manage our operational risk through:

 

 

Training, supervision and development of our people;

 

 

Active participation of senior management in identifying and mitigating our key operational risks;

 

 

Independent control and support functions that monitor operational risk on a daily basis, and implementation of extensive policies and procedures, and controls designed to prevent the occurrence of operational risk events;

 

 

Proactive communication between our revenue-producing units and our independent control and support functions; and

 

 

A network of systems to facilitate the collection of data used to analyze and assess our operational risk exposure.

We combine top-down and bottom-up approaches to manage and measure operational risk. From a top-down perspective, our senior management assesses firmwide and business-level operational risk profiles. From a bottom-up perspective, revenue-producing units and independent control and support functions are responsible for risk identification and risk management on a day-to-day basis, including escalating operational risks to senior management.

Our operational risk management framework is in part designed to comply with the operational risk measurement rules under the Capital Framework and has evolved based on the changing needs of our businesses and regulatory guidance.

Our operational risk management framework consists of the following practices:

 

 

Risk identification and assessment;

 

 

Risk measurement; and

 

 

Risk monitoring and reporting.

Risk Identification and Assessment

The core of our operational risk management framework is risk identification and assessment. We have a comprehensive data collection process, including firmwide policies and procedures, for operational risk events.

We have established policies that require our revenue-producing units and our independent control and support functions to report and escalate operational risk events. When operational risk events are identified, our policies require that the events be documented and analyzed to determine whether changes are required in our systems and/or processes to further mitigate the risk of future events.

In addition, our systems capture internal operational risk event data, key metrics such as transaction volumes, and statistical information such as performance trends. We use an internally developed operational risk management application to aggregate and organize this information. One of our key risk identification and assessment tools is an operational risk and control self-assessment process, which is performed by managers from both revenue-producing units and independent control and support functions. This process consists of the identification and rating of operational risks, on a forward-looking basis, and the related controls. The results from this process are analyzed to evaluate operational risk exposures and identify businesses, activities or products with heightened levels of operational risk.

Risk Measurement

We measure our operational risk exposure over a twelve-month time horizon using both statistical modeling and scenario analyses, which involve qualitative and quantitative assessments of internal and external operational risk event data and internal control factors for each of our businesses. Operational risk measurement also incorporates an assessment of business environment factors including but not limited to:

 

 

Evaluations of the complexity of our business activities;

 

 

The degree of automation in our processes;

 

 

New activity information;

 

 

The legal and regulatory environment; and

 

 

Changes in the markets for our products and services, including the diversity and sophistication of our customers and counterparties.

 

 

100   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

 

The results from these scenario analyses are used to monitor changes in operational risk and to determine business lines that may have heightened exposure to operational risk. These analyses ultimately are used in the determination of the appropriate level of operational risk capital to hold.

Risk Monitoring and Reporting

We evaluate changes in our operational risk profile and our businesses, including changes in business mix or jurisdictions in which we operate, by monitoring the factors noted above at a firmwide level. We have both preventive and detective internal controls, which are designed to reduce the frequency and severity of operational risk losses and the probability of operational risk events. We monitor the results of assessments and independent internal audits of these internal controls.

We have established limits and thresholds consistent with our risk appetite statement, as well as escalation protocols. We provide periodic operational risk reports, which include instances that breach escalation thresholds, to senior management, risk committees and the Risk Committee of the Board.

Model Review and Validation

The statistical models utilized by Operational Risk Management are subject to independent review and validation by Model Risk Management. See “Model Risk Management” for further information about the review and validation of these models.

Model Risk Management

Overview

Model risk is the potential for adverse consequences from decisions made based on model outputs that may be incorrect or used inappropriately. We rely on quantitative models across our business activities primarily to value certain financial assets and financial liabilities, to monitor and manage our risk, and to measure and monitor our regulatory capital.

Our model risk management framework is managed through a governance structure and risk management controls, which encompass standards designed to ensure we maintain a comprehensive model inventory, including risk assessment and classification, sound model development practices, independent review and model-specific usage controls. The Firmwide Model Risk Control Committee oversees our model risk management framework. Model Risk Management, which is independent of model developers, model owners and model users, reports to our chief risk officer, is responsible for identifying and reporting significant risks associated with models, and provides periodic updates to senior management, risk committees and the Risk Committee of the Board.

Model Review and Validation

Model Risk Management consists of quantitative professionals who perform an independent review, validation and approval of our models. This review includes an analysis of the model documentation, independent testing, an assessment of the appropriateness of the methodology used, and verification of compliance with model development and implementation standards. Model Risk Management reviews all existing models on an annual basis, and approves new models or significant changes to models prior to implementation.

The model validation process incorporates a review of models and trade and risk parameters across a broad range of scenarios (including extreme conditions) in order to critically evaluate and verify:

 

 

The model’s conceptual soundness, including the reasonableness of model assumptions, and suitability for intended use;

 

 

The testing strategy utilized by the model developers to ensure that the models function as intended;

 

 

The suitability of the calculation techniques incorporated in the model;

 

 

The model’s accuracy in reflecting the characteristics of the related product and its significant risks;

 

 

The model’s consistency with models for similar products; and

 

 

The model’s sensitivity to input parameters and assumptions.

See “Critical Accounting Policies — Fair Value — Review of Valuation Models,” “Liquidity Risk Management,” “Market Risk Management,” “Credit Risk Management” and “Operational Risk Management” for further information about our use of models within these areas.

Item 7A.    Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk

Quantitative and qualitative disclosures about market risk are set forth in “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Risk Management” in Part II, Item 7 of this Form 10-K.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   101


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

Item 8.    Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

 

Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting

    

 

Management of The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc., together with its consolidated subsidiaries (the firm), is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting. The firm’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed under the supervision of the firm’s principal executive and principal financial officers to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of the firm’s financial statements for external reporting purposes in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.

As of December 31, 2017, management conducted an assessment of the firm’s internal control over financial reporting based on the framework established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). Based on this assessment, management has determined that the firm’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2017 was effective.

Our internal control over financial reporting includes policies and procedures that pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect transactions and dispositions of assets; provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and the directors of the firm; and provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of the firm’s assets that could have a material effect on our financial statements.

The firm’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2017 has been audited by PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, as stated in their report appearing on page 103, which expresses an unqualified opinion on the effectiveness of the firm’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2017.

 

 

102   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

    

 

To the Board of Directors and the Shareholders of The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc.:

Opinions on the Financial Statements and Internal Control over Financial Reporting

We have audited the accompanying consolidated statements of financial condition of The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. and its subsidiaries (the Company) as of December 31, 2017 and 2016, and the related consolidated statements of earnings, comprehensive income, changes in shareholders’ equity and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2017, including the related notes (collectively referred to as the “consolidated financial statements”). We also have audited the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2017, based on criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO).

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company as of December 31, 2017 and 2016, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2017 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. Also in our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2017, based on criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the COSO.

Basis for Opinions

The Company’s management is responsible for these consolidated financial statements, for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting, and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting appearing on page 102. Our responsibility is to express opinions on the Company’s consolidated financial statements and on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audits. We are a public accounting firm registered with the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (PCAOB) and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the consolidated financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud, and whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects.

Our audits of the consolidated financial statements included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the consolidated financial statements, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the consolidated financial statements. Our audits also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the consolidated financial statements. Our audit of internal control over financial reporting included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audits also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinions.

Definition and Limitations of Internal Control over Financial Reporting

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

/s/ PRICEWATERHOUSECOOPERS LLP

New York, New York

February 23, 2018

We have served as the Company’s auditor since 1922.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   103


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Statements of Earnings

 

    Year Ended December  
in millions, except per share amounts     2017        2016        2015  

Revenues

       

Investment banking

    $  7,371        $  6,273        $  7,027  

Investment management

    5,803        5,407        5,868  

Commissions and fees

    3,051        3,208        3,320  

Market making

    7,660        9,933        9,523  

Other principal transactions

    5,256        3,200        5,018  

Total non-interest revenues

    29,141        28,021        30,756  

 

Interest income

    13,113        9,691        8,452  

Interest expense

    10,181        7,104        5,388  

Net interest income

    2,932        2,587        3,064  

Net revenues, including net interest income

    32,073        30,608        33,820  

 

Operating expenses

       

Compensation and benefits

    11,853        11,647        12,678  

 

Brokerage, clearing, exchange and distribution fees

    2,540        2,555        2,576  

Market development

    588        457        557  

Communications and technology

    897        809        806  

Depreciation and amortization

    1,152        998        991  

Occupancy

    733        788        772  

Professional fees

    965        882        963  

Other expenses

    2,213        2,168        5,699  

Total non-compensation expenses

    9,088        8,657        12,364  

Total operating expenses

    20,941        20,304        25,042  

 

Pre-tax earnings

    11,132        10,304        8,778  

Provision for taxes

    6,846        2,906        2,695  

Net earnings

    4,286        7,398        6,083  

Preferred stock dividends

    601        311        515  

Net earnings applicable to common shareholders

    $  3,685        $  7,087        $  5,568  

 

Earnings per common share

       

Basic

    $    9.12        $  16.53        $  12.35  

Diluted

    $    9.01        $  16.29        $  12.14  

 

Average common shares

       

Basic

    401.6        427.4        448.9  

Diluted

    409.1        435.1        458.6  

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

104   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017        2016        2015  

Net earnings

    $4,286        $7,398        $6,083  

Other comprehensive income/(loss) adjustments, net of tax:

       

Currency translation

    22        (60      (114

Debt valuation adjustment

    (807      (544       

Pension and postretirement liabilities

    130        (199      139  

Available-for-sale securities

    (9              

Other comprehensive income/(loss)

    (664      (803      25  

Comprehensive income

    $3,622        $6,595        $6,108  

 

 

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   105


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017       2016  

Assets

   

Cash and cash equivalents

    $110,051       $121,711  

Collateralized agreements:

   

Securities purchased under agreements to resell (includes $120,420 and $116,077 at fair value)

    120,822       116,925  

Securities borrowed (includes $78,189 and $82,398 at fair value)

    190,848       184,600  

Receivables:

   

Brokers, dealers and clearing organizations

    24,676       18,044  

Customers and counterparties (includes $3,526 and $3,266 at fair value)

    60,112       47,780  

Loans receivable

    65,933       49,672  

Financial instruments owned (at fair value and includes $50,335 and $51,278 pledged as collateral)

    315,988       295,952  

Other assets

    28,346       25,481  

Total assets

    $916,776       $860,165  

 

Liabilities and shareholders’ equity

   

Deposits (includes $22,902 and $13,782 at fair value)

    $138,604       $124,098  

Collateralized financings:

   

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase (at fair value)

    84,718       71,816  

Securities loaned (includes $5,357 and $2,647 at fair value)

    14,793       7,524  

Other secured financings (includes $24,345 and $21,073 at fair value)

    24,788       21,523  

Payables:

   

Brokers, dealers and clearing organizations

    6,672       4,386  

Customers and counterparties

    171,497       184,069  

Financial instruments sold, but not yet purchased (at fair value)

    111,930       117,143  

Unsecured short-term borrowings (includes $16,904 and $14,792 at fair value)

    46,922       39,265  

Unsecured long-term borrowings (includes $38,638 and $29,410 at fair value)

    217,687       189,086  

Other liabilities and accrued expenses (includes $268 and $621 at fair value)

    16,922       14,362  

Total liabilities

    834,533       773,272  

 

Commitments, contingencies and guarantees

   

 

Shareholders’ equity

   

Preferred stock; aggregate liquidation preference of $11,853 and $11,203

    11,853       11,203  

Common stock; 884,592,863 and 873,608,100 shares issued, and 374,808,805 and 392,632,230 shares outstanding

    9       9  

Share-based awards

    2,777       3,914  

Nonvoting common stock; no shares issued and outstanding

           

Additional paid-in capital

    53,357       52,638  

Retained earnings

    91,519       89,039  

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

    (1,880     (1,216

Stock held in treasury, at cost; 509,784,060 and 480,975,872 shares

    (75,392     (68,694

Total shareholders’ equity

    82,243       86,893  

Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity

    $916,776       $860,165  

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

106   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Statements of Changes in Shareholders’ Equity

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017        2016        2015  

Preferred stock

       

Beginning balance

    $ 11,203        $ 11,200        $   9,200  

Issued

    1,500        1,325        2,000  

Redeemed

    (850      (1,322       

Ending balance

    11,853        11,203        11,200  

Common stock

       

Beginning balance

    9        9        9  

Issued

                   

Ending balance

    9        9        9  

Share-based awards

       

Beginning balance, as previously reported

    3,914        4,151        3,766  

Cumulative effect of the change in accounting principle related to forfeiture of share-based awards

    35                

Beginning balance, adjusted

    3,949        4,151        3,766  

Issuance and amortization of share-based awards

    1,810        2,143        2,308  

Delivery of common stock underlying share-based awards

    (2,704      (2,068      (1,742

Forfeiture of share-based awards

    (89      (102      (72

Exercise of share-based awards

    (189      (210      (109

Ending balance

    2,777        3,914        4,151  

Additional paid-in capital

       

Beginning balance

    52,638        51,340        50,049  

Delivery of common stock underlying share-based awards

    2,934        2,282        2,092  

Cancellation of share-based awards in satisfaction of withholding tax requirements

    (2,220      (1,121      (1,198

Preferred stock issuance costs, net of reversals upon redemption

    8        (10      (7

Excess net tax benefit related to share-based awards

           147        406  

Cash settlement of share-based awards

    (3             (2

Ending balance

    53,357        52,638        51,340  

Retained earnings

       

Beginning balance, as previously reported

    89,039        83,386        78,984  

Cumulative effect of the change in accounting principle related to:

       

Debt valuation adjustment, net of tax

           (305       

Forfeiture of share-based awards, net of tax

    (24              

Beginning balance, adjusted

    89,015        83,081        78,984  

Net earnings

    4,286        7,398        6,083  

Dividends and dividend equivalents declared on common stock and share-based awards

    (1,181      (1,129      (1,166

Dividends declared on preferred stock

    (587      (577      (515

Preferred stock redemption discount/(premium)

    (14      266         

Ending balance

    91,519        89,039        83,386  

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

       

Beginning balance, as previously reported

    (1,216      (718      (743

Cumulative effect of the change in accounting principle related to debt valuation adjustment, net of tax

           305         

Beginning balance, adjusted

    (1,216      (413      (743

Other comprehensive income/(loss)

    (664      (803      25  

Ending balance

    (1,880      (1,216      (718

Stock held in treasury, at cost

       

Beginning balance

    (68,694      (62,640      (58,468

Repurchased

    (6,721      (6,069      (4,195

Reissued

    34        22        32  

Other

    (11      (7      (9

Ending balance

    (75,392      (68,694      (62,640

Total shareholders’ equity

    $ 82,243        $ 86,893        $ 86,728  

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   107


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017        2016        2015  

Cash flows from operating activities

       

Net earnings

    $    4,286        $    7,398        $   6,083  

Adjustments to reconcile net earnings to net cash provided by/(used for) operating activities:

       

Depreciation and amortization

    1,152        998        991  

Deferred income taxes

    5,458        551        425  

Share-based compensation

    1,769        2,111        2,272  

Loss/(gain) related to extinguishment of subordinated borrowings

    (114      3        (34

Changes in operating assets and liabilities:

       

Receivables and payables (excluding loans receivable), net

    (30,082      (15,813      19,132  

Collateralized transactions (excluding other secured financings), net

    10,025        78        (14,825

Financial instruments owned (excluding available-for-sale securities)

    (11,327      15,253        16,078  

Financial instruments sold, but not yet purchased

    (5,296      1,960        (16,835

Other, net

    6,387        (5,639      (3,806

Net cash provided by/(used for) operating activities

    (17,742      6,900        9,481  

Cash flows from investing activities

       

Purchase of property, leasehold improvements and equipment

    (3,185      (2,876      (1,833

Proceeds from sales of property, leasehold improvements and equipment

    574        381        228  

Net cash acquired in/(used for) business acquisitions

    (2,383      14,922        (1,808

Purchase of investments

    (9,853              

Proceeds from sales and paydowns of investments

    2,887        1,512        1,019  

Loans receivable, net

    (17,156      (4,669      (16,180

Net cash provided by/(used for) investing activities

    (29,116      9,270        (18,574

Cash flows from financing activities

       

Unsecured short-term borrowings, net

    (501      (1,506      (369

Other secured financings (short-term), net

    (405      (808      (867

Proceeds from issuance of other secured financings (long-term)

    7,401        4,186        10,349  

Repayment of other secured financings (long-term), including the current portion

    (4,726      (7,375      (6,502

Purchase of APEX, senior guaranteed securities and trust preferred securities

    (237      (1,171      (1

Proceeds from issuance of unsecured long-term borrowings

    58,347        50,763        44,595  

Repayment of unsecured long-term borrowings, including the current portion

    (30,756      (36,557      (29,520

Derivative contracts with a financing element, net

    1,684        2,115        (47

Deposits, net

    14,506        10,058        14,639  

Preferred stock redemption

    (850              

Common stock repurchased

    (6,772      (6,078      (4,135

Settlement of share-based awards in satisfaction of withholding tax requirements

    (2,223      (1,128      (1,204

Dividends and dividend equivalents paid on common stock, preferred stock and share-based awards

    (1,769      (1,706      (1,681

Proceeds from issuance of preferred stock, net of issuance costs

    1,495        1,303        1,993  

Proceeds from issuance of common stock, including exercise of share-based awards

    7        6        259  

Cash settlement of share-based awards

    (3             (2

Net cash provided by financing activities

    35,198        12,102        27,507  

Net increase/(decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

    (11,660      28,272        18,414  

Cash and cash equivalents, beginning balance

    121,711        93,439        75,025  

Cash and cash equivalents, ending balance

    $110,051        $121,711        $ 93,439  

SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURES:

Cash payments for interest, net of capitalized interest, were $11.17 billion, $7.14 billion and $4.82 billion, and cash payments for income taxes, net of refunds, were $1.42 billion, $1.06 billion and $2.65 billion for 2017, 2016 and 2015, respectively. Cash flows related to common stock repurchased includes common stock repurchased in the prior period for which settlement occurred during the current period and excludes common stock repurchased during the current period for which settlement occurred in the following period.

Non-cash activities during 2017:

 

 

The firm exchanged $237 million of Trust Preferred Securities and common beneficial interests for $248 million of the firm’s junior subordinated debt.

Non-cash activities during 2016:

 

 

The impact of adoption of ASU No. 2015-02 was a net reduction to both total assets and total liabilities of approximately $200 million. See Note 3 for further information.

 

 

The firm sold assets and liabilities of $1.81 billion and $697 million, respectively, that were previously classified as held for sale, in exchange for $1.11 billion of financial instruments.

 

 

The firm exchanged $1.04 billion of APEX for $1.31 billion of Series E and Series F Preferred Stock. See Note 19 for further information.

 

 

The firm exchanged $127 million of senior guaranteed trust securities for $124 million of the firm’s junior subordinated debt.

Non-cash activities during 2015:

 

 

The firm exchanged $262 million of Trust Preferred Securities and common beneficial interests for $296 million of the firm’s junior subordinated debt.

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

108   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Note 1.

Description of Business

The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. (Group Inc. or parent company), a Delaware corporation, together with its consolidated subsidiaries (collectively, the firm), is a leading global investment banking, securities and investment management firm that provides a wide range of financial services to a substantial and diversified client base that includes corporations, financial institutions, governments and individuals. Founded in 1869, the firm is headquartered in New York and maintains offices in all major financial centers around the world.

The firm reports its activities in the following four business segments:

Investment Banking

The firm provides a broad range of investment banking services to a diverse group of corporations, financial institutions, investment funds and governments. Services include strategic advisory assignments with respect to mergers and acquisitions, divestitures, corporate defense activities, restructurings, spin-offs and risk management, and debt and equity underwriting of public offerings and private placements, including local and cross-border transactions and acquisition financing, as well as derivative transactions directly related to these activities.

Institutional Client Services

The firm facilitates client transactions and makes markets in fixed income, equity, currency and commodity products, primarily with institutional clients such as corporations, financial institutions, investment funds and governments. The firm also makes markets in and clears client transactions on major stock, options and futures exchanges worldwide and provides financing, securities lending and other prime brokerage services to institutional clients.

Investing & Lending

The firm invests in and originates loans to provide financing to clients. These investments and loans are typically longer-term in nature. The firm makes investments, some of which are consolidated, including through its merchant banking business and its special situations group, in debt securities and loans, public and private equity securities, infrastructure and real estate entities. Some of these investments are made indirectly through funds that the firm manages. The firm also makes unsecured and secured loans to retail clients through its digital platforms, Marcus: by Goldman Sachs (Marcus) and Goldman Sachs Private Bank Select (GS Select), respectively.

Investment Management

The firm provides investment management services and offers investment products (primarily through separately managed accounts and commingled vehicles, such as mutual funds and private investment funds) across all major asset classes to a diverse set of institutional and individual clients. The firm also offers wealth advisory services provided by the firm’s subsidiary, The Ayco Company, L.P., including portfolio management and financial planning and counseling, and brokerage and other transaction services to high-net-worth individuals and families.

Note 2.

Basis of Presentation

These consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States (U.S. GAAP) and include the accounts of Group Inc. and all other entities in which the firm has a controlling financial interest. Intercompany transactions and balances have been eliminated.

All references to 2017, 2016 and 2015 refer to the firm’s years ended, or the dates, as the context requires, December 31, 2017, December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, respectively. Any reference to a future year refers to a year ending on December 31 of that year. Certain reclassifications have been made to previously reported amounts to conform to the current presentation.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   109


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Note 3.

Significant Accounting Policies

 

The firm’s significant accounting policies include when and how to measure the fair value of assets and liabilities, accounting for goodwill and identifiable intangible assets, and when to consolidate an entity. See Notes 5 through 8 for policies on fair value measurements, Note 13 for policies on goodwill and identifiable intangible assets, and below and Note 12 for policies on consolidation accounting. All other significant accounting policies are either described below or included in the following footnotes:

 

Financial Instruments Owned and Financial Instruments

Sold, But Not Yet Purchased

    Note 4  

Fair Value Measurements

    Note 5  

Cash Instruments

    Note 6  

Derivatives and Hedging Activities

    Note 7  

Fair Value Option

    Note 8  

Loans Receivable

    Note 9  

Collateralized Agreements and Financings

    Note 10  

Securitization Activities

    Note 11  

Variable Interest Entities

    Note 12  

Other Assets

    Note 13  

Deposits

    Note 14  

Short-Term Borrowings

    Note 15  

Long-Term Borrowings

    Note 16  

Other Liabilities and Accrued Expenses

    Note 17  

Commitments, Contingencies and Guarantees

    Note 18  

Shareholders’ Equity

    Note 19  

Regulation and Capital Adequacy

    Note 20  

Earnings Per Common Share

    Note 21  

Transactions with Affiliated Funds

    Note 22  

Interest Income and Interest Expense

    Note 23  

Income Taxes

    Note 24  

Business Segments

    Note 25  

Credit Concentrations

    Note 26  

Legal Proceedings

    Note 27  

Employee Benefit Plans

    Note 28  

Employee Incentive Plans

    Note 29  

Parent Company

    Note 30  

Consolidation

The firm consolidates entities in which the firm has a controlling financial interest. The firm determines whether it has a controlling financial interest in an entity by first evaluating whether the entity is a voting interest entity or a variable interest entity (VIE).

Voting Interest Entities. Voting interest entities are entities in which (i) the total equity investment at risk is sufficient to enable the entity to finance its activities independently and (ii) the equity holders have the power to direct the activities of the entity that most significantly impact its economic performance, the obligation to absorb the losses of the entity and the right to receive the residual returns of the entity. The usual condition for a controlling financial interest in a voting interest entity is ownership of a majority voting interest. If the firm has a controlling majority voting interest in a voting interest entity, the entity is consolidated.

Variable Interest Entities. A VIE is an entity that lacks one or more of the characteristics of a voting interest entity. The firm has a controlling financial interest in a VIE when the firm has a variable interest or interests that provide it with (i) the power to direct the activities of the VIE that most significantly impact the VIE’s economic performance and (ii) the obligation to absorb losses of the VIE or the right to receive benefits from the VIE that could potentially be significant to the VIE. See Note 12 for further information about VIEs.

Equity-Method Investments. When the firm does not have a controlling financial interest in an entity but can exert significant influence over the entity’s operating and financial policies, the investment is accounted for either (i) under the equity method of accounting or (ii) at fair value by electing the fair value option available under U.S. GAAP. Significant influence generally exists when the firm owns 20% to 50% of the entity’s common stock or in-substance common stock.

In general, the firm accounts for investments acquired after the fair value option became available, at fair value. In certain cases, the firm applies the equity method of accounting to new investments that are strategic in nature or closely related to the firm’s principal business activities, when the firm has a significant degree of involvement in the cash flows or operations of the investee or when cost-benefit considerations are less significant. See Note 13 for further information about equity-method investments.

 

 

110   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Investment Funds. The firm has formed numerous investment funds with third-party investors. These funds are typically organized as limited partnerships or limited liability companies for which the firm acts as general partner or manager. Generally, the firm does not hold a majority of the economic interests in these funds. These funds are usually voting interest entities and generally are not consolidated because third-party investors typically have rights to terminate the funds or to remove the firm as general partner or manager. Investments in these funds are generally measured at net asset value (NAV) and are included in financial instruments owned. See Notes 6, 18 and 22 for further information about investments in funds.

Use of Estimates

Preparation of these consolidated financial statements requires management to make certain estimates and assumptions, the most important of which relate to fair value measurements, accounting for goodwill and identifiable intangible assets, income tax expense related to the Tax Cuts and Jobs Act (Tax Legislation), provisions for losses that may arise from litigation and regulatory proceedings (including governmental investigations), the allowance for losses on loans receivable and lending commitments held for investment, and provisions for losses that may arise from tax audits. These estimates and assumptions are based on the best available information but actual results could be materially different.

Revenue Recognition

Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities at Fair Value. Financial instruments owned and financial instruments sold, but not yet purchased are recorded at fair value either under the fair value option or in accordance with other U.S. GAAP. In addition, the firm has elected to account for certain of its other financial assets and financial liabilities at fair value by electing the fair value option. The fair value of a financial instrument is the amount that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date. Financial assets are marked to bid prices and financial liabilities are marked to offer prices. Fair value measurements do not include transaction costs. Fair value gains or losses are generally included in market making for positions in Institutional Client Services and other principal transactions for positions in Investing & Lending. See Notes 5 through 8 for further information about fair value measurements.

Investment Banking. Fees from financial advisory assignments and underwriting revenues are recognized in earnings when the services related to the underlying transaction are completed under the terms of the assignment. Expenses associated with such transactions are deferred until the related revenue is recognized or the assignment is otherwise concluded. Expenses associated with financial advisory assignments are recorded as non-compensation expenses, net of client reimbursements. Underwriting revenues are presented net of related expenses. As a result of adopting ASU No. 2014-09, “Revenue from Contracts with Customers (Topic 606),” the firm will amend its accounting policy on the recognition and presentation of certain investment banking revenues and related expenses. See “Recent Accounting Developments” for further information.

Investment Management. The firm earns management fees and incentive fees for investment management services. Management fees for mutual funds are calculated as a percentage of daily net asset value and are received monthly. Management fees for hedge funds and separately managed accounts are calculated as a percentage of month-end net asset value and are generally received quarterly. Management fees for private equity funds are calculated as a percentage of monthly invested capital or commitments and are received quarterly, semi-annually or annually, depending on the fund. All management fees are recognized over the period that the related service is provided. Incentive fees are calculated as a percentage of a fund’s or separately managed account’s return, or excess return above a specified benchmark or other performance target. Incentive fees are generally based on investment performance over a 12-month period or over the life of a fund. Fees that are based on performance over a 12-month period are subject to adjustment prior to the end of the measurement period. For fees that are based on investment performance over the life of the fund, future investment underperformance may require fees previously distributed to the firm to be returned to the fund. Incentive fees are recognized only when all material contingencies have been resolved. Management and incentive fee revenues are included in investment management revenues.

The firm makes payments to brokers and advisors related to the placement of the firm’s investment funds. These payments are calculated based on either a percentage of the management fee or the investment fund’s net asset value. Where the firm is principal to the arrangement, such costs are recorded on a gross basis and included in brokerage, clearing, exchange and distribution fees, and where the firm is agent to the arrangement, such costs are recorded on a net basis in investment management revenues.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   111


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

As a result of adopting ASU No. 2014-09, the firm will amend its accounting policy on the recognition and presentation of certain investment management revenues and related expenses. See “Recent Accounting Developments” for further information.

Commissions and Fees. The firm earns commissions and fees from executing and clearing client transactions on stock, options and futures markets, as well as over-the-counter (OTC) transactions. Commissions and fees are recognized on the day the trade is executed.

Transfers of Financial Assets

Transfers of financial assets are accounted for as sales when the firm has relinquished control over the assets transferred. For transfers of financial assets accounted for as sales, any gains or losses are recognized in net revenues. Assets or liabilities that arise from the firm’s continuing involvement with transferred financial assets are initially recognized at fair value. For transfers of financial assets that are not accounted for as sales, the assets are generally included in financial instruments owned and the transfer is accounted for as a collateralized financing, with the related interest expense recognized over the life of the transaction. See Note 10 for further information about transfers of financial assets accounted for as collateralized financings and Note 11 for further information about transfers of financial assets accounted for as sales.

Cash and Cash Equivalents

The firm defines cash equivalents as highly liquid overnight deposits held in the ordinary course of business. As of December 2017 and December 2016, cash and cash equivalents included $10.79 billion and $11.15 billion, respectively, of cash and due from banks, and $99.26 billion and $110.56 billion, respectively, of interest-bearing deposits with banks. The firm segregates cash for regulatory and other purposes related to client activity. As of December 2017 and December 2016, $18.44 billion and $14.65 billion, respectively, of cash and cash equivalents were segregated for regulatory and other purposes. See “Recent Accounting Developments” for further information. In addition, the firm segregates securities for regulatory and other purposes related to client activity. See Note 10 for further information about segregated securities.

Receivables from and Payables to Brokers, Dealers and Clearing Organizations

Receivables from and payables to brokers, dealers and clearing organizations are accounted for at cost plus accrued interest, which generally approximates fair value. While these receivables and payables are carried at amounts that approximate fair value, they are not accounted for at fair value under the fair value option or at fair value in accordance with other U.S. GAAP and therefore are not included in the firm’s fair value hierarchy in Notes 6 through 8. Had these receivables and payables been included in the firm’s fair value hierarchy, substantially all would have been classified in level 2 as of both December 2017 and December 2016.

Receivables from Customers and Counterparties

Receivables from customers and counterparties generally relate to collateralized transactions. Such receivables primarily consist of customer margin loans, certain transfers of assets accounted for as secured loans rather than purchases at fair value and collateral posted in connection with certain derivative transactions. Substantially all of these receivables are accounted for at amortized cost net of estimated uncollectible amounts. Certain of the firm’s receivables from customers and counterparties are accounted for at fair value under the fair value option, with changes in fair value generally included in market making revenues. See Note 8 for further information about receivables from customers and counterparties accounted for at fair value under the fair value option. In addition, as of December 2017 and December 2016, the firm’s receivables from customers and counterparties included $4.63 billion and $2.60 billion, respectively, of loans held for sale, accounted for at the lower of cost or fair value. See Note 5 for an overview of the firm’s fair value measurement policies.

As of both December 2017 and December 2016, the carrying value of receivables not accounted for at fair value generally approximated fair value. While these receivables are carried at amounts that approximate fair value, they are not accounted for at fair value under the fair value option or at fair value in accordance with other U.S. GAAP and therefore are not included in the firm’s fair value hierarchy in Notes 6 through 8. Had these receivables been included in the firm’s fair value hierarchy, substantially all would have been classified in level 2 as of both December 2017 and December 2016. Interest on receivables from customers and counterparties is recognized over the life of the transaction and included in interest income.

 

 

112   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Payables to Customers and Counterparties

Payables to customers and counterparties primarily consist of customer credit balances related to the firm’s prime brokerage activities. Payables to customers and counterparties are accounted for at cost plus accrued interest, which generally approximates fair value. While these payables are carried at amounts that approximate fair value, they are not accounted for at fair value under the fair value option or at fair value in accordance with other U.S. GAAP and therefore are not included in the firm’s fair value hierarchy in Notes 6 through 8. Had these payables been included in the firm’s fair value hierarchy, substantially all would have been classified in level 2 as of both December 2017 and December 2016. Interest on payables to customers and counterparties is recognized over the life of the transaction and included in interest expense.

Offsetting Assets and Liabilities

To reduce credit exposures on derivatives and securities financing transactions, the firm may enter into master netting agreements or similar arrangements (collectively, netting agreements) with counterparties that permit it to offset receivables and payables with such counterparties. A netting agreement is a contract with a counterparty that permits net settlement of multiple transactions with that counterparty, including upon the exercise of termination rights by a non-defaulting party. Upon exercise of such termination rights, all transactions governed by the netting agreement are terminated and a net settlement amount is calculated. In addition, the firm receives and posts cash and securities collateral with respect to its derivatives and securities financing transactions, subject to the terms of the related credit support agreements or similar arrangements (collectively, credit support agreements). An enforceable credit support agreement grants the non-defaulting party exercising termination rights the right to liquidate the collateral and apply the proceeds to any amounts owed. In order to assess enforceability of the firm’s right of setoff under netting and credit support agreements, the firm evaluates various factors including applicable bankruptcy laws, local statutes and regulatory provisions in the jurisdiction of the parties to the agreement.

Derivatives are reported on a net-by-counterparty basis (i.e., the net payable or receivable for derivative assets and liabilities for a given counterparty) in the consolidated statements of financial condition when a legal right of setoff exists under an enforceable netting agreement. Resale and repurchase agreements and securities borrowed and loaned transactions with the same term and currency are presented on a net-by-counterparty basis in the consolidated statements of financial condition when such transactions meet certain settlement criteria and are subject to netting agreements.

In the consolidated statements of financial condition, derivatives are reported net of cash collateral received and posted under enforceable credit support agreements, when transacted under an enforceable netting agreement. In the consolidated statements of financial condition, resale and repurchase agreements, and securities borrowed and loaned, are not reported net of the related cash and securities received or posted as collateral. See Note 10 for further information about collateral received and pledged, including rights to deliver or repledge collateral. See Notes 7 and 10 for further information about offsetting.

Foreign Currency Translation

Assets and liabilities denominated in non-U.S. currencies are translated at rates of exchange prevailing on the date of the consolidated statements of financial condition and revenues and expenses are translated at average rates of exchange for the period. Foreign currency remeasurement gains or losses on transactions in nonfunctional currencies are recognized in earnings. Gains or losses on translation of the financial statements of a non-U.S. operation, when the functional currency is other than the U.S. dollar, are included, net of hedges and taxes, in the consolidated statements of comprehensive income.

Recent Accounting Developments

Revenue from Contracts with Customers (ASC 606). In May 2014, the FASB issued ASU No. 2014-09. This ASU, as amended, provides comprehensive guidance on the recognition of revenue from customers arising from the transfer of goods and services, guidance on accounting for certain contract costs and new disclosures.

The firm adopted this ASU in January 2018 under a modified retrospective approach. As a result of adopting this ASU, the firm will, among other things, delay recognition of non-refundable and milestone payments on financial advisory assignments until the assignments are completed, and recognize certain investment management fees earlier than under the firm’s existing revenue recognition policies. The cumulative effect of adopting this ASU on January 1, 2018 was a decrease to retained earnings of $53 million (net of tax).

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   113


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The firm will also prospectively change the presentation of certain costs from a net presentation within net revenues to a gross basis, and vice versa. Beginning in 2018, certain underwriting expenses, which are currently netted against Investment Banking revenues and certain distribution costs, which are currently netted against Investment Management revenues, will be presented gross as operating expenses. Soft dollar commissions, which are currently reported gross as operating expenses, will be presented net within commissions and fees. The impact of this ASU will depend on the nature of the firm’s activities after adoption, although these changes in presentation are not expected to have a material impact on the firm’s results of operations.

Measuring the Financial Assets and the Financial Liabilities of a Consolidated Collateralized Financing Entity (ASC 810). In August 2014, the FASB issued ASU No. 2014-13, “Consolidation (Topic 810) — Measuring the Financial Assets and the Financial Liabilities of a Consolidated Collateralized Financing Entity (CFE).” This ASU provides an alternative to reflect changes in the fair value of the financial assets and the financial liabilities of the CFE by measuring either the fair value of the assets or liabilities, whichever is more observable, and provides new disclosure requirements for those electing this approach.

The firm adopted the ASU in January 2016. Adoption of the ASU did not materially affect the firm’s financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.

Amendments to the Consolidation Analysis (ASC 810). In February 2015, the FASB issued ASU No. 2015-02, “Consolidation (Topic 810) — Amendments to the Consolidation Analysis.” This ASU eliminates the deferral of the requirements of ASU No. 2009-17, “Consolidations (Topic 810) — Improvements to Financial Reporting by Enterprises Involved with Variable Interest Entities” for certain interests in investment funds and provides a scope exception for certain investments in money market funds. It also makes several modifications to the consolidation guidance for VIEs and general partners’ investments in limited partnerships, as well as modifications to the evaluation of whether limited partnerships are VIEs or voting interest entities.

The firm adopted the ASU in January 2016, using a modified retrospective approach. The impact of adoption was a net reduction to both total assets and total liabilities of approximately $200 million, substantially all included in financial instruments owned and in other liabilities and accrued expenses, respectively. Adoption of this ASU did not have an impact on the firm’s results of operations. See Note 12 for further information about the adoption.

Simplifying the Accounting for Measurement-Period Adjustments (ASC 805). In September 2015, the FASB issued ASU No. 2015-16, “Business Combinations (Topic 805) — Simplifying the Accounting for Measurement-Period Adjustments.” This ASU eliminates the requirement for an acquirer in a business combination to account for measurement-period adjustments retrospectively.

The firm adopted the ASU in January 2016. Adoption of the ASU did not materially affect the firm’s financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.

Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities (ASC 825). In January 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-01, “Financial Instruments (Topic 825) — Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities.” This ASU amends certain aspects of recognition, measurement, presentation and disclosure of financial instruments. It includes a requirement to present separately in other comprehensive income changes in fair value attributable to a firm’s own credit spreads (debt valuation adjustment or DVA), net of tax, on financial liabilities for which the fair value option was elected.

The ASU was effective for the firm in January 2018. Early adoption was permitted under a modified retrospective approach for the requirements related to DVA. In January 2016, the firm early adopted this ASU for the requirements related to DVA and reclassified the cumulative DVA, a gain of $305 million (net of tax), from retained earnings to accumulated other comprehensive loss. The adoption of the remaining provisions of the ASU in January 2018 did not have a material impact on the firm’s financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.

Leases (ASC 842). In February 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-02, “Leases (Topic 842).” This ASU requires that, for leases longer than one year, a lessee recognize in the statements of financial condition a right-of-use asset, representing the right to use the underlying asset for the lease term, and a lease liability, representing the liability to make lease payments. It also requires that for finance leases, a lessee recognize interest expense on the lease liability, separately from the amortization of the right-of-use asset in the statements of earnings, while for operating leases, such amounts should be recognized as a combined expense. It also requires that for qualifying sale-leaseback transactions the seller recognize the gain or loss at the time control of the asset is transferred instead of amortizing it over the lease period. In addition, this ASU requires expanded disclosures about the nature and terms of lease agreements.

 

 

114   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The ASU is effective for the firm in January 2019 under a modified retrospective approach. Early adoption is permitted. The firm’s implementation efforts include reviewing the terms of existing leases and service contracts, which may include embedded leases. Based on the implementation efforts to date, the firm expects a gross up on its consolidated statements of financial condition upon recognition of the right-of-use assets and lease liabilities and does not expect the amount of the gross up to have a material impact on its financial condition.

Improvements to Employee Share-Based Payment Accounting (ASC 718). In March 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-09, “Compensation — Stock Compensation (Topic 718) — Improvements to Employee Share-Based Payment Accounting.” This ASU includes a requirement that the tax effect related to the settlement of share-based awards be recorded in income tax benefit or expense in the statements of earnings rather than directly to additional paid-in capital. This change has no impact on total shareholders’ equity and is required to be adopted prospectively. The ASU also allows for forfeitures to be recorded when they occur rather than estimated over the vesting period. This change is required to be applied on a modified retrospective basis.

The firm adopted the ASU in January 2017 and the impact of the restricted stock unit (RSU) deliveries and option exercises during 2017 was a reduction to the provision for taxes of $719 million, which was recognized in the consolidated statements of earnings. The impact will vary in future periods depending upon, among other things, the number of RSUs delivered and their change in value since grant. Prior to the adoption of this ASU, this amount would have been recorded directly to additional paid-in capital. The firm also elected to account for forfeitures as they occur, rather than to estimate forfeitures over the vesting period, and the cumulative effect of this election upon adoption was an increase of $35 million to share-based awards and a decrease of $24 million (net of tax of $11 million) to retained earnings.

In addition, the ASU modifies the classification of certain share-based payment activities within the statements of cash flows. As a result, the firm reclassified, on a retrospective basis, a cash outflow of $1.13 billion and $1.20 billion related to the settlement of share-based awards in satisfaction of withholding tax requirements from operating activities to financing activities and a cash inflow of $202 million and $407 million of excess tax benefits related to share-based awards from financing activities to operating activities for 2016 and 2015, respectively.

Measurement of Credit Losses on Financial Instruments (ASC 326). In June 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-13, “Financial Instruments — Credit Losses (Topic 326) — Measurement of Credit Losses on Financial Instruments.” This ASU amends several aspects of the measurement of credit losses on financial instruments, including replacing the existing incurred credit loss model and other models with the Current Expected Credit Losses (CECL) model and amending certain aspects of accounting for purchased financial assets with deterioration in credit quality since origination.

Under CECL, the allowance for losses for financial assets that are measured at amortized cost reflects management’s estimate of credit losses over the remaining expected life of the financial assets. Expected credit losses for newly recognized financial assets, as well as changes to expected credit losses during the period, would be recognized in earnings. For certain purchased financial assets with deterioration in credit quality since origination, an initial allowance would be recorded for expected credit losses and recognized as an increase to the purchase price rather than as an expense. Expected credit losses, including losses on off-balance-sheet exposures such as lending commitments, will be measured based on historical experience, current conditions and forecasts that affect the collectability of the reported amount.

The ASU is effective for the firm in January 2020 under a modified retrospective approach. Early adoption is permitted in January 2019. Adoption of the ASU will result in earlier recognition of credit losses and an increase in the recorded allowance for certain purchased loans with deterioration in credit quality since origination with a corresponding increase to their gross carrying value. The impact of adoption of this ASU on the firm’s financial condition, results of operations and cash flows will depend on, among other things, the economic environment and the type of financial assets held by the firm on the date of adoption.

Classification of Certain Cash Receipts and Cash Payments (ASC 230). In August 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-15, “Statement of Cash Flows (Topic 230) — Classification of Certain Cash Receipts and Cash Payments.” This ASU provides guidance on the disclosure and classification of certain items within the statements of cash flows.

The firm adopted this ASU in January 2018 under a retrospective approach. The impact of this ASU will depend on the nature of the firm’s activities after adoption, although the firm does not expect the change in classification to have a material impact on the consolidated statements of cash flows.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   115


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Restricted Cash (ASC 230). In November 2016, the FASB issued ASU No. 2016-18, “Statement of Cash Flows (Topic 230) — Restricted Cash.” This ASU requires that cash segregated for regulatory and other purposes be included in cash and cash equivalents disclosed in the statements of cash flows and is required to be applied retrospectively.

The firm early adopted the ASU in December 2016 and reclassified cash segregated for regulatory and other purposes into cash and cash equivalents disclosed in the consolidated statements of cash flows. The impact of adoption was a decrease of $3.69 billion and an increase of $909 million for 2016 and 2015, respectively, to net cash provided by operating activities. In addition, in December 2016, to be consistent with the presentation of segregated cash in the consolidated statements of cash flows under the ASU, the firm reclassified amounts previously included in cash and securities segregated for regulatory and other purposes into cash and cash equivalents, securities purchased under agreements to resell, securities borrowed and financial instruments owned in the consolidated statements of financial condition. Previously reported amounts in the consolidated statements of cash flows and notes to the consolidated financial statements have been conformed to the current presentation.

Clarifying the Definition of a Business (ASC 805). In January 2017, the FASB issued ASU No. 2017-01, “Business Combinations (Topic 805) — Clarifying the Definition of a Business.” The ASU amends the definition of a business and provides a threshold which must be considered to determine whether a transaction is an acquisition (or disposal) of an asset or a business.

The firm adopted this ASU in January 2018 under a prospective approach. The impact of this ASU will depend on the nature of the firm’s activities after adoption, although the firm expects that fewer transactions will be treated as acquisitions (or disposals) of businesses.

Simplifying the Test for Goodwill Impairment (ASC 350). In January 2017, the FASB issued ASU No. 2017-04, “Intangibles — Goodwill and Other (Topic 350) — Simplifying the Test for Goodwill Impairment.” The ASU simplifies the quantitative goodwill impairment test by eliminating the second step of the test. Under this ASU, impairment will be measured by comparing the estimated fair value of the reporting unit with its carrying value.

The ASU is effective for the firm in 2020. The firm early adopted this ASU in the fourth quarter of 2017. Adoption of the ASU did not have a material impact on the results of the firm’s goodwill impairment test.

Clarifying the Scope of Asset Derecognition Guidance and Accounting for Partial Sales of Nonfinancial Assets (ASC 610-20). In February 2017, the FASB issued ASU No. 2017-05, “Other Income — Gains and Losses from the Derecognition of Nonfinancial Assets (Subtopic 610-20) — Clarifying the Scope of Asset Derecognition Guidance and Accounting for Partial Sales of Nonfinancial Assets.” The ASU clarifies the scope of guidance applicable to sales of nonfinancial assets and also provides guidance on accounting for partial sales of such assets.

The firm adopted this ASU in January 2018 under a modified retrospective approach. Adoption of the ASU did not have an impact on the firm’s financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.

Targeted Improvements to Accounting for Hedging Activities (ASC 815). In August 2017, the FASB issued ASU No. 2017-12, “Derivatives and Hedging (Topic 815) — Targeted Improvements to Accounting for Hedging Activities.” The ASU amends certain of the rules for hedging relationships and expands the types of strategies that are eligible for hedge accounting treatment to more closely align the results of hedge accounting with risk management activities.

The firm early adopted this ASU in January 2018. Adoption of this ASU did not have a material impact on the firm’s financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.

Reclassification of Certain Tax Effects from Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (ASC 220). In February 2018, the FASB issued ASU No. 2018-02, “Income Statement — Reporting Comprehensive Income (Topic 220) — Reclassification of Certain Tax Effects from Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income.” This ASU permits a reporting entity to reclassify the income tax effects of Tax Legislation on items within accumulated other comprehensive income to retained earnings.

The ASU is effective for the firm in January 2019 under a retrospective or a modified retrospective approach. Early adoption is permitted. Since this ASU only permits reclassification within shareholders’ equity, adoption of this ASU will not have a material impact on the firm’s financial condition.

 

 

116   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Note 4.

 

Financial Instruments Owned and Financial Instruments Sold, But Not Yet Purchased

    

 

Financial instruments owned and financial instruments sold, but not yet purchased are accounted for at fair value either under the fair value option or in accordance with other U.S. GAAP. See Note 8 for information about other financial assets and financial liabilities at fair value.

The table below presents the firm’s financial instruments owned and financial instruments sold, but not yet purchased.

 

$ in millions    

Financial
Instruments
Owned
 
 
 
    



Financial
Instruments
Sold, But
Not Yet
Purchased
 
 
 
 
 

As of December 2017

    

Money market instruments

    $    1,608        $           –  

Government and agency obligations:

    

U.S.

    76,418        17,911  

Non-U.S.

    33,956        23,311  

Loans and securities backed by:

    

Commercial real estate

    3,436        1  

Residential real estate

    11,993         

Corporate loans and debt securities

    33,683        7,153  

State and municipal obligations

    1,471         

Other debt obligations

    2,164        1  

Equity securities

    96,132        23,882  

Commodities

    3,194        40  

Investments in funds at NAV

    4,596         

Subtotal

    268,651        72,299  

Derivatives

    47,337        39,631  

Total

    $315,988        $111,930  

 

As of December 2016

    

Money market instruments

    $    1,319        $           –  

Government and agency obligations:

    

U.S.

    57,657        16,627  

Non-U.S.

    29,381        20,502  

Loans and securities backed by:

    

Commercial real estate

    3,842         

Residential real estate

    12,195        3  

Corporate loans and debt securities

    28,659        6,570  

State and municipal obligations

    1,059         

Other debt obligations

    1,358        1  

Equity securities

    94,692        25,941  

Commodities

    5,653         

Investments in funds at NAV

    6,465         

Subtotal

    242,280        69,644  

Derivatives

    53,672        47,499  

Total

    $295,952        $117,143  

In the table above:

 

 

Money market instruments includes commercial paper, certificates of deposit and time deposits, substantially all of which have a maturity of less than one year.

 

 

Equity securities includes public and private equities, exchange-traded funds and convertible debentures. Such amounts include investments accounted for at fair value under the fair value option where the firm would otherwise apply the equity method of accounting of $8.49 billion and $7.92 billion as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively.

Gains and Losses from Market Making and Other Principal Transactions

The table below presents market making revenues by major product type, as well as other principal transactions revenues.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017        2016        2015  

Interest rates

    $  6,406        $ (1,979      $ (1,360

Credit

    701        1,854        920  

Currencies

    (3,249      6,158        3,345  

Equities

    3,162        2,873        5,515  

Commodities

    640        1,027        1,103  

Market making

    7,660        9,933        9,523  

Other principal transactions

    5,256        3,200        5,018  

Total

    $12,916        $13,133        $14,541  

In the table above:

 

 

Gains/(losses) include both realized and unrealized gains and losses, and are primarily related to the firm’s financial instruments owned and financial instruments sold, but not yet purchased, including both derivative and non-derivative financial instruments.

 

 

Gains/(losses) exclude related interest income and interest expense. See Note 23 for further information about interest income and interest expense.

 

 

Gains/(losses) on other principal transactions are included in the firm’s Investing & Lending segment. See Note 25 for net revenues, including net interest income, by product type for Investing & Lending, as well as the amount of net interest income included in Investing & Lending.

 

 

Gains/(losses) are not representative of the manner in which the firm manages its business activities because many of the firm’s market-making and client facilitation strategies utilize financial instruments across various product types. Accordingly, gains or losses in one product type frequently offset gains or losses in other product types. For example, most of the firm’s longer-term derivatives across product types are sensitive to changes in interest rates and may be economically hedged with interest rate swaps. Similarly, a significant portion of the firm’s cash instruments and derivatives across product types has exposure to foreign currencies and may be economically hedged with foreign currency contracts.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   117


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Note 5.

Fair Value Measurements

 

The fair value of a financial instrument is the amount that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date. Financial assets are marked to bid prices and financial liabilities are marked to offer prices. Fair value measurements do not include transaction costs. The firm measures certain financial assets and financial liabilities as a portfolio (i.e., based on its net exposure to market and/or credit risks).

The best evidence of fair value is a quoted price in an active market. If quoted prices in active markets are not available, fair value is determined by reference to prices for similar instruments, quoted prices or recent transactions in less active markets, or internally developed models that primarily use market-based or independently sourced inputs including, but not limited to, interest rates, volatilities, equity or debt prices, foreign exchange rates, commodity prices, credit spreads and funding spreads (i.e., the spread or difference between the interest rate at which a borrower could finance a given financial instrument relative to a benchmark interest rate).

U.S. GAAP has a three-level hierarchy for disclosure of fair value measurements. This hierarchy prioritizes inputs to the valuation techniques used to measure fair value, giving the highest priority to level 1 inputs and the lowest priority to level 3 inputs. A financial instrument’s level in this hierarchy is based on the lowest level of input that is significant to its fair value measurement. In evaluating the significance of a valuation input, the firm considers, among other factors, a portfolio’s net risk exposure to that input. The fair value hierarchy is as follows:

Level 1. Inputs are unadjusted quoted prices in active markets to which the firm had access at the measurement date for identical, unrestricted assets or liabilities.

Level 2. Inputs to valuation techniques are observable, either directly or indirectly.

Level 3. One or more inputs to valuation techniques are significant and unobservable.

The fair values for substantially all of the firm’s financial assets and financial liabilities are based on observable prices and inputs and are classified in levels 1 and 2 of the fair value hierarchy. Certain level 2 and level 3 financial assets and financial liabilities may require appropriate valuation adjustments that a market participant would require to arrive at fair value for factors such as counterparty and the firm’s credit quality, funding risk, transfer restrictions, liquidity and bid/offer spreads. Valuation adjustments are generally based on market evidence.

See Notes 6 through 8 for further information about fair value measurements of cash instruments, derivatives and other financial assets and financial liabilities at fair value.

The table below presents financial assets and financial liabilities accounted for at fair value under the fair value option or in accordance with other U.S. GAAP.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Total level 1 financial assets

    $155,086        $135,401  

Total level 2 financial assets

    395,606        419,585  

Total level 3 financial assets

    19,201        23,280  

Investments in funds at NAV

    4,596        6,465  

Counterparty and cash collateral netting

    (56,366      (87,038

Total financial assets at fair value

    $518,123        $497,693  

Total assets

    $916,776        $860,165  

Total level 3 financial assets divided by:

    

Total assets

    2.1%        2.7%  

Total financial assets at fair value

    3.7%        4.7%  

Total level 1 financial liabilities

    $  63,589        $  62,504  

Total level 2 financial liabilities

    261,719        232,027  

Total level 3 financial liabilities

    19,620        21,448  

Counterparty and cash collateral netting

    (39,866      (44,695

Total financial liabilities at fair value

    $305,062        $271,284  

 

Total level 3 financial liabilities divided by total financial liabilities at fair value

    6.4%        7.9%  

In the table above:

 

 

Counterparty netting among positions classified in the same level is included in that level.

 

 

Counterparty and cash collateral netting represents the impact on derivatives of netting across levels of the fair value hierarchy.

 

 

118   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The table below presents a summary of level 3 financial assets.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Cash instruments

    $15,395        $18,035  

Derivatives

    3,802        5,190  

Other financial assets

    4        55  

Total

    $19,201        $23,280  

Level 3 financial assets as of December 2017 decreased compared with December 2016, primarily reflecting a decrease in level 3 cash instruments. See Notes 6 through 8 for further information about level 3 financial assets (including information about unrealized gains and losses related to level 3 financial assets and financial liabilities, and transfers in and out of level 3).

Note 6.

Cash Instruments

Cash instruments include U.S. government and agency obligations, non-U.S. government and agency obligations, mortgage-backed loans and securities, corporate loans and debt securities, equity securities, investments in funds at NAV, and other non-derivative financial instruments owned and financial instruments sold, but not yet purchased. See below for the types of cash instruments included in each level of the fair value hierarchy and the valuation techniques and significant inputs used to determine their fair values. See Note 5 for an overview of the firm’s fair value measurement policies.

Level 1 Cash Instruments

Level 1 cash instruments include certain money market instruments, U.S. government obligations, most non-U.S. government obligations, certain government agency obligations, certain corporate debt securities and actively traded listed equities. These instruments are valued using quoted prices for identical unrestricted instruments in active markets.

The firm defines active markets for equity instruments based on the average daily trading volume both in absolute terms and relative to the market capitalization for the instrument. The firm defines active markets for debt instruments based on both the average daily trading volume and the number of days with trading activity.

Level 2 Cash Instruments

Level 2 cash instruments include most money market instruments, most government agency obligations, certain non-U.S. government obligations, most mortgage-backed loans and securities, most corporate loans and debt securities, most state and municipal obligations, most other debt obligations, restricted or less liquid listed equities, commodities and certain lending commitments.

Valuations of level 2 cash instruments can be verified to quoted prices, recent trading activity for identical or similar instruments, broker or dealer quotations or alternative pricing sources with reasonable levels of price transparency. Consideration is given to the nature of the quotations (e.g., indicative or firm) and the relationship of recent market activity to the prices provided from alternative pricing sources.

Valuation adjustments are typically made to level 2 cash instruments (i) if the cash instrument is subject to transfer restrictions and/or (ii) for other premiums and liquidity discounts that a market participant would require to arrive at fair value. Valuation adjustments are generally based on market evidence.

Level 3 Cash Instruments

Level 3 cash instruments have one or more significant valuation inputs that are not observable. Absent evidence to the contrary, level 3 cash instruments are initially valued at transaction price, which is considered to be the best initial estimate of fair value. Subsequently, the firm uses other methodologies to determine fair value, which vary based on the type of instrument. Valuation inputs and assumptions are changed when corroborated by substantive observable evidence, including values realized on sales of financial assets.

Valuation Techniques and Significant Inputs of Level 3 Cash Instruments

Valuation techniques of level 3 cash instruments vary by instrument, but are generally based on discounted cash flow techniques. The valuation techniques and the nature of significant inputs used to determine the fair values of each type of level 3 cash instrument are described below:

Loans and Securities Backed by Commercial Real Estate. Loans and securities backed by commercial real estate are directly or indirectly collateralized by a single commercial real estate property or a portfolio of properties, and may include tranches of varying levels of subordination. Significant inputs are generally determined based on relative value analyses and include:

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   119


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

 

Transaction prices in both the underlying collateral and instruments with the same or similar underlying collateral;

 

 

Market yields implied by transactions of similar or related assets and/or current levels and changes in market indices such as the CMBX (an index that tracks the performance of commercial mortgage bonds);

 

 

A measure of expected future cash flows in a default scenario (recovery rates) implied by the value of the underlying collateral, which is mainly driven by current performance of the underlying collateral, capitalization rates and multiples. Recovery rates are expressed as a percentage of notional or face value of the instrument and reflect the benefit of credit enhancements on certain instruments; and

 

 

Timing of expected future cash flows (duration) which, in certain cases, may incorporate the impact of other unobservable inputs (e.g., prepayment speeds).

Loans and Securities Backed by Residential Real Estate. Loans and securities backed by residential real estate are directly or indirectly collateralized by portfolios of residential real estate and may include tranches of varying levels of subordination. Significant inputs are generally determined based on relative value analyses, which incorporate comparisons to instruments with similar collateral and risk profiles. Significant inputs include:

 

 

Transaction prices in both the underlying collateral and instruments with the same or similar underlying collateral;

 

 

Market yields implied by transactions of similar or related assets;

 

 

Cumulative loss expectations, driven by default rates, home price projections, residential property liquidation timelines, related costs and subsequent recoveries; and

 

 

Duration, driven by underlying loan prepayment speeds and residential property liquidation timelines.

Corporate Loans and Debt Securities. Corporate loans and debt securities includes bank loans and bridge loans and corporate debt securities. Significant inputs are generally determined based on relative value analyses, which incorporate comparisons both to prices of credit default swaps that reference the same or similar underlying instrument or entity and to other debt instruments for the same issuer for which observable prices or broker quotations are available. Significant inputs include:

 

 

Market yields implied by transactions of similar or related assets and/or current levels and trends of market indices such as CDX and LCDX (indices that track the performance of corporate credit and loans, respectively);

 

Current performance and recovery assumptions and, where the firm uses credit default swaps to value the related cash instrument, the cost of borrowing the underlying reference obligation; and

 

 

Duration.

Equity Securities. Equity securities includes private equity securities and convertible debentures. Recent third-party completed or pending transactions (e.g., merger proposals, tender offers, debt restructurings) are considered to be the best evidence for any change in fair value. When these are not available, the following valuation methodologies are used, as appropriate:

 

 

Industry multiples (primarily EBITDA multiples) and public comparables;

 

 

Transactions in similar instruments;

 

 

Discounted cash flow techniques; and

 

 

Third-party appraisals.

The firm also considers changes in the outlook for the relevant industry and financial performance of the issuer as compared to projected performance. Significant inputs include:

 

 

Market and transaction multiples;

 

 

Discount rates and capitalization rates; and

 

 

For equity securities with debt-like features, market yields implied by transactions of similar or related assets, current performance and recovery assumptions, and duration.

Other Cash Instruments. Other cash instruments consists of non-U.S. government and agency obligations, state and municipal obligations, and other debt obligations. Significant inputs are generally determined based on relative value analyses, which incorporate comparisons both to prices of credit default swaps that reference the same or similar underlying instrument or entity and to other debt instruments for the same issuer for which observable prices or broker quotations are available. Significant inputs include:

 

 

Market yields implied by transactions of similar or related assets and/or current levels and trends of market indices;

 

 

Current performance and recovery assumptions and, where the firm uses credit default swaps to value the related cash instrument, the cost of borrowing the underlying reference obligation; and

 

 

Duration.

 

 

120   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Fair Value of Cash Instruments by Level

The tables below present cash instrument assets and liabilities at fair value by level within the fair value hierarchy.

 

    As of December 2017  
$ in millions     Level 1       Level 2       Level 3       Total  

Assets

       

Money market instruments

    $       398       $  1,209       $         1       $    1,608  

Government and agency obligations:

       

U.S.

    50,796       25,622             76,418  

Non-U.S.

    27,070       6,882       4       33,956  

Loans and securities backed by:

       

Commercial real estate

          2,310       1,126       3,436  

Residential real estate

          11,325       668       11,993  

Corporate loans and debt securities

    752       29,661       3,270       33,683  

State and municipal obligations

          1,401       70       1,471  

Other debt obligations

          1,812       352       2,164  

Equity securities

    76,044       10,184       9,904       96,132  

Commodities

          3,194             3,194  

Subtotal

    $155,060       $93,600       $15,395       $264,055  

Investments in funds at NAV

                            4,596  

Total cash instrument assets

                            $268,651  

Liabilities

       

Government and agency obligations:

       

U.S.

    $ (17,845     $      (66     $         –       $ (17,911

Non-U.S.

    (21,820     (1,491           (23,311

Loans and securities backed by commercial real estate

          (1           (1

Corporate loans and debt securities

    (2     (7,099     (52     (7,153

Other debt obligations

          (1           (1

Equity securities

    (23,866           (16     (23,882

Commodities

          (40           (40

Total cash instrument liabilities

    $ (63,533     $ (8,698     $      (68     $ (72,299

 

    As of December 2016  
$ in millions     Level 1       Level 2       Level 3       Total  

Assets

       

Money market instruments

    $       188       $  1,131       $          –       $    1,319  

Government and agency obligations:

       

U.S.

    35,254       22,403             57,657  

Non-U.S.

    22,433       6,933       15       29,381  

Loans and securities backed by:

       

Commercial real estate

          2,197       1,645       3,842  

Residential real estate

          11,350       845       12,195  

Corporate loans and debt
securities

    215       23,804       4,640       28,659  

State and municipal obligations

          960       99       1,059  

Other debt obligations

          830       528       1,358  

Equity securities

    77,276       7,153       10,263       94,692  

Commodities

          5,653             5,653  

Subtotal

    $135,366       $82,414       $18,035       $235,815  

Investments in funds at NAV

                            6,465  

Total cash instrument assets

                            $242,280  

Liabilities

       

Government and agency obligations:

       

U.S.

    $ (16,615     $      (12     $          –       $ (16,627

Non-U.S.

    (19,137     (1,364     (1     (20,502

Loans and securities backed by residential real estate

          (3           (3

Corporate loans and debt
securities

    (2     (6,524     (44     (6,570

Other debt obligations

          (1           (1

Equity securities

    (25,768     (156     (17     (25,941

Total cash instrument liabilities

    $ (61,522     $ (8,060     $      (62     $ (69,644

In the tables above:

 

 

Cash instrument assets and liabilities are included in financial instruments owned and financial instruments sold, but not yet purchased, respectively.

 

 

Cash instrument assets are shown as positive amounts and cash instrument liabilities are shown as negative amounts.

 

 

Money market instruments includes commercial paper, certificates of deposit and time deposits.

 

 

Equity securities includes public and private equities, exchange-traded funds and convertible debentures.

 

 

As of both December 2017 and December 2016, substantially all of the firm’s level 3 equity securities consisted of private equity securities.

 

 

Total cash instrument assets included collateralized debt obligations (CDOs) and collateralized loan obligations (CLOs) backed by real estate and corporate obligations of $918 million and $461 million in level 2, and $250 million and $624 million in level 3 as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   121


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Significant Unobservable Inputs

The table below presents the amount of level 3 assets, and ranges and weighted averages of significant unobservable inputs used to value the firm’s level 3 cash instruments.

 

    Level 3 Assets and Range of Significant Unobservable
Inputs (Weighted Average) as of December
 
$ in millions     2017       2016  

Loans and securities backed by commercial real estate

 

Level 3 assets

    $1,126       $1,645  

Yield

    4.6% to 22.0% (13.4%     3.7% to 23.0% (13.0%

Recovery rate

    14.3% to 89.0% (43.8%     8.9% to 99.0% (60.6%

Duration (years)

    0.8 to 6.4 (2.1     0.8 to 6.2 (2.1

Loans and securities backed by residential real estate

 

Level 3 assets

    $668       $845  

Yield

    2.3% to 15.0% (8.3%     0.8% to 15.6% (8.7%

Cumulative loss rate

    12.5% to 43.0% (21.8%     8.9% to 47.1% (24.2%

Duration (years)

    0.7 to 14.0 (6.9     1.1 to 16.1 (7.3

Corporate loans and debt securities

 

Level 3 assets

    $3,270       $4,640  

Yield

    3.6% to 24.5% (12.3%     2.5% to 25.0% (10.3%

Recovery rate

    0.0% to 85.3% (62.8%     0.0% to 85.0% (56.5%

Duration (years)

    0.5 to 7.6 (3.2     0.6 to 15.7 (2.9

Equity securities

 

Level 3 assets

    $9,904       $10,263  

Multiples

    1.1x to 30.5x (8.9x     0.8x to 19.7x (6.8x

Discount rate/yield

    3.0% to 20.3% (14.0%     6.5% to 25.0% (16.0%

Capitalization rate

    4.3% to 12.0% (6.1%     4.2% to 12.5% (6.8%

Other cash instruments

 

Level 3 assets

    $427       $642  

Yield

    4.0% to 11.7% (8.4%     1.9% to 14.0% (8.8%

Recovery rate

    N/A       0.0% to 93.0% (61.4%

Duration (years)

    3.5 to 11.4 (5.1     0.9 to 12.0 (4.3

In the table above:

 

 

Ranges represent the significant unobservable inputs that were used in the valuation of each type of cash instrument.

 

 

Weighted averages are calculated by weighting each input by the relative fair value of the cash instruments.

 

 

The ranges and weighted averages of these inputs are not representative of the appropriate inputs to use when calculating the fair value of any one cash instrument. For example, the highest multiple for private equity securities is appropriate for valuing a specific private equity security but may not be appropriate for valuing any other private equity security. Accordingly, the ranges of inputs do not represent uncertainty in, or possible ranges of, fair value measurements of the firm’s level 3 cash instruments.

 

Increases in yield, discount rate, capitalization rate, duration or cumulative loss rate used in the valuation of the firm’s level 3 cash instruments would result in a lower fair value measurement, while increases in recovery rate or multiples would result in a higher fair value measurement. Due to the distinctive nature of each of the firm’s level 3 cash instruments, the interrelationship of inputs is not necessarily uniform within each product type.

 

 

Equity securities includes private equity securities and convertible debentures.

 

 

Loans and securities backed by commercial and residential real estate, corporate loans and debt securities and other cash instruments are valued using discounted cash flows, and equity securities are valued using market comparables and discounted cash flows.

 

 

The fair value of any one instrument may be determined using multiple valuation techniques. For example, market comparables and discounted cash flows may be used together to determine fair value. Therefore, the level 3 balance encompasses both of these techniques.

 

 

Recovery rate was not significant to the valuation of level 3 other cash instrument assets as of December 2017.

Transfers Between Levels of the Fair Value Hierarchy

Transfers between levels of the fair value hierarchy are reported at the beginning of the reporting period in which they occur. See “Level 3 Rollforward” below for information about transfers between level 2 and level 3.

During 2017, transfers into level 2 from level 1 of cash instruments were $63 million, reflecting transfers of public equity securities due to decreased market activity in these instruments. Transfers into level 1 from level 2 of cash instruments during 2017 were $154 million, reflecting transfers of public equity securities due to increased market activity in these instruments.

During 2016, transfers into level 2 from level 1 of cash instruments were $135 million, reflecting transfers of public equity securities due to decreased market activity in these instruments. Transfers into level 1 from level 2 of cash instruments during 2016 were $267 million, reflecting transfers of public equity securities due to increased market activity in these instruments.

 

 

122   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Level 3 Rollforward

The table below presents a summary of the changes in fair value for level 3 cash instrument assets and liabilities.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Total cash instrument assets

    

Beginning balance

    $18,035        $18,131  

Net realized gains/(losses)

    419        574  

Net unrealized gains/(losses)

    1,144        397  

Purchases

    1,635        3,072  

Sales

    (3,315      (2,326

Settlements

    (2,265      (3,503

Transfers into level 3

    2,405        3,405  

Transfers out of level 3

    (2,663      (1,715

Ending balance

    $15,395        $18,035  

Total cash instrument liabilities

    

Beginning balance

    $      (62      $    (193

Net realized gains/(losses)

    (8      20  

Net unrealized gains/(losses)

    (28      19  

Purchases

    97        91  

Sales

    (20      (49

Settlements

    (32      (7

Transfers into level 3

    (18      (12

Transfers out of level 3

    3        69  

Ending balance

    $      (68      $      (62

In the table above:

 

 

Changes in fair value are presented for all cash instrument assets and liabilities that are classified in level 3 as of the end of the period.

 

 

Net unrealized gains/(losses) relates to instruments that were still held at period-end.

 

 

Purchases includes originations and secondary purchases.

 

 

If a cash instrument asset or liability was transferred to level 3 during a reporting period, its entire gain or loss for the period is classified in level 3. For level 3 cash instrument assets, increases are shown as positive amounts, while decreases are shown as negative amounts. For level 3 cash instrument liabilities, increases are shown as negative amounts, while decreases are shown as positive amounts.

 

 

Level 3 cash instruments are frequently economically hedged with level 1 and level 2 cash instruments and/or level 1, level 2 or level 3 derivatives. Accordingly, gains or losses that are classified in level 3 can be partially offset by gains or losses attributable to level 1 or level 2 cash instruments and/or level 1, level 2 or level 3 derivatives. As a result, gains or losses included in the level 3 rollforward below do not necessarily represent the overall impact on the firm’s results of operations, liquidity or capital resources.

The table below disaggregates, by product type, the information for cash instrument assets included in the summary table above.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Loans and securities backed by commercial real estate

 

Beginning balance

    $  1,645        $  1,924  

Net realized gains/(losses)

    35        60  

Net unrealized gains/(losses)

    71        (19

Purchases

    176        331  

Sales

    (319      (320

Settlements

    (392      (617

Transfers into level 3

    141        510  

Transfers out of level 3

    (231      (224

Ending balance

    $  1,126        $  1,645  

Loans and securities backed by residential real estate

 

Beginning balance

    $     845        $  1,765  

Net realized gains/(losses)

    37        60  

Net unrealized gains/(losses)

    96        26  

Purchases

    98        298  

Sales

    (246      (791

Settlements

    (104      (278

Transfers into level 3

    21        73  

Transfers out of level 3

    (79      (308

Ending balance

    $     668        $     845  

Corporate loans and debt securities

 

Beginning balance

    $  4,640        $  5,242  

Net realized gains/(losses)

    145        261  

Net unrealized gains/(losses)

    (13      34  

Purchases

    666        1,078  

Sales

    (1,003      (645

Settlements

    (1,062      (1,823

Transfers into level 3

    1,130        1,023  

Transfers out of level 3

    (1,233      (530

Ending balance

    $  3,270        $  4,640  

Equity securities

 

Beginning balance

    $10,263        $  8,549  

Net realized gains/(losses)

    185        158  

Net unrealized gains/(losses)

    982        371  

Purchases

    624        1,122  

Sales

    (1,702      (412

Settlements

    (559      (634

Transfers into level 3

    1,113        1,732  

Transfers out of level 3

    (1,002      (623

Ending balance

    $  9,904        $10,263  

Other cash instruments

 

Beginning balance

    $     642        $     651  

Net realized gains/(losses)

    17        35  

Net unrealized gains/(losses)

    8        (15

Purchases

    71        243  

Sales

    (45      (158

Settlements

    (148      (151

Transfers into level 3

           67  

Transfers out of level 3

    (118      (30

Ending balance

    $     427        $     642  
 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   123


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Level 3 Rollforward Commentary

Year Ended December 2017. The net realized and unrealized gains on level 3 cash instrument assets of $1.56 billion (reflecting $419 million of net realized gains and $1.14 billion of net unrealized gains) for 2017 included gains/(losses) of approximately $(99) million, $1.13 billion and $532 million reported in market making, other principal transactions and interest income, respectively.

The net unrealized gains on level 3 cash instrument assets for 2017 primarily reflected gains on private equity securities, principally driven by strong corporate performance and company-specific events.

Transfers into level 3 during 2017 primarily reflected transfers of certain corporate loans and debt securities and private equity securities from level 2, principally due to reduced price transparency as a result of a lack of market evidence, including fewer market transactions in these instruments.

Transfers out of level 3 during 2017 primarily reflected transfers of certain corporate loans and debt securities and private equity securities to level 2, principally due to increased price transparency as a result of market evidence, including market transactions in these instruments, and transfers of certain corporate loans and debt securities to level 2, principally due to certain unobservable yield and duration inputs no longer being significant to the valuation of these instruments.

Year Ended December 2016. The net realized and unrealized gains on level 3 cash instrument assets of $971 million (reflecting $574 million of net realized gains and $397 million of net unrealized gains) for 2016 included gains/(losses) of approximately $(311) million, $625 million and $657 million reported in market making, other principal transactions and interest income, respectively.

The net unrealized gains on level 3 cash instrument assets for 2016 primarily reflected gains on private equity securities, principally driven by strong corporate performance and company-specific events.

Transfers into level 3 during 2016 primarily reflected transfers of certain private equity securities, corporate loans and debt securities, and loans and securities backed by commercial real estate from level 2, principally due to reduced price transparency as a result of a lack of market evidence, including fewer market transactions in these instruments.

Transfers out of level 3 during 2016 primarily reflected transfers of certain private equity securities, corporate loans and debt securities, and loans and securities backed by residential real estate to level 2, principally due to increased price transparency as a result of market evidence, including market transactions in these instruments.

Available-for-Sale Securities

The table below presents details about cash instruments that are accounted for as available-for-sale.

 

$ in millions    
Amortized
Cost
 
 
   
Fair
Value
 
 
   

Weighted
Average
Yield
 
 
 

As of December 2017

 

   

Less than 5 years

    $3,834       $3,800       1.95%  

Greater than 5 years

    5,207       5,222       2.41%  

Total U.S. government obligations

    9,041       9,022       2.22%  

Less than 5 years

    19       19       0.43%  

Greater than 5 years

    233       235       4.62%  

Total other available-for-sale securities

    252       254       4.30%  

Total available-for-sale securities

    $9,293       $9,276       2.27%  

 

As of December 2016

 

   

Less than 5 years

    $     24       $     24       0.43%  

Total U.S. government obligations

    24       24       0.43%  

Less than 5 years

    31       31       2.11%  

Greater than 5 years

    34       34       3.85%  

Total other available-for-sale securities

    65       65       3.03%  

Total available-for-sale securities

    $     89       $     89       2.32%  

In the table above:

 

 

U.S. government obligations were classified in level 1 of the fair value hierarchy as of both December 2017 and December 2016.

 

 

Other available-for-sale securities includes corporate debt securities, other debt obligations, securities backed by commercial real estate and money market instruments. As of December 2017, substantially all of these securities were classified in level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. As of December 2016, these securities were primarily classified in level 2 of the fair value hierarchy.

 

 

The gross unrealized gains/(losses) included in accumulated other comprehensive loss related to available-for-sale securities were not material.

 

 

124   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Investments in Funds at Net Asset Value Per Share

Cash instruments at fair value include investments in funds that are measured at NAV of the investment fund. The firm uses NAV to measure the fair value of its fund investments when (i) the fund investment does not have a readily determinable fair value and (ii) the NAV of the investment fund is calculated in a manner consistent with the measurement principles of investment company accounting, including measurement of the investments at fair value.

Substantially all of the firm’s investments in funds at NAV consist of investments in firm-sponsored private equity, credit, real estate and hedge funds where the firm co-invests with third-party investors.

Private equity funds primarily invest in a broad range of industries worldwide, including leveraged buyouts, recapitalizations, growth investments and distressed investments. Credit funds generally invest in loans and other fixed income instruments and are focused on providing private high-yield capital for leveraged and management buyout transactions, recapitalizations, financings, refinancings, acquisitions and restructurings for private equity firms, private family companies and corporate issuers. Real estate funds invest globally, primarily in real estate companies, loan portfolios, debt recapitalizations and property. Private equity, credit and real estate funds are closed-end funds in which the firm’s investments are generally not eligible for redemption. Distributions will be received from these funds as the underlying assets are liquidated or distributed.

The firm also invests in hedge funds, primarily multi-disciplinary hedge funds that employ a fundamental bottom-up investment approach across various asset classes and strategies. The firm’s investments in hedge funds primarily include interests where the underlying assets are illiquid in nature, and proceeds from redemptions will not be received until the underlying assets are liquidated or distributed.

Many of the funds described above are “covered funds” as defined in the Volcker Rule of the U.S. Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (Dodd-Frank Act). The Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (Federal Reserve Board or FRB) extended the conformance period to July 2022 for the firm’s investments in, and relationships with, certain legacy “illiquid funds” (as defined in the Volcker Rule) that were in place prior to December 2013. This extension is applicable to substantially all of the firm’s remaining investments in, and relationships with, covered funds in the table below.

The table below presents the fair value of the firm’s investments in funds at NAV and related unfunded commitments.

 

$ in millions    
Fair Value of
Investments
 
 
    
Unfunded
Commitments
 
 

As of December 2017

    

Private equity funds

    $3,478        $   614  

Credit funds

    266        985  

Hedge funds

    223         

Real estate funds

    629        201  

Total

    $4,596        $1,800  

 

As of December 2016

    

Private equity funds

    $4,628        $1,393  

Credit funds

    421        166  

Hedge funds

    410         

Real estate funds

    1,006        272  

Total

    $6,465        $1,831  

Note 7.

Derivatives and Hedging Activities

Derivative Activities

Derivatives are instruments that derive their value from underlying asset prices, indices, reference rates and other inputs, or a combination of these factors. Derivatives may be traded on an exchange (exchange-traded) or they may be privately negotiated contracts, which are usually referred to as OTC derivatives. Certain of the firm’s OTC derivatives are cleared and settled through central clearing counterparties (OTC-cleared), while others are bilateral contracts between two counterparties (bilateral OTC).

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   125


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Market-Making. As a market maker, the firm enters into derivative transactions to provide liquidity to clients and to facilitate the transfer and hedging of their risks. In this role, the firm typically acts as principal and is required to commit capital to provide execution, and maintains inventory in response to, or in anticipation of, client demand.

Risk Management. The firm also enters into derivatives to actively manage risk exposures that arise from its market-making and investing and lending activities in derivative and cash instruments. The firm’s holdings and exposures are hedged, in many cases, on either a portfolio or risk-specific basis, as opposed to an instrument-by-instrument basis. The offsetting impact of this economic hedging is reflected in the same business segment as the related revenues. In addition, the firm may enter into derivatives designated as hedges under U.S. GAAP. These derivatives are used to manage interest rate exposure in certain fixed-rate unsecured long-term and short-term borrowings, and deposits, and to manage foreign currency exposure on the net investment in certain non-U.S. operations.

The firm enters into various types of derivatives, including:

 

 

Futures and Forwards. Contracts that commit counterparties to purchase or sell financial instruments, commodities or currencies in the future.

 

 

Swaps. Contracts that require counterparties to exchange cash flows such as currency or interest payment streams. The amounts exchanged are based on the specific terms of the contract with reference to specified rates, financial instruments, commodities, currencies or indices.

 

 

Options. Contracts in which the option purchaser has the right, but not the obligation, to purchase from or sell to the option writer financial instruments, commodities or currencies within a defined time period for a specified price.

Derivatives are reported on a net-by-counterparty basis (i.e., the net payable or receivable for derivative assets and liabilities for a given counterparty) when a legal right of setoff exists under an enforceable netting agreement (counterparty netting). Derivatives are accounted for at fair value, net of cash collateral received or posted under enforceable credit support agreements (cash collateral netting). Derivative assets and liabilities are included in financial instruments owned and financial instruments sold, but not yet purchased, respectively. Realized and unrealized gains and losses on derivatives not designated as hedges under ASC 815 are included in market making and other principal transactions in Note 4.

The tables below present the gross fair value and the notional amounts of derivative contracts by major product type, the amounts of counterparty and cash collateral netting in the consolidated statements of financial condition, as well as cash and securities collateral posted and received under enforceable credit support agreements that do not meet the criteria for netting under U.S. GAAP.

 

    As of December 2017         As of December 2016  
$ in millions    
Derivative
Assets
 
 
   
Derivative
Liabilities
 
 
       
Derivative
Assets
 
 
   
Derivative
Liabilities
 
 

Not accounted for as hedges

 

     

Exchange-traded

    $        554       $        644         $        443       $        382  

OTC-cleared

    5,392       2,773         189,471       168,946  

Bilateral OTC

    274,986       249,750           309,037       289,491  

Total interest rates

    280,932       253,167           498,951       458,819  

OTC-cleared

    5,727       5,670         4,837       4,811  

Bilateral OTC

    16,966       15,600           21,530       18,770  

Total credit

    22,693       21,270           26,367       23,581  

Exchange-traded

    23       363         36       176  

OTC-cleared

    988       847         796       798  

Bilateral OTC

    94,481       95,127           111,032       106,318  

Total currencies

    95,492       96,337           111,864       107,292  

Exchange-traded

    4,135       3,854         3,219       3,187  

OTC-cleared

    197       197         189       197  

Bilateral OTC

    9,748       12,097           8,945       10,487  

Total commodities

    14,080       16,148           12,353       13,871  

Exchange-traded

    10,552       10,335         8,576       8,064  

Bilateral OTC

    40,735       45,253           39,516       45,826  

Total equities

    51,287       55,588           48,092       53,890  

Subtotal

    464,484       442,510           697,627       657,453  

Accounted for as hedges

 

     

OTC-cleared

    21               4,347       156  

Bilateral OTC

    2,309       3           4,180       10  

Total interest rates

    2,330       3           8,527       166  

OTC-cleared

    15       30         30       40  

Bilateral OTC

    34       114           55       64  

Total currencies

    49       144           85       104  

Subtotal

    2,379       147           8,612       270  

Total gross fair value

    $ 466,863       $ 442,657           $ 706,239       $ 657,723  

Offset in consolidated statements of financial condition

 

Exchange-traded

    $  (12,963     $  (12,963       $    (9,727     $    (9,727

OTC-cleared

    (9,267     (9,267       (171,864     (171,864

Bilateral OTC

    (341,824     (341,824         (385,647     (385,647

Counterparty netting

    (364,054     (364,054         (567,238     (567,238

OTC-cleared

    (2,423     (180       (27,560     (2,940

Bilateral OTC

    (53,049     (38,792         (57,769     (40,046

Cash collateral netting

    (55,472     (38,972         (85,329     (42,986

Total amounts offset

    $(419,526     $(403,026         $(652,567     $(610,224

Included in consolidated statements of financial condition

 

Exchange-traded

    $     2,301       $     2,233         $     2,547       $     2,082  

OTC-cleared

    650       70         246       144  

Bilateral OTC

    44,386       37,328           50,879       45,273  

Total

    $   47,337       $   39,631           $   53,672       $   47,499  

Not offset in consolidated statements of financial condition

 

Cash collateral

    $       (602     $    (2,375       $       (535     $    (2,085

Securities collateral

    (13,947     (8,722         (15,518     (10,224

Total

    $   32,788       $   28,534           $   37,619       $   35,190  
 

 

126   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

    Notional Amounts as of December  
$ in millions     2017          2016  

Not accounted for as hedges

      

Exchange-traded

    $10,212,510          $  4,425,532  

OTC-cleared

    14,739,556          16,646,145  

Bilateral OTC

    12,862,328          11,131,442  

Total interest rates

    37,814,394          32,203,119  

OTC-cleared

    386,163          378,432  

Bilateral OTC

    868,226          1,045,913  

Total credit

    1,254,389          1,424,345  

Exchange-traded

    10,450          13,800  

OTC-cleared

    98,549          62,799  

Bilateral OTC

    7,331,516          5,576,748  

Total currencies

    7,440,515          5,653,347  

Exchange-traded

    239,749          227,707  

OTC-cleared

    3,925          3,506  

Bilateral OTC

    250,547          196,899  

Total commodities

    494,221          428,112  

Exchange-traded

    655,485          605,335  

Bilateral OTC

    1,127,812          959,112  

Total equities

    1,783,297          1,564,447  

Subtotal

    48,786,816          41,273,370  

Accounted for as hedges

      

OTC-cleared

    52,785          55,328  

Bilateral OTC

    15,188          36,607  

Total interest rates

    67,973          91,935  

OTC-cleared

    2,210          1,703  

Bilateral OTC

    8,347          8,544  

Total currencies

    10,557          10,247  

Subtotal

    78,530          102,182  

Total notional amounts

    $48,865,346          $41,375,552  

In the tables above:

 

 

Gross fair values exclude the effects of both counterparty netting and collateral, and therefore are not representative of the firm’s exposure.

 

 

Where the firm has received or posted collateral under credit support agreements, but has not yet determined such agreements are enforceable, the related collateral has not been netted.

 

 

Notional amounts, which represent the sum of gross long and short derivative contracts, provide an indication of the volume of the firm’s derivative activity and do not represent anticipated losses.

 

 

Total gross fair value of derivatives included derivative assets and derivative liabilities of $11.24 billion and $13.00 billion, respectively, as of December 2017, and derivative assets and derivative liabilities of $19.92 billion and $20.79 billion, respectively, as of December 2016, which are not subject to an enforceable netting agreement or are subject to a netting agreement that the firm has not yet determined to be enforceable.

During 2017, pursuant to a rule change at a clearing organization and to an election under the rules of another clearing organization, transactions with such clearing organizations are considered settled each day. The impact of reflecting transactions with these two clearing organizations as settled would have been a reduction in gross derivative assets and liabilities as of December 2016 of $189.08 billion and $166.04 billion, respectively, and a corresponding decrease in counterparty and cash collateral netting, with no impact to the consolidated statements of financial condition.

Valuation Techniques for Derivatives

The firm’s level 2 and level 3 derivatives are valued using derivative pricing models (e.g., discounted cash flow models, correlation models, and models that incorporate option pricing methodologies, such as Monte Carlo simulations). Price transparency of derivatives can generally be characterized by product type, as described below.

 

 

Interest Rate. In general, the key inputs used to value interest rate derivatives are transparent, even for most long-dated contracts. Interest rate swaps and options denominated in the currencies of leading industrialized nations are characterized by high trading volumes and tight bid/offer spreads. Interest rate derivatives that reference indices, such as an inflation index, or the shape of the yield curve (e.g., 10-year swap rate vs. 2-year swap rate) are more complex, but the key inputs are generally observable.

 

 

Credit. Price transparency for credit default swaps, including both single names and baskets of credits, varies by market and underlying reference entity or obligation. Credit default swaps that reference indices, large corporates and major sovereigns generally exhibit the most price transparency. For credit default swaps with other underliers, price transparency varies based on credit rating, the cost of borrowing the underlying reference obligations, and the availability of the underlying reference obligations for delivery upon the default of the issuer. Credit default swaps that reference loans, asset-backed securities and emerging market debt instruments tend to have less price transparency than those that reference corporate bonds. In addition, more complex credit derivatives, such as those sensitive to the correlation between two or more underlying reference obligations, generally have less price transparency.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   127


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

 

Currency. Prices for currency derivatives based on the exchange rates of leading industrialized nations, including those with longer tenors, are generally transparent. The primary difference between the price transparency of developed and emerging market currency derivatives is that emerging markets tend to be observable for contracts with shorter tenors.

 

 

Commodity. Commodity derivatives include transactions referenced to energy (e.g., oil and natural gas), metals (e.g., precious and base) and soft commodities (e.g., agricultural). Price transparency varies based on the underlying commodity, delivery location, tenor and product quality (e.g., diesel fuel compared to unleaded gasoline). In general, price transparency for commodity derivatives is greater for contracts with shorter tenors and contracts that are more closely aligned with major and/or benchmark commodity indices.

 

 

Equity. Price transparency for equity derivatives varies by market and underlier. Options on indices and the common stock of corporates included in major equity indices exhibit the most price transparency. Equity derivatives generally have observable market prices, except for contracts with long tenors or reference prices that differ significantly from current market prices. More complex equity derivatives, such as those sensitive to the correlation between two or more individual stocks, generally have less price transparency.

Liquidity is essential to observability of all product types. If transaction volumes decline, previously transparent prices and other inputs may become unobservable. Conversely, even highly structured products may at times have trading volumes large enough to provide observability of prices and other inputs. See Note 5 for an overview of the firm’s fair value measurement policies.

Level 1 Derivatives

Level 1 derivatives include short-term contracts for future delivery of securities when the underlying security is a level 1 instrument, and exchange-traded derivatives if they are actively traded and are valued at their quoted market price.

Level 2 Derivatives

Level 2 derivatives include OTC derivatives for which all significant valuation inputs are corroborated by market evidence and exchange-traded derivatives that are not actively traded and/or that are valued using models that calibrate to market-clearing levels of OTC derivatives.

The selection of a particular model to value a derivative depends on the contractual terms of and specific risks inherent in the instrument, as well as the availability of pricing information in the market. For derivatives that trade in liquid markets, model selection does not involve significant management judgment because outputs of models can be calibrated to market-clearing levels.

Valuation models require a variety of inputs, such as contractual terms, market prices, yield curves, discount rates (including those derived from interest rates on collateral received and posted as specified in credit support agreements for collateralized derivatives), credit curves, measures of volatility, prepayment rates, loss severity rates and correlations of such inputs. Significant inputs to the valuations of level 2 derivatives can be verified to market transactions, broker or dealer quotations or other alternative pricing sources with reasonable levels of price transparency. Consideration is given to the nature of the quotations (e.g., indicative or firm) and the relationship of recent market activity to the prices provided from alternative pricing sources.

Level 3 Derivatives

Level 3 derivatives are valued using models which utilize observable level 1 and/or level 2 inputs, as well as unobservable level 3 inputs. The significant unobservable inputs used to value the firm’s level 3 derivatives are described below.

 

 

For the majority of the firm’s interest rate and currency derivatives classified in level 3, significant unobservable inputs include correlations of certain currencies and interest rates (e.g., the correlation between Euro inflation and Euro interest rates) and specific interest rate volatilities.

 

 

For level 3 credit derivatives, significant unobservable inputs include illiquid credit spreads and upfront credit points, which are unique to specific reference obligations and reference entities, recovery rates and certain correlations required to value credit derivatives (e.g., the likelihood of default of the underlying reference obligation relative to one another).

 

 

For level 3 commodity derivatives, significant unobservable inputs include volatilities for options with strike prices that differ significantly from current market prices and prices or spreads for certain products for which the product quality or physical location of the commodity is not aligned with benchmark indices.

 

 

128   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

 

For level 3 equity derivatives, significant unobservable inputs generally include equity volatility inputs for options that are long-dated and/or have strike prices that differ significantly from current market prices. In addition, the valuation of certain structured trades requires the use of level 3 correlation inputs, such as the correlation of the price performance of two or more individual stocks or the correlation of the price performance for a basket of stocks to another asset class such as commodities.

Subsequent to the initial valuation of a level 3 derivative, the firm updates the level 1 and level 2 inputs to reflect observable market changes and any resulting gains and losses are classified in level 3. Level 3 inputs are changed when corroborated by evidence such as similar market transactions, third-party pricing services and/or broker or dealer quotations or other empirical market data. In circumstances where the firm cannot verify the model value by reference to market transactions, it is possible that a different valuation model could produce a materially different estimate of fair value. See below for further information about significant unobservable inputs used in the valuation of level 3 derivatives.

Valuation Adjustments

Valuation adjustments are integral to determining the fair value of derivative portfolios and are used to adjust the mid-market valuations produced by derivative pricing models to the appropriate exit price valuation. These adjustments incorporate bid/offer spreads, the cost of liquidity, credit valuation adjustments and funding valuation adjustments, which account for the credit and funding risk inherent in the uncollateralized portion of derivative portfolios. The firm also makes funding valuation adjustments to collateralized derivatives where the terms of the agreement do not permit the firm to deliver or repledge collateral received. Market-based inputs are generally used when calibrating valuation adjustments to market-clearing levels.

In addition, for derivatives that include significant unobservable inputs, the firm makes model or exit price adjustments to account for the valuation uncertainty present in the transaction.

Fair Value of Derivatives by Level

The tables below present the fair value of derivatives on a gross basis by level and major product type, as well as the impact of netting, included in the consolidated statements of financial condition.

 

    As of December 2017  
$ in millions     Level 1       Level 2       Level 3       Total  

Assets

       

Interest rates

    $   18       $ 282,933       $    311       $ 283,262  

Credit

          19,053       3,640       22,693  

Currencies

          95,401       140       95,541  

Commodities

          13,727       353       14,080  

Equities

    8       50,870       409       51,287  

Gross fair value

    26       461,984       4,853       466,863  

Counterparty netting in levels

          (362,109     (1,051     (363,160

Subtotal

    $   26       $   99,875       $ 3,802       $ 103,703  

Cross-level counterparty netting

          (894

Cash collateral netting

                            (55,472

Net fair value

                            $   47,337  

Liabilities

       

Interest rates

    $  (28     $(252,421     $   (721     $(253,170

Credit

          (19,135     (2,135     (21,270

Currencies

          (96,160     (321     (96,481

Commodities

          (15,842     (306     (16,148

Equities

    (28     (53,902     (1,658     (55,588

Gross fair value

    (56     (437,460     (5,141     (442,657

Counterparty netting in levels

          362,109       1,051       363,160  

Subtotal

    $  (56     $  (75,351     $(4,090     $  (79,497

Cross-level counterparty netting

          894  

Cash collateral netting

                            38,972  

Net fair value

                            $  (39,631
    As of December 2016  
$ in millions     Level 1       Level 2       Level 3       Total  

Assets

       

Interest rates

    $   46       $ 506,818       $    614       $ 507,478  

Credit

          21,388       4,979       26,367  

Currencies

          111,762       187       111,949  

Commodities

          11,950       403       12,353  

Equities

    1       47,667       424       48,092  

Gross fair value

    47       699,585       6,607       706,239  

Counterparty netting in levels

    (12     (564,100     (1,417     (565,529

Subtotal

    $   35       $ 135,485       $ 5,190       $ 140,710  

Cross-level counterparty netting

          (1,709

Cash collateral netting

                            (85,329

Net fair value

                            $   53,672  

Liabilities

       

Interest rates

    $  (27     $(457,963     $   (995     $(458,985

Credit

          (21,106     (2,475     (23,581

Currencies

          (107,212     (184     (107,396

Commodities

          (13,541     (330     (13,871

Equities

    (967     (49,083     (3,840     (53,890

Gross fair value

    (994     (648,905     (7,824     (657,723

Counterparty netting in levels

    12       564,100       1,417       565,529  

Subtotal

    $(982     $  (84,805     $(6,407     $  (92,194

Cross-level counterparty netting

          1,709  

Cash collateral netting

                            42,986  

Net fair value

                            $  (47,499
 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   129


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

In the tables above:

 

 

The gross fair values exclude the effects of both counterparty netting and collateral netting, and therefore are not representative of the firm’s exposure.

 

 

Counterparty netting is reflected in each level to the extent that receivable and payable balances are netted within the same level and is included in counterparty netting in levels. Where the counterparty netting is across levels, the netting is included in cross-level counterparty netting.

 

 

Derivative assets are shown as positive amounts and derivative liabilities are shown as negative amounts.

Significant Unobservable Inputs

The table below presents the amount of level 3 assets (liabilities), and ranges, averages and medians of significant unobservable inputs used to value the firm’s level 3 derivatives.

 

    Level 3 Assets (Liabilities) and Range of Significant
Unobservable Inputs (Average/Median) as of  December
 
$ in millions     2017       2016  

Interest rates, net

    $(410)       $(381)  

 

Correlation

    (10)% to 95% (71%/79%)       (10)% to 86% (56%/60%)  

 

Volatility (bps)

    31 to 150 (84/78)       31 to 151 (84/57)  

Credit, net

    $1,505        $2,504   

 

Correlation

    28% to 84% (61%/60%)       35% to 91% (65%/68%)  

 

Credit spreads (bps)

    1 to 633 (69/42)       1 to 993 (122/73)  

 

Upfront credit points

    0 to 97 (42/38)       0 to 100 (43/35)  

 

Recovery rates

    22% to 73% (68%/73%)       1% to 97% (58%/70%)  

Currencies, net

    $(181)       $3   

 

Correlation

    49% to 72% (61%/62%)       25% to 70% (50%/55%)  

Commodities, net

    $47        $73   

 

Volatility

    9% to 79% (24%/24%)       13% to 68% (33%/33%)  

Natural gas spread

 

 

 

 

$(2.38) to $3.34 

($(0.22)/$(0.12))

 

 

 

   

$(1.81) to $4.33 

($(0.14)/$(0.05))

 

 

Oil spread

 

 

 

 

$(2.86) to $23.61 

($6.47/$2.35)

 

 

 

   
$(19.72) to $64.92 
($25.30/$16.43)
 
 

Equities, net

    $(1,249)       $(3,416)  

 

Correlation

    (36)% to 94% (50%/52%)       (39)% to 88% (41%/41%)  

 

Volatility

    4% to 72% (24%/22%)       5% to 72% (24%/23%)  

In the table above:

 

 

Derivative assets are shown as positive amounts and derivative liabilities are shown as negative amounts.

 

 

Ranges represent the significant unobservable inputs that were used in the valuation of each type of derivative.

 

 

Averages represent the arithmetic average of the inputs and are not weighted by the relative fair value or notional of the respective financial instruments. An average greater than the median indicates that the majority of inputs are below the average. For example, the difference between the average and the median for credit spreads and oil spread inputs indicates that the majority of the inputs fall in the lower end of the range.

 

The ranges, averages and medians of these inputs are not representative of the appropriate inputs to use when calculating the fair value of any one derivative. For example, the highest correlation for interest rate derivatives is appropriate for valuing a specific interest rate derivative but may not be appropriate for valuing any other interest rate derivative. Accordingly, the ranges of inputs do not represent uncertainty in, or possible ranges of, fair value measurements of the firm’s level 3 derivatives.

 

 

Interest rates, currencies and equities derivatives are valued using option pricing models, credit derivatives are valued using option pricing, correlation and discounted cash flow models, and commodities derivatives are valued using option pricing and discounted cash flow models.

 

 

The fair value of any one instrument may be determined using multiple valuation techniques. For example, option pricing models and discounted cash flows models are typically used together to determine fair value. Therefore, the level 3 balance encompasses both of these techniques.

 

 

Correlation within currencies and equities includes cross-product type correlation.

 

 

Natural gas spread represents the spread per million British thermal units of natural gas.

 

 

Oil spread represents the spread per barrel of oil and refined products.

Range of Significant Unobservable Inputs

The following is information about the ranges of significant unobservable inputs used to value the firm’s level 3 derivative instruments:

 

 

Correlation. Ranges for correlation cover a variety of underliers both within one product type (e.g., equity index and equity single stock names) and across product types (e.g., correlation of an interest rate and a currency), as well as across regions. Generally, cross-product type correlation inputs are used to value more complex instruments and are lower than correlation inputs on assets within the same derivative product type.

 

 

Volatility. Ranges for volatility cover numerous underliers across a variety of markets, maturities and strike prices. For example, volatility of equity indices is generally lower than volatility of single stocks.

 

 

Credit spreads, upfront credit points and recovery rates. The ranges for credit spreads, upfront credit points and recovery rates cover a variety of underliers (index and single names), regions, sectors, maturities and credit qualities (high-yield and investment-grade). The broad range of this population gives rise to the width of the ranges of significant unobservable inputs.

 

 

130   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

 

Commodity prices and spreads. The ranges for commodity prices and spreads cover variability in products, maturities and delivery locations.

Sensitivity of Fair Value Measurement to Changes in Significant Unobservable Inputs

The following is a description of the directional sensitivity of the firm’s level 3 fair value measurements to changes in significant unobservable inputs, in isolation:

 

 

Correlation. In general, for contracts where the holder benefits from the convergence of the underlying asset or index prices (e.g., interest rates, credit spreads, foreign exchange rates, inflation rates and equity prices), an increase in correlation results in a higher fair value measurement.

 

 

Volatility. In general, for purchased options, an increase in volatility results in a higher fair value measurement.

 

 

Credit spreads, upfront credit points and recovery rates. In general, the fair value of purchased credit protection increases as credit spreads or upfront credit points increase or recovery rates decrease. Credit spreads, upfront credit points and recovery rates are strongly related to distinctive risk factors of the underlying reference obligations, which include reference entity-specific factors such as leverage, volatility and industry, market-based risk factors, such as borrowing costs or liquidity of the underlying reference obligation, and macroeconomic conditions.

 

 

Commodity prices and spreads. In general, for contracts where the holder is receiving a commodity, an increase in the spread (price difference from a benchmark index due to differences in quality or delivery location) or price results in a higher fair value measurement.

Due to the distinctive nature of each of the firm’s level 3 derivatives, the interrelationship of inputs is not necessarily uniform within each product type.

Level 3 Rollforward

The table below presents a summary of the changes in fair value for all level 3 derivatives.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Total level 3 derivatives

    

Beginning balance

    $(1,217      $    495  

Net realized gains/(losses)

    (119      (37

Net unrealized gains/(losses)

    (436      777  

Purchases

    301        115  

Sales

    (611      (3,557

Settlements

    1,891        782  

Transfers into level 3

    (39      352  

Transfers out of level 3

    (58      (144

Ending balance

    $   (288      $(1,217

In the table above:

 

 

Changes in fair value are presented for all derivative assets and liabilities that are classified in level 3 as of the end of the period.

 

 

Net unrealized gains/(losses) relates to instruments that were still held at period-end.

 

 

If a derivative was transferred into level 3 during a reporting period, its entire gain or loss for the period is classified in level 3. Transfers between levels are reported at the beginning of the reporting period in which they occur.

 

 

Positive amounts for transfers into level 3 and negative amounts for transfers out of level 3 represent net transfers of derivative assets. Negative amounts for transfers into level 3 and positive amounts for transfers out of level 3 represent net transfers of derivative liabilities.

 

 

A derivative with level 1 and/or level 2 inputs is classified in level 3 in its entirety if it has at least one significant level 3 input.

 

 

If there is one significant level 3 input, the entire gain or loss from adjusting only observable inputs (i.e., level 1 and level 2 inputs) is classified in level 3.

 

 

Gains or losses that have been classified in level 3 resulting from changes in level 1 or level 2 inputs are frequently offset by gains or losses attributable to level 1 or level 2 derivatives and/or level 1, level 2 and level 3 cash instruments. As a result, gains/(losses) included in the level 3 rollforward below do not necessarily represent the overall impact on the firm’s results of operations, liquidity or capital resources.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   131


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The table below disaggregates, by major product type, the information for level 3 derivatives included in the summary table above.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Interest rates, net

    

Beginning balance

    $   (381      $   (398

Net realized gains/(losses)

    (62      (41

Net unrealized gains/(losses)

    20        (138

Purchases

    4        5  

Sales

    (14      (3

Settlements

    30        36  

Transfers into level 3

    (12      195  

Transfers out of level 3

    5        (37

Ending balance

    $   (410      $   (381

Credit, net

    

Beginning balance

    $ 2,504        $ 2,793  

Net realized gains/(losses)

    42         

Net unrealized gains/(losses)

    (188      196  

Purchases

    20        20  

Sales

    (27      (73

Settlements

    (739      (516

Transfers into level 3

    3        179  

Transfers out of level 3

    (110      (95

Ending balance

    $ 1,505        $ 2,504  

Currencies, net

    

Beginning balance

    $        3        $     (34

Net realized gains/(losses)

    (39      (30

Net unrealized gains/(losses)

    (192      (42

Purchases

    4        14  

Sales

    (3      (2

Settlements

    62        90  

Transfers into level 3

    (9      1  

Transfers out of level 3

    (7      6  

Ending balance

    $   (181      $        3  

Commodities, net

    

Beginning balance

    $      73        $   (262

Net realized gains/(losses)

    (4      (23

Net unrealized gains/(losses)

    216        101  

Purchases

    102        24  

Sales

    (301      (119

Settlements

    (27      391  

Transfers into level 3

    (25      (23

Transfers out of level 3

    13        (16

Ending balance

    $      47        $      73  

Equities, net

    

Beginning balance

    $(3,416      $(1,604

Net realized gains/(losses)

    (56      57  

Net unrealized gains/(losses)

    (292      660  

Purchases

    171        52  

Sales

    (266      (3,360

Settlements

    2,565        781  

Transfers into level 3

    4         

Transfers out of level 3

    41        (2

Ending balance

    $(1,249      $(3,416

Level 3 Rollforward Commentary

Year Ended December 2017. The net realized and unrealized losses on level 3 derivatives of $555 million (reflecting $119 million of net realized losses and $436 million of net unrealized losses) for 2017 included losses of $90 million and $465 million reported in market making and other principal transactions, respectively.

The net unrealized losses on level 3 derivatives for 2017 were primarily attributable to losses on certain equity derivatives, reflecting the impact of changes in equity prices, losses on certain currency derivatives, primarily reflecting the impact of changes in foreign exchanges rates, and losses on certain credit derivatives, reflecting the impact of tighter credit spreads, partially offset by gains on certain commodity derivatives, reflecting the impact of an increase in commodity prices.

Transfers into level 3 derivatives during 2017 were not material.

Transfers out of level 3 derivatives during 2017 primarily reflected transfers of certain credit derivatives assets to level 2, principally due to certain unobservable inputs no longer being significant to the valuation of these derivatives.

Year Ended December 2016. The net realized and unrealized gains on level 3 derivatives of $740 million (reflecting $37 million of net realized losses and $777 million of net unrealized gains) for 2016 included gains/(losses) of approximately $980 million and $(240) million reported in market making and other principal transactions, respectively.

The net unrealized gains on level 3 derivatives for 2016 were primarily attributable to gains on certain equity derivatives, reflecting the impact of an increase in equity prices.

Transfers into level 3 derivatives during 2016 primarily reflected transfers of certain interest rate derivative assets from level 2, principally due to reduced transparency of certain unobservable inputs used to value these derivatives, and transfers of certain credit derivative assets from level 2 primarily due to unobservable credit spread inputs becoming significant to the net risk of certain portfolios.

Transfers out of level 3 derivatives during 2016 primarily reflected transfers of certain credit derivatives assets to level 2, primarily due to unobservable credit spread inputs no longer being significant to the net risk of certain portfolios.

 

 

132   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

OTC Derivatives

The table below presents the fair values of OTC derivative assets and liabilities by tenor and major product type.

 

$ in millions    
Less than
1 Year
 
 
   
1 - 5
Years
 
 
   
Greater than
5 Years
 
 
    Total  

As of December 2017

       

Assets

       

Interest rates

    $  3,717       $15,445       $57,200       $  76,362  

Credit

    760       4,079       3,338       8,177  

Currencies

    12,184       6,219       7,245       25,648  

Commodities

    3,175       2,526       181       5,882  

Equities

    4,969       5,607       1,387       11,963  

Counterparty netting in tenors

    (3,719     (4,594     (2,807     (11,120

Subtotal

    $21,086       $29,282       $66,544       $116,912  

Cross-tenor counterparty netting

 

        (16,404

Cash collateral netting

                            (55,472

Total

                            $  45,036  

Liabilities

       

Interest rates

    $  4,517       $  8,471       $33,193       $  46,181  

Credit

    2,078       3,588       1,088       6,754  

Currencies

    14,326       7,119       4,802       26,247  

Commodities

    3,599       2,167       2,465       8,231  

Equities

    6,453       6,647       3,381       16,481  

Counterparty netting in tenors

    (3,719     (4,594     (2,807     (11,120

Subtotal

    $27,254       $23,398       $42,122       $  92,774  

Cross-tenor counterparty netting

 

        (16,404

Cash collateral netting

                            (38,972

Total

                            $  37,398  

 

As of December 2016

       

Assets

       

Interest rates

    $  5,845       $18,376       $79,507       $103,728  

Credit

    1,763       2,695       4,889       9,347  

Currencies

    18,344       8,292       8,428       35,064  

Commodities

    3,273       1,415       179       4,867  

Equities

    3,141       9,249       1,341       13,731  

Counterparty netting in tenors

    (3,543     (5,550     (3,794     (12,887

Subtotal

    $28,823       $34,477       $90,550       $153,850  

Cross-tenor counterparty netting

 

        (17,396

Cash collateral netting

                            (85,329

Total

                            $  51,125  

Liabilities

       

Interest rates

    $  5,679       $10,814       $38,812       $  55,305  

Credit

    2,060       3,328       1,167       6,555  

Currencies

    14,720       9,771       5,879       30,370  

Commodities

    2,546       1,555       2,315       6,416  

Equities

    7,000       10,426       2,614       20,040  

Counterparty netting in tenors

    (3,543     (5,550     (3,794     (12,887

Subtotal

    $28,462       $30,344       $46,993       $105,799  

Cross-tenor counterparty netting

 

        (17,396

Cash collateral netting

                            (42,986

Total

                            $  45,417  

In the table above:

 

 

Tenor is based on expected duration for mortgage-related credit derivatives and generally on remaining contractual maturity for other derivatives.

 

 

Counterparty netting within the same product type and tenor category is included within such product type and tenor category.

 

 

Counterparty netting across product types within the same tenor category is included in counterparty netting in tenors. Where the counterparty netting is across tenor categories, the netting is included in cross-tenor counterparty netting.

Credit Derivatives

The firm enters into a broad array of credit derivatives in locations around the world to facilitate client transactions and to manage the credit risk associated with market-making and investing and lending activities. Credit derivatives are actively managed based on the firm’s net risk position.

Credit derivatives are generally individually negotiated contracts and can have various settlement and payment conventions. Credit events include failure to pay, bankruptcy, acceleration of indebtedness, restructuring, repudiation and dissolution of the reference entity.

The firm enters into the following types of credit derivatives:

 

 

Credit Default Swaps. Single-name credit default swaps protect the buyer against the loss of principal on one or more bonds, loans or mortgages (reference obligations) in the event the issuer (reference entity) of the reference obligations suffers a credit event. The buyer of protection pays an initial or periodic premium to the seller and receives protection for the period of the contract. If there is no credit event, as defined in the contract, the seller of protection makes no payments to the buyer of protection. However, if a credit event occurs, the seller of protection is required to make a payment to the buyer of protection, which is calculated in accordance with the terms of the contract.

 

 

Credit Options. In a credit option, the option writer assumes the obligation to purchase or sell a reference obligation at a specified price or credit spread. The option purchaser buys the right, but does not assume the obligation, to sell the reference obligation to, or purchase it from, the option writer. The payments on credit options depend either on a particular credit spread or the price of the reference obligation.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   133


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

 

Credit Indices, Baskets and Tranches. Credit derivatives may reference a basket of single-name credit default swaps or a broad-based index. If a credit event occurs in one of the underlying reference obligations, the protection seller pays the protection buyer. The payment is typically a pro-rata portion of the transaction’s total notional amount based on the underlying defaulted reference obligation. In certain transactions, the credit risk of a basket or index is separated into various portions (tranches), each having different levels of subordination. The most junior tranches cover initial defaults and once losses exceed the notional amount of these junior tranches, any excess loss is covered by the next most senior tranche in the capital structure.

 

 

Total Return Swaps. A total return swap transfers the risks relating to economic performance of a reference obligation from the protection buyer to the protection seller. Typically, the protection buyer receives from the protection seller a floating rate of interest and protection against any reduction in fair value of the reference obligation, and in return the protection seller receives the cash flows associated with the reference obligation, plus any increase in the fair value of the reference obligation.

The firm economically hedges its exposure to written credit derivatives primarily by entering into offsetting purchased credit derivatives with identical underliers. Substantially all of the firm’s purchased credit derivative transactions are with financial institutions and are subject to stringent collateral thresholds. In addition, upon the occurrence of a specified trigger event, the firm may take possession of the reference obligations underlying a particular written credit derivative, and consequently may, upon liquidation of the reference obligations, recover amounts on the underlying reference obligations in the event of default.

As of December 2017, written and purchased credit derivatives had total gross notional amounts of $611.04 billion and $643.37 billion, respectively, for total net notional purchased protection of $32.33 billion. As of December 2016, written and purchased credit derivatives had total gross notional amounts of $690.47 billion and $733.98 billion, respectively, for total net notional purchased protection of $43.51 billion. Substantially all of the firm’s written and purchased credit derivatives are credit default swaps.

The table below presents certain information about credit derivatives.

 

    Credit Spread on Underlier (basis points)  
$ in millions     0 - 250      
251 -
500
 
 
   
501 -
1,000
 
 
   

Greater
than
1,000
 
 
 
    Total  

As of December 2017

 

       

Maximum Payout/Notional Amount of Written Credit Derivatives by Tenor

 

Less than 1 year

    $182,446       $  8,531       $     705       $  4,067       $195,749  

1 – 5 years

    335,872       10,201       8,747       7,553       362,373  

Greater than 5 years

    49,440       2,142       817       519       52,918  

Total

    $567,758       $20,874       $10,269       $12,139       $611,040  

Maximum Payout/Notional Amount of Purchased Credit Derivatives

 

Offsetting

    $492,325       $13,424       $  9,395       $10,663       $525,807  

Other

    99,861       14,483       1,777       1,442       117,563  

Fair Value of Written Credit Derivatives

 

Asset

    $  14,317       $     513       $     208       $     155       $  15,193  

Liability

    896       402       752       3,920       5,970  

Net asset/(liability)

    $  13,421       $     111       $    (544     $ (3,765     $    9,223  

 

As of December 2016

 

       

Maximum Payout/Notional Amount of Written Credit Derivatives by Tenor

 

Less than 1 year

    $207,727       $  5,819       $  1,016       $  8,629       $223,191  

1 – 5 years

    375,208       17,255       8,643       7,986       409,092  

Greater than 5 years

    52,977       3,928       1,045       233       58,183  

Total

    $635,912       $27,002       $10,704       $16,848       $690,466  

Maximum Payout/Notional Amount of Purchased Credit Derivatives

 

Offsetting

    $558,305       $20,588       $10,133       $15,186       $604,212  

Other

    119,509       7,712       1,098       1,446       129,765  

Fair Value of Written Credit Derivatives

 

Asset

    $  13,919       $     606       $     187       $       45       $  14,757  

Liability

    2,436       902       809       5,686       9,833  

Net asset/(liability)

    $  11,483       $    (296     $    (622     $ (5,641     $    4,924  

In the table above:

 

 

Fair values exclude the effects of both netting of receivable balances with payable balances under enforceable netting agreements, and netting of cash received or posted under enforceable credit support agreements, and therefore are not representative of the firm’s credit exposure.

 

 

Tenor is based on expected duration for mortgage-related credit derivatives and on remaining contractual maturity for other credit derivatives.

 

 

The credit spread on the underlier, together with the tenor of the contract, are indicators of payment/performance risk. The firm is less likely to pay or otherwise be required to perform where the credit spread and the tenor are lower.

 

 

Offsetting purchased credit derivatives represent the notional amount of purchased credit derivatives that economically hedge written credit derivatives with identical underliers and are included in offsetting.

 

 

Other purchased credit derivatives represent the notional amount of all other purchased credit derivatives not included in offsetting.

 

 

134   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Impact of Credit Spreads on Derivatives

On an ongoing basis, the firm realizes gains or losses relating to changes in credit risk through the unwind of derivative contracts and changes in credit mitigants.

The net gain, including hedges, attributable to the impact of changes in credit exposure and credit spreads (counterparty and the firm’s) on derivatives was $66 million for 2017, $85 million for 2016 and $9 million for 2015.

Bifurcated Embedded Derivatives

The table below presents the fair value and the notional amount of derivatives that have been bifurcated from their related borrowings.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Fair value of assets

    $   882        $   676  

Fair value of liabilities

    1,200        864  

Net liability

    $   318        $   188  

 

Notional amount

    $9,578        $8,726  

In the table above, these derivatives, which are recorded at fair value, primarily consist of interest rate, equity and commodity products and are included in unsecured short-term borrowings and unsecured long-term borrowings with the related borrowings. See Note 8 for further information.

Derivatives with Credit-Related Contingent Features

Certain of the firm’s derivatives have been transacted under bilateral agreements with counterparties who may require the firm to post collateral or terminate the transactions based on changes in the firm’s credit ratings. The firm assesses the impact of these bilateral agreements by determining the collateral or termination payments that would occur assuming a downgrade by all rating agencies. A downgrade by any one rating agency, depending on the agency’s relative ratings of the firm at the time of the downgrade, may have an impact which is comparable to the impact of a downgrade by all rating agencies.

The table below presents the aggregate fair value of net derivative liabilities under such agreements (excluding application of collateral posted to reduce these liabilities), the related aggregate fair value of the assets posted as collateral and the additional collateral or termination payments that could have been called by counterparties in the event of a one-notch and two-notch downgrade in the firm’s credit ratings.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017       2016  

Net derivative liabilities under bilateral agreements

    $29,877       $32,927  

Collateral posted

    $25,329       $27,840  

Additional collateral or termination payments:

   

One-notch downgrade

    $     358       $     677  

Two-notch downgrade

    $  1,856       $  2,216  

Hedge Accounting

The firm applies hedge accounting for (i) certain interest rate swaps used to manage the interest rate exposure of certain fixed-rate unsecured long-term and short-term borrowings and certain fixed-rate certificates of deposit and (ii) certain foreign currency forward contracts and foreign currency-denominated debt used to manage foreign currency exposures on the firm’s net investment in certain non-U.S. operations.

To qualify for hedge accounting, the hedging instrument must be highly effective at reducing the risk from the exposure being hedged. Additionally, the firm must formally document the hedging relationship at inception and test the hedging relationship at least on a quarterly basis to ensure the hedging instrument continues to be highly effective over the life of the hedging relationship.

Fair Value Hedges

The firm designates certain interest rate swaps as fair value hedges of certain fixed-rate unsecured long-term and short-term debt and fixed-rate certificates of deposit. These interest rate swaps hedge changes in fair value attributable to the designated benchmark interest rate (e.g., London Interbank Offered Rate (LIBOR) or Overnight Index Swap Rate), effectively converting a substantial portion of fixed-rate obligations into floating-rate obligations.

The firm applies a statistical method that utilizes regression analysis when assessing the effectiveness of its fair value hedging relationships in achieving offsetting changes in the fair values of the hedging instrument and the risk being hedged (i.e., interest rate risk). An interest rate swap is considered highly effective in offsetting changes in fair value attributable to changes in the hedged risk when the regression analysis results in a coefficient of determination of 80% or greater and a slope between 80% and 125%.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   135


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

For qualifying fair value hedges, gains or losses on derivatives are included in interest expense. The change in fair value of the hedged item attributable to the risk being hedged is reported as an adjustment to its carrying value and is subsequently amortized into interest expense over its remaining life. Gains or losses resulting from hedge ineffectiveness are included in interest expense. When a derivative is no longer designated as a hedge, any remaining difference between the carrying value and par value of the hedged item is amortized to interest expense over the remaining life of the hedged item using the effective interest method. See Note 23 for further information about interest income and interest expense.

The table below presents the gains/(losses) from interest rate derivatives accounted for as hedges, the related hedged borrowings and deposits, and the hedge ineffectiveness on these derivatives, which primarily consists of amortization of prepaid credit spreads resulting from the passage of time.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017        2016        2015  

Interest rate hedges

    $(2,867      $(1,480      $(1,613

Hedged borrowings and deposits

    2,183        834        898  

Hedge ineffectiveness

    $   (684      $   (646      $   (715

Net Investment Hedges

The firm seeks to reduce the impact of fluctuations in foreign exchange rates on its net investments in certain non-U.S. operations through the use of foreign currency forward contracts and foreign currency-denominated debt. For foreign currency forward contracts designated as hedges, the effectiveness of the hedge is assessed based on the overall changes in the fair value of the forward contracts (i.e., based on changes in forward rates). For foreign currency-denominated debt designated as a hedge, the effectiveness of the hedge is assessed based on changes in spot rates.

For qualifying net investment hedges, the gains or losses on the hedging instruments, to the extent effective, are included in currency translation.

The table below presents the gains/(losses) from net investment hedging.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017        2016        2015  

Hedges:

       

Foreign currency forward contract

    $(805      $135        $695  

Foreign currency-denominated debt

    $  (67      $ (85      $   (9

The gain/(loss) related to ineffectiveness was not material for 2017, 2016 or 2015. The net gain/(loss) reclassified to earnings from accumulated other comprehensive income was $41 million (reflecting a gain of $205 million related to hedges and a loss of $164 million on the related net investments in non-U.S. operations) for 2017, $28 million (reflecting a gain of $167 million related to hedges and a loss of $139 million on the related net investments in non-U.S. operations) for 2016 and not material for 2015.

As of December 2017 and December 2016, the firm had designated $1.81 billion and $1.69 billion, respectively, of foreign currency-denominated debt, included in unsecured long-term borrowings and unsecured short-term borrowings, as hedges of net investments in non-U.S. subsidiaries.

Note 8.

Fair Value Option

Other Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities at Fair Value

In addition to all cash and derivative instruments included in financial instruments owned and financial instruments sold, but not yet purchased, the firm accounts for certain of its other financial assets and financial liabilities at fair value, substantially all of which are accounted for at fair value under the fair value option. The primary reasons for electing the fair value option are to:

 

 

Reflect economic events in earnings on a timely basis;

 

 

Mitigate volatility in earnings from using different measurement attributes (e.g., transfers of financial instruments owned accounted for as financings are recorded at fair value, whereas the related secured financing would be recorded on an accrual basis absent electing the fair value option); and

 

 

Address simplification and cost-benefit considerations (e.g., accounting for hybrid financial instruments at fair value in their entirety versus bifurcation of embedded derivatives and hedge accounting for debt hosts).

 

 

136   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Hybrid financial instruments are instruments that contain bifurcatable embedded derivatives and do not require settlement by physical delivery of nonfinancial assets (e.g., physical commodities). If the firm elects to bifurcate the embedded derivative from the associated debt, the derivative is accounted for at fair value and the host contract is accounted for at amortized cost, adjusted for the effective portion of any fair value hedges. If the firm does not elect to bifurcate, the entire hybrid financial instrument is accounted for at fair value under the fair value option.

Other financial assets and financial liabilities accounted for at fair value under the fair value option include:

 

 

Repurchase agreements and substantially all resale agreements;

 

 

Securities borrowed and loaned within Fixed Income, Currency and Commodities Client Execution (FICC Client Execution);

 

 

Substantially all other secured financings, including transfers of assets accounted for as financings rather than sales;

 

 

Certain unsecured short-term and long-term borrowings, substantially all of which are hybrid financial instruments;

 

 

Certain receivables from customers and counterparties, including transfers of assets accounted for as secured loans rather than purchases and certain margin loans;

 

 

Certain time deposits issued by the firm’s bank subsidiaries (deposits with no stated maturity are not eligible for a fair value option election), including structured certificates of deposit, which are hybrid financial instruments; and

 

 

Certain subordinated liabilities of consolidated VIEs.

Fair Value of Other Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities by Level

The table below presents, by level within the fair value hierarchy, other financial assets and financial liabilities at fair value, substantially all of which are accounted for at fair value under the fair value option.

 

$ in millions     Level 1       Level 2       Level 3       Total  

As of December 2017

       

Assets

       

Securities purchased under agreements to resell

    $  –       $ 120,420       $          –       $ 120,420  

Securities borrowed

          78,189             78,189  

Receivables from customers and counterparties

          3,522       4       3,526  

Total

    $  –       $ 202,131       $          4       $ 202,135  

Liabilities

       

Deposits

    $  –       $  (19,934     $  (2,968     $  (22,902

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

          (84,681     (37     (84,718

Securities loaned

          (5,357           (5,357

Other secured financings

          (23,956     (389     (24,345

Unsecured borrowings:

       

Short-term

          (12,310     (4,594     (16,904

Long-term

          (31,204     (7,434     (38,638

Other liabilities and accrued
expenses

          (228     (40     (268

Total

    $  –       $(177,670     $(15,462     $(193,132

 

As of December 2016

       

Assets

       

Securities purchased under agreements to resell

    $  –       $ 116,077       $          –       $ 116,077  

Securities borrowed

          82,398             82,398  

Receivables from customers and counterparties

          3,211       55       3,266  

Total

    $  –       $ 201,686       $        55       $ 201,741  

Liabilities

       

Deposits

    $  –       $  (10,609     $  (3,173     $  (13,782

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

          (71,750     (66     (71,816

Securities loaned

          (2,647           (2,647

Other secured financings

          (20,516     (557     (21,073

Unsecured borrowings:

       

Short-term

          (10,896     (3,896     (14,792

Long-term

          (22,185     (7,225     (29,410

Other liabilities and accrued
expenses

          (559     (62     (621

Total

    $  –       $(139,162     $(14,979     $(154,141

In the table above, other financial assets are shown as positive amounts and other financial liabilities are shown as negative amounts.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   137


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Valuation Techniques and Significant Inputs

Other financial assets and financial liabilities at fair value are generally valued based on discounted cash flow techniques, which incorporate inputs with reasonable levels of price transparency, and are generally classified in level 2 because the inputs are observable. Valuation adjustments may be made for liquidity and for counterparty and the firm’s credit quality.

See below for information about the significant inputs used to value other financial assets and financial liabilities at fair value, including the ranges of significant unobservable inputs used to value the level 3 instruments within these categories. These ranges represent the significant unobservable inputs that were used in the valuation of each type of other financial assets and financial liabilities at fair value. The ranges and weighted averages of these inputs are not representative of the appropriate inputs to use when calculating the fair value of any one instrument. For example, the highest yield presented below for other secured financings is appropriate for valuing a specific agreement in that category but may not be appropriate for valuing any other agreements in that category. Accordingly, the ranges of inputs presented below do not represent uncertainty in, or possible ranges of, fair value measurements of the firm’s level 3 other financial assets and financial liabilities.

Resale and Repurchase Agreements and Securities Borrowed and Loaned. The significant inputs to the valuation of resale and repurchase agreements and securities borrowed and loaned are funding spreads, the amount and timing of expected future cash flows and interest rates. As of both December 2017 and December 2016, the firm had no level 3 resale agreements, securities borrowed or securities loaned. As of both December 2017 and December 2016, the firm’s level 3 repurchase agreements were not material. See Note 10 for further information about collateralized agreements and financings.

Other Secured Financings. The significant inputs to the valuation of other secured financings at fair value are the amount and timing of expected future cash flows, interest rates, funding spreads, the fair value of the collateral delivered by the firm (which is determined using the amount and timing of expected future cash flows, market prices, market yields and recovery assumptions) and the frequency of additional collateral calls. The ranges of significant unobservable inputs used to value level 3 other secured financings are as follows:

As of December 2017:

 

 

Yield: 0.6% to 13.0% (weighted average: 3.3%)

 

 

Duration: 0.7 to 11.0 years (weighted average: 2.7 years)

As of December 2016:

 

 

Yield: 0.4% to 16.6% (weighted average: 3.5%)

 

 

Duration: 0.1 to 5.7 years (weighted average: 2.3 years)

Generally, increases in funding spreads, yield or duration, in isolation, would result in a lower fair value measurement. Due to the distinctive nature of each of the firm’s level 3 other secured financings, the interrelationship of inputs is not necessarily uniform across such financings. See Note 10 for further information about collateralized agreements and financings.

Unsecured Short-term and Long-term Borrowings. The significant inputs to the valuation of unsecured short-term and long-term borrowings at fair value are the amount and timing of expected future cash flows, interest rates, the credit spreads of the firm, as well as commodity prices in the case of prepaid commodity transactions. The inputs used to value the embedded derivative component of hybrid financial instruments are consistent with the inputs used to value the firm’s other derivative instruments. See Note 7 for further information about derivatives. See Notes 15 and 16 for further information about unsecured short-term and long-term borrowings, respectively.

Certain of the firm’s unsecured short-term and long-term borrowings are classified in level 3, substantially all of which are hybrid financial instruments. As the significant unobservable inputs used to value hybrid financial instruments primarily relate to the embedded derivative component of these borrowings, these inputs are incorporated in the firm’s derivative disclosures related to unobservable inputs in Note 7.

 

 

138   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Receivables from Customers and Counterparties. Receivables from customers and counterparties at fair value primarily consist of transfers of assets accounted for as secured loans rather than purchases. The significant inputs to the valuation of such receivables are commodity prices, interest rates, the amount and timing of expected future cash flows and funding spreads. As of both December 2017 and December 2016, the firm’s level 3 receivables from customers and counterparties were not material.

Deposits. The significant inputs to the valuation of time deposits are interest rates and the amount and timing of future cash flows. The inputs used to value the embedded derivative component of hybrid financial instruments are consistent with the inputs used to value the firm’s other derivative instruments. See Note 7 for further information about derivatives and Note 14 for further information about deposits.

The firm’s deposits that are classified in level 3 are hybrid financial instruments. As the significant unobservable inputs used to value hybrid financial instruments primarily relate to the embedded derivative component of these deposits, these inputs are incorporated in the firm’s derivative disclosures related to unobservable inputs in Note 7.

Transfers Between Levels of the Fair Value Hierarchy

Transfers between levels of the fair value hierarchy are reported at the beginning of the reporting period in which they occur. There were no transfers of other financial assets and financial liabilities between level 1 and level 2 during both 2017 and 2016. See “Level 3 Rollforward” below for information about transfers between level 2 and level 3.

Level 3 Rollforward

The table below presents a summary of the changes in fair value for level 3 other financial assets and financial liabilities accounted for at fair value.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Total other financial assets

    

Beginning balance

    $         55        $         45  

Net realized gains/(losses)

           6  

Net unrealized gains/(losses)

           1  

Purchases

    1        10  

Settlements

    (52      (7

Ending balance

    $           4        $         55  

Total other financial liabilities

    

Beginning balance

    $(14,979      $(11,244

Net realized gains/(losses)

    (362      (99

Net unrealized gains/(losses)

    (1,047      (7

Purchases

    (3      (8

Sales

    1         

Issuances

    (8,382      (10,236

Settlements

    6,859        5,983  

Transfers into level 3

    (611      (759

Transfers out of level 3

    3,062        1,391  

Ending balance

    $(15,462      $(14,979

In the table above:

 

 

Changes in fair value are presented for all other financial assets and financial liabilities that are classified in level 3 as of the end of the period.

 

 

Net unrealized gains/(losses) relates to instruments that were still held at period-end.

 

 

If a financial asset or financial liability was transferred to level 3 during a reporting period, its entire gain or loss for the period is classified in level 3. For level 3 other financial assets, increases are shown as positive amounts, while decreases are shown as negative amounts. For level 3 other financial liabilities, increases are shown as negative amounts, while decreases are shown as positive amounts.

 

 

Level 3 other financial assets and financial liabilities are frequently economically hedged with cash instruments and derivatives. Accordingly, gains or losses that are classified in level 3 can be partially offset by gains or losses attributable to level 1, 2 or 3 cash instruments or derivatives. As a result, gains or losses included in the level 3 rollforward below do not necessarily represent the overall impact on the firm’s results of operations, liquidity or capital resources.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   139


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The table below disaggregates, by the consolidated statements of financial condition line items, the information for other financial liabilities included in the summary table above.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Deposits

    

Beginning balance

    $(3,173      $(2,215

Net realized gains/(losses)

    (6      (22

Net unrealized gains/(losses)

    (239      (89

Issuances

    (661      (993

Settlements

    232        146  

Transfers out of level 3

    879         

Ending balance

    $(2,968      $(3,173

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

 

Beginning balance

    $     (66      $     (71

Net unrealized gains/(losses)

    (1      (6

Settlements

    30        11  

Ending balance

    $     (37      $     (66

Other secured financings

    

Beginning balance

    $   (557      $   (549

Net realized gains/(losses)

    17        (8

Net unrealized gains/(losses)

    (40      (3

Purchases

    (3      (5

Sales

    1         

Issuances

    (32      (150

Settlements

    171        273  

Transfers into level 3

    (12      (117

Transfers out of level 3

    66        2  

Ending balance

    $   (389      $   (557

Unsecured short-term borrowings

    

Beginning balance

    $(3,896      $(4,133

Net realized gains/(losses)

    (332      (57

Net unrealized gains/(losses)

    (230      (115

Issuances

    (4,599      (3,837

Settlements

    3,675        3,492  

Transfers into level 3

    (131      (370

Transfers out of level 3

    919        1,124  

Ending balance

    $(4,594      $(3,896

Unsecured long-term borrowings

    

Beginning balance

    $(7,225      $(4,224

Net realized gains/(losses)

    (60      (27

Net unrealized gains/(losses)

    (559      190  

Purchases

           (3

Issuances

    (3,071      (5,201

Settlements

    2,751        2,047  

Transfers into level 3

    (468      (272

Transfers out of level 3

    1,198        265  

Ending balance

    $(7,434      $(7,225

Other liabilities and accrued expenses

    

Beginning balance

    $     (62      $     (52

Net realized gains/(losses)

    19        15  

Net unrealized gains/(losses)

    22        16  

Issuances

    (19      (55

Settlements

           14  

Ending balance

    $     (40      $     (62

Level 3 Rollforward Commentary

Year Ended December 2017. The net realized and unrealized losses on level 3 other financial liabilities of $1.41 billion (reflecting $362 million of net realized losses and $1.05 billion of net unrealized losses) for 2017 included losses of $1.20 billion, $45 million and $10 million reported in market making, other principal transactions and interest expense, respectively, in the consolidated statements of earnings, and losses of $149 million reported in debt valuation adjustment in the consolidated statements of comprehensive income.

The net unrealized losses on level 3 other financial liabilities for 2017 primarily reflected losses on certain hybrid financial instruments included in unsecured long-term and short-term borrowings, principally due to an increase in global equity prices and the impact of tighter credit spreads, and losses on certain hybrid financial instruments included in deposits, principally due to the impact of an increase in the market value of the underlying assets.

Transfers into level 3 of other financial liabilities during 2017 primarily reflected transfers of certain hybrid financial instruments included in unsecured long-term borrowings from level 2, principally due to reduced transparency of volatility inputs used to value these instruments.

Transfers out of level 3 of other financial liabilities during 2017 primarily reflected transfers of certain hybrid financial instruments included in unsecured long-term and short-term borrowings to level 2, principally due to increased transparency of certain inputs used to value these instruments as a result of market transactions in similar instruments, and transfers of certain hybrid financial instruments included in deposits to level 2, principally due to increased transparency of correlation and volatility inputs used to value these instruments.

Year Ended December 2016. The net realized and unrealized losses on level 3 other financial liabilities of $106 million (reflecting $99 million of net realized losses and $7 million of net unrealized losses) for 2016 included losses of approximately $21 million and $10 million reported in market making and interest expense, respectively, in the consolidated statements of earnings, and losses of $75 million reported in debt valuation adjustment in the consolidated statements of comprehensive income.

The net unrealized losses on level 3 other financial liabilities for 2016 primarily reflected losses on certain hybrid financial instruments included in unsecured short-term borrowings, principally due to an increase in global equity prices, and losses on certain hybrid financial instruments included in deposits, principally due to the impact of an increase in the market value of the underlying assets, partially offset by gains on certain hybrid financial instruments included in unsecured long-term borrowings, principally due to changes in foreign exchange rates.

 

 

140   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K
     


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Transfers into level 3 of other financial liabilities during 2016 primarily reflected transfers of certain hybrid financial instruments included in unsecured short-term and long-term borrowings from level 2, principally due to reduced transparency of certain inputs, including correlation and volatility inputs used to value these instruments.

Transfers out of level 3 of other financial liabilities during 2016 primarily reflected transfers of certain hybrid financial instruments included in unsecured short-term and long-term borrowings to level 2, principally due to increased transparency of correlation and volatility inputs used to value these instruments.

Gains and Losses on Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities Accounted for at Fair Value Under the Fair Value Option

The table below presents the gains and losses recognized in earnings as a result of the firm electing to apply the fair value option to certain financial assets and financial liabilities.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017        2016        2015  

Unsecured short-term borrowings

    $(2,585      $(1,028      $ 346  

Unsecured long-term borrowings

    (1,357      584        771  

Other liabilities and accrued expenses

    222        (55      (684

Other

    (620      (630      (217

Total

    $(4,340      $(1,129      $ 216  

In the table above:

 

 

Gains/(losses) are included in market making and other principal transactions.

 

 

Gains/(losses) exclude contractual interest, which is included in interest income and interest expense, for all instruments other than hybrid financial instruments. See Note 23 for further information about interest income and interest expense.

 

 

Gains/(losses) included in unsecured short-term borrowings are substantially all related to the embedded derivative component of hybrid financial instruments for 2017, 2016 and 2015. Gains/(losses) included in unsecured long-term borrowings are primarily related to the embedded derivative component of hybrid financial instruments for 2017, 2016 and 2015. These gains and losses would have been recognized under other U.S. GAAP even if the firm had not elected to account for the entire hybrid financial instrument at fair value.

 

 

Other liabilities and accrued expenses includes gains/(losses) on certain subordinated liabilities of consolidated VIEs.

 

 

Other primarily consists of gains/(losses) on receivables from customers and counterparties, deposits and other secured financings.

Excluding the gains and losses on the instruments accounted for under the fair value option described above, market making and other principal transactions primarily represent gains and losses on financial instruments owned and financial instruments sold, but not yet purchased.

Loans and Lending Commitments

The table below presents the difference between the aggregate fair value and the aggregate contractual principal amount for loans and long-term receivables for which the fair value option was elected.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017       2016  

Performing loans and long-term receivables

   

Aggregate contractual principal in excess of fair value

    $   952       $   478  

Loans on nonaccrual status and/or more than 90 days past due

 

Aggregate contractual principal in excess of fair value

    $5,266       $8,101  

Aggregate fair value of loans on nonaccrual status and/or more than 90 days past due

    $2,104       $2,138  

In the table above, the aggregate contractual principal amount of loans on nonaccrual status and/or more than 90 days past due (which excludes loans carried at zero fair value and considered uncollectible) exceeds the related fair value primarily because the firm regularly purchases loans, such as distressed loans, at values significantly below the contractual principal amounts.

As of December 2017 and December 2016, the fair value of unfunded lending commitments for which the fair value option was elected was a liability of $31 million and $80 million, respectively, and the related total contractual amount of these lending commitments was $9.94 billion and $7.19 billion, respectively. See Note 18 for further information about lending commitments.

Long-Term Debt Instruments

The difference between the aggregate contractual principal amount and the related fair value of long-term other secured financings for which the fair value option was elected was not material as of December 2017, and the aggregate contractual principal amount exceeded the related fair value by $361 million as of December 2016. The aggregate contractual principal amount of unsecured long-term borrowings for which the fair value option was elected exceeded the related fair value by $1.69 billion and $1.56 billion as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively. The amounts above include both principal- and non-principal-protected long-term borrowings.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   141


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Impact of Credit Spreads on Loans and Lending Commitments

The estimated net gain attributable to changes in instrument-specific credit spreads on loans and lending commitments for which the fair value option was elected was $268 million for 2017, $281 million for 2016 and $751 million for 2015. The firm generally calculates the fair value of loans and lending commitments for which the fair value option is elected by discounting future cash flows at a rate which incorporates the instrument-specific credit spreads. For floating-rate loans and lending commitments, substantially all changes in fair value are attributable to changes in instrument-specific credit spreads, whereas for fixed-rate loans and lending commitments, changes in fair value are also attributable to changes in interest rates.

Debt Valuation Adjustment

The firm calculates the fair value of financial liabilities for which the fair value option is elected by discounting future cash flows at a rate which incorporates the firm’s credit spreads.

The table below presents details about the net DVA losses on such financial liabilities.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

DVA (pre-tax)

    $(1,232      $(844

DVA (net of tax)

    $   (807      $(544

In the table above:

 

 

DVA (net of tax) is included in debt valuation adjustment in the consolidated statements of comprehensive income.

 

 

The gains/(losses) reclassified to earnings from accumulated other comprehensive loss upon extinguishment of such financial liabilities were not material for both 2017 and 2016.

Note 9.

Loans Receivable

Loans receivable consists of loans held for investment that are accounted for at amortized cost net of allowance for loan losses. Interest on loans receivable is recognized over the life of the loan and is recorded on an accrual basis.

The table below presents details about loans receivable.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Corporate loans

    $30,749        $24,837  

Loans to PWM clients

    16,591        13,828  

Loans backed by commercial real estate

    7,987        4,761  

Loans backed by residential real estate

    6,234        3,865  

Marcus loans

    1,912        208  

Other loans

    3,263        2,682  

Total loans receivable, gross

    66,736        50,181  

Allowance for loan losses

    (803      (509

Total loans receivable

    $65,933        $49,672  

As of December 2017 and December 2016, the fair value of loans receivable was $66.29 billion and $49.80 billion, respectively. Had these loans been carried at fair value and included in the fair value hierarchy, $38.75 billion and $28.40 billion would have been classified in level 2, and $27.54 billion and $21.40 billion would have been classified in level 3, as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively.

The following is a description of the captions in the table above:

 

 

Corporate Loans. Corporate loans includes term loans, revolving lines of credit, letter of credit facilities and bridge loans, and are principally used for operating liquidity and general corporate purposes, or in connection with acquisitions. Corporate loans may be secured or unsecured, depending on the loan purpose, the risk profile of the borrower and other factors. Loans receivable related to the firm’s relationship lending activities are reported within corporate loans.

 

 

Loans to Private Wealth Management Clients. Loans to Private Wealth Management (PWM) clients includes loans used by clients to finance private asset purchases, employ leverage for strategic investments in real or financial assets, bridge cash flow timing gaps or provide liquidity for other needs. Such loans are primarily secured by securities or other assets.

 

 

Loans Backed by Commercial Real Estate. Loans backed by commercial real estate includes loans extended by the firm that are directly or indirectly secured by hotels, retail stores, multifamily housing complexes and commercial and industrial properties. Loans backed by commercial real estate also includes loans purchased by the firm.

 

 

142   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

 

Loans Backed by Residential Real Estate. Loans backed by residential real estate includes loans extended by the firm to clients who warehouse assets that are directly or indirectly secured by residential real estate. Loans backed by residential real estate also includes loans purchased by the firm.

 

 

Marcus Loans. Marcus loans represents unsecured loans to retail clients.

 

 

Other Loans. Other loans primarily includes loans extended to clients who warehouse assets that are directly or indirectly secured by retail loans, including auto loans, and private student loans and other assets.

The firm monitors the geographic diversification of loans receivable. The regional composition of such loans was approximately 79% and 78% in the Americas, approximately 17% and 18% in Europe, Middle East and Africa (EMEA), and approximately 4% and 4% in Asia as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively.

Lending Commitments

The table below presents details about lending commitments that are held for investment and accounted for on an accrual basis.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Corporate

    $118,553        $93,407  

Other

    5,951        4,638  

Total

    $124,504        $98,045  

In the table above:

 

 

Corporate lending commitments primarily relates to the firm’s relationship lending activities.

 

 

Other lending commitments primarily relates to lending commitments extended by the firm to clients who warehouse assets backed by real estate and other assets.

 

 

The carrying value of lending commitments were liabilities of $423 million (including allowance for losses of $274 million) and $327 million (including allowance for losses of $212 million) as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively.

 

 

The estimated fair value of such lending commitments were liabilities of $2.27 billion and $2.55 billion as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively. Had these lending commitments been carried at fair value and included in the fair value hierarchy, $772 million and $1.10 billion would have been classified in level 2, and $1.50 billion and $1.45 billion would have been classified in level 3, as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively.

Purchased Credit Impaired (PCI) Loans

Loans receivable includes PCI loans, which represent acquired loans or pools of loans with evidence of credit deterioration subsequent to their origination and where it is probable, at acquisition, that the firm will not be able to collect all contractually required payments. Loans acquired within the same reporting period, which have at least two common risk characteristics, one of which relates to their credit risk, are eligible to be pooled together and considered a single unit of account. PCI loans are initially recorded at the acquisition price and the difference between the acquisition price and the expected cash flows (accretable yield) is recognized as interest income over the life of such loans or pools of loans on an effective yield method. Expected cash flows on PCI loans are determined using various inputs and assumptions, including default rates, loss severities, recoveries, amount and timing of prepayments and other macroeconomic indicators.

The table below presents details about PCI loans.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Loans backed by commercial real estate

    $1,116        $1,444  

Loans backed by residential real estate

    3,327        2,508  

Other loans

    10        18  

Total gross carrying value

    $4,453        $3,970  

 

Total outstanding principal balance

    $9,512        $8,515  

Total accretable yield

    $   662        $   526  

The table below presents details about PCI loans at the time of acquisition.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017        2016        2015  

Fair value

    $1,769        $2,514        $2,267  

Expected cash flows

    $1,961        $2,818        $2,499  

Contractually required cash flows

    $4,092        $6,389        $6,472  
 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   143


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Credit Quality

Risk Assessment. The firm’s risk assessment process includes evaluating the credit quality of its loans receivable. For loans receivable (excluding PCI and Marcus loans) and lending commitments, the firm performs credit reviews which include initial and ongoing analyses of its borrowers. A credit review is an independent analysis of the capacity and willingness of a borrower to meet its financial obligations, resulting in an internal credit rating. The determination of internal credit ratings also incorporates assumptions with respect to the nature of and outlook for the borrower’s industry and the economic environment. The firm also assigns a regulatory risk rating to such loans based on the definitions provided by the U.S. federal bank regulatory agencies.

The firm enters into economic hedges to mitigate credit risk on certain loans receivable and corporate lending commitments (both of which are held for investment) related to the firm’s relationship lending activities. Such hedges are accounted for at fair value. See Note 18 for further information about these lending commitments and associated hedges.

The table below presents gross loans receivable (excluding PCI and Marcus loans of $6.37 billion and $4.18 billion as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively) and lending commitments by the firm’s internally determined public rating agency equivalent and by regulatory risk rating.

 

$ in millions     Loans       
Lending
Commitments
 
 
     Total  

Credit Rating Equivalent

       

As of December 2017

       

Investment-grade

    $24,192        $  89,409        $113,601  

Non-investment-grade

    36,179        35,095        71,274  

Total

    $60,371        $124,504        $184,875  

 

As of December 2016

       

Investment-grade

    $18,434        $  72,323        $  90,757  

Non-investment-grade

    27,569        25,722        53,291  

Total

    $46,003        $  98,045        $144,048  

 

Regulatory Risk Rating

       

As of December 2017

       

Non-criticized/pass

    $56,720        $119,427        $176,147  

Criticized

    3,651        5,077        8,728  

Total

    $60,371        $124,504        $184,875  

 

As of December 2016

       

Non-criticized/pass

    $42,938        $  94,966        $137,904  

Criticized

    3,065        3,079        6,144  

Total

    $46,003        $  98,045        $144,048  

In the table above, non-criticized/pass loans and lending commitments represent loans and lending commitments that are performing and/or do not demonstrate adverse characteristics that are likely to result in a credit loss.

For Marcus loans, an important credit-quality indicator is the Fair Isaac Corporation (FICO) credit score, which measures a borrower’s creditworthiness by considering factors such as payment and credit history. FICO credit scores are refreshed periodically by the firm to assess the updated creditworthiness of the borrower. As of December 2017 and December 2016, greater than 80% of the Marcus loans receivable had an underlying FICO credit score above 660 (with a weighted average FICO credit score in excess of 700).

For PCI loans, the firm’s risk assessment process includes reviewing certain key metrics, such as delinquency status, collateral values, expected cash flows and other risk factors.

Impaired Loans. Loans receivable (excluding PCI loans) are determined to be impaired when it is probable that the firm will not be able to collect all principal and interest due under the contractual terms of the loan. At that time, loans are generally placed on nonaccrual status and all accrued but uncollected interest is reversed against interest income, and interest subsequently collected is recognized on a cash basis to the extent the loan balance is deemed collectible. Otherwise, all cash received is used to reduce the outstanding loan balance.

In certain circumstances, the firm may also modify the original terms of a loan agreement by granting a concession to a borrower experiencing financial difficulty. Such modifications are considered troubled debt restructurings and typically include interest rate reductions, payment extensions, and modification of loan covenants. Loans modified in a troubled debt restructuring are considered impaired and are subject to specific loan-level reserves.

As of December 2017 and December 2016, the gross carrying value of impaired loans receivable (excluding PCI loans) on nonaccrual status was $845 million and $404 million, respectively. As of December 2017 and December 2016, such loans included $61 million and $142 million, respectively, of corporate loans that were modified in a troubled debt restructuring. The firm did not have any lending commitments related to these loans as of December 2017. Such lending commitments were $144 million as of December 2016.

When it is determined that the firm cannot reasonably estimate expected cash flows on PCI loans or pools of loans, such loans are placed on nonaccrual status.

 

 

144   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Allowance for Losses on Loans and Lending Commitments

    

The firm’s allowance for loan losses consists of specific loan-level reserves, portfolio level reserves and reserves on PCI loans as described below:

 

 

Specific loan-level reserves are determined on loans (excluding PCI loans) that exhibit credit quality weakness and are therefore individually evaluated for impairment.

 

 

Portfolio level reserves are determined on loans (excluding PCI loans) not evaluated for specific loan-level reserves by aggregating groups of loans with similar risk characteristics and estimating the probable loss inherent in the portfolio.

 

 

Reserves on PCI loans are recorded when it is determined that the expected cash flows, which are reassessed on a quarterly basis, will be lower than those used to establish the current effective yield for such loans or pools of loans. If the expected cash flows are determined to be significantly higher than those used to establish the current effective yield, such increases are initially recognized as a reduction to any previously recorded allowances for loan losses and any remaining increases are recognized as interest income prospectively over the life of the loan or pools of loans as an increase to the effective yield.

The allowance for loan losses is determined using various risk factors, including industry default and loss data, current macroeconomic indicators, borrower’s capacity to meet its financial obligations, borrower’s country of risk, loan seniority and collateral type. In addition, for loans backed by real estate, risk factors include loan to value ratio, debt service ratio and home price index. Risk factors for Marcus loans include FICO credit scores and delinquency status.

Management’s estimate of loan losses entails judgment about loan collectability at the reporting dates, and there are uncertainties inherent in those judgments. While management uses the best information available to determine this estimate, future adjustments to the allowance may be necessary based on, among other things, changes in the economic environment or variances between actual results and the original assumptions used. Loans are charged off against the allowance for loan losses when deemed to be uncollectible.

The firm also records an allowance for losses on lending commitments that are held for investment and accounted for on an accrual basis. Such allowance is determined using the same methodology as the allowance for loan losses, while also taking into consideration the probability of drawdowns or funding, and is included in other liabilities and accrued expenses.

The tables below present gross loans receivable and lending commitments by impairment methodology.

 

    As of December 2017  
$ in millions     Specific        Portfolio        PCI        Total  

Loans Receivable

          

Corporate loans

    $377        $  30,372        $       –        $  30,749  

Loans to PWM clients

    163        16,428               16,591  

Loans backed by:

          

Commercial real estate

           6,871        1,116        7,987  

Residential real estate

    231        2,676        3,327        6,234  

Marcus loans

           1,912               1,912  

Other loans

    74        3,179        10        3,263  

Total

    $845        $  61,438        $4,453        $  66,736  

Lending Commitments

          

Corporate

    $  53        $118,500        $       –        $118,553  

Other

           5,951               5,951  

Total

    $  53        $124,451        $       –        $124,504  
    As of December 2016  
$ in millions     Specific        Portfolio        PCI        Total  

Loans Receivable

          

Corporate loans

    $327        $  24,510        $       –        $  24,837  

Loans to PWM clients

    77        13,751               13,828  

Loans backed by:

          

Commercial real estate

           3,317        1,444        4,761  

Residential real estate

           1,357        2,508        3,865  

Marcus loans

           208               208  

Other loans

           2,664        18        2,682  

Total

    $404        $  45,807        $3,970        $  50,181  

Lending Commitments

          

Corporate

    $211        $  93,196        $       –        $  93,407  

Other

           4,638               4,638  

Total

    $211        $  97,834        $       –        $  98,045  

In the tables above, gross loans receivable and lending commitments, subject to specific loan-level reserves, included $492 million and $122 million of impaired loans and lending commitments as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively, which did not require a reserve as the loan was deemed to be recoverable.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   145


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The table below presents changes in the allowance for loan losses and the allowance for losses on lending commitments, as well as details by impairment methodology.

 

    Year Ended December 2017         Year Ended December 2016  
$ in millions    
Loans
Receivable
 
 
   
Lending
Commitments
 
 
       
Loans
Receivable
 
 
   
Lending
Commitments
 
 

Changes in the allowance for losses

 

     

Beginning balance

    $ 509       $212         $414       $188  

Charge-offs

    (203             (8      

Provision

    574       83         138       44  

Other

    (77     (21         (35     (20

Ending balance

    $ 803       $274           $509       $212  

Allowance for losses by impairment methodology

 

Specific

    $ 119       $  14         $127       $  39  

Portfolio

    518       260         370       173  

PCI

    166                 12        

Total

    $ 803       $274           $509       $212  

In the table above:

 

 

The provision for losses on loans and lending commitments is included in other principal transactions, and was primarily related to corporate loans and lending commitments, and loans backed by commercial real estate.

 

 

Other represents the reduction to the allowance related to loans and lending commitments transferred to held for sale.

 

 

Portfolio level reserves were primarily related to corporate loans, specific loan-level reserves were substantially all related to corporate loans and reserves on PCI loans were related to loans backed by real estate.

 

 

Substantially all of the allowance for losses on lending commitments were related to corporate lending commitments.

Note 10.

Collateralized Agreements and Financings

Collateralized agreements are securities purchased under agreements to resell (resale agreements) and securities borrowed. Collateralized financings are securities sold under agreements to repurchase (repurchase agreements), securities loaned and other secured financings. The firm enters into these transactions in order to, among other things, facilitate client activities, invest excess cash, acquire securities to cover short positions and finance certain firm activities.

Collateralized agreements and financings are presented on a net-by-counterparty basis when a legal right of setoff exists. Interest on collateralized agreements and collateralized financings is recognized over the life of the transaction and included in interest income and interest expense, respectively. See Note 23 for further information about interest income and interest expense.

The table below presents the carrying value of resale and repurchase agreements and securities borrowed and loaned transactions.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017       2016  

Securities purchased under agreements to resell

    $120,822       $116,925  

Securities borrowed

    $190,848       $184,600  

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

    $  84,718       $  71,816  

Securities loaned

    $  14,793       $    7,524  

In the table above:

 

 

Substantially all resale agreements and all repurchase agreements are carried at fair value under the fair value option. See Note 8 for further information about the valuation techniques and significant inputs used to determine fair value.

 

 

As of December 2017 and December 2016, $78.19 billion and $82.40 billion of securities borrowed, and $5.36 billion and $2.65 billion of securities loaned were at fair value, respectively.

Resale and Repurchase Agreements

A resale agreement is a transaction in which the firm purchases financial instruments from a seller, typically in exchange for cash, and simultaneously enters into an agreement to resell the same or substantially the same financial instruments to the seller at a stated price plus accrued interest at a future date.

A repurchase agreement is a transaction in which the firm sells financial instruments to a buyer, typically in exchange for cash, and simultaneously enters into an agreement to repurchase the same or substantially the same financial instruments from the buyer at a stated price plus accrued interest at a future date.

Even though repurchase and resale agreements (including “repos- and reverses-to-maturity”) involve the legal transfer of ownership of financial instruments, they are accounted for as financing arrangements because they require the financial instruments to be repurchased or resold before or at the maturity of the agreement. The financial instruments purchased or sold in resale and repurchase agreements typically include U.S. government and agency, and investment-grade sovereign obligations.

 

 

146   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The firm receives financial instruments purchased under resale agreements and makes delivery of financial instruments sold under repurchase agreements. To mitigate credit exposure, the firm monitors the market value of these financial instruments on a daily basis, and delivers or obtains additional collateral due to changes in the market value of the financial instruments, as appropriate. For resale agreements, the firm typically requires collateral with a fair value approximately equal to the carrying value of the relevant assets in the consolidated statements of financial condition.

Securities Borrowed and Loaned Transactions

In a securities borrowed transaction, the firm borrows securities from a counterparty in exchange for cash or securities. When the firm returns the securities, the counterparty returns the cash or securities. Interest is generally paid periodically over the life of the transaction.

In a securities loaned transaction, the firm lends securities to a counterparty in exchange for cash or securities. When the counterparty returns the securities, the firm returns the cash or securities posted as collateral. Interest is generally paid periodically over the life of the transaction.

The firm receives securities borrowed and makes delivery of securities loaned. To mitigate credit exposure, the firm monitors the market value of these securities on a daily basis, and delivers or obtains additional collateral due to changes in the market value of the securities, as appropriate. For securities borrowed transactions, the firm typically requires collateral with a fair value approximately equal to the carrying value of the securities borrowed transaction.

Securities borrowed and loaned within FICC Client Execution are recorded at fair value under the fair value option. See Note 8 for further information about securities borrowed and loaned accounted for at fair value.

Securities borrowed and loaned within Securities Services are recorded based on the amount of cash collateral advanced or received plus accrued interest. As these agreements generally can be terminated on demand, they exhibit little, if any, sensitivity to changes in interest rates. Therefore, the carrying value of such agreements approximates fair value. While these agreements are carried at amounts that approximate fair value, they are not accounted for at fair value under the fair value option or at fair value in accordance with other U.S. GAAP and therefore are not included in the firm’s fair value hierarchy in Notes 6 through 8. Had these agreements been included in the firm’s fair value hierarchy, they would have been classified in level 2 as of both December 2017 and December 2016.

Offsetting Arrangements

The table below presents the gross and net resale and repurchase agreements and securities borrowed and loaned transactions, and the related amount of counterparty netting included in the consolidated statements of financial condition, as well as the amounts of counterparty netting and cash and securities collateral, not offset in the consolidated statements of financial condition.

 

    Assets         Liabilities  
$ in millions    
Resale
agreements
 
 
   
Securities
borrowed
 
 
       
Repurchase
agreements
 
 
   
Securities
loaned
 
 

As of December 2017

 

       

Included in consolidated statements of financial condition

 

Gross carrying value

    $ 209,972       $ 195,783         $173,868       $19,728  

Counterparty netting

    (89,150     (4,935         (89,150     (4,935

Total

    120,822       190,848           84,718       14,793  

Amounts not offset

         

Counterparty netting

    (5,441     (4,412       (5,441     (4,412

Collateral

    (113,305     (177,679         (76,793     (9,731

Total

    $     2,076       $     8,757           $    2,484       $     650  

 

As of December 2016

 

       

Included in consolidated statements of financial condition

 

Gross carrying value

    $ 173,561       $ 189,571         $128,452       $12,495  

Counterparty netting

    (56,636     (4,971         (56,636     (4,971

Total

    116,925       184,600           71,816       7,524  

Amounts not offset

         

Counterparty netting

    (8,319     (4,045       (8,319     (4,045

Collateral

    (107,148     (170,625         (62,081     (3,087

Total

    $     1,458       $     9,930           $    1,416       $     392  

In the table above:

 

 

Substantially all of the gross carrying values of these arrangements are subject to enforceable netting agreements.

 

 

Where the firm has received or posted collateral under credit support agreements, but has not yet determined such agreements are enforceable, the related collateral has not been netted.

 

 

Amounts not offset includes counterparty netting that does not meet the criteria for netting under U.S. GAAP and the fair value of cash or securities collateral received or posted subject to enforceable credit support agreements.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   147


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Gross Carrying Value of Repurchase Agreements and Securities Loaned

The table below presents the gross carrying value of repurchase agreements and securities loaned by class of collateral pledged.

 

$ in millions    
Repurchase
agreements
 
 
    
Securities
loaned
 
 

As of December 2017

    

Money market instruments

    $        97        $         –  

U.S. government and agency obligations

    80,591         

Non-U.S. government and agency obligations

    73,031        2,245  

Securities backed by commercial real estate

    43         

Securities backed by residential real estate

    338         

Corporate debt securities

    7,140        1,145  

State and municipal obligations

            

Other debt obligations

    55         

Equity securities

    12,573        16,338  

Total

    $173,868        $19,728  

 

As of December 2016

    

Money market instruments

    $       317        $         –  

U.S. government and agency obligations

    47,207        115  

Non-U.S. government and agency obligations

    56,156        1,846  

Securities backed by commercial real estate

    208         

Securities backed by residential real estate

    122         

Corporate debt securities

    8,297        39  

State and municipal obligations

    831         

Other debt obligations

    286         

Equity securities

    15,028        10,495  

Total

    $128,452        $12,495  

The table below presents the gross carrying value of repurchase agreements and securities loaned by maturity date.

 

    As of December 2017  
$ in millions    
Repurchase
agreements
 
 
    
Securities
loaned
 
 

No stated maturity and overnight

    $  65,280        $  9,389  

2 - 30 days

    59,344        4,967  

31 - 90 days

    13,489        756  

91 days - 1 year

    21,392        2,302  

Greater than 1 year

    14,363        2,314  

Total

    $173,868        $19,728  

In the table above:

 

 

Repurchase agreements and securities loaned that are repayable prior to maturity at the option of the firm are reflected at their contractual maturity dates.

 

 

Repurchase agreements and securities loaned that are redeemable prior to maturity at the option of the holder are reflected at the earliest dates such options become exercisable.

Other Secured Financings

In addition to repurchase agreements and securities loaned transactions, the firm funds certain assets through the use of other secured financings and pledges financial instruments and other assets as collateral in these transactions. These other secured financings consist of:

 

 

Liabilities of consolidated VIEs;

 

 

Transfers of assets accounted for as financings rather than sales (primarily collateralized central bank financings, pledged commodities, bank loans and mortgage whole loans); and

 

 

Other structured financing arrangements.

Other secured financings includes arrangements that are nonrecourse. As of December 2017 and December 2016, nonrecourse other secured financings were $5.31 billion and $2.54 billion, respectively.

The firm has elected to apply the fair value option to substantially all other secured financings because the use of fair value eliminates non-economic volatility in earnings that would arise from using different measurement attributes. See Note 8 for further information about other secured financings that are accounted for at fair value.

Other secured financings that are not recorded at fair value are recorded based on the amount of cash received plus accrued interest, which generally approximates fair value. While these financings are carried at amounts that approximate fair value, they are not accounted for at fair value under the fair value option or at fair value in accordance with other U.S. GAAP and therefore are not included in the firm’s fair value hierarchy in Notes 6 through 8. Had these financings been included in the firm’s fair value hierarchy, they would have been primarily classified in level 2 as of both December 2017 and December 2016.

 

 

148   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The table below presents information about other secured financings.

 

$ in millions    

U.S.

Dollar

 

 

   

Non-U.S.

Dollar

 

 

    Total  

As of December 2017

     

Other secured financings (short-term):

     

At fair value

    $  7,704       $  6,856       $14,560  

At amortized cost

    $         –       $     336       $     336  

Weighted average interest rates

    –%       2.61%    

Other secured financings (long-term):

     

At fair value

    $  6,779       $  3,006       $  9,785  

At amortized cost

    $     107       $         –       $     107  

Weighted average interest rates

    3.89%       –%          

Total

    $14,590       $10,198       $24,788  

 

Other secured financings collateralized by:

 

   

Financial instruments

    $12,454       $  9,870       $22,324  

Other assets

    $  2,136       $     328       $  2,464  

 

As of December 2016

     

Other secured financings (short-term):

     

At fair value

    $  9,380       $  3,738       $13,118  

At amortized cost

    $         –       $         –       $         –  

Weighted average interest rates

    –%       –%    

Other secured financings (long-term):

     

At fair value

    $  5,562       $  2,393       $  7,955  

At amortized cost

    $     145       $     305       $     450  

Weighted average interest rates

    4.06%       2.16%          

Total

    $15,087       $  6,436       $21,523  

 

Other secured financings collateralized by:

 

   

Financial instruments

    $13,858       $  5,974       $19,832  

Other assets

    $  1,229       $     462       $  1,691  

In the table above:

 

 

Short-term other secured financings includes financings maturing within one year of the financial statement date and financings that are redeemable within one year of the financial statement date at the option of the holder.

 

 

Weighted average interest rates excludes other secured financings at fair value and includes the effect of hedging activities. See Note 7 for further information about hedging activities.

 

 

Total other secured financings included $1.55 billion and $285 million related to transfers of financial assets accounted for as financings rather than sales as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively. Such financings were collateralized by financial assets of $1.57 billion and $285 million as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively, primarily included in financial instruments owned.

 

 

Other secured financings collateralized by financial instruments included $16.61 billion and $13.65 billion of other secured financings collateralized by financial instruments owned as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively, and $5.71 billion and $6.18 billion of other secured financings collateralized by financial instruments received as collateral and repledged as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively.

The table below presents other secured financings by maturity date.

 

$ in millions    

As of

December 2017

 

 

Other secured financings (short-term)

    $14,896  

Other secured financings (long-term):

 

2019

    3,439  

2020

    1,555  

2021

    551  

2022

    2,468  

2023 - thereafter

    1,879  

Total other secured financings (long-term) 

    9,892  

Total other secured financings

    $24,788  

In the table above:

 

 

Long-term other secured financings that are repayable prior to maturity at the option of the firm are reflected at their contractual maturity dates.

 

 

Long-term other secured financings that are redeemable prior to maturity at the option of the holder are reflected at the earliest dates such options become exercisable.

Collateral Received and Pledged

The firm receives cash and securities (e.g., U.S. government and agency obligations, other sovereign and corporate obligations, as well as equity securities) as collateral, primarily in connection with resale agreements, securities borrowed, derivative transactions and customer margin loans. The firm obtains cash and securities as collateral on an upfront or contingent basis for derivative instruments and collateralized agreements to reduce its credit exposure to individual counterparties.

In many cases, the firm is permitted to deliver or repledge financial instruments received as collateral when entering into repurchase agreements and securities loaned transactions, primarily in connection with secured client financing activities. The firm is also permitted to deliver or repledge these financial instruments in connection with other secured financings, collateralized derivative transactions and firm or customer settlement requirements.

The firm also pledges certain financial instruments owned in connection with repurchase agreements, securities loaned transactions and other secured financings, and other assets (substantially all real estate and cash) in connection with other secured financings to counterparties who may or may not have the right to deliver or repledge them.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   149


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The table below presents financial instruments at fair value received as collateral that were available to be delivered or repledged and were delivered or repledged by the firm.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Collateral available to be delivered or repledged

    $763,984        $634,609  

Collateral that was delivered or repledged

    $599,565        $495,717  

In the table above, as of December 2017 and December 2016, collateral available to be delivered or repledged excludes $1.52 billion and $15.47 billion, respectively, of securities received under resale agreements and securities borrowed transactions that contractually had the right to be delivered or repledged, but were segregated for regulatory and other purposes.

The table below presents information about assets pledged.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Financial instruments owned pledged to counterparties that:

 

Had the right to deliver or repledge

    $  50,335        $  51,278  

Did not have the right to deliver or repledge

    $  78,656        $  61,099  

Other assets pledged to counterparties that did not have the right to deliver or repledge

    $    4,838        $    3,287  

The firm also segregated $10.42 billion and $15.29 billion of securities included in financial instruments owned as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively, for regulatory and other purposes. See Note 3 for information about segregated cash.

Note 11.

Securitization Activities

The firm securitizes residential and commercial mortgages, corporate bonds, loans and other types of financial assets by selling these assets to securitization vehicles (e.g., trusts, corporate entities and limited liability companies) or through a resecuritization. The firm acts as underwriter of the beneficial interests that are sold to investors. The firm’s residential mortgage securitizations are primarily in connection with government agency securitizations.

Beneficial interests issued by securitization entities are debt or equity instruments that give the investors rights to receive all or portions of specified cash inflows to a securitization vehicle and include senior and subordinated interests in principal, interest and/or other cash inflows. The proceeds from the sale of beneficial interests are used to pay the transferor for the financial assets sold to the securitization vehicle or to purchase securities which serve as collateral.

The firm accounts for a securitization as a sale when it has relinquished control over the transferred financial assets. Prior to securitization, the firm generally accounts for assets pending transfer at fair value and therefore does not typically recognize significant gains or losses upon the transfer of assets. Net revenues from underwriting activities are recognized in connection with the sales of the underlying beneficial interests to investors.

For transfers of financial assets that are not accounted for as sales, the assets remain in financial instruments owned and the transfer is accounted for as a collateralized financing, with the related interest expense recognized over the life of the transaction. See Notes 10 and 23 for further information about collateralized financings and interest expense, respectively.

The firm generally receives cash in exchange for the transferred assets but may also have continuing involvement with the transferred financial assets, including ownership of beneficial interests in securitized financial assets, primarily in the form of debt instruments. The firm may also purchase senior or subordinated securities issued by securitization vehicles (which are typically VIEs) in connection with secondary market-making activities.

The primary risks included in beneficial interests and other interests from the firm’s continuing involvement with securitization vehicles are the performance of the underlying collateral, the position of the firm’s investment in the capital structure of the securitization vehicle and the market yield for the security. These interests primarily are accounted for at fair value and classified in level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. Beneficial interests and other interests not accounted for at fair value are carried at amounts that approximate fair value. See Notes 5 through 8 for further information about fair value measurements.

The table below presents the amount of financial assets securitized and the cash flows received on retained interests in securitization entities in which the firm had continuing involvement as of the end of the period.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017        2016        2015  

Residential mortgages

    $18,142        $12,164        $10,479  

Commercial mortgages

    7,872        233        6,043  

Other financial assets

    481        181         

Total

    $26,495        $12,578        $16,522  

 

Retained interests cash flows

    $     264        $     189        $     174  
 

 

150   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The table below presents the firm’s continuing involvement in nonconsolidated securitization entities to which the firm sold assets, as well as the total outstanding principal amount of transferred assets in which the firm has continuing involvement.

 

$ in millions    

Outstanding

Principal

Amount

 

 

 

   

Retained

Interests

 

 

   

Purchased

Interests

 

 

As of December 2017

     

U.S. government agency-issued collateralized mortgage obligations

    $20,232       $1,120       $16  

Other residential mortgage-backed

    10,558       711       17  

Other commercial mortgage-backed

    7,916       228       7  

Corporate debt and other asset-backed

    2,108       56       1  

Total

    $40,814       $2,115       $41  

 

As of December 2016

     

U.S. government agency-issued collateralized mortgage obligations

    $25,140       $   953       $24  

Other residential mortgage-backed

    3,261       540       6  

Other commercial mortgage-backed

    357       15        

Corporate debt and other asset-backed

    2,284       56       6  

Total 

    $31,042       $1,564       $36  

In the table above:

 

 

The outstanding principal amount is presented for the purpose of providing information about the size of the securitization entities and is not representative of the firm’s risk of loss.

 

 

The firm’s risk of loss from retained or purchased interests is limited to the carrying value of these interests.

 

 

Purchased interests represent senior and subordinated interests, purchased in connection with secondary market-making activities, in securitization entities in which the firm also holds retained interests.

 

 

Substantially all of the total outstanding principal amount and total retained interests relate to securitizations during 2012 and thereafter.

 

 

The fair value of retained interests was $2.13 billion and $1.58 billion as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively.

In addition to the interests in the table above, the firm had other continuing involvement in the form of derivative transactions and commitments with certain nonconsolidated VIEs. The carrying value of these derivatives and commitments was a net asset of $86 million and $48 million as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively. The notional amounts of these derivatives and commitments are included in maximum exposure to loss in the nonconsolidated VIE table in Note 12.

The table below presents the weighted average key economic assumptions used in measuring the fair value of mortgage-backed retained interests and the sensitivity of this fair value to immediate adverse changes of 10% and 20% in those assumptions.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Fair value of retained interests

    $2,071        $1,519  

Weighted average life (years)

    6.0        7.5  

Constant prepayment rate

    9.4%        8.1%  

Impact of 10% adverse change

    $    (19      $    (14

Impact of 20% adverse change

    $    (35      $    (28

Discount rate

    4.2%        5.3%  

Impact of 10% adverse change

    $    (35      $    (37

Impact of 20% adverse change

    $    (70      $    (71

In the table above:

 

 

Amounts do not reflect the benefit of other financial instruments that are held to mitigate risks inherent in these retained interests.

 

 

Changes in fair value based on an adverse variation in assumptions generally cannot be extrapolated because the relationship of the change in assumptions to the change in fair value is not usually linear.

 

 

The impact of a change in a particular assumption is calculated independently of changes in any other assumption. In practice, simultaneous changes in assumptions might magnify or counteract the sensitivities disclosed above.

 

 

The constant prepayment rate is included only for positions for which it is a key assumption in the determination of fair value.

 

 

The discount rate for retained interests that relate to U.S. government agency-issued collateralized mortgage obligations does not include any credit loss. Expected credit loss assumptions are reflected in the discount rate for the remainder of retained interests.

The firm has other retained interests not reflected in the table above with a fair value of $56 million and a weighted average life of 4.5 years as of December 2017, and a fair value of $56 million and a weighted average life of 3.5 years as of December 2016. Due to the nature and fair value of certain of these retained interests, the weighted average assumptions for constant prepayment and discount rates and the related sensitivity to adverse changes are not meaningful as of both December 2017 and December 2016. The firm’s maximum exposure to adverse changes in the value of these interests is the carrying value of $56 million and $56 million as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   151


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Note 12.

Variable Interest Entities

 

A variable interest in a VIE is an investment (e.g., debt or equity securities) or other interest (e.g., derivatives or loans and lending commitments) that will absorb portions of the VIE’s expected losses and/or receive portions of the VIE’s expected residual returns.

The firm’s variable interests in VIEs include senior and subordinated debt; loans and lending commitments; limited and general partnership interests; preferred and common equity; derivatives that may include foreign currency, equity and/or credit risk; guarantees; and certain of the fees the firm receives from investment funds. Certain interest rate, foreign currency and credit derivatives the firm enters into with VIEs are not variable interests because they create, rather than absorb, risk.

VIEs generally finance the purchase of assets by issuing debt and equity securities that are either collateralized by or indexed to the assets held by the VIE. The debt and equity securities issued by a VIE may include tranches of varying levels of subordination. The firm’s involvement with VIEs includes securitization of financial assets, as described in Note 11, and investments in and loans to other types of VIEs, as described below. See Note 11 for further information about securitization activities, including the definition of beneficial interests. See Note 3 for the firm’s consolidation policies, including the definition of a VIE.

VIE Consolidation Analysis

The enterprise with a controlling financial interest in a VIE is known as the primary beneficiary and consolidates the VIE. The firm determines whether it is the primary beneficiary of a VIE by performing an analysis that principally considers:

 

 

Which variable interest holder has the power to direct the activities of the VIE that most significantly impact the VIE’s economic performance;

 

 

Which variable interest holder has the obligation to absorb losses or the right to receive benefits from the VIE that could potentially be significant to the VIE;

 

 

The VIE’s purpose and design, including the risks the VIE was designed to create and pass through to its variable interest holders;

 

 

The VIE’s capital structure;

 

 

The terms between the VIE and its variable interest holders and other parties involved with the VIE; and

 

 

Related-party relationships.

The firm reassesses its evaluation of whether an entity is a VIE when certain reconsideration events occur. The firm reassesses its determination of whether it is the primary beneficiary of a VIE on an ongoing basis based on current facts and circumstances.

VIE Activities

In 2017, the firm aggregated corporate debt VIEs with other asset-backed VIEs and aggregated power-related VIEs with real estate, credit-related and other investing VIEs (rather than in investments in funds and other VIEs). Previously reported amounts have been conformed to the current presentation.

The firm is principally involved with VIEs through the following business activities:

Mortgage-Backed VIEs. The firm sells residential and commercial mortgage loans and securities to mortgage-backed VIEs and may retain beneficial interests in the assets sold to these VIEs. The firm purchases and sells beneficial interests issued by mortgage-backed VIEs in connection with market-making activities. In addition, the firm may enter into derivatives with certain of these VIEs, primarily interest rate swaps, which are typically not variable interests. The firm generally enters into derivatives with other counterparties to mitigate its risk.

Real Estate, Credit- and Power-Related and Other Investing VIEs. The firm purchases equity and debt securities issued by and makes loans to VIEs that hold real estate, performing and nonperforming debt, distressed loans, power-related assets and equity securities. The firm typically does not sell assets to, or enter into derivatives with, these VIEs.

Corporate Debt and Other Asset-Backed VIEs. The firm structures VIEs that issue notes to clients, and purchases and sells beneficial interests issued by corporate debt and other asset-backed VIEs in connection with market-making activities. Certain of these VIEs synthetically create the exposure for the beneficial interests they issue by entering into credit derivatives with the firm, rather than purchasing the underlying assets. In addition, the firm may enter into derivatives, such as total return swaps, with certain corporate debt and other asset-backed VIEs, under which the firm pays the VIE a return due to the beneficial interest holders and receives the return on the collateral owned by the VIE. The collateral owned by these VIEs is primarily other asset-backed loans and securities. The firm generally can be removed as the total return swap counterparty and enters into derivatives with other counterparties to mitigate its risk related to these swaps. The firm may sell assets to the corporate debt and other asset-backed VIEs it structures.

 

 

152   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Principal-Protected Note VIEs. The firm structures VIEs that issue principal-protected notes to clients. These VIEs own portfolios of assets, principally with exposure to hedge funds. Substantially all of the principal protection on the notes issued by these VIEs is provided by the asset portfolio rebalancing that is required under the terms of the notes. The firm enters into total return swaps with these VIEs under which the firm pays the VIE the return due to the principal-protected note holders and receives the return on the assets owned by the VIE. The firm may enter into derivatives with other counterparties to mitigate its risk. The firm also obtains funding through these VIEs.

Investments in Funds. The firm makes equity investments in certain of the investment fund VIEs it manages and is entitled to receive fees from these VIEs. The firm typically does not sell assets to, or enter into derivatives with, these VIEs.

Adoption of ASU No. 2015-02

The firm adopted ASU No. 2015-02 as of January 1, 2016. Upon adoption, certain of the firm’s investments in entities that were previously classified as voting interest entities are now classified as VIEs. These include investments in certain limited partnership entities that have been deconsolidated upon adoption as certain fee interests are not considered significant interests under the guidance, and the firm is no longer deemed to have a controlling financial interest in such entities. See Note 3 for further information about the adoption of ASU No. 2015-02.

Nonconsolidated VIEs. As a result of adoption as of January 1, 2016, investments in funds nonconsolidated VIEs included $10.70 billion in assets in VIEs, $543 million in carrying value of variable interests — assets and $559 million in maximum exposure to loss related to investments in limited partnership entities that were previously classified as nonconsolidated voting interest entities.

Consolidated VIEs. As a result of adoption as of January 1, 2016, real estate, credit-related and other investing consolidated VIEs included $302 million of assets, substantially all included in financial instruments owned, and $122 million of liabilities, included in other liabilities and accrued expenses, primarily related to investments in limited partnership entities that were previously classified as consolidated voting interest entities.

Nonconsolidated VIEs

The table below presents a summary of the nonconsolidated VIEs in which the firm holds variable interests. The nature of the firm’s variable interests can take different forms, as described in the rows under maximum exposure to loss.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Total nonconsolidated VIEs

    

Assets in VIEs

    $97,962        $70,083  

Carrying value of variable interests — assets

    8,425        6,199  

Carrying value of variable interests — liabilities

    214        254  

Maximum exposure to loss:

    

Retained interests

    2,115        1,564  

Purchased interests

    1,172        544  

Commitments and guarantees

    3,462        2,196  

Derivatives

    8,406        7,144  

Loans and investments

    4,454        3,760  

Total maximum exposure to loss

    $19,609        $15,208  

In the table above:

 

 

The firm’s exposure to the obligations of VIEs is generally limited to its interests in these entities. In certain instances, the firm provides guarantees, including derivative guarantees, to VIEs or holders of variable interests in VIEs.

 

 

The maximum exposure to loss excludes the benefit of offsetting financial instruments that are held to mitigate the risks associated with these variable interests.

 

 

The maximum exposure to loss from retained interests, purchased interests, and loans and investments is the carrying value of these interests.

 

 

The maximum exposure to loss from commitments and guarantees, and derivatives is the notional amount, which does not represent anticipated losses and also has not been reduced by unrealized losses already recorded. As a result, the maximum exposure to loss exceeds liabilities recorded for commitments and guarantees, and derivatives provided to VIEs.

 

 

Total maximum exposure to loss from commitments and guarantees, and derivatives included $1.26 billion and $1.28 billion as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively, related to transactions with VIEs to which the firm transferred assets.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   153


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The table below disaggregates, by principal business activity, the information for nonconsolidated VIEs included in the summary table above.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Mortgage-backed

    

Assets in VIEs

    $55,153        $32,714  

Carrying value of variable interests — assets

    3,128        1,936  

Maximum exposure to loss:

    

Retained interests

    2,059        1,508  

Purchased interests

    1,067        429  

Commitments and guarantees

    11        9  

Derivatives

    99        163  

Total maximum exposure to loss

    $  3,236        $  2,109  

Real estate, credit- and power-related and other investing

 

Assets in VIEs

    $15,539        $11,771  

Carrying value of variable interests — assets

    3,289        2,911  

Carrying value of variable interests — liabilities

    2        9  

Maximum exposure to loss:

    

Commitments and guarantees

    1,617        1,658  

Loans and investments

    3,289        2,911  

Total maximum exposure to loss

    $  4,906        $  4,569  

Corporate debt and other asset-backed

    

Assets in VIEs

    $16,251        $11,540  

Carrying value of variable interests — assets

    1,660        602  

Carrying value of variable interests — liabilities

    212        245  

Maximum exposure to loss:

    

Retained interests

    56        56  

Purchased interests

    105        115  

Commitments and guarantees

    1,779        461  

Derivatives

    8,303        6,975  

Loans and investments

    817        99  

Total maximum exposure to loss

    $11,060        $  7,706  

Investments in funds

    

Assets in VIEs

    $11,019        $14,058  

Carrying value of variable interests — assets

    348        750  

Maximum exposure to loss:

    

Commitments and guarantees

    55        68  

Derivatives

    4        6  

Loans and investments

    348        750  

Total maximum exposure to loss

    $     407        $     824  

As of both December 2017 and December 2016, the carrying values of the firm’s variable interests in nonconsolidated VIEs are included in the consolidated statements of financial condition as follows:

 

 

Mortgage-backed: Assets were primarily included in financial instruments owned.

 

 

Real estate, credit- and power-related and other investing: Assets were primarily included in financial instruments owned and liabilities were included in financial instruments sold, but not yet purchased and other liabilities and accrued expenses.

 

 

Corporate debt and other asset-backed: Substantially all assets were included in financial instruments owned and liabilities were included in financial instruments sold, but not yet purchased.

 

 

Investments in funds: Assets were included in financial instruments owned.

Consolidated VIEs

The table below presents a summary of the carrying value and classification of assets and liabilities in consolidated VIEs.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017       2016  

Total consolidated VIEs

   

Assets

   

Cash and cash equivalents

    $   275       $   300  

Receivables from customers and counterparties

    2        

Loans receivable

    427       603  

Financial instruments owned

    1,194       2,047  

Other assets

    1,273       682  

Total

    $3,171       $3,632  

Liabilities

   

Other secured financings

    $1,023       $   854  

Payables to brokers, dealers and clearing organizations

          1  

Financial instruments sold, but not yet purchased

    15       7  

Unsecured short-term borrowings

    79       197  

Unsecured long-term borrowings

    225       334  

Other liabilities and accrued expenses

    577       803  

Total

    $1,919       $2,196  

In the table above:

 

 

Assets and liabilities are presented net of intercompany eliminations and exclude the benefit of offsetting financial instruments that are held to mitigate the risks associated with the firm’s variable interests.

 

 

VIEs in which the firm holds a majority voting interest are excluded if (i) the VIE meets the definition of a business and (ii) the VIE’s assets can be used for purposes other than the settlement of its obligations.

 

 

Substantially all assets can only be used to settle obligations of the VIE.

 

 

154   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The table below disaggregates, by principal business activity, the information for consolidated VIEs included in the summary table above.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017       2016  

Real estate, credit-related and other investing

   

Assets

   

Cash and cash equivalents

    $   275       $   300  

Loans receivable

    375       603  

Financial instruments owned

    896       1,708  

Other assets

    1,267       680  

Total

    $2,813       $3,291  

Liabilities

   

Other secured financings

    $   327       $   284  

Payables to brokers, dealers and clearing organizations

          1  

Financial instruments sold, but not yet purchased

    15       7  

Other liabilities and accrued expenses

    577       803  

Total

    $   919       $1,095  

 

Mortgage-backed and other asset-backed

 

 

Assets

   

Receivables from customers and counterparties

    $       2       $       –  

Loans receivable

    52        

Financial instruments owned

    242       253  

Other assets

    6       2  

Total

    $   302       $   255  

Liabilities

   

Other secured financings

    $   207       $   139  

Total

    $   207       $   139  

 

Principal-protected notes

   

Assets

   

Financial instruments owned

    $     56       $     86  

Total

    $     56       $     86  

Liabilities

   

Other secured financings

    $   489       $   431  

Unsecured short-term borrowings

    79       197  

Unsecured long-term borrowings

    225       334  

Total

    $   793       $   962  

In the table above:

 

 

The majority of the assets in principal-protected notes VIEs are intercompany and are eliminated in consolidation.

 

 

Creditors and beneficial interest holders of real estate, credit-related and other investing VIEs, and mortgage-backed and other asset-backed VIEs do not have recourse to the general credit of the firm.

Note 13.

Other Assets

Other assets are generally less liquid, nonfinancial assets. The table below presents other assets by type.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017       2016  

Property, leasehold improvements and equipment

    $15,094       $12,070  

Goodwill and identifiable intangible assets

    4,038       4,095  

Income tax-related assets

    3,728       5,550  

Miscellaneous receivables and other 

    5,486       3,766  

Total

    $28,346       $25,481  

In the table above:

 

 

Property, leasehold improvements and equipment is net of accumulated depreciation and amortization of $8.28 billion and $7.68 billion as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively. Property, leasehold improvements and equipment included $5.97 billion and $5.96 billion as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively, related to property, leasehold improvements and equipment that the firm uses in connection with its operations. The remainder is held by investment entities, including VIEs, consolidated by the firm. Substantially all property and equipment is depreciated on a straight-line basis over the useful life of the asset. Leasehold improvements are amortized on a straight-line basis over the useful life of the improvement or the term of the lease, whichever is shorter. Capitalized costs of software developed or obtained for internal use are amortized on a straight-line basis over three years.

 

 

The decrease in income tax-related assets during 2017 primarily reflected the estimated impact of Tax Legislation on income tax-related assets. See Note 24 for further information about Tax Legislation.

 

 

Miscellaneous receivables and other included debt securities accounted for as held-to-maturity of $800 million and $87 million as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively. As of both December 2017 and December 2016, these securities were backed by residential real estate and had maturities of greater than ten years. These securities are carried at amortized cost and the carrying value of these securities approximated fair value as of both December 2017 and December 2016. As these securities are not accounted for at fair value under the fair value option or at fair value in accordance with other U.S. GAAP, their fair value is not included in the firm’s fair value hierarchy in Notes 6 through 8. Had these securities been included in the firm’s fair value hierarchy, substantially all would have been classified in level 2 as of both December 2017 and December 2016.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   155


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

 

Miscellaneous receivables and other included investments in qualified affordable housing projects of $679 million and $682 million as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively.

 

 

Miscellaneous receivables and other included equity-method investments of $275 million and $219 million as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively.

 

 

Miscellaneous receivables and other included assets classified as held for sale of $634 million as of December 2017 related to certain of the firm’s consolidated investments within its Investing & Lending segment, substantially all of which consisted of property and equipment.

Goodwill and Identifiable Intangible Assets

Goodwill. The table below presents the carrying value of goodwill.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Investment Banking:

    

Financial Advisory

    $     98        $     98  

Underwriting

    183        183  

Institutional Client Services:

    

FICC Client Execution

    269        269  

Equities client execution

    2,403        2,403  

Securities services

    105        105  

Investing & Lending

    2        2  

Investment Management

    605        606  

Total

    $3,665        $3,666  

Goodwill is the cost of acquired companies in excess of the fair value of net assets, including identifiable intangible assets, at the acquisition date.

Goodwill is assessed for impairment annually in the fourth quarter or more frequently if events occur or circumstances change that indicate an impairment may exist. When assessing goodwill for impairment, first, qualitative factors are assessed to determine whether it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying value. If the results of the qualitative assessment are not conclusive, a quantitative goodwill test is performed.

The quantitative goodwill test compares the estimated fair value of each reporting unit with its estimated net book value (including goodwill and identifiable intangible assets). If the reporting unit’s estimated fair value exceeds its estimated net book value, goodwill is not impaired. An impairment is recognized if the estimated fair value of a reporting unit is less than its estimated net book value, with the amount of impairment equal to the difference between those values. To estimate the fair value of each reporting unit, a relative value technique is used because the firm believes market participants would use this technique to value the firm’s reporting units. The relative value technique applies observable price-to-earnings multiples or price-to-book multiples and projected return on equity of comparable competitors to reporting units’ net earnings or net book value. The estimated net book value of each reporting unit reflects an allocation of total shareholders’ equity and represents the estimated amount of total shareholders’ equity required to support the activities of the reporting unit under currently applicable regulatory capital requirements.

In the fourth quarter of 2017, the firm assessed goodwill for impairment for each of its reporting units by performing a qualitative assessment. Multiple factors were assessed with respect to each of the firm’s reporting units to determine whether it was more likely than not that the estimated fair value of any of these reporting units was less than its estimated carrying value. The qualitative assessment also considered changes since the prior quantitative tests.

The firm considered the following factors in the qualitative assessment performed in the fourth quarter when evaluating whether it was more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit was less than its carrying value:

 

 

Performance Indicators. During 2017, the firm’s net revenues and pre-tax margin increased as compared with 2016. Net earnings, diluted earnings per common share, return on average common shareholders’ equity and book value per common share for 2017 decreased as compared with 2016 due to Tax Legislation. However, Tax Legislation will result in a lower effective income tax rate in the future. See Note 24 for further information about Tax Legislation. In addition, although certain expenses increased, there were no significant negative changes to the firm’s overall cost structure since the prior quantitative goodwill tests were performed.

 

 

Firm and Industry Events. There were no events, entity-specific or otherwise, since the prior quantitative goodwill tests that would have had a significant negative impact on the valuation of the firm’s reporting units.

 

 

156   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

 

Macroeconomic Indicators. Since the prior quantitative goodwill tests, the firm’s general operating environment improved as concerns about the outlook for global economic growth moderated.

 

 

Fair Value Indicators. Since the prior quantitative goodwill tests, fair value indicators improved as global equity prices increased and credit spreads tightened. In addition, most publicly traded industry participants, including the firm, experienced increases in stock price, price-to-book multiples and price-to-earnings multiples.

As a result of the qualitative assessment, the firm determined that it was more likely than not that the estimated fair value of each of the reporting units exceeded its respective carrying value. Therefore, the firm determined that goodwill for each reporting unit was not impaired and that a quantitative goodwill test was not required.

Identifiable Intangible Assets. The table below presents the carrying value of identifiable intangible assets.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Institutional Client Services:

    

FICC Client Execution

    $      37        $      65  

Equities client execution

    88        141  

Investing & Lending

    140        105  

Investment Management

    108        118  

Total

    $    373        $    429  

The table below presents further details on the net carrying value of identifiable intangible assets.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Customer lists

    

Gross carrying value

    $ 1,091        $ 1,065  

Accumulated amortization

    (903      (837

Net carrying value

    188        228  

 

Other

    

Gross carrying value

    584        543  

Accumulated amortization

    (399      (342

Net carrying value

    185        201  

 

Total gross carrying value

    1,675        1,608  

Total accumulated amortization

    (1,302      (1,179

Total net carrying value

    $    373        $    429  

In the table above:

 

 

The net carrying value of other intangibles primarily includes intangible assets related to acquired leases and commodities transportation rights.

 

 

During 2017 and 2016, the firm acquired $113 million and $89 million, respectively, of intangible assets, primarily related to acquired leases, with a weighted average amortization period of five and three years, respectively.

Substantially all of the firm’s identifiable intangible assets are considered to have finite useful lives and are amortized over their estimated useful lives generally using the straight-line method.

The tables below present details about amortization of identifiable intangible assets.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017        2016        2015  

Amortization

    $150        $162        $132  

 

$ in millions    
As of
December 2017
 
 

Estimated future amortization

 

2018

    $133  

2019

    $  98  

2020

    $  39  

2021

    $  27  

2022

    $  20  

Impairments

The firm tests property, leasehold improvements and equipment, identifiable intangible assets and other assets for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances suggest that an asset’s or asset group’s carrying value may not be fully recoverable. To the extent the carrying value of an asset exceeds the projected undiscounted cash flows expected to result from the use and eventual disposal of the asset or asset group, the firm determines the asset is impaired and records an impairment equal to the difference between the estimated fair value and the carrying value of the asset or asset group. In addition, the firm will recognize an impairment prior to the sale of an asset if the carrying value of the asset exceeds its estimated fair value.

During 2017, 2016 and 2015, impairments were not material to the firm’s results of operations or financial condition.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   157


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Note 14.

Deposits

 

The table below presents the types and sources of the firm’s deposits.

 

$ in millions    
Savings and
Demand
 
 
     Time        Total  

As of December 2017

       

Private bank deposits

    $50,579        $  1,623        $  52,202  

Marcus deposits

    13,787        3,330        17,117  

Brokered certificates of deposit

           35,704        35,704  

Deposit sweep programs

    16,019               16,019  

Institutional deposits

    1        17,561        17,562  

Total

    $80,386        $58,218        $138,604  

 

As of December 2016

       

Private bank deposits

    $50,655        $  3,100        $  53,755  

Marcus deposits

    10,511        1,337        11,848  

Brokered certificates of deposit

           34,905        34,905  

Deposit sweep programs

    16,019               16,019  

Institutional deposits

    12        7,559        7,571  

Total

    $77,197        $46,901        $124,098  

In the table above:

 

 

Substantially all deposits are interest-bearing.

 

 

Savings and demand deposits have no stated maturity.

 

 

Time deposits included $22.90 billion and $13.78 billion as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively, of deposits accounted for at fair value under the fair value option. See Note 8 for further information about deposits accounted for at fair value.

 

 

Time deposits had a weighted average maturity of approximately 2 years and 2.5 years as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively.

 

 

Deposit sweep programs represent long-term contractual agreements with several U.S. broker-dealers who sweep client cash to FDIC-insured deposits.

 

 

Deposits insured by the FDIC as of December 2017 and December 2016 were approximately $75.02 billion and $69.91 billion, respectively.

The table below presents deposits held in U.S. and non-U.S. offices.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

U.S. offices

    $111,002        $106,037  

Non-U.S. offices

    27,602        18,061  

Total

    $138,604        $124,098  

In the table above, U.S. deposits were held at Goldman Sachs Bank USA (GS Bank USA) and substantially all non-U.S. deposits were held at Goldman Sachs International Bank (GSIB).

The table below presents maturities of time deposits held in U.S. and non-U.S. offices.

 

    As of December 2017  
$ in millions     U.S.        Non-U.S.        Total  

2018

    $13,106        $15,037        $28,143  

2019

    7,297        3,179        10,476  

2020

    5,142        12        5,154  

2021

    3,574        43        3,617  

2022

    4,907        86        4,993  

2023 - thereafter

    5,289        546        5,835  

Total

    $39,315        $18,903        $58,218  

As of December 2017, deposits in U.S. and non-U.S. offices included $1.43 billion and $11.66 billion, respectively, of time deposits that were greater than $250,000.

The firm’s savings and demand deposits are recorded based on the amount of cash received plus accrued interest, which approximates fair value. In addition, the firm designates certain derivatives as fair value hedges to convert a portion of its time deposits not accounted for at fair value from fixed-rate obligations into floating-rate obligations. The carrying value of time deposits not accounted for at fair value approximated fair value as of both December 2017 and December 2016. While these savings and demand deposits and time deposits are carried at amounts that approximate fair value, they are not accounted for at fair value under the fair value option or at fair value in accordance with other U.S. GAAP and therefore are not included in the firm’s fair value hierarchy in Notes 6 through 8. Had these deposits been included in the firm’s fair value hierarchy, they would have been classified in level 2 as of both December 2017 and December 2016.

 

 

158   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Note 15.

Short-Term Borrowings

The table below presents details about the firm’s short-term borrowings.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Other secured financings (short-term)

    $14,896        $13,118  

Unsecured short-term borrowings

    46,922        39,265  

Total

    $61,818        $52,383  

See Note 10 for information about other secured financings.

Unsecured short-term borrowings includes the portion of unsecured long-term borrowings maturing within one year of the financial statement date and unsecured long-term borrowings that are redeemable within one year of the financial statement date at the option of the holder.

The firm accounts for certain hybrid financial instruments at fair value under the fair value option. See Note 8 for further information about unsecured short-term borrowings that are accounted for at fair value. The carrying value of unsecured short-term borrowings that are not recorded at fair value generally approximates fair value due to the short-term nature of the obligations. While these unsecured short-term borrowings are carried at amounts that approximate fair value, they are not accounted for at fair value under the fair value option or at fair value in accordance with other U.S. GAAP and therefore are not included in the firm’s fair value hierarchy in Notes 6 through 8. Had these borrowings been included in the firm’s fair value hierarchy, substantially all would have been classified in level 2 as of both December 2017 and December 2016.

The table below presents details about the firm’s unsecured short-term borrowings.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Current portion of unsecured long-term borrowings

    $30,090        $23,528  

Hybrid financial instruments

    12,973        11,700  

Other unsecured short-term borrowings

    3,859        4,037  

Total

    $46,922        $39,265  

 

Weighted average interest rate 

    2.28%        1.68%  

In the table above:

 

 

The current portion of unsecured long-term borrowings included $26.28 billion and $21.53 billion as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively, issued by Group Inc.

 

 

The weighted average interest rates for these borrowings include the effect of hedging activities and exclude unsecured short-term borrowings accounted for at fair value under the fair value option. See Note 7 for further information about hedging activities.

Note 16.

Long-Term Borrowings

The table below presents details about the firm’s long-term borrowings.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Other secured financings (long-term)

    $    9,892        $    8,405  

Unsecured long-term borrowings

    217,687        189,086  

Total

    $227,579        $197,491  

See Note 10 for information about other secured financings.

The table below presents unsecured long-term borrowings extending through 2057, which consists principally of senior borrowings.

 

$ in millions    

U.S.

Dollar

 

 

    
Non-U.S.
Dollar
 
 
     Total  

As of December 2017

       

Fixed-rate obligations:

       

Group Inc.

    $101,791        $  35,116        $136,907  

Subsidiaries

    2,244        1,859        4,103  

Floating-rate obligations:

       

Group Inc.

    29,637        23,938        53,575  

Subsidiaries

    14,977        8,125        23,102  

Total

    $148,649        $  69,038        $217,687  

 

As of December 2016

       

Fixed-rate obligations:

       

Group Inc.

    $  93,885        $  31,274        $125,159  

Subsidiaries

    2,228        885        3,113  

Floating-rate obligations:

       

Group Inc.

    27,864        19,112        46,976  

Subsidiaries

    8,884        4,954        13,838  

Total

    $132,861        $  56,225        $189,086  

In the table above:

 

 

Floating interest rates are generally based on LIBOR or Overnight Index Swap Rate. Equity-linked and indexed instruments are included in floating-rate obligations.

 

 

Interest rates on U.S. dollar-denominated debt ranged from 1.60% to 10.04% (with a weighted average rate of 4.24%) and 1.60% to 10.04% (with a weighted average rate of 4.57%) as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively.

 

 

Interest rates on non-U.S. dollar-denominated debt ranged from 0.31% to 13.00% (with a weighted average rate of 2.60%) and 0.02% to 13.00% (with a weighted average rate of 3.05%) as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   159


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The table below presents unsecured long-term borrowings by maturity date.

 

    As of December 2017  
$ in millions     Group Inc.        Subsidiaries        Total  

2019

    $  24,915        $  5,590        $  30,505  

2020

    20,215        2,905        23,120  

2021

    20,547        1,234        21,781  

2022

    21,044        1,558        22,602  

2023 - thereafter

    103,761        15,918        119,679  

Total

    $190,482        $27,205        $217,687  

In the table above:

 

 

Unsecured long-term borrowings maturing within one year of the financial statement date and unsecured long-term borrowings that are redeemable within one year of the financial statement date at the option of the holder are excluded as they are included in unsecured short-term borrowings.

 

 

Unsecured long-term borrowings that are repayable prior to maturity at the option of the firm are reflected at their contractual maturity dates.

 

 

Unsecured long-term borrowings that are redeemable prior to maturity at the option of the holder are reflected at the earliest dates such options become exercisable.

 

 

Unsecured long-term borrowings included $5.61 billion of adjustments to the carrying value of certain unsecured long-term borrowings resulting from the application of hedge accounting by year of maturity as follows: $167 million in 2019, $192 million in 2020, $387 million in 2021, $(82) million in 2022, and $4.95 billion in 2023 and thereafter.

The firm designates certain derivatives as fair value hedges to convert a portion of its fixed-rate unsecured long-term borrowings not accounted for at fair value into floating-rate obligations. See Note 7 for further information about hedging activities.

The table below presents unsecured long-term borrowings, after giving effect to such hedging activities.

 

$ in millions     Group Inc.        Subsidiaries        Total  

As of December 2017

       

Fixed-rate obligations:

       

At fair value

    $           –        $     147        $       147  

At amortized cost

    86,951        3,852        90,803  

Floating-rate obligations:

       

At fair value

    18,207        20,284        38,491  

At amortized cost

    85,324        2,922        88,246  

Total

    $190,482        $27,205        $217,687  

 

As of December 2016

       

Fixed-rate obligations:

       

At fair value

    $           –        $     150        $       150  

At amortized cost

    71,225        3,493        74,718  

Floating-rate obligations:

       

At fair value

    17,591        11,669        29,260  

At amortized cost

    83,319        1,639        84,958  

Total

    $172,135        $16,951        $189,086  

In the table above, the weighted average interest rates on the aggregate amounts were 2.86% (3.67% related to fixed-rate obligations and 2.02% related to floating-rate obligations) and 2.87% (3.90% related to fixed-rate obligations and 1.97% related to floating-rate obligations) as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively. These rates exclude unsecured long-term borrowings accounted for at fair value under the fair value option.

As of both December 2017 and December 2016, the carrying value of unsecured long-term borrowings for which the firm did not elect the fair value option approximated fair value. As these borrowings are not accounted for at fair value under the fair value option or at fair value in accordance with other U.S. GAAP, their fair value is not included in the firm’s fair value hierarchy in Notes 6 through 8. Had these borrowings been included in the firm’s fair value hierarchy, substantially all would have been classified in level 2 as of both December 2017 and December 2016.

Subordinated Borrowings

Unsecured long-term borrowings includes subordinated debt and junior subordinated debt. Junior subordinated debt is junior in right of payment to other subordinated borrowings, which are junior to senior borrowings. As of December 2017 and December 2016, subordinated debt had maturities ranging from 2020 to 2045, and 2018 to 2045, respectively. Subordinated debt that matures within one year is included in unsecured short-term borrowings.

The table below presents details about the firm’s subordinated borrowings.

 

$ in millions    
Par
Amount
 
 
    
Carrying
Amount
 
 
     Rate  

As of December 2017

       

Subordinated debt

    $14,117        $16,235        3.31%  

Junior subordinated debt

    1,168        1,539        2.37%  

Total

    $15,285        $17,774        3.24%  

 

As of December 2016

       

Subordinated debt

    $15,058        $17,604        4.29%  

Junior subordinated debt

    1,360        1,809        5.70%  

Total

    $16,418        $19,413        4.41%  

In the table above:

 

 

Par amount and carrying amount of subordinated debt issued by Group Inc. were $13.96 billion and $16.08 billion, respectively, as of December 2017, and $14.84 billion and $17.39 billion, respectively, as of December 2016.

 

 

The rate is the weighted average interest rate for these borrowings, including the effect of fair value hedges used to convert fixed-rate obligations into floating-rate obligations. See Note 7 for further information about hedging activities. The rates exclude subordinated borrowings accounted for at fair value under the fair value option.

 

 

160   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

During 2017, the firm repurchased or redeemed subordinated debt with a par amount of $1.45 billion (carrying value of $1.80 billion) for $1.70 billion. As a result, such debt was extinguished.

Junior Subordinated Debt

Junior Subordinated Debt Held by Trusts. In 2012, the Vesey Street Investment Trust I (Vesey Street Trust) and the Murray Street Investment Trust I (Murray Street Trust) issued an aggregate of $2.25 billion of senior guaranteed trust securities to third parties, the proceeds of which were used to purchase junior subordinated debt issued by Group Inc. from Goldman Sachs Capital II and Goldman Sachs Capital III (APEX Trusts). The APEX Trusts used the proceeds to purchase shares of Group Inc.’s Perpetual Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series E (Series E Preferred Stock) and Perpetual Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series F (Series F Preferred Stock). The senior guaranteed trust securities issued by the Vesey Street Trust and the related junior subordinated debt matured during the third quarter of 2016. As of December 2016, $1.45 billion of senior guaranteed trust securities issued by the Murray Street Trust and the related junior subordinated debt were outstanding. These securities and the related junior subordinated debt matured during the first quarter of 2017.

The APEX Trusts are Delaware statutory trusts sponsored by the firm and wholly-owned finance subsidiaries of the firm for regulatory and legal purposes but are not consolidated for accounting purposes.

The firm has covenanted in favor of the holders of Group Inc.’s 6.345% junior subordinated debt due February 15, 2034, that, subject to certain exceptions, the firm will not redeem or purchase the capital securities issued by the APEX Trusts, shares of Group Inc.’s Series E or Series F Preferred Stock or shares of Group Inc.’s Series O Perpetual Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock if the redemption or purchase results in less than $253 million aggregate liquidation preference outstanding, prior to specified dates in 2022 for a price that exceeds a maximum amount determined by reference to the net cash proceeds that the firm has received from the sale of qualifying securities. During 2016, the firm exchanged a par amount of $1.32 billion of APEX issued by the APEX Trusts for a corresponding redemption value of the Series E and Series F Preferred Stock, which was permitted under the covenants referenced above.

Junior Subordinated Debt Issued in Connection with Trust Preferred Securities. Group Inc. issued $2.84 billion of junior subordinated debt in 2004 to Goldman Sachs Capital I (Trust), a Delaware statutory trust. The Trust issued $2.75 billion of guaranteed preferred beneficial interests (Trust Preferred Securities) to third parties and $85 million of common beneficial interests to Group Inc. and used the proceeds from the issuances to purchase the junior subordinated debt from Group Inc. As of December 2017, the outstanding par amount of junior subordinated debt held by the Trust was $1.17 billion and the outstanding par amount of Trust Preferred Securities and common beneficial interests issued by the Trust was $1.13 billion and $35.1 million, respectively. During 2017, the firm purchased $186 million (par amount) of Trust Preferred Securities and delivered these securities, along with $5.7 million of common beneficial interests, to the Trust in exchange for a corresponding par amount of the junior subordinated debt. Following the exchanges, these Trust Preferred Securities, common beneficial interests and junior subordinated debt were extinguished. As of December 2016, the outstanding par amount of junior subordinated debt held by the Trust was $1.36 billion and the outstanding par amount of Trust Preferred Securities and common beneficial interests issued by the Trust was $1.32 billion and $40.8 million, respectively. The Trust is a wholly-owned finance subsidiary of the firm for regulatory and legal purposes but is not consolidated for accounting purposes.

The firm pays interest semi-annually on the junior subordinated debt at an annual rate of 6.345% and the debt matures on February 15, 2034. The coupon rate and the payment dates applicable to the beneficial interests are the same as the interest rate and payment dates for the junior subordinated debt. The firm has the right, from time to time, to defer payment of interest on the junior subordinated debt, and therefore cause payment on the Trust’s preferred beneficial interests to be deferred, in each case up to ten consecutive semi-annual periods. During any such deferral period, the firm will not be permitted to, among other things, pay dividends on or make certain repurchases of its common stock. The Trust is not permitted to pay any distributions on the common beneficial interests held by Group Inc. unless all dividends payable on the preferred beneficial interests have been paid in full.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   161


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Note 17.

Other Liabilities and Accrued Expenses

The table below presents other liabilities and accrued expenses by type.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Compensation and benefits

    $  6,710        $  7,181  

Noncontrolling interests

    553        506  

Income tax-related liabilities

    4,051        1,794  

Employee interests in consolidated funds

    156        77  

Subordinated liabilities of consolidated VIEs

    19        584  

Accrued expenses and other

    5,433        4,220  

Total

    $16,922        $14,362  

In the table above, the increase in income tax-related liabilities during 2017 reflected the estimated impact of Tax Legislation on income tax-related liabilities. See Note 24 for further information about Tax Legislation.

Note 18.

Commitments, Contingencies and Guarantees

Commitments

The table below presents the firm’s commitments by type.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Commercial lending:

    

Investment-grade

    $  93,115        $  73,664  

Non-investment-grade

    45,291        34,878  

Warehouse financing

    5,340        3,514  

Total commitments to extend credit

    143,746        112,056  

Contingent and forward starting collateralized agreements

    41,756        25,348  

Forward starting collateralized financings

    16,902        8,939  

Letters of credit

    437        373  

Investment commitments

    6,840        8,444  

Other

    6,310        6,014  

Total commitments

    $215,991        $161,174  

The table below presents the firm’s commitments by period of expiration.

 

    As of December 2017  
$ in millions     2018      
2019 -
2020
 
 
   
2021 -
2022
 
 
   
2023 -
Thereafter
 
 

Commercial lending:

       

Investment-grade

    $14,593       $38,836       $38,431       $  1,255  

Non-investment-grade

    2,614       12,297       21,833       8,547  

Warehouse financing

    1,688       1,730       1,241       681  

Total commitments to extend credit

    18,895       52,863       61,505       10,483  

Contingent and forward starting collateralized agreements

    41,756                    

Forward starting collateralized financings

    16,902                    

Letters of credit

    288       109             40  

Investment commitments

    2,836       676       493       2,835  

Other

    6,089       171       50        

Total commitments

    $86,766       $53,819       $62,048       $13,358  

Commitments to Extend Credit

The firm’s commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend with fixed termination dates and depend on the satisfaction of all contractual conditions to borrowing. These commitments are presented net of amounts syndicated to third parties. The total commitment amount does not necessarily reflect actual future cash flows because the firm may syndicate all or substantial additional portions of these commitments. In addition, commitments can expire unused or be reduced or cancelled at the counterparty’s request.

As of December 2017 and December 2016, $124.50 billion and $98.05 billion, respectively, of the firm’s lending commitments were held for investment and were accounted for on an accrual basis. See Note 9 for further information about such commitments. In addition, as of December 2017 and December 2016, $9.84 billion and $6.87 billion, respectively, of the firm’s lending commitments were held for sale and were accounted for at the lower of cost or fair value. The firm accounts for the remaining commitments to extend credit at fair value. Losses, if any, are generally recorded, net of any fees in other principal transactions.

 

 

162   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Commercial Lending. The firm’s commercial lending commitments are extended to investment-grade and non-investment-grade corporate borrowers. Commitments to investment-grade corporate borrowers are principally used for operating liquidity and general corporate purposes. The firm also extends lending commitments in connection with contingent acquisition financing and other types of corporate lending, as well as commercial real estate financing. Commitments that are extended for contingent acquisition financing are often intended to be short-term in nature, as borrowers often seek to replace them with other funding sources.

Sumitomo Mitsui Financial Group, Inc. (SMFG) provides the firm with credit loss protection on certain approved loan commitments (primarily investment-grade commercial lending commitments). The notional amount of such loan commitments was $25.70 billion and $26.88 billion as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively. The credit loss protection on loan commitments provided by SMFG is generally limited to 95% of the first loss the firm realizes on such commitments, up to a maximum of approximately $950 million. In addition, subject to the satisfaction of certain conditions, upon the firm’s request, SMFG will provide protection for 70% of additional losses on such commitments, up to a maximum of $1.13 billion, of which $550 million and $768 million of protection had been provided as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively. The firm also uses other financial instruments to mitigate credit risks related to certain commitments not covered by SMFG. These instruments primarily include credit default swaps that reference the same or similar underlying instrument or entity, or credit default swaps that reference a market index.

Warehouse Financing. The firm provides financing to clients who warehouse financial assets. These arrangements are secured by the warehoused assets, primarily consisting of retail and corporate loans.

Contingent and Forward Starting Collateralized Agreements / Forward Starting Collateralized Financings

Contingent and forward starting collateralized agreements includes resale and securities borrowing agreements, and forward starting collateralized financings includes repurchase and secured lending agreements that settle at a future date, generally within three business days. The firm also enters into commitments to provide contingent financing to its clients and counterparties through resale agreements. The firm’s funding of these commitments depends on the satisfaction of all contractual conditions to the resale agreement and these commitments can expire unused.

Letters of Credit

The firm has commitments under letters of credit issued by various banks which the firm provides to counterparties in lieu of securities or cash to satisfy various collateral and margin deposit requirements.

Investment Commitments

Investment commitments includes commitments to invest in private equity, real estate and other assets directly and through funds that the firm raises and manages. Investment commitments included $2.09 billion and $2.10 billion as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively, related to commitments to invest in funds managed by the firm. If these commitments are called, they would be funded at market value on the date of investment.

Leases

The firm has contractual obligations under long-term noncancelable lease agreements for office space expiring on various dates through 2069. Certain agreements are subject to periodic escalation provisions for increases in real estate taxes and other charges.

The table below presents future minimum rental payments, net of minimum sublease rentals.

 

$ in millions    
As of
December 2017
 
 

2018

    $   299  

2019

    282  

2020

    262  

2021

    205  

2022

    145  

2023 - thereafter

    771  

Total

    $1,964  

Rent charged to operating expenses was $273 million for 2017, $244 million for 2016 and $249 million for 2015.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   163


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Operating leases include office space held in excess of current requirements. Rent expense relating to space held for growth is included in occupancy expenses. The firm records a liability, based on the fair value of the remaining lease rentals reduced by any potential or existing sublease rentals, for leases where the firm has ceased using the space and management has concluded that the firm will not derive any future economic benefits. Costs to terminate a lease before the end of its term are recognized and measured at fair value on termination. Total occupancy expenses for space held in excess of the firm’s current requirements and exit costs related to its office space were not material for both 2017 and 2015, and were approximately $68 million for 2016.

Contingencies

Legal Proceedings. See Note 27 for information about legal proceedings, including certain mortgage-related matters, and agreements the firm has entered into to toll the statute of limitations.

Certain Mortgage-Related Contingencies. There are multiple areas of focus by regulators, governmental agencies and others within the mortgage market that may impact originators, issuers, servicers and investors. There remains significant uncertainty surrounding the nature and extent of any potential exposure for participants in this market.

The firm has not been a significant originator of residential mortgage loans. The firm did purchase loans originated by others and generally received loan-level representations. During the period 2005 through 2008, the firm sold approximately $10 billion of loans to government-sponsored enterprises and approximately $11 billion of loans to other third parties. In addition, the firm transferred $125 billion of loans to trusts and other mortgage securitization vehicles. In connection with both sales of loans and securitizations, the firm provided loan-level representations and/or assigned the loan-level representations from the party from whom the firm purchased the loans.

The firm’s exposure to claims for repurchase of residential mortgage loans based on alleged breaches of representations will depend on a number of factors such as the extent to which these claims are made within the statute of limitations, taking into consideration the agreements to toll the statute of limitations the firm entered into with trustees representing certain trusts. Based upon the large number of defaults in residential mortgages, including those sold or securitized by the firm, there is a potential for repurchase claims. However, the firm is not in a position to make a meaningful estimate of that exposure at this time.

Other Contingencies. In connection with the sale of Metro International Trade Services (Metro), the firm agreed to provide indemnities to the buyer, which primarily relate to fundamental representations and warranties, and potential liabilities for legal or regulatory proceedings arising out of the conduct of Metro’s business while the firm owned it.

In connection with the settlement agreement with the Residential Mortgage-Backed Securities Working Group of the U.S. Financial Fraud Enforcement Task Force (RMBS Working Group), the firm agreed to provide $1.80 billion in consumer relief in the form of principal forgiveness for underwater homeowners and distressed borrowers; financing for construction, rehabilitation and preservation of affordable housing; and support for debt restructuring, foreclosure prevention and housing quality improvement programs, as well as land banks.

Guarantees

The table below presents information about certain derivatives that meet the definition of a guarantee, securities lending indemnifications and certain other financial guarantees.

 

$ in millions     Derivatives      


Securities

lending
indemnifications

 

 
 

   

Other
financial
guarantees
 
 
 

As of December 2017

     

Carrying Value of Net Liability

    $       5,406       $         –       $     37  

Maximum Payout/Notional Amount by Period of Expiration

 

2018

    $1,139,751       $37,959       $   723  

2019 - 2020

    205,983             1,515  

2021 - 2022

    71,599             1,209  

2023 - thereafter

    76,540             137  

Total

    $1,493,873       $37,959       $3,584  

 

As of December 2016

     

Carrying Value of Net Liability

    $       8,873       $         –       $     50  

Maximum Payout/Notional Amount by Period of Expiration

 

2017

    $   432,328       $33,403       $1,064  

2018 - 2019

    261,676             763  

2020 - 2021

    71,264             1,662  

2022 - thereafter

    51,506             173  

Total

    $   816,774       $33,403       $3,662  

In the table above:

 

 

The maximum payout is based on the notional amount of the contract and does not represent anticipated losses.

 

 

Amounts exclude certain commitments to issue standby letters of credit that are included in commitments to extend credit. See the tables in “Commitments” above for a summary of the firm’s commitments.

 

 

The carrying value for derivatives included derivative assets of $2.20 billion and $1.20 billion and derivative liabilities of $7.61 billion and $10.07 billion as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively.

 

 

164   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Derivative Guarantees. The firm enters into various derivatives that meet the definition of a guarantee under U.S. GAAP, including written equity and commodity put options, written currency contracts and interest rate caps, floors and swaptions. These derivatives are risk managed together with derivatives that do not meet the definition of a guarantee, and therefore the amounts in the table above do not reflect the firm’s overall risk related to its derivative activities. Disclosures about derivatives are not required if they may be cash settled and the firm has no basis to conclude it is probable that the counterparties held the underlying instruments at inception of the contract. The firm has concluded that these conditions have been met for certain large, internationally active commercial and investment bank counterparties, central clearing counterparties and certain other counterparties. Accordingly, the firm has not included such contracts in the table above. In addition, see Note 7 for information about credit derivatives that meet the definition of a guarantee, which are not included in the table above.

Derivatives are accounted for at fair value and therefore the carrying value is considered the best indication of payment/performance risk for individual contracts. However, the carrying values in the table above exclude the effect of counterparty and cash collateral netting.

Securities Lending Indemnifications. The firm, in its capacity as an agency lender, indemnifies most of its securities lending customers against losses incurred in the event that borrowers do not return securities and the collateral held is insufficient to cover the market value of the securities borrowed. Collateral held by the lenders in connection with securities lending indemnifications was $39.03 billion and $34.33 billion as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively. Because the contractual nature of these arrangements requires the firm to obtain collateral with a market value that exceeds the value of the securities lent to the borrower, there is minimal performance risk associated with these guarantees.

Other Financial Guarantees. In the ordinary course of business, the firm provides other financial guarantees of the obligations of third parties (e.g., standby letters of credit and other guarantees to enable clients to complete transactions and fund-related guarantees). These guarantees represent obligations to make payments to beneficiaries if the guaranteed party fails to fulfill its obligation under a contractual arrangement with that beneficiary.

Guarantees of Securities Issued by Trusts. The firm has established trusts, including Goldman Sachs Capital I, the APEX Trusts and other entities for the limited purpose of issuing securities to third parties, lending the proceeds to the firm and entering into contractual arrangements with the firm and third parties related to this purpose. The firm does not consolidate these entities. See Note 16 for further information about the transactions involving Goldman Sachs Capital I and the APEX Trusts.

The firm effectively provides for the full and unconditional guarantee of the securities issued by these entities. Timely payment by the firm of amounts due to these entities under the guarantee, borrowing, preferred stock and related contractual arrangements will be sufficient to cover payments due on the securities issued by these entities.

Management believes that it is unlikely that any circumstances will occur, such as nonperformance on the part of paying agents or other service providers, that would make it necessary for the firm to make payments related to these entities other than those required under the terms of the guarantee, borrowing, preferred stock and related contractual arrangements and in connection with certain expenses incurred by these entities.

Indemnities and Guarantees of Service Providers. In the ordinary course of business, the firm indemnifies and guarantees certain service providers, such as clearing and custody agents, trustees and administrators, against specified potential losses in connection with their acting as an agent of, or providing services to, the firm or its affiliates.

The firm may also be liable to some clients or other parties for losses arising from its custodial role or caused by acts or omissions of third-party service providers, including sub-custodians and third-party brokers. In certain cases, the firm has the right to seek indemnification from these third-party service providers for certain relevant losses incurred by the firm. In addition, the firm is a member of payment, clearing and settlement networks, as well as securities exchanges around the world that may require the firm to meet the obligations of such networks and exchanges in the event of member defaults and other loss scenarios.

In connection with the firm’s prime brokerage and clearing businesses, the firm agrees to clear and settle on behalf of its clients the transactions entered into by them with other brokerage firms. The firm’s obligations in respect of such transactions are secured by the assets in the client’s account, as well as any proceeds received from the transactions cleared and settled by the firm on behalf of the client. In connection with joint venture investments, the firm may issue loan guarantees under which it may be liable in the event of fraud, misappropriation, environmental liabilities and certain other matters involving the borrower.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   165


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The firm is unable to develop an estimate of the maximum payout under these guarantees and indemnifications. However, management believes that it is unlikely the firm will have to make any material payments under these arrangements, and no material liabilities related to these guarantees and indemnifications have been recognized in the consolidated statements of financial condition as of both December 2017 and December 2016.

Other Representations, Warranties and Indemnifications. The firm provides representations and warranties to counterparties in connection with a variety of commercial transactions and occasionally indemnifies them against potential losses caused by the breach of those representations and warranties. The firm may also provide indemnifications protecting against changes in or adverse application of certain U.S. tax laws in connection with ordinary-course transactions such as securities issuances, borrowings or derivatives.

In addition, the firm may provide indemnifications to some counterparties to protect them in the event additional taxes are owed or payments are withheld, due either to a change in or an adverse application of certain non-U.S. tax laws.

These indemnifications generally are standard contractual terms and are entered into in the ordinary course of business. Generally, there are no stated or notional amounts included in these indemnifications, and the contingencies triggering the obligation to indemnify are not expected to occur. The firm is unable to develop an estimate of the maximum payout under these guarantees and indemnifications. However, management believes that it is unlikely the firm will have to make any material payments under these arrangements, and no material liabilities related to these arrangements have been recognized in the consolidated statements of financial condition as of both December 2017 and December 2016.

Guarantees of Subsidiaries. Group Inc. fully and unconditionally guarantees the securities issued by GS Finance Corp., a wholly-owned finance subsidiary of the firm. Group Inc. has guaranteed the payment obligations of Goldman Sachs & Co. LLC (GS&Co.) and GS Bank USA, subject to certain exceptions.

In addition, Group Inc. guarantees many of the obligations of its other consolidated subsidiaries on a transaction-by-transaction basis, as negotiated with counterparties. Group Inc. is unable to develop an estimate of the maximum payout under its subsidiary guarantees; however, because these guaranteed obligations are also obligations of consolidated subsidiaries, Group Inc.’s liabilities as guarantor are not separately disclosed.

Note 19.

Shareholders’ Equity

Common Equity

As of both December 2017 and December 2016, the firm had 4.00 billion authorized shares of common stock and 200 million authorized shares of nonvoting common stock, each with a par value of $0.01 per share.

Dividends declared per common share were $2.90 in 2017, $2.60 in 2016 and $2.55 in 2015. On January 16, 2018, the Board of Directors of Group Inc. (Board) declared a dividend of $0.75 per common share to be paid on March 29, 2018 to common shareholders of record on March 1, 2018.

The firm’s share repurchase program is intended to help maintain the appropriate level of common equity. The share repurchase program is effected primarily through regular open-market purchases (which may include repurchase plans designed to comply with Rule 10b5-1), the amounts and timing of which are determined primarily by the firm’s current and projected capital position, but which may also be influenced by general market conditions and the prevailing price and trading volumes of the firm’s common stock. Prior to repurchasing common stock, the firm must receive confirmation that the FRB does not object to such capital action.

The table below presents the amount of common stock repurchased by the firm under the share repurchase program.

 

    Year Ended December  
in millions, except per share amounts     2017       2016       2015  

Common share repurchases

    29.0       36.6       22.1  

Average cost per share

    $231.87       $165.88       $189.41  

Total cost of common share repurchases

    $  6,721       $  6,069       $  4,195  

Pursuant to the terms of certain share-based compensation plans, employees may remit shares to the firm or the firm may cancel RSUs or stock options to satisfy minimum statutory employee tax withholding requirements and the exercise price of stock options. Under these plans, during 2017, 2016 and 2015, 12,165 shares, 49,374 shares and 35,217 shares were remitted with a total value of $3 million, $7 million and $6 million, and the firm cancelled 8.1 million, 6.1 million and 5.7 million of RSUs with a total value of $1.94 billion, $921 million and $1.03 billion, respectively. Under these plans, the firm also cancelled 4.6 million, 5.5 million and 2.0 million of stock options with a total value of $1.09 billion, $1.11 billion and $406 million during 2017, 2016 and 2015, respectively.

 

 

166   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Preferred Equity

The tables below present details about the perpetual preferred stock issued and outstanding as of December 2017.

 

Series    
Shares
Authorized
 
 
    
Shares
Issued
 
 
    
Shares
Outstanding
 
 
    
Depositary Shares
Per Share
 
 

A

    50,000        30,000        29,999        1,000  

B

    50,000        32,000        32,000        1,000  

C

    25,000        8,000        8,000        1,000  

D

    60,000        54,000        53,999        1,000  

E

    17,500        7,667        7,667        N/A  

F

    5,000        1,615        1,615        N/A  

J

    46,000        40,000        40,000        1,000  

K

    32,200        28,000        28,000        1,000  

L

    52,000        52,000        52,000        25  

M

    80,000        80,000        80,000        25  

N

    31,050        27,000        27,000        1,000  

O

    26,000        26,000        26,000        25  

P

    66,000        60,000        60,000        25  

Total

    540,750        446,282        446,280           

 

Series     Earliest Redemption Date       
Liquidation
Preference
 
 
      

Redemption
Value
($ in millions)
 
 
 

A

    Currently redeemable        $  25,000          $     750  

B

    Currently redeemable        $  25,000          800  

C

    Currently redeemable        $  25,000          200  

D

    Currently redeemable        $  25,000          1,350  

E

    Currently redeemable        $100,000          767  

F

    Currently redeemable        $100,000          161  

J

    May 10, 2023        $  25,000          1,000  

K

    May 10, 2024        $  25,000          700  

L

    May 10, 2019        $  25,000          1,300  

M

    May 10, 2020        $  25,000          2,000  

N

    May 10, 2021        $  25,000          675  

O

    November 10, 2026        $  25,000          650  

P

    November 10, 2022        $  25,000          1,500  

Total

                        $11,853  

In the tables above:

 

 

All shares have a par value of $0.01 per share and, where applicable, each share is represented by the specified number of depositary shares.

 

 

The earliest redemption date represents the date on which each share of non-cumulative Preferred Stock is redeemable at the firm’s option.

 

 

Prior to redeeming preferred stock, the firm must receive confirmation that the FRB does not object to such capital action.

 

 

In November 2017, Group Inc. issued 60,000 shares of Series P perpetual 5.00% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock (Series P Preferred Stock).

 

 

The redemption price per share for Series A through F Preferred Stock is the liquidation preference plus declared and unpaid dividends. The redemption price per share for Series J through P Preferred Stock is the liquidation preference plus accrued and unpaid dividends. Each share of non-cumulative Series E and Series F Preferred Stock issued and outstanding is redeemable at the firm’s option, subject to certain covenant restrictions governing the firm’s ability to redeem the preferred stock without issuing common stock or other instruments with equity-like characteristics. See Note 16 for information about the replacement capital covenants applicable to the Series E and Series F Preferred Stock.

 

All series of preferred stock are pari passu and have a preference over the firm’s common stock on liquidation.

 

 

The firm’s ability to declare or pay dividends on, or purchase, redeem or otherwise acquire, its common stock is subject to certain restrictions in the event that the firm fails to pay or set aside full dividends on the preferred stock for the latest completed dividend period.

During 2016, the firm delivered a par amount of $1.32 billion (fair value of $1.04 billion) of APEX to the APEX Trusts in exchange for 9,833 shares of Series E Preferred Stock and 3,385 shares of Series F Preferred Stock for a total redemption value of $1.32 billion (net carrying value of $1.31 billion). Following the exchange, these shares of Series E and Series F Preferred Stock were cancelled. The difference between the fair value of the APEX and the net carrying value of the preferred stock at the time of cancellation was $266 million. This difference was recorded as a reduction to preferred stock dividends in 2016. See Note 16 for further information about APEX.

In November 2017, the firm redeemed the 34,000 shares of Series I 5.95% Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock (Series I Preferred Stock) for the stated redemption price of $850 million ($25,000 per share), plus accrued and unpaid dividends. The difference between the redemption value of the Series I Preferred Stock and the net carrying value at the time of redemption was $14 million. This difference was recorded as an addition to preferred stock dividends in 2017.

In February 2018, the firm redeemed 26,000 shares of its outstanding Series B 6.20% Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock (Series B Preferred Stock) with a redemption value of $650 million ($25,000 per share). The difference between the redemption value of the Series B Preferred Stock and the net carrying value at the time of redemption was $15 million. This difference will be recorded as an addition to preferred stock dividends in the first quarter of 2018.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   167


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The table below presents the dividend rates of the firm’s perpetual preferred stock as of December 2017.

 

Series   Per Annum Dividend Rate

A

  3 month LIBOR + 0.75%, with floor of 3.75%, payable quarterly

B

  6.20%, payable quarterly

C

  3 month LIBOR + 0.75%, with floor of 4.00%, payable quarterly

D

  3 month LIBOR + 0.67%, with floor of 4.00%, payable quarterly

E

  3 month LIBOR + 0.77%, with floor of 4.00%, payable quarterly

F

  3 month LIBOR + 0.77%, with floor of 4.00%, payable quarterly

J

 

5.50% to, but excluding, May 10, 2023;

3 month LIBOR + 3.64% thereafter, payable quarterly

K

 

6.375% to, but excluding, May 10, 2024;

3 month LIBOR + 3.55% thereafter, payable quarterly

L

  5.70%, payable semi-annually, from issuance date to, but excluding, May 10, 2019; 3 month LIBOR + 3.884%, payable quarterly, thereafter

M

  5.375%, payable semi-annually, from issuance date to, but excluding, May 10, 2020; 3 month LIBOR + 3.922%, payable quarterly, thereafter

N

  6.30%, payable quarterly

O

  5.30%, payable semi-annually, from issuance date to, but excluding, November 10, 2026; 3 month LIBOR + 3.834%, payable quarterly, thereafter

P

  5.00%, payable semi-annually, from issuance date to, but excluding, November 10, 2022; 3 month LIBOR + 2.874%, payable quarterly, thereafter

In the table above, dividends on each series of preferred stock are payable in arrears for the periods specified.

The table below presents dividends declared on the firm’s preferred stock.

 

    Year Ended December  
    2017       2016       2015  
Series  

per

share

  $ in millions      

per

share

  $ in millions      

per

share

   
$ in
millions
 
 

A

  $   950.51   $  29     $   953.12   $  29     $   950.52     $  28  

B

  $1,550.00   50     $1,550.00   50     $1,550.00     50  

C

  $1,013.90   8     $1,016.68   8     $1,013.90     8  

D

  $1,013.90   55     $1,016.68   55     $1,013.90     54  

E

  $4,055.55   31     $4,066.66   50     $4,055.55     71  

F

  $4,055.55   6     $4,066.66   13     $4,055.55     20  

I

  $1,487.52   51     $1,487.52   51     $1,487.52     51  

J

  $1,375.00   55     $1,375.00   55     $1,375.00     55  

K

  $1,593.76   45     $1,593.76   45     $1,593.76     45  

L

  $1,425.00   74     $1,425.00   74     $1,425.00     74  

M

  $1,343.76   107     $1,343.76   107     $   735.33     59  

N

  $1,575.00   42     $1,124.38   30     $            –      

O

  $1,325.00   34       $   379.10   10       $            –      

Total

      $587           $577             $515  

In the table above, the total preferred dividend amounts for Series E and Series F Preferred Stock for 2016 include prorated dividends of $866.67 per share related to 4,861 shares of Series E Preferred Stock and 1,639 shares of Series F Preferred Stock, which were cancelled during 2016.

On January 10, 2018, Group Inc. declared dividends of $244.79, $387.50, $261.11, $261.11, $343.75, $398.44 and $393.75 per share of Series A Preferred Stock, Series B Preferred Stock, Series C Preferred Stock, Series D Preferred Stock, Series J Preferred Stock, Series K Preferred Stock and Series N Preferred Stock, respectively, to be paid on February 12, 2018 to preferred shareholders of record on January 28, 2018. In addition, the firm declared dividends of $1,000.00 per each share of Series E Preferred Stock and Series F Preferred Stock, to be paid on March 1, 2018 to preferred shareholders of record on February 14, 2018.

Accumulated Other Comprehensive Loss

The table below presents changes in the accumulated other comprehensive loss, net of tax, by type.

 

$ in millions    
Beginning
balance
 
 
   



Other
comprehensive
income/(loss)
adjustments,
net of tax
 
 
 
 
 
   
Ending
balance
 
 

Year Ended December 2017

     

Currency translation

    $   (647     $   22       $   (625

Debt valuation adjustment

    (239     (807     (1,046

Pension and postretirement liabilities

    (330     130       (200

Available-for-sale securities

          (9     (9

Total

    $(1,216     $(664     $(1,880

 

Year Ended December 2016

     

Currency translation

    $   (587     $  (60     $   (647

Debt valuation adjustment

    305       (544     (239

Pension and postretirement liabilities

    (131     (199     (330

Total

    $   (413     $(803     $(1,216

In the table above, the beginning balance of accumulated other comprehensive loss for December 2016 has been adjusted to reflect the cumulative effect of the change in accounting principle related to debt valuation adjustment, net of tax. See Note 3 for further information about the adoption of ASU No. 2016-01. See Note 8 for further information about the debt valuation adjustment.

 

 

168   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Note 20.

Regulation and Capital Adequacy

 

The FRB is the primary regulator of Group Inc., a bank holding company (BHC) under the U.S. Bank Holding Company Act of 1956 and a financial holding company under amendments to this Act. As a BHC, the firm is subject to consolidated regulatory capital requirements which are calculated in accordance with the risk-based capital and leverage regulations of the FRB, subject to certain transitional provisions (Capital Framework).

The risk-based capital requirements are expressed as capital ratios that compare measures of regulatory capital to risk-weighted assets (RWAs). Failure to comply with these capital requirements could result in restrictions being imposed by the firm’s regulators. The firm’s capital levels are also subject to qualitative judgments by the regulators about components of capital, risk weightings and other factors. Furthermore, certain of the firm’s subsidiaries are subject to separate regulations and capital requirements as described below.

Capital Framework

The regulations under the Capital Framework are largely based on the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision’s (Basel Committee) capital framework for strengthening international capital standards (Basel III) and also implement certain provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act. Under the Capital Framework, the firm is an “Advanced approach” banking organization and has been designated as a global systemically important bank (G-SIB).

The firm calculates its Common Equity Tier 1 (CET1), Tier 1 capital and Total capital ratios in accordance with (i) the Standardized approach and market risk rules set out in the Capital Framework (together, the Standardized Capital Rules) and (ii) the Advanced approach and market risk rules set out in the Capital Framework (together, the Basel III Advanced Rules). The lower of each capital ratio calculated in (i) and (ii) is the ratio against which the firm’s compliance with its minimum ratio requirements is assessed. Each of the capital ratios calculated in accordance with the Basel III Advanced Rules was lower than that calculated in accordance with the Standardized Capital Rules and therefore the Basel III Advanced ratios were the ratios that applied to the firm as of both December 2017 and December 2016. The capital ratios that apply to the firm can change in future reporting periods as a result of these regulatory requirements.

Regulatory Capital and Capital Ratios. The table below presents the minimum ratios required for the firm.

 

    As of December  
      2017        2016  

CET1 ratio

    7.000%        5.875%  

Tier 1 capital ratio

    8.500%        7.375%  

Total capital ratio

    10.500%        9.375%  

Tier 1 leverage ratio

    4.000%        4.000%  

In the table above:

 

 

The minimum capital ratios as of December 2017 reflect (i) the 50% phase-in of the capital conservation buffer of 2.5%, (ii) the 50% phase-in of the G-SIB buffer of 2.5% (based on 2015 financial data), and (iii) the countercyclical capital buffer of zero percent, each described below.

 

 

The minimum capital ratios as of December 2016 reflect (i) the 25% phase-in of the capital conservation buffer of 2.5%, (ii) the 25% phase-in of the G-SIB buffer of 3% (based on 2014 financial data), and (iii) the countercyclical capital buffer of zero percent, each described below.

 

 

Tier 1 leverage ratio is defined as Tier 1 capital divided by quarterly average adjusted total assets (which includes adjustments for goodwill and identifiable intangible assets, and certain investments in nonconsolidated financial institutions).

Certain aspects of the Capital Framework’s requirements phase in over time (transitional provisions). These include capital buffers and certain deductions from regulatory capital (such as investments in nonconsolidated financial institutions). These deductions from regulatory capital are required to be phased in ratably per year from 2014 to 2018, with residual amounts not deducted during the transitional period subject to risk weighting. In addition, junior subordinated debt issued to trusts is being phased out of regulatory capital. The minimum CET1, Tier 1 and Total capital ratios that apply to the firm will increase as the capital buffers are phased in.

The capital conservation buffer, which consists entirely of capital that qualifies as CET1, began to phase in on January 1, 2016 and will continue to do so in increments of 0.625% per year until it reaches 2.5% of RWAs on January 1, 2019.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   169


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The G-SIB buffer, which is an extension of the capital conservation buffer, phases in ratably, beginning on January 1, 2016, becoming fully effective on January 1, 2019, and must consist entirely of capital that qualifies as CET1. The buffer must be calculated using two methodologies, the higher of which is reflected in the firm’s minimum risk-based capital ratios. The first calculation is based upon the Basel Committee’s methodology which, among other factors, relies upon measures of the size, activity and complexity of each G-SIB. The second calculation uses similar inputs, but it includes a measure of reliance on short-term wholesale funding. The firm’s G-SIB buffer will be updated annually based on financial data from the prior year, and will be generally applicable for the following year.

The Capital Framework also provides for a countercyclical capital buffer, which is an extension of the capital conservation buffer, of up to 2.5% (consisting entirely of CET1) intended to counteract systemic vulnerabilities. As of December 2017, the FRB has set the countercyclical capital buffer at zero percent.

Failure to meet the capital levels inclusive of the buffers could limit the firm’s ability to distribute capital, including share repurchases and dividend payments, and to make certain discretionary compensation payments.

Definition of Risk-Weighted Assets. RWAs are calculated in accordance with both the Standardized Capital Rules and the Basel III Advanced Rules. The following is a comparison of RWA calculations under these rules:

 

 

RWAs for credit risk in accordance with the Standardized Capital Rules are calculated in a different manner than the Basel III Advanced Rules. The primary difference is that the Standardized Capital Rules do not contemplate the use of internal models to compute exposure for credit risk on derivatives and securities financing transactions, whereas the Basel III Advanced Rules permit the use of such models, subject to supervisory approval. In addition, credit RWAs calculated in accordance with the Standardized Capital Rules utilize prescribed risk-weights which depend largely on the type of counterparty, rather than on internal assessments of the creditworthiness of such counterparties;

 

RWAs for market risk in accordance with the Standardized Capital Rules and the Basel III Advanced Rules are generally consistent; and

 

 

RWAs for operational risk are not required by the Standardized Capital Rules, whereas the Basel III Advanced Rules do include such a requirement.

Credit Risk

Credit RWAs are calculated based upon measures of exposure, which are then risk weighted. The following is a description of the calculation of credit RWAs in accordance with the Standardized Capital Rules and the Basel III Advanced Rules:

 

 

For credit RWAs calculated in accordance with the Standardized Capital Rules, the firm utilizes prescribed risk-weights which depend largely on the type of counterparty (e.g., whether the counterparty is a sovereign, bank, broker-dealer or other entity). The exposure measure for derivatives is based on a combination of positive net current exposure and a percentage of the notional amount of each derivative. The exposure measure for securities financing transactions is calculated to reflect adjustments for potential price volatility, the size of which depends on factors such as the type and maturity of the security, and whether it is denominated in the same currency as the other side of the financing transaction. The firm utilizes specific required formulaic approaches to measure exposure for securitizations and equities; and

 

 

For credit RWAs calculated in accordance with the Basel III Advanced Rules, the firm has been given permission by its regulators to compute risk-weights for wholesale and retail credit exposures in accordance with the Advanced Internal Ratings-Based approach. This approach is based on internal assessments of the creditworthiness of counterparties, with key inputs being the probability of default, loss given default and the effective maturity. The firm utilizes internal models to measure exposure for derivatives and securities financing transactions. The Capital Framework requires that a BHC obtain prior written agreement from its regulators before using internal models for such purposes. The firm utilizes specific required formulaic approaches to measure exposure for securitizations and equities.

 

 

170   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Market Risk

Market RWAs are calculated based on measures of exposure which include Value-at-Risk (VaR), stressed VaR, incremental risk and comprehensive risk based on internal models, and a standardized measurement method for specific risk. The market risk regulatory capital rules require that a BHC obtain prior written agreement from its regulators before using any internal model to calculate its risk-based capital requirement. The following is further information regarding the measures of exposure for market RWAs calculated in accordance with the Standardized Capital Rules and Basel III Advanced Rules:

 

 

VaR is the potential loss in value of inventory positions, as well as certain other financial assets and financial liabilities, due to adverse market movements over a defined time horizon with a specified confidence level. For both risk management purposes and regulatory capital calculations the firm uses a single VaR model which captures risks including those related to interest rates, equity prices, currency rates and commodity prices. However, VaR used for regulatory capital requirements (regulatory VaR) differs from risk management VaR due to different time horizons and confidence levels (10-day and 99% for regulatory VaR vs. one-day and 95% for risk management VaR), as well as differences in the scope of positions on which VaR is calculated. In addition, the daily net revenues used to determine risk management VaR exceptions (i.e., comparing the daily net revenues to the VaR measure calculated as of the end of the prior business day) include intraday activity, whereas the FRB’s regulatory capital rules require that intraday activity be excluded from daily net revenues when calculating regulatory VaR exceptions. Intraday activity includes bid/offer net revenues, which are more likely than not to be positive by their nature. As a result, there may be differences in the number of VaR exceptions and the amount of daily net revenues calculated for regulatory VaR compared to the amounts calculated for risk management VaR. The firm’s positional losses observed on a single day did not exceed its 99% one-day regulatory VaR during 2017 and exceeded its 99% one-day regulatory VaR on two occasions during 2016. There was no change in the VaR multiplier used to calculate Market RWAs;

 

Stressed VaR is the potential loss in value of inventory positions, as well as certain other financial assets and financial liabilities, during a period of significant market stress;

 

 

Incremental risk is the potential loss in value of non-securitized inventory positions due to the default or credit migration of issuers of financial instruments over a one-year time horizon;

 

 

Comprehensive risk is the potential loss in value, due to price risk and defaults, within the firm’s credit correlation positions; and

 

 

Specific risk is the risk of loss on a position that could result from factors other than broad market movements, including event risk, default risk and idiosyncratic risk. The standardized measurement method is used to determine specific risk RWAs, by applying supervisory defined risk-weighting factors after applicable netting is performed.

Operational Risk

Operational RWAs are only required to be included under the Basel III Advanced Rules. The firm has been given permission by its regulators to calculate operational RWAs in accordance with the “Advanced Measurement Approach,” and therefore utilizes an internal risk-based model to quantify Operational RWAs.

Consolidated Regulatory Capital Ratios

Capital Ratios and RWAs. Each of the capital ratios calculated in accordance with the Basel III Advanced Rules was lower than that calculated in accordance with the Standardized Capital Rules as of both December 2017 and December 2016, and therefore such lower ratios applied to the firm as of these dates.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   171


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The table below presents the ratios calculated in accordance with both the Standardized Capital Rules and Basel III Advanced Rules.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017       2016  

Common shareholders’ equity

    $  70,390       $  75,690  

Deduction for goodwill and identifiable intangible assets, net of deferred tax liabilities

    (3,269     (2,874

Deduction for investments in nonconsolidated financial institutions

          (424

Other adjustments

    (11     (346

Common Equity Tier 1

    67,110       72,046  

Preferred stock

    11,853       11,203  

Deduction for investments in covered funds

    (590     (445

Other adjustments

    (42     (364

Tier 1 capital

    $  78,331       $  82,440  

Standardized Tier 2 and Total capital

   

Tier 1 capital

    $  78,331       $  82,440  

Qualifying subordinated debt

    13,360       14,566  

Junior subordinated debt issued to trusts

    567       792  

Allowance for losses on loans and lending commitments

    1,078       722  

Other adjustments

    (28     (6

Standardized Tier 2 capital

    14,977       16,074  

Standardized Total capital

    $  93,308       $  98,514  

Basel III Advanced Tier 2 and Total capital

   

Tier 1 capital

    $  78,331       $  82,440  

Standardized Tier 2 capital

    14,977       16,074  

Allowance for losses on loans and lending commitments

    (1,078     (722

Basel III Advanced Tier 2 capital

    13,899       15,352  

Basel III Advanced Total capital

    $  92,230       $  97,792  

 

RWAs

   

Standardized

    $555,611       $496,676  

Basel III Advanced

    $617,646       $549,650  

 

CET1 ratio

   

Standardized

    12.1%       14.5%  

Basel III Advanced

    10.9%       13.1%  

 

Tier 1 capital ratio

   

Standardized

    14.1%       16.6%  

Basel III Advanced

    12.7%       15.0%  

 

Total capital ratio

   

Standardized

    16.8%       19.8%  

Basel III Advanced

    14.9%       17.8%  

 

Tier 1 leverage ratio

    8.4%       9.4%  

Effective January 2018, the firm was subject to the fully phased-in CET1 ratios. As of December 2017, the firm’s CET1 ratios, on a fully phased-in basis, calculated in accordance with the Standardized Capital Rules and Basel III Advanced Rules were lower by 0.2 percentage points, as compared to the transitional CET1 ratios.

In the table above:

 

 

Deduction for goodwill and identifiable intangible assets, net of deferred tax liabilities, included goodwill of $3.67 billion as of both December 2017 and December 2016, and identifiable intangible assets of $298 million (80% of $373 million) and $257 million (60% of $429 million) as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively, net of associated deferred tax liabilities of $694 million and $1.05 billion as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively. Goodwill is fully deducted from CET1, while the deduction for identifiable intangible assets is required to be phased into CET1 ratably over five years from 2014 to 2018. The balance that is not deducted during the transitional period is risk weighted.

 

 

Deduction for investments in nonconsolidated financial institutions represents the amount by which the firm’s investments in the capital of nonconsolidated financial institutions exceed certain prescribed thresholds. The deduction for such investments is required to be phased into CET1 ratably over five years from 2014 to 2018. As of December 2017 and December 2016, CET1 reflects 80% and 60% of the deduction, respectively. The balance that is not deducted during the transitional period is risk weighted.

 

 

Deduction for investments in covered funds represents the firm’s aggregate investments in applicable covered funds, excluding investments that are subject to an extended conformance period. This deduction was not subject to a transition period. See Note 6 for further information about the Volcker Rule.

 

 

Other adjustments within CET1 and Tier 1 capital primarily include credit valuation adjustments on derivative liabilities, pension and postretirement liabilities, the overfunded portion of the firm’s defined benefit pension plan obligation net of associated deferred tax liabilities, disallowed deferred tax assets, debt valuation adjustments and other required credit risk-based deductions. The deduction for such items is generally required to be phased into CET1 ratably over five years from 2014 to 2018. As of December 2017 and December 2016, CET1 reflects 80% and 60% of such deduction, respectively. The balance that is not deducted from CET1 during the transitional period is generally deducted from Tier 1 capital within other adjustments.

 

 

172   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

 

As of December 2017, junior subordinated debt issued to trusts was fully phased out of Tier 1 capital, with 50% included in Tier 2 capital and 50% fully phased out of regulatory capital. As of December 2016, junior subordinated debt issued to trusts was fully phased out of Tier 1 capital, with 60% included in Tier 2 capital and 40% fully phased out of regulatory capital. Junior subordinated debt issued to trusts is reduced by the amount of trust preferred securities purchased by the firm and will be fully phased out of Tier 2 capital by 2022 at a rate of 10% per year. See Note 16 for further information about the firm’s junior subordinated debt issued to trusts and trust preferred securities purchased by the firm.

 

 

Qualifying subordinated debt is subordinated debt issued by Group Inc. with an original maturity of five years or greater. The outstanding amount of subordinated debt qualifying for Tier 2 capital is reduced upon reaching a remaining maturity of five years. See Note 16 for further information about the firm’s subordinated debt.

The tables below present changes in CET1, Tier 1 capital and Tier 2 capital.

 

   

Year Ended

December 2017

 

$ in millions

 

 

Standardized

 

    

Basel III

Advanced

 

 

Common Equity Tier 1

    

Beginning balance

    $72,046        $72,046  

Change in common shareholders’ equity

    (5,300      (5,300

Change in deduction for:

    

Transitional provisions

    (426      (426

Goodwill and identifiable intangible assets, net of deferred tax liabilities

    (324      (324

Investments in nonconsolidated financial institutions

    586        586  

Change in other adjustments

    528        528  

Ending balance

    $67,110        $67,110  

Tier 1 capital

    

Beginning balance

    $82,440        $82,440  

Change in deduction for:

    

Transitional provisions

    (274      (274

Investments in covered funds

    (145      (145

Other net decrease in CET1

    (4,510      (4,510

Change in preferred stock

    650        650  

Change in other adjustments

    170        170  

Ending balance

    78,331        78,331  

Tier 2 capital

    

Beginning balance

    16,074        15,352  

Change in qualifying subordinated debt

    (1,206      (1,206

Redesignation of junior subordinated debt issued to trusts

    (225      (225

Change in the allowance for losses on loans and lending commitments

    356         

Change in other adjustments

    (22      (22

Ending balance

    14,977        13,899  

Total capital

    $93,308        $92,230  
   

Year Ended

December 2016

 

$ in millions

 

 

Standardized

 

    

Basel III

Advanced

 

 

Common Equity Tier 1

    

Beginning balance

    $71,363        $71,363  

Change in common shareholders’ equity

    162        162  

Change in deduction for:

    

Transitional provisions

    (839      (839

Goodwill and identifiable intangible assets, net of deferred tax liabilities

    16        16  

Investments in nonconsolidated financial institutions

    895        895  

Change in other adjustments

    449        449  

Ending balance

    $72,046        $72,046  

Tier 1 capital

    

Beginning balance

    $81,511        $81,511  

Change in deduction for:

    

Transitional provisions

    (558      (558

Investments in covered funds

    (32      (32

Other net increase in CET1

    1,522        1,522  

Redesignation of junior subordinated debt issued to trusts

    (330      (330

Change in preferred stock

    3        3  

Change in other adjustments

    324        324  

Ending balance

    82,440        82,440  

Tier 2 capital

    

Beginning balance

    16,705        16,103  

Change in qualifying subordinated debt

    (566      (566

Redesignation of junior subordinated debt issued to trusts

    (198      (198

Change in the allowance for losses on loans and lending commitments

    120         

Change in other adjustments

    13        13  

Ending balance

    16,074        15,352  

Total capital

    $98,514        $97,792  

In the tables above, the change in the deduction for transitional provisions represents the increased phase-in of the deduction from 60% to 80% (effective January 1, 2017) for 2017 and from 40% to 60% (effective January 1, 2016) for 2016.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   173


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The tables below present the components of RWAs calculated in accordance with the Standardized Capital Rules and Basel III Advanced Rules.

 

    Standardized Capital Rules
as of December
 
$ in millions     2017          2016  

Credit RWAs

      

Derivatives

    $126,076          $124,286  

Commitments, guarantees and loans

    145,104          115,744  

Securities financing transactions 

    77,962          71,319  

Equity investments

    48,155          41,428  

Other

    70,933          58,636  

Total Credit RWAs

    468,230          411,413  

Market RWAs

      

Regulatory VaR

    7,532          9,750  

Stressed VaR

    32,753          22,475  

Incremental risk

    8,441          7,875  

Comprehensive risk

    2,397          5,338  

Specific risk

    36,258          39,825  

Total Market RWAs

    87,381          85,263  

Total RWAs

    $555,611          $496,676  
    Basel III Advanced Rules
as of December
 
$ in millions     2017          2016  

Credit RWAs

      

Derivatives

    $102,986          $105,096  

Commitments, guarantees and loans

    163,375          122,792  

Securities financing transactions

    19,362          14,673  

Equity investments

    51,626          44,095  

Other

    75,968          63,431  

Total Credit RWAs

    413,317          350,087  

Market RWAs

      

Regulatory VaR

    7,532          9,750  

Stressed VaR

    32,753          22,475  

Incremental risk

    8,441          7,875  

Comprehensive risk

    1,870          4,550  

Specific risk

    36,258          39,825  

Total Market RWAs

    86,854          84,475  

Total Operational RWAs

    117,475          115,088  

Total RWAs

    $617,646          $549,650  

In the tables above:

 

 

Securities financing transactions represent resale and repurchase agreements and securities borrowed and loaned transactions.

 

 

Other includes receivables, certain debt securities, cash and cash equivalents and other assets.

The table below presents changes in RWAs calculated in accordance with the Standardized Capital Rules and Basel III Advanced Rules.

 

   

Year Ended

December 2017

 
$ in millions     Standardized       
Basel III
Advanced
 
 

Risk-Weighted Assets

    

Beginning balance

    $496,676        $549,650  

Credit RWAs

    

Change in:

    

Deduction for transitional provisions

    (233      (233

Derivatives

    1,790        (2,110

Commitments, guarantees and loans

    29,360        40,583  

Securities financing transactions

    6,643        4,689  

Equity investments

    6,889        7,693  

Other

    12,368        12,608  

Change in Credit RWAs

    56,817        63,230  

Market RWAs

    

Change in:

    

Regulatory VaR

    (2,218      (2,218

Stressed VaR

    10,278        10,278  

Incremental risk

    566        566  

Comprehensive risk

    (2,941      (2,680

Specific risk

    (3,567      (3,567

Change in Market RWAs

    2,118        2,379  

Operational RWAs

    

Change in operational risk

           2,387  

Change in Operational RWAs

           2,387  

Ending balance

    $555,611        $617,646  

In the table above, the increased deduction for transitional provisions represents the increased phase-in of the deduction from 60% to 80%, effective January 1, 2017.

Standardized Credit RWAs as of December 2017 increased by $56.82 billion compared with December 2016, primarily reflecting an increase in commitments, guarantees and loans, principally due to increased lending activity. Standardized Market RWAs as of December 2017 increased by $2.12 billion compared with December 2016, primarily reflecting an increase in stressed VaR as a result of increased risk exposures partially offset by decreases in specific risk, as a result of changes in risk exposures, and comprehensive risk, as a result of changes in risk measurements.

Basel III Advanced Credit RWAs as of December 2017 increased by $63.23 billion compared with December 2016, primarily reflecting an increase in commitments, guarantees and loans, principally due to increased lending activity. Basel III Advanced Market RWAs as of December 2017 increased by $2.38 billion compared with December 2016, primarily reflecting an increase in stressed VaR as a result of increased risk exposures partially offset by decreases in specific risk, as a result of changes in risk exposures, and comprehensive risk, as a result of changes in risk measurements.

 

 

174   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The table below presents changes in RWAs calculated in accordance with the Standardized Capital Rules and Basel III Advanced Rules.

 

   

Year Ended

December 2016

 
$ in millions     Standardized       
Basel III
Advanced
 
 

Risk-Weighted Assets

    

Beginning balance

    $524,107        $577,651  

Credit RWAs

    

Change in:

    

Deduction for transitional provisions

    (531      (531

Derivatives

    (12,555      (8,575

Commitments, guarantees and loans

    4,353        8,269  

Securities financing transactions

    (73      (228

Equity investments

    4,196        4,440  

Other

    (4,095      2,630  

Change in Credit RWAs

    (8,705      6,005  

Market RWAs

    

Change in:

    

Regulatory VaR

    (2,250      (2,250

Stressed VaR

    737        737  

Incremental risk

    (1,638      (1,638

Comprehensive risk

    (387      (167

Specific risk

    (15,188      (15,188

Change in Market RWAs

    (18,726      (18,506

Operational RWAs

    

Change in operational risk

           (15,500

Change in Operational RWAs

           (15,500

Ending balance

    $496,676        $549,650  

In the table above, the increased deduction for transitional provisions represents the increased phase-in of the deduction from 40% to 60%, effective January 1, 2016.

Standardized Credit RWAs as of December 2016 decreased by $8.71 billion compared with December 2015, primarily reflecting a decrease in derivatives, principally due to reduced exposures, and a decrease in receivables included in other credit RWAs reflecting the impact of firm and client activity. This decrease was partially offset by increases in commitments, guarantees and loans principally due to increased lending activity, and equity investments, principally due to increased exposures and the impact of market movements. Standardized Market RWAs as of December 2016 decreased by $18.73 billion compared with December 2015, primarily reflecting a decrease in specific risk as a result of reduced risk exposures.

Basel III Advanced Credit RWAs as of December 2016 increased by $6.01 billion compared with December 2015, primarily reflecting an increase in commitments, guarantees and loans principally due to increased lending activity, and an increase in equity investments, principally due to increased exposures and the impact of market movements. These increases were partially offset by a decrease in derivatives, principally due to lower counterparty credit risk and reduced exposure. Basel III Advanced Market RWAs as of December 2016 decreased by $18.51 billion compared with December 2015, primarily reflecting a decrease in specific risk as a result of reduced risk exposures. Basel III Advanced Operational RWAs as of December 2016 decreased by $15.50 billion compared with December 2015, reflecting a decrease in the frequency of certain events incorporated within the firm’s risk-based model.

Bank Subsidiaries

Regulatory Capital Ratios. GS Bank USA, an FDIC-insured, New York State-chartered bank and a member of the Federal Reserve System, is supervised and regulated by the FRB, the FDIC, the New York State Department of Financial Services and the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau, and is subject to regulatory capital requirements that are calculated in substantially the same manner as those applicable to BHCs. For purposes of assessing the adequacy of its capital, GS Bank USA calculates its capital ratios in accordance with the risk-based capital and leverage requirements applicable to state member banks. Those requirements are based on the Capital Framework described above. GS Bank USA is an Advanced approach banking organization under the Capital Framework.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   175


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Under the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action applicable to GS Bank USA, in order to meet the quantitative requirements for being a “well-capitalized” depository institution, GS Bank USA must meet higher minimum requirements than the minimum ratios in the table below. As of both December 2017 and December 2016, GS Bank USA was in compliance with its minimum capital requirements and the “well-capitalized” minimum ratios.

The table below presents the minimum ratios and the “well-capitalized” minimum ratios required for GS Bank USA.

 

    Minimum Ratio as of December      
“Well-capitalized”
Minimum Ratio
 
 
      2017          2016    

CET1 ratio

    5.750%          5.125%       6.5%  

Tier 1 capital ratio

    7.250%          6.625%       8.0%  

Total capital ratio

    9.250%          8.625%       10.0%  

Tier 1 leverage ratio

    4.000%          4.000%       5.0%  

In the table above:

 

 

The minimum capital ratios as of December 2017 reflect (i) the 50% phase-in of the capital conservation buffer of 2.5% and (ii) the countercyclical capital buffer of zero percent, each described above.

 

 

The minimum capital ratios as of December 2016 reflect (i) the 25% phase-in of the capital conservation buffer of 2.5% and (ii) the countercyclical capital buffer of zero percent, each described above.

GS Bank USA’s capital levels and prompt corrective action classification are also subject to qualitative judgments by the regulators about components of capital, risk weightings and other factors. Failure to comply with these capital requirements, including a breach of the buffers described above, could result in restrictions being imposed by GS Bank USA’s regulators.

Similar to the firm, GS Bank USA is required to calculate each of the CET1, Tier 1 capital and Total capital ratios in accordance with both the Standardized Capital Rules and Basel III Advanced Rules. The lower of each capital ratio calculated in accordance with the Standardized Capital Rules and Basel III Advanced Rules is the ratio against which GS Bank USA’s compliance with its minimum ratio requirements is assessed. Each of the capital ratios calculated in accordance with the Standardized Capital Rules was lower than that calculated in accordance with the Basel III Advanced Rules and therefore the Standardized Capital ratios were the ratios that applied to GS Bank USA as of both December 2017 and December 2016. The capital ratios that apply to GS Bank USA can change in future reporting periods as a result of these regulatory requirements.

The table below presents the ratios for GS Bank USA calculated in accordance with both the Standardized Capital Rules and Basel III Advanced Rules.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Standardized

    

Common Equity Tier 1

    $  25,343        $  24,485  

 

Tier 1 capital

    25,343        24,485  

Tier 2 capital

    2,547        2,382  

Total capital

    $  27,890        $  26,867  

 

Basel III Advanced

    

Common Equity Tier 1

    $  25,343        $  24,485  

 

Tier 1 capital

    25,343        24,485  

Standardized Tier 2 capital

    2,547        2,382  

Allowance for losses on loans and
lending commitments

    (547      (382

Tier 2 capital

    2,000        2,000  

Total capital

    $  27,343        $  26,485  

 

RWAs

    

Standardized

    $229,775        $204,232  

Basel III Advanced

    $164,602        $131,051  

 

CET1 ratio

    

Standardized

    11.0%        12.0%  

Basel III Advanced

    15.4%        18.7%  

 

Tier 1 capital ratio

    

Standardized

    11.0%        12.0%  

Basel III Advanced

    15.4%        18.7%  

 

Total capital ratio

    

Standardized

    12.1%        13.2%  

Basel III Advanced

    16.6%        20.2%  

 

Tier 1 leverage ratio

    15.0%        14.4%  

The decrease in GS Bank USA’s Standardized and Basel III Advanced capital ratios from December 2016 to December 2017 is primarily due to an increase in credit RWAs, principally due to an increase in lending activity.

The firm’s principal non-U.S. bank subsidiary, GSIB, is a wholly-owned credit institution, regulated by the Prudential Regulation Authority (PRA) and the Financial Conduct Authority (FCA) and is subject to minimum capital requirements. As of both December 2017 and December 2016, GSIB was in compliance with all regulatory capital requirements.

Other. The deposits of GS Bank USA are insured by the FDIC to the extent provided by law. The FRB requires that GS Bank USA maintain cash reserves with the Federal Reserve Bank of New York. The amount deposited by GS Bank USA at the Federal Reserve Bank of New York was $50.86 billion and $74.24 billion as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively, which exceeded required reserve amounts by $50.74 billion and $74.09 billion as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively.

 

 

176   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Broker-Dealer Subsidiaries

U.S. Regulated Broker-Dealer Subsidiaries. GS&Co. is the firm’s primary U.S. regulated broker-dealer subsidiary and is subject to regulatory capital requirements including those imposed by the SEC and the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority, Inc. In addition, GS&Co. is a registered futures commission merchant and is subject to regulatory capital requirements imposed by the CFTC, the Chicago Mercantile Exchange and the National Futures Association. Rule 15c3-1 of the SEC and Rule 1.17 of the CFTC specify uniform minimum net capital requirements, as defined, for their registrants, and also effectively require that a significant part of the registrants’ assets be kept in relatively liquid form. GS&Co. has elected to calculate its minimum capital requirements in accordance with the “Alternative Net Capital Requirement” as permitted by Rule 15c3-1.

As of December 2017 and December 2016, GS&Co. had regulatory net capital, as defined by Rule 15c3-1, of $15.57 billion and $17.17 billion, respectively, which exceeded the amount required by $13.15 billion and $14.66 billion, respectively. In addition to its alternative minimum net capital requirements, GS&Co. is also required to hold tentative net capital in excess of $1 billion and net capital in excess of $500 million in accordance with the market and credit risk standards of Appendix E of Rule 15c3-1. GS&Co. is also required to notify the SEC in the event that its tentative net capital is less than $5 billion. As of both December 2017 and December 2016, GS&Co. had tentative net capital and net capital in excess of both the minimum and the notification requirements.

Non-U.S. Regulated Broker-Dealer Subsidiaries. The firm’s principal non-U.S. regulated broker-dealer subsidiaries include Goldman Sachs International (GSI) and Goldman Sachs Japan Co., Ltd. (GSJCL). GSI, the firm’s U.K. broker-dealer, is regulated by the PRA and the FCA. GSJCL, the firm’s Japanese broker-dealer, is regulated by Japan’s Financial Services Agency. These and certain other non-U.S. subsidiaries of the firm are also subject to capital adequacy requirements promulgated by authorities of the countries in which they operate. As of both December 2017 and December 2016, these subsidiaries were in compliance with their local capital adequacy requirements.

Restrictions on Payments

Group Inc.’s ability to withdraw capital from its regulated subsidiaries is limited by minimum equity capital requirements applicable to those subsidiaries, provisions of applicable law and regulations and other regulatory restrictions that limit the ability of those subsidiaries to declare and pay dividends without prior regulatory approval (e.g., the amount of dividends that may be paid by GS Bank USA is limited to the lesser of the amounts calculated under a recent earnings test and an undivided profits test) even if the relevant subsidiary would satisfy the equity capital requirements applicable to it after giving effect to the dividend. For example, the FRB, the FDIC and the New York State Department of Financial Services have authority to prohibit or to limit the payment of dividends by the banking organizations they supervise (including GS Bank USA) if, in the relevant regulator’s opinion, payment of a dividend would constitute an unsafe or unsound practice in the light of the financial condition of the banking organization.

As of December 2017 and December 2016, Group Inc. was required to maintain $53.02 billion and $46.49 billion, respectively, of minimum equity capital in its regulated subsidiaries in order to satisfy the regulatory requirements of such subsidiaries.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   177


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Note 21.

Earnings Per Common Share

Basic earnings per common share (EPS) is calculated by dividing net earnings applicable to common shareholders by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding and RSUs for which no future service is required as a condition to the delivery of the underlying common stock (collectively, basic shares). Diluted EPS includes the determinants of basic EPS and, in addition, reflects the dilutive effect of the common stock deliverable for stock options and for RSUs for which future service is required as a condition to the delivery of the underlying common stock.

The table below presents the computations of basic and diluted EPS.

 

    Year Ended December  
in millions, except per share amounts     2017        2016        2015  

Net earnings applicable to common shareholders

    $3,685        $7,087        $5,568  

Weighted average basic shares

    401.6        427.4        448.9  

Effect of dilutive securities:

       

RSUs

    5.3        4.7        5.3  

Stock options

    2.2        3.0        4.4  

Dilutive securities

    7.5        7.7        9.7  

Weighted average basic shares and dilutive securities

    409.1        435.1        458.6  

 

Basic EPS

    $  9.12        $16.53        $12.35  

Diluted EPS

    $  9.01        $16.29        $12.14  

In the table above, unvested share-based awards that have non-forfeitable rights to dividends or dividend equivalents are treated as a separate class of securities in calculating EPS. The impact of applying this methodology was a reduction in basic EPS of $0.06 for 2017, and $0.05 for both 2016 and 2015.

The diluted EPS computations in the table above do not include antidilutive securities (RSUs and common shares underlying stock options) of 0.1 million for 2017, 2.8 million for 2016 and 6.0 million for 2015.

Note 22.

Transactions with Affiliated Funds

The firm has formed numerous nonconsolidated investment funds with third-party investors. As the firm generally acts as the investment manager for these funds, it is entitled to receive management fees and, in certain cases, advisory fees or incentive fees from these funds. Additionally, the firm invests alongside the third-party investors in certain funds.

The tables below present fees earned from affiliated funds, fees receivable from affiliated funds and the aggregate carrying value of the firm’s interests in affiliated funds.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017       2016       2015  

Fees earned from funds

    $2,932       $2,777       $3,293  
          As of December  
$ in millions             2017       2016  

Fees receivable from funds

      $   637       $   554  

Aggregate carrying value of interests in funds

 

    $4,993       $6,841  

The firm may periodically determine to waive certain management fees on selected money market funds. Management fees waived were $98 million and $104 million for 2017 and 2016, respectively.

The Volcker Rule restricts the firm from providing financial support to covered funds (as defined in the rule) after the expiration of the conformance period. As a general matter, in the ordinary course of business, the firm does not expect to provide additional voluntary financial support to any covered funds but may choose to do so with respect to funds that are not subject to the Volcker Rule; however, in the event that such support is provided, the amount is not expected to be material.

As of December 2017 and December 2016, the firm had an outstanding guarantee, as permitted under the Volcker Rule, on behalf of its funds of $154 million and $300 million, respectively. The firm has voluntarily provided this guarantee in connection with a financing agreement with a third-party lender executed by one of the firm’s real estate funds that is not covered by the Volcker Rule. As of both December 2017 and December 2016, except as noted above, the firm has not provided any additional financial support to its affiliated funds.

In addition, in the ordinary course of business, the firm may also engage in other activities with its affiliated funds including, among others, securities lending, trade execution, market making, custody, and acquisition and bridge financing. See Note 18 for the firm’s investment commitments related to these funds.

 

 

178   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Note 23.

Interest Income and Interest Expense

Interest is recorded over the life of the instrument on an accrual basis based on contractual interest rates. The table below presents the firm’s sources of interest income and interest expense.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017        2016        2015  

Interest income

       

Deposits with banks

    $     819        $   452        $   241  

Collateralized agreements

    1,661        691        17  

Financial instruments owned

    5,904        5,444        5,862  

Loans receivable

    2,678        1,843        1,191  

Other interest

    2,051        1,261        1,141  

Total interest income

    13,113        9,691        8,452  

Interest expense

       

Deposits

    1,380        878        408  

Collateralized financings

    863        442        330  

Financial instruments sold, but
not yet purchased

    1,388        1,251        1,319  

Short-term secured and
unsecured borrowings

    698        446        429  

Long-term secured and
unsecured borrowings

    4,599        4,242        3,878  

Other interest

    1,253        (155      (976

Total interest expense

    10,181        7,104        5,388  

Net interest income

    $  2,932        $2,587        $3,064  

In the table above:

 

 

Collateralized agreements includes rebates paid and interest income on securities borrowed.

 

 

Other interest income includes interest income on customer debit balances and other interest-earning assets.

 

 

Collateralized financings consists of securities sold under agreements to repurchase and securities loaned.

 

 

Other interest expense includes rebates received on other interest-bearing liabilities and interest expense on customer credit balances.

Note 24.

Income Taxes

Tax Legislation

The provision for taxes in 2017 reflected an increase in Income tax expense of $4.40 billion representing the estimated impact of Tax Legislation enacted on December 22, 2017. The $4.40 billion income tax expense includes the repatriation tax on undistributed earnings of foreign subsidiaries, the effects of the implementation of a territorial tax system and the remeasurement of U.S. deferred tax assets at lower enacted tax rates.

The repatriation tax is based on the greater of the firm’s post-1986 earnings and profits as of November 2, 2017 or December 31, 2017. Income taxes paid or payable to foreign jurisdictions partially reduce the repatriation tax as a foreign tax credit, based on a formula that includes future earnings of certain foreign subsidiaries. The calculation resulted in an estimated income tax expense of $3.32 billion.

U.S. deferred tax assets and liabilities were required to be remeasured as of December 22, 2017 to the new U.S. federal income tax rate of 21% and to any federal impact associated with state and local deferred income taxes, as well as due to the implementation of the territorial tax system. This remeasurement resulted in an estimated income tax expense of $1.08 billion.

While the components of the impact of Tax Legislation described above were calculated to account for all available information, these amounts are estimates. The firm anticipates modification to the estimate may occur as a result of (i) refinement of the firm’s calculations based on updated information, (ii) changes in the firm’s interpretations and assumptions, (iii) updates from issuance of future legislative guidance and (iv) actions the firm may take as a result of Tax Legislation.

Provision for Income Taxes

Income taxes are provided for using the asset and liability method under which deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognized for temporary differences between the financial reporting and tax bases of assets and liabilities. The firm reports interest expense related to income tax matters in provision for taxes and income tax penalties in other expenses.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   179


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The table below presents the components of the provision for taxes.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017        2016        2015  

Current taxes

       

U.S. federal

    $   320        $1,032        $1,116  

State and local

    64        139        (12

Non-U.S.

    1,004        1,184        1,166  

Total current tax expense

    1,388        2,355        2,270  

Deferred taxes

       

U.S. federal

    5,083        399        397  

State and local

    157        51        62  

Non-U.S.

    218        101        (34

Total deferred tax expense

    5,458        551        425  

Provision for taxes

    $6,846        $2,906        $2,695  

In the table above:

 

 

State and local current taxes includes the impact of settlements of state and local examinations.

 

 

U.S. federal deferred tax expense includes the estimated impact of Tax Legislation.

The table below presents a reconciliation of the U.S. federal statutory income tax rate to the firm’s effective income tax rate.

 

    Year Ended December  
      2017       2016       2015  

U.S. federal statutory income tax rate

    35.0%       35.0%       35.0%  

State and local taxes, net of U.S. federal income tax effects

    1.5%       0.9%       0.3%  

ASU No. 2016-09 tax benefits on settlement of employee share-based awards

    (6.4)%              

Non-U.S. operations

    (6.3)%       (6.7)%       (12.1)%  

Tax credits

    (2.1)%       (2.0)%       (1.7)%  

Tax-exempt income, including dividends

    (0.2)%       (0.3)%       (0.7)%  

Tax Legislation — repatriation tax

    29.8%              

Tax Legislation — remeasurement of deferred tax assets

    9.7%              

Non-deductible legal expenses

    0.5%       1.0%       10.2%  

Other

          0.3%       (0.3)%  

Effective income tax rate

    61.5%       28.2%       30.7%  

In the table above:

 

 

Non-U.S. operations includes the impact of permanently reinvested earnings and excludes the estimated impact of Tax Legislation.

 

 

State and local taxes, net of U.S. federal income tax effects includes the impact of settlements of state and local examinations.

 

 

Substantially all of the non-deductible legal expenses for 2015 relate to provisions for the settlement agreement with the RMBS Working Group.

Deferred Income Taxes

Deferred income taxes reflect the net tax effects of temporary differences between the financial reporting and tax bases of assets and liabilities. These temporary differences result in taxable or deductible amounts in future years and are measured using the tax rates and laws that will be in effect when such differences are expected to reverse. Valuation allowances are established to reduce deferred tax assets to the amount that more likely than not will be realized and primarily relate to the ability to utilize losses in various tax jurisdictions. Tax assets and liabilities are presented as a component of other assets and other liabilities and accrued expenses, respectively.

The table below presents the significant components of deferred tax assets and liabilities, excluding the impact of netting within tax jurisdictions.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

Deferred tax assets

    

Compensation and benefits

    $1,233        $2,461  

ASC 740 asset related to unrecognized tax benefits

    75        231  

Non-U.S. operations

           967  

Net operating losses

    428        427  

Occupancy-related

    67        100  

Other comprehensive income-related

    408        757  

Tax credits carryforward

    1,006         

Other, net

    113        394  

Subtotal

    3,330        5,337  

Valuation allowance

    (156      (115

Total deferred tax assets

    $3,174        $5,222  

Deferred tax liabilities

    

Depreciation and amortization

    $   826        $1,200  

Tax Legislation — repatriation tax

    3,114         

Non-U.S. operations

    180         

Unrealized gains

    742        342  

Total deferred tax liabilities

    $4,862        $1,542  

The firm has recorded deferred tax assets of $428 million and $427 million as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively, in connection with U.S. federal, state and local and foreign net operating loss carryforwards. The firm also recorded a valuation allowance of $128 million and $67 million as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively, related to these net operating loss carryforwards.

 

 

180   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

As of December 2017, the U.S. federal, state and local, and foreign net operating loss carryforwards were $268 million, $1.33 billion and $1.23 billion, respectively. If not utilized, the U.S. federal, state and local, and foreign net operating loss carryforwards will begin to expire in 2018. If these carryforwards expire, they will not have a material impact on the firm’s results of operations. As of December 2017, the foreign tax credit carryforwards were $446 million, the general business credit carryforwards were $533 million and the state and local tax credit carryforwards were $27 million. If not utilized, the foreign tax credit carryforward will begin to expire in 2027, the general business credit carryforward will begin to expire in 2037, and the state and local tax credit carryforward will begin to expire in 2020.

The firm had no capital loss carryforwards and no related net deferred income tax assets as of December 2017 and December 2016.

The valuation allowance increased by $41 million during 2017 and increased by $42 million during 2016. The increases in 2017 and 2016 were primarily due to an increase in deferred tax assets from which the firm does not expect to realize any benefit.

The firm permanently reinvested eligible earnings of certain foreign subsidiaries. As of December 2017, substantially all U.S. taxes were accrued on these subsidiaries’ earnings and profits as a result of Tax Legislation repatriation tax. As of December 2016, the firm did not accrue any U.S. income taxes that would arise if such earnings were repatriated, resulting in an unrecognized net deferred tax liability of $6.18 billion, attributable to reinvested earnings of $31.24 billion.

Unrecognized Tax Benefits

The firm recognizes tax positions in the consolidated financial statements only when it is more likely than not that the position will be sustained on examination by the relevant taxing authority based on the technical merits of the position. A position that meets this standard is measured at the largest amount of benefit that will more likely than not be realized on settlement. A liability is established for differences between positions taken in a tax return and amounts recognized in the consolidated financial statements.

The accrued liability for interest expense related to income tax matters and income tax penalties was $81 million and $141 million as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively. The firm recognized interest expense and income tax penalties of $63 million, $27 million and $17 million for 2017, 2016 and 2015, respectively. It is reasonably possible that unrecognized tax benefits could change significantly during the twelve months subsequent to December 2017 due to potential audit settlements. However, at this time it is not possible to estimate any potential change.

The table below presents the changes in the liability for unrecognized tax benefits. This liability is included in other liabilities and accrued expenses. See Note 17 for further information.

 

    Year Ended or as of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016        2015  

Beginning balance

    $ 852        $ 825        $ 871  

Increases based on tax positions related to the current year

    94        113        65  

Increases based on tax positions related to prior years

    101        188        158  

Decreases based on tax positions related to prior years

    (128      (88      (205

Decreases related to settlements

    (255      (186      (87

Exchange rate fluctuations

    1               23  

Ending balance

    $ 665        $ 852        $ 825  

 

Related deferred income tax asset

    75        231        197  

Net unrecognized tax benefit

    $ 590        $ 621        $ 628  

Regulatory Tax Examinations

The firm is subject to examination by the U.S. Internal Revenue Service (IRS) and other taxing authorities in jurisdictions where the firm has significant business operations, such as the United Kingdom, Japan, Hong Kong and various states, such as New York. The tax years under examination vary by jurisdiction. The firm does not expect completion of these audits to have a material impact on the firm’s financial condition but it may be material to operating results for a particular period, depending, in part, on the operating results for that period.

The table below presents the earliest tax years that remain subject to examination by major jurisdiction.

 

Jurisdiction    

As of

December 2017

 

 

U.S. Federal

    2011  

New York State and City

    2011  

United Kingdom

    2014  

Japan

    2014  

Hong Kong

    2011  
 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   181


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

U.S. Federal examinations of 2011 and 2012 began in 2013. The firm has been accepted into the Compliance Assurance Process program by the IRS for each of the tax years from 2013 through 2018. This program allows the firm to work with the IRS to identify and resolve potential U.S. federal tax issues before the filing of tax returns. The 2013 through 2016 tax years remain subject to post-filing review.

During the fourth quarter of 2017, New York State and City examinations for the firm (excluding GS Bank USA) of fiscal 2007 through calendar 2010 were completed. The completion of these examinations did not have a material impact on the firm’s effective income tax rate. New York State and City examinations (excluding GS Bank USA) of 2011 through 2014 began in the fourth quarter of 2017. New York State and City examinations for GS Bank USA have been completed through 2014.

During the first quarter of 2017, the firm concluded examinations with the Hong Kong tax authorities related to 2007 through 2015, with 2011 through 2015 subject to final review. The completion of these examinations did not have a material impact on the firm’s effective income tax rate.

All years including and subsequent to the years in the table above remain open to examination by the taxing authorities. The firm believes that the liability for unrecognized tax benefits it has established is adequate in relation to the potential for additional assessments.

Note 25.

Business Segments

The firm reports its activities in the following four business segments: Investment Banking, Institutional Client Services, Investing & Lending and Investment Management.

Basis of Presentation

In reporting segments, certain of the firm’s business lines have been aggregated where they have similar economic characteristics and are similar in each of the following areas: (i) the nature of the services they provide, (ii) their methods of distribution, (iii) the types of clients they serve and (iv) the regulatory environments in which they operate.

The cost drivers of the firm taken as a whole, compensation, headcount and levels of business activity, are broadly similar in each of the firm’s business segments. Compensation and benefits expenses in the firm’s segments reflect, among other factors, the overall performance of the firm, as well as the performance of individual businesses. Consequently, pre-tax margins in one segment of the firm’s business may be significantly affected by the performance of the firm’s other business segments.

The firm allocates assets (including allocations of global core liquid assets and cash, secured client financing and other assets), revenues and expenses among the four business segments. Due to the integrated nature of these segments, estimates and judgments are made in allocating certain assets, revenues and expenses. The allocation process is based on the manner in which management currently views the performance of the segments. Transactions between segments are based on specific criteria or approximate third-party rates.

The table below presents the firm’s net revenues, pre-tax earnings and total assets by segment. Management believes that this information provides a reasonable representation of each segment’s contribution to consolidated pre-tax earnings and total assets.

 

    Year Ended or as of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016        2015  

Investment Banking

       

Financial Advisory

    $    3,188        $    2,932        $    3,470  

 

Equity underwriting

    1,243        891        1,546  

Debt underwriting

    2,940        2,450        2,011  

Total Underwriting

    4,183        3,341        3,557  

Total net revenues

    7,371        6,273        7,027  

Operating expenses

    3,526        3,437        3,713  

Pre-tax earnings

    $    3,845        $    2,836        $    3,314  

 

Segment assets

    $    2,202        $    1,824        $    2,564  

 

Institutional Client Services

       

FICC Client Execution

    $    5,299        $    7,556        $    7,322  

 

Equities client execution

    2,046        2,194        3,028  

Commissions and fees

    2,920        3,078        3,156  

Securities services

    1,637        1,639        1,645  

Total Equities

    6,603        6,911        7,829  

Total net revenues

    11,902        14,467        15,151  

Operating expenses

    9,692        9,713        13,938  

Pre-tax earnings

    $    2,210        $    4,754        $    1,213  

 

Segment assets

    $675,255        $645,689        $663,394  

 

Investing & Lending

       

Equity securities

    $    4,578        $    2,573        $    3,781  

Debt securities and loans

    2,003        1,507        1,655  

Total net revenues

    6,581        4,080        5,436  

Operating expenses

    2,796        2,386        2,402  

Pre-tax earnings

    $    3,785        $    1,694        $    3,034  

 

Segment assets

    $226,016        $198,181        $179,428  

 

Investment Management

       

Management and other fees

    $    5,144        $    4,798        $    4,887  

Incentive fees

    417        421        780  

Transaction revenues

    658        569        539  

Total net revenues

    6,219        5,788        6,206  

Operating expenses

    4,800        4,654        4,841  

Pre-tax earnings

    $    1,419        $    1,134        $    1,365  

 

Segment assets

    $  13,303        $  14,471        $  16,009  

 

Total net revenues

    $  32,073        $  30,608        $  33,820  

Total operating expenses

    20,941        20,304        25,042  

Total pre-tax earnings

    $  11,132        $  10,304        $    8,778  

 

Total assets

    $916,776        $860,165        $861,395  
 

 

182   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

In the table above:

 

 

Revenues and expenses directly associated with each segment are included in determining pre-tax earnings.

 

 

Net revenues in the firm’s segments include allocations of interest income and interest expense to specific securities, commodities and other positions in relation to the cash generated by, or funding requirements of, such underlying positions. Net interest is included in segment net revenues as it is consistent with the way in which management assesses segment performance.

 

 

Overhead expenses not directly allocable to specific segments are allocated ratably based on direct segment expenses.

 

 

All operating expenses have been allocated to the firm’s segments except for charitable contributions of $127 million for 2017, $114 million for 2016 and $148 million for 2015.

 

 

Total operating expenses included net provisions for litigation and regulatory proceedings of $188 million for 2017, $396 million for 2016 and $4.01 billion (of which $3.37 billion was related to the settlement agreement with the RMBS Working Group) for 2015.

The table below presents the amounts of net interest income by segment included in net revenues.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017        2016        2015  

Investment Banking

    $       –        $       –        $       –  

Institutional Client Services

    1,322        1,456        2,472  

Investing & Lending

    1,325        880        418  

Investment Management

    285        251        174  

Total net interest income

    $2,932        $2,587        $3,064  

The table below presents the amounts of depreciation and amortization expense by segment included in pre-tax earnings.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017        2016        2015  

Investment Banking

    $   124        $   126        $   123  

Institutional Client Services

    514        489        462  

Investing & Lending

    314        215        253  

Investment Management

    200        168        153  

Total depreciation and amortization

    $1,152        $   998        $   991  

Geographic Information

Due to the highly integrated nature of international financial markets, the firm manages its businesses based on the profitability of the enterprise as a whole. The methodology for allocating profitability to geographic regions is dependent on estimates and management judgment because a significant portion of the firm’s activities require cross-border coordination in order to facilitate the needs of the firm’s clients.

Geographic results are generally allocated as follows:

 

 

Investment Banking: location of the client and investment banking team.

 

 

Institutional Client Services: FICC Client Execution and Equities (excluding Securities services): location of the market-making desk; Securities services: location of the primary market for the underlying security.

 

 

Investing & Lending: Investing: location of the investment; Lending: location of the client.

 

 

Investment Management: location of the sales team.

The table below presents the total net revenues, pre-tax earnings and net earnings of the firm by geographic region allocated based on the methodology referred to above, as well as the percentage of total net revenues, pre-tax earnings and net earnings (excluding Corporate) for each geographic region.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017       2016       2015  

Net revenues

           

Americas

    $19,405       61%       $18,144       60%       $19,202       56%  

EMEA

    7,852       24%       8,040       26%       8,981       27%  

Asia

    4,816       15%       4,424       14%       5,637       17%  

Total net revenues

    $32,073       100%       $30,608       100%       $33,820       100%  

Pre-tax earnings

           

Americas

    $  7,119       63%       $  6,352       61%       $  3,359       37%  

EMEA

    2,583       23%       2,883       28%       3,364       38%  

Asia

    1,557       14%       1,183       11%       2,203       25%  

Subtotal

    11,259       100%       10,418       100%       8,926       100%  

Corporate

    (127             (114             (148        

Total pre-tax earnings

    $11,132               $10,304               $  8,778          

Net earnings

           

Americas

    $     997       23%       $  4,337       58%       $  1,587       26%  

EMEA

    2,144       49%       2,270       30%       2,914       47%  

Asia

    1,241       28%       870       12%       1,686       27%  

Subtotal

    4,382       100%       7,477       100%       6,187       100%  

Corporate

    (96             (79             (104        

Total net earnings

    $  4,286               $  7,398               $  6,083          
 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   183


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

In the table above:

 

 

Americas net earnings included estimated income tax expense of $4.40 billion recorded in 2017 related to Tax Legislation.

 

 

Americas pre-tax earnings included provisions of $3.37 billion recorded in 2015 related to the settlement agreement with the RMBS Working Group.

 

 

Corporate pre-tax earnings includes charitable contributions that have not been allocated to the firm’s geographic regions.

 

 

Substantially all of the amounts in Americas were attributable to the U.S.

 

 

Asia includes Australia and New Zealand.

Note 26.

Credit Concentrations

The firm’s concentrations of credit risk arise from its market making, client facilitation, investing, underwriting, lending and collateralized transactions, and cash management activities, and may be impacted by changes in economic, industry or political factors. These activities expose the firm to many different industries and counterparties, and may also subject the firm to a concentration of credit risk to a particular central bank, counterparty, borrower or issuer, including sovereign issuers, or to a particular clearing house or exchange. The firm seeks to mitigate credit risk by actively monitoring exposures and obtaining collateral from counterparties as deemed appropriate.

The firm measures and monitors its credit exposure based on amounts owed to the firm after taking into account risk mitigants that management considers when determining credit risk. Such risk mitigants include netting and collateral arrangements and economic hedges, such as credit derivatives, futures and forward contracts. Netting and collateral agreements permit the firm to offset receivables and payables with such counterparties and/or enable the firm to obtain collateral on an upfront or contingent basis.

The table below presents the credit concentrations in cash instruments held by the firm and included in financial instruments owned.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

U.S. government and agency obligations

    $76,418        $57,657  

% of total assets

    8.3%        6.7%  

Non-U.S. government and agency obligations

    $33,956        $29,381  

% of total assets

    3.7%        3.4%  

In addition, as of December 2017 and December 2016, the firm had $76.13 billion and $94.72 billion, respectively, of cash deposits held at central banks (included in cash and cash equivalents), of which $50.86 billion and $74.24 billion, respectively, was held at the Federal Reserve Bank of New York.

As of both December 2017 and December 2016, the firm did not have credit exposure to any other counterparty that exceeded 2% of total assets.

Collateral obtained by the firm related to derivative assets is principally cash and is held by the firm or a third-party custodian. Collateral obtained by the firm related to resale agreements and securities borrowed transactions is primarily U.S. government and agency obligations and non-U.S. government and agency obligations. See Note 10 for further information about collateralized agreements and financings.

The table below presents U.S. government and agency obligations and non-U.S. government and agency obligations that collateralize resale agreements and securities borrowed transactions.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016  

U.S. government and agency obligations

    $96,905        $89,721  

Non-U.S. government and agency obligations

    $92,850        $80,234  

In the table above:

 

 

Non-U.S. government and agency obligations primarily consist of securities issued by the governments of Japan, France, the U.K. and Germany.

 

 

Given that the firm’s primary credit exposure on such transactions is to the counterparty to the transaction, the firm would be exposed to the collateral issuer only in the event of counterparty default.

 

 

184   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Note 27.

Legal Proceedings

 

The firm is involved in a number of judicial, regulatory and arbitration proceedings (including those described below) concerning matters arising in connection with the conduct of the firm’s businesses. Many of these proceedings are in early stages, and many of these cases seek an indeterminate amount of damages.

Under ASC 450, an event is “reasonably possible” if “the chance of the future event or events occurring is more than remote but less than likely” and an event is “remote” if “the chance of the future event or events occurring is slight.” Thus, references to the upper end of the range of reasonably possible loss for cases in which the firm is able to estimate a range of reasonably possible loss mean the upper end of the range of loss for cases for which the firm believes the risk of loss is more than slight.

With respect to matters described below for which management has been able to estimate a range of reasonably possible loss where (i) actual or potential plaintiffs have claimed an amount of money damages, (ii) the firm is being, or threatened to be, sued by purchasers in a securities offering and is not being indemnified by a party that the firm believes will pay the full amount of any judgment, or (iii) the purchasers are demanding that the firm repurchase securities, management has estimated the upper end of the range of reasonably possible loss as being equal to (a) in the case of (i), the amount of money damages claimed, (b) in the case of (ii), the difference between the initial sales price of the securities that the firm sold in such offering and the estimated lowest subsequent price of such securities prior to the action being commenced and (c) in the case of (iii), the price that purchasers paid for the securities less the estimated value, if any, as of December 2017 of the relevant securities, in each of cases (i), (ii) and (iii), taking into account any other factors believed to be relevant to the particular matter or matters of that type. As of the date hereof, the firm has estimated the upper end of the range of reasonably possible aggregate loss for such matters and for any other matters described below where management has been able to estimate a range of reasonably possible aggregate loss to be approximately $1.5 billion in excess of the aggregate reserves for such matters.

Management is generally unable to estimate a range of reasonably possible loss for matters other than those included in the estimate above, including where (i) actual or potential plaintiffs have not claimed an amount of money damages, except in those instances where management can otherwise determine an appropriate amount, (ii) matters are in early stages, (iii) matters relate to regulatory investigations or reviews, except in those instances where management can otherwise determine an appropriate amount, (iv) there is uncertainty as to the likelihood of a class being certified or the ultimate size of the class, (v) there is uncertainty as to the outcome of pending appeals or motions, (vi) there are significant factual issues to be resolved, and/or (vii) there are novel legal issues presented. For example, the firm’s potential liabilities with respect to future mortgage-related “put-back” claims described below may ultimately result in an increase in the firm’s liabilities, but are not included in management’s estimate of reasonably possible loss. As another example, the firm’s potential liabilities with respect to the investigations and reviews described below in “Regulatory Investigations and Reviews and Related Litigation” also generally are not included in management’s estimate of reasonably possible loss. However, management does not believe, based on currently available information, that the outcomes of such other matters will have a material adverse effect on the firm’s financial condition, though the outcomes could be material to the firm’s operating results for any particular period, depending, in part, upon the operating results for such period. See Note 18 for further information about mortgage-related contingencies.

Mortgage-Related Matters

Beginning in April 2010, a number of purported securities law class actions were filed in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York challenging the adequacy of Group Inc.’s public disclosure of, among other things, the firm’s activities in the CDO market, and the firm’s conflict of interest management.

The consolidated amended complaint filed on July 25, 2011, which names as defendants Group Inc. and certain current and former officers and employees of Group Inc. and its affiliates, generally alleges violations of Sections 10(b) and 20(a) of the Exchange Act and seeks unspecified damages. On January 12, 2018, the U.S. Court of Appeals for the Second Circuit vacated the district court’s class certification order and remanded for reconsideration.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   185


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

In June 2012, the Board received a demand from a shareholder that the Board investigate and take action relating to the firm’s mortgage-related activities and to stock sales by certain directors and executives of the firm. On February 15, 2013, this shareholder filed a putative shareholder derivative action in New York Supreme Court, New York County, against Group Inc. and certain current or former directors and employees, based on these activities and stock sales. The derivative complaint includes allegations of breach of fiduciary duty, unjust enrichment, abuse of control, gross mismanagement and corporate waste, and seeks, among other things, unspecified monetary damages, disgorgement of profits and certain corporate governance and disclosure reforms. On May 28, 2013, Group Inc. informed the shareholder that the Board completed its investigation and determined to refuse the demand. On June 20, 2013, the shareholder made a books and records demand requesting materials relating to the Board’s determination. The parties have agreed to stay proceedings in the putative derivative action pending resolution of the books and records demand.

In addition, the Board has received books and records demands from several shareholders for materials relating to, among other subjects, the firm’s mortgage servicing and foreclosure activities, participation in federal programs providing assistance to financial institutions and homeowners, loan sales to Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac, mortgage-related activities and conflicts management.

The firm has entered into agreements with U.S. Bank National Association to toll the relevant statute of limitations with respect to claims for repurchase of residential mortgage loans based on alleged breaches of representations related to $1.7 billion original notional face amount of securitizations issued by trusts for which U.S. Bank National Association acts as trustee.

The firm has received subpoenas or requests for information from, and is engaged in discussions with, certain regulators and law enforcement agencies with which it has not entered into settlement agreements as part of inquiries or investigations relating to mortgage-related matters.

Director Compensation-Related Litigation

On May 9, 2017, Group Inc. and certain of its current and former directors were named as defendants in a purported direct and derivative shareholder action in the Court of Chancery of the State of Delaware (a similar purported derivative action, filed in June 2015, alleging excessive director compensation over the period 2012 to 2014 was voluntarily dismissed without prejudice in December 2016). The new complaint alleges that excessive compensation has been paid to the non-employee director defendants since 2015, and that certain disclosures in connection with soliciting stockholder approval of the stock incentive plans were deficient. The complaint asserts claims for breaches of fiduciary duties and seeks, among other things, rescission or in some cases rescissory damages, disgorgement, and shareholder votes on several matters. Defendants moved to dismiss on July 28, 2017.

Currencies-Related Litigation

GS&Co. and Group Inc. are among the defendants named in putative class actions filed in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York beginning in September 2016 on behalf of putative indirect purchasers of foreign exchange instruments. The consolidated amended complaint, filed on June 30, 2017, generally alleges a conspiracy to manipulate the foreign currency exchange markets and asserts claims under federal and state antitrust laws and state consumer protection laws and seeks injunctive relief, as well as treble damages in an unspecified amount. Defendants moved to dismiss on August 11, 2017.

Financial Advisory Services

Group Inc. and certain of its affiliates are from time to time parties to various civil litigation and arbitration proceedings and other disputes with clients and third parties relating to the firm’s financial advisory activities. These claims generally seek, among other things, compensatory damages and, in some cases, punitive damages, and in certain cases allege that the firm did not appropriately disclose or deal with conflicts of interest.

 

 

186   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Underwriting Litigation

Firm affiliates are among the defendants in a number of proceedings in connection with securities offerings. In these proceedings, including those described below, the plaintiffs assert class action or individual claims under federal and state securities laws and in some cases other applicable laws, allege that the offering documents for the securities that they purchased contained material misstatements and omissions, and generally seek compensatory and rescissory damages in unspecified amounts. Certain of these proceedings involve additional allegations.

Cobalt International Energy. Cobalt International Energy, Inc. (Cobalt), certain of its officers and directors (including employees of affiliates of Group Inc. who served as directors of Cobalt), affiliates of shareholders of Cobalt (including Group Inc.) and the underwriters (including GS&Co.) for certain offerings of Cobalt’s securities are defendants in a putative securities class action filed on November 30, 2014 in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of Texas. The second consolidated amended complaint, filed on March 15, 2017, relates to a $1.67 billion February 2012 offering of Cobalt common stock, a $1.38 billion December 2012 offering of Cobalt’s convertible notes, a $1.00 billion January 2013 offering of Cobalt’s common stock, a $1.33 billion May 2013 offering of Cobalt’s common stock, and a $1.30 billion May 2014 offering of Cobalt’s convertible notes.

The consolidated amended complaint alleges that, among others, Group Inc. and GS&Co. are liable as controlling persons with respect to all five offerings, and that the shareholder affiliates (including Group Inc.) are liable for the sale of Cobalt common stock on the basis of inside information. The consolidated amended complaint also seeks damages from GS&Co. in connection with its acting as an underwriter of 16,594,500 shares of common stock representing an aggregate offering price of approximately $465 million, $690 million principal amount of convertible notes, and approximately $508 million principal amount of convertible notes in the February 2012, December 2012 and May 2014 offerings, respectively, for an aggregate offering price of approximately $1.66 billion.

On January 19, 2016, the court granted, with leave to replead, the underwriter defendants’ motions to dismiss as to claims by plaintiffs who purchased Cobalt securities after April 30, 2013, but denied the motions to dismiss in all other respects. On June 15, 2017, the court granted the plaintiffs’ motion for class certification and denied certain of the shareholder affiliates’ motions (including Group Inc.) to dismiss the claim alleging sales based on inside information. On August 4, 2017, the U.S. Court of Appeals for the Fifth Circuit granted defendants’ petition for interlocutory review of the class certification order. On August 23, 2017, the district court denied the defendants’ motion for reconsideration of certain aspects of the class certification order. The district court and the Fifth Circuit denied defendants’ request to stay discovery pending resolution of the Fifth Circuit proceeding. On December 14, 2017, Cobalt filed for Chapter 11 bankruptcy.

Cobalt, certain of its officers and directors (including employees of affiliates of Group Inc. who served as directors of Cobalt), certain shareholders of Cobalt (including funds affiliated with Group Inc.), and affiliates of these shareholders (including Group Inc.) are defendants in putative shareholder derivative actions filed on May 6, 2016 and November 29, 2016 in Texas District Court, Harris County. As to the director and officer defendants (including employees of affiliates of Group Inc. who served as directors of Cobalt), the petitions generally allege that they breached their fiduciary duties under state law by making materially false and misleading statements concerning Cobalt. As to the shareholder defendants and their affiliates (including Group Inc. and several affiliated funds), the original petition also alleges that they breached their fiduciary duties by selling Cobalt securities in the common stock offerings described above on the basis of inside information. The petitions seek, among other things, unspecified monetary damages and disgorgement of proceeds from the sale of Cobalt common stock. On March 6, 2017, the court denied defendants’ motion to dismiss the May petition as to the shareholder defendants and their affiliates (including Group Inc. and its affiliated funds). Defendants moved to dismiss the November petition on January 30, 2017.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   187


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Adeptus Health. GS&Co. is among the underwriters named as defendants in several putative securities class actions, filed beginning in October 2016 and consolidated in the U.S. District Court for the Eastern District of Texas. In addition to the underwriters, the defendants include certain of Adeptus Health Inc.’s (Adeptus) past and present directors and officers as well as its principal private equity investor. As to the underwriters, the consolidated amended complaint, filed on November 21, 2017, relates to the $124 million June 2014 initial public offering, the $154 million May 2015 secondary equity offering, the $411 million July 2015 secondary equity offering, and the $175 million June 2016 secondary equity offering. GS&Co. underwrote 1.69 million shares of common stock in the June 2014 initial public offering representing an aggregate offering price of approximately $37 million, 962,378 shares of common stock in the May 2015 offering representing an aggregate offering price of approximately $61 million, 1.76 million shares of common stock in the July 2015 offering representing an aggregate offering price of approximately $184 million, and all the shares of common stock in the June 2016 offering representing an aggregate offering price of approximately $175 million. On April 19, 2017, Adeptus filed for Chapter 11 bankruptcy. The defendants filed motions to dismiss on February 5, 2018.

TerraForm Global. GS&Co. is among the underwriters, placement agents and initial purchasers named as defendants in several putative class actions and individual actions filed beginning in October 2015 relating to the $675 million July 2015 initial public offering of the common stock of TerraForm Global, Inc. (TerraForm Global), the June 2015 private placement of $335 million of TerraForm Global Class D units, and the August 2015 Rule 144A offering of $810 million principal amount of TerraForm Global senior notes. On December 20, 2017, the parties reached a definitive settlement in the individual actions relating to TerraForm Global’s offerings, which resolved all claims without any contribution by GS&Co. On the same date, the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York preliminarily approved a settlement funded by TerraForm Global in the class action relating to TerraForm Global’s initial public offering, which would resolve the litigation.

GS&Co., as underwriter, sold 2,340,000 shares of TerraForm Global common stock in the initial public offering representing an aggregate offering price of approximately $35 million. GS&Co., as initial purchaser, sold approximately $49 million principal amount of TerraForm Global senior notes in the Rule 144A offering.

SunEdison. GS&Co. is among the underwriters named as defendants in several putative class actions and individual actions filed beginning in March 2016 relating to the August 2015 public offering of $650 million of SunEdison, Inc. (SunEdison) convertible preferred stock. On April 21, 2016, SunEdison filed for Chapter 11 bankruptcy. The pending cases were transferred to the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York and on March 17, 2017, certain plaintiffs filed an amended complaint. The defendants also include certain of SunEdison’s directors and officers. GS&Co., as underwriter, sold 138,890 shares of SunEdison convertible preferred stock in the offering, representing an aggregate offering price of approximately $139 million.

Valeant Pharmaceuticals International. GS&Co. and Goldman Sachs Canada Inc. (GS Canada) are among the underwriters and initial purchasers named as defendants in a putative class action filed on March 2, 2016 in the Superior Court of Quebec, Canada. In addition to the underwriters and initial purchasers, the defendants include Valeant Pharmaceuticals International, Inc. (Valeant), certain directors and officers of Valeant and Valeant’s auditor. As to GS&Co. and GS Canada, the complaint relates to the June 2013 public offering of $2.3 billion of common stock, the June 2013 Rule 144A offering of $3.2 billion principal amount of senior notes, and the November 2013 Rule 144A offering of $900 million principal amount of senior notes. The complaint asserts claims under the Quebec Securities Act and the Civil Code of Quebec. On August 29, 2017, the court certified a class that includes only non-U.S. purchasers in the offerings. Defendant’s motion for leave to appeal the certification was denied on November 30, 2017.

GS&Co. and GS Canada, as sole underwriters, sold 5,334,897 shares of common stock in the June 2013 offering to non-U.S. purchasers representing an aggregate offering price of approximately $453 million and, as initial purchasers, had a proportional share of sales to non-U.S. purchasers of approximately CAD14.2 million in principal amount of senior notes in the June 2013 and November 2013 Rule 144A offerings.

Snap Inc. GS&Co. is among the underwriters named as defendants in putative securities class actions pending in California Superior Court, County of Los Angeles, California Superior Court, County of San Mateo and the U.S. District Court for the Central District of California beginning in May 2017, relating to Snap Inc.’s $3.91 billion March 2017 initial public offering. In addition to the underwriters, the defendants include Snap Inc. and certain of its officers and directors. GS&Co. underwrote 57,040,000 shares of common stock representing an aggregate offering price of approximately $970 million. Defendants moved to dismiss the federal court action on December 1, 2017.

 

 

188   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Investment Management Services

Group Inc. and certain of its affiliates are parties to various civil litigation and arbitration proceedings and other disputes with clients relating to losses allegedly sustained as a result of the firm’s investment management services. These claims generally seek, among other things, restitution or other compensatory damages and, in some cases, punitive damages.

Interest Rate Swap Antitrust Litigation

Group Inc., GS&Co., GSI, GS Bank USA and Goldman Sachs Financial Markets, L.P. (GSFM) are among the defendants named in a putative antitrust class action relating to the trading of interest rate swaps, filed in November 2015 and consolidated in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York. The same Goldman Sachs entities also are among the defendants named in an antitrust action relating to the trading of interest rate swaps filed in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York in April 2016 by two operators of swap execution facilities and certain of their affiliates. These actions have been consolidated for pretrial proceedings. The second consolidated amended complaint in both actions, filed on December 9, 2016, generally asserts claims under federal antitrust law and state common law in connection with an alleged conspiracy among the defendants to preclude exchange trading of interest rate swaps. The complaint in the individual action also asserts claims under state antitrust law. The complaints seek declaratory and injunctive relief, as well as treble damages in an unspecified amount. Defendants moved to dismiss both actions on January 20, 2017. On July 28, 2017, the district court issued a decision dismissing the state common law claims asserted by the plaintiffs in the individual action and otherwise limiting the antitrust claims in both actions and the state common law claim in the putative class action to the period from 2013 to 2016.

Securities Lending Antitrust Litigation

Group Inc. and GS&Co. are among the defendants named in a putative antitrust class action and an individual action relating to securities lending practices filed in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York beginning in August 2017. The complaints generally assert claims under federal antitrust law and state common law in connection with an alleged conspiracy among the defendants to preclude the development of electronic platforms for securities lending transactions. The individual complaint also asserts claims for tortious interference with business relations and under state trade practices law. The complaints seek declaratory and injunctive relief, as well as treble damages and restitution in unspecified amounts. Group Inc. was voluntarily dismissed from the putative class action on January 26, 2018. Defendants moved to dismiss the class action complaint on January 26, 2018.

Credit Default Swap Antitrust Litigation

Group Inc., GS&Co., GSI, GS Bank USA and GSFM are among the defendants named in an antitrust action relating to the trading of credit default swaps filed in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York on June 8, 2017 by the operator of a swap execution facility and certain of its affiliates. The complaint generally asserts claims under federal and state antitrust laws and state common law in connection with an alleged conspiracy among the defendants to preclude trading of credit default swaps on the plaintiffs’ swap execution facility. The complaint seeks declaratory and injunctive relief, as well as treble damages in an unspecified amount. Defendants moved to dismiss on September 11, 2017.

Commodities-Related Litigation

GSI is among the defendants named in putative class actions relating to trading in platinum and palladium, filed beginning on November 25, 2014 and most recently amended on May 15, 2017, in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York. The amended complaint generally alleges that the defendants violated federal antitrust laws and the Commodity Exchange Act in connection with an alleged conspiracy to manipulate a benchmark for physical platinum and palladium prices and seek declaratory and injunctive relief, as well as treble damages in an unspecified amount. Defendants moved to dismiss the third consolidated amended complaint on July 21, 2017.

U.S. Treasury Securities Litigation

GS&Co. is among the primary dealers named as defendants in several putative class actions relating to the market for U.S. Treasury securities, filed beginning in July 2015 and consolidated in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York. GS&Co. is also among the primary dealers named as defendants in a similar individual action filed in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York on August 25, 2017. The consolidated class action complaint, filed on December 29, 2017, generally alleges that the defendants violated antitrust laws in connection with an alleged conspiracy to manipulate the when-issued market and auctions for U.S. Treasury securities and that certain defendants, including GS&Co., colluded to preclude trading of U.S. Treasury securities on electronic trading platforms in order to impede competition in the bidding process. The individual action alleges a similar conspiracy regarding manipulation of the when-issued market and auctions, as well as related futures and options in violation of the Commodity Exchange Act. The complaints seek declaratory and injunctive relief, treble damages in an unspecified amount and restitution.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   189


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Employment-Related Matters

On September 15, 2010, a putative class action was filed in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York by three female former employees alleging that Group Inc. and GS&Co. have systematically discriminated against female employees in respect of compensation, promotion, assignments, mentoring and performance evaluations. The complaint alleges a class consisting of all female employees employed at specified levels in specified areas by Group Inc. and GS&Co. since July 2002, and asserts claims under federal and New York City discrimination laws. The complaint seeks class action status, injunctive relief and unspecified amounts of compensatory, punitive and other damages.

On July 17, 2012, the district court issued a decision granting in part Group Inc.’s and GS&Co.’s motion to strike certain of plaintiffs’ class allegations on the ground that plaintiffs lacked standing to pursue certain equitable remedies and denying Group Inc.’s and GS&Co.’s motion to strike plaintiffs’ class allegations in their entirety as premature. On March 21, 2013, the U.S. Court of Appeals for the Second Circuit held that arbitration should be compelled with one of the named plaintiffs, who as a managing director was a party to an arbitration agreement with the firm. On March 10, 2015, the magistrate judge to whom the district judge assigned the remaining plaintiffs’ May 2014 motion for class certification recommended that the motion be denied in all respects. On August 3, 2015, the magistrate judge granted the plaintiffs’ motion to intervene two female individuals, one of whom was employed by the firm as of September 2010 and the other of whom ceased to be an employee of the firm subsequent to the magistrate judge’s decision. On August 30, 2017, the district court vacated that portion of the magistrate judge’s March 10, 2015 decision that recommended denial of plaintiffs’ motion for certification of an injunctive and declaratory judgment class.

1Malaysia Development Berhad (1MDB)-Related Matters

The firm has received subpoenas and requests for documents and information from various governmental and regulatory bodies and self-regulatory organizations as part of investigations and reviews relating to financing transactions and other matters involving 1MDB, a sovereign wealth fund in Malaysia. The firm is cooperating with all such governmental and regulatory investigations and reviews.

Regulatory Investigations and Reviews and Related Litigation

Group Inc. and certain of its affiliates are subject to a number of other investigations and reviews by, and in some cases have received subpoenas and requests for documents and information from, various governmental and regulatory bodies and self-regulatory organizations and litigation and shareholder requests relating to various matters relating to the firm’s businesses and operations, including:

 

 

The 2008 financial crisis;

 

 

The public offering process;

 

 

The firm’s investment management and financial advisory services;

 

 

Conflicts of interest;

 

 

Research practices, including research independence and interactions between research analysts and other firm personnel, including investment banking personnel, as well as third parties;

 

 

Transactions involving government-related financings and other matters, municipal securities, including wall-cross procedures and conflict of interest disclosure with respect to state and municipal clients, the trading and structuring of municipal derivative instruments in connection with municipal offerings, political contribution rules, municipal advisory services and the possible impact of credit default swap transactions on municipal issuers;

 

 

190   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

 

The offering, auction, sales, trading and clearance of corporate and government securities, currencies, commodities and other financial products and related sales and other communications and activities, as well as the firm’s supervision and controls relating to such activities, including compliance with the SEC’s short sale rule, algorithmic, high-frequency and quantitative trading, the firm’s U.S. alternative trading system (dark pool), futures trading, options trading, when-issued trading, transaction reporting, technology systems and controls, securities lending practices, trading and clearance of credit derivative instruments and interest rate swaps, commodities activities and metals storage, private placement practices, allocations of and trading in securities, and trading activities and communications in connection with the establishment of benchmark rates, such as currency rates;

 

 

Compliance with the U.S. Foreign Corrupt Practices Act;

 

 

The firm’s hiring and compensation practices;

 

 

The firm’s system of risk management and controls; and

 

 

Insider trading, the potential misuse and dissemination of material nonpublic information regarding corporate and governmental developments and the effectiveness of the firm’s insider trading controls and information barriers.

The firm is cooperating with all such governmental and regulatory investigations and reviews.

Note 28.

Employee Benefit Plans

The firm sponsors various pension plans and certain other postretirement benefit plans, primarily healthcare and life insurance. The firm also provides certain benefits to former or inactive employees prior to retirement.

Defined Benefit Pension Plans and Postretirement Plans

Employees of certain non-U.S. subsidiaries participate in various defined benefit pension plans. These plans generally provide benefits based on years of credited service and a percentage of the employee’s eligible compensation. The firm maintains a defined benefit pension plan for certain U.K. employees. As of April 2008, the U.K. defined benefit plan was closed to new participants and frozen for existing participants as of March 31, 2016. The non-U.S. plans do not have a material impact on the firm’s consolidated results of operations.

The firm also maintains a defined benefit pension plan for substantially all U.S. employees hired prior to November 1, 2003. As of November 2004, this plan was closed to new participants and frozen for existing participants. In addition, the firm maintains unfunded postretirement benefit plans that provide medical and life insurance for eligible retirees and their dependents covered under these programs. These plans do not have a material impact on the firm’s consolidated results of operations.

The firm recognizes the funded status of its defined benefit pension and postretirement plans, measured as the difference between the fair value of the plan assets and the benefit obligation, in the consolidated statements of financial condition. As of December 2017, other assets and other liabilities and accrued expenses included $346 million (related to overfunded pension plans) and $606 million, respectively, related to these plans. As of December 2016, other assets and other liabilities and accrued expenses included $72 million (related to overfunded pension plans) and $592 million, respectively, related to these plans.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   191


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Defined Contribution Plans

The firm contributes to employer-sponsored U.S. and non-U.S. defined contribution plans. The firm’s contribution to these plans was $257 million for 2017, $236 million for 2016 and $231 million for 2015.

Note 29.

Employee Incentive Plans

The cost of employee services received in exchange for a share-based award is generally measured based on the grant-date fair value of the award. Share-based awards that do not require future service (i.e., vested awards, including awards granted to retirement-eligible employees) are expensed immediately. Share-based awards that require future service are amortized over the relevant service period. Effective January 2017, forfeitures are recorded when they occur. Prior to January 2017, expected forfeitures were estimated and recorded over the vesting period. See Note 3 for information about the adoption of ASU No. 2016-09.

Cash dividend equivalents paid on outstanding RSUs are charged to retained earnings. If RSUs that require future service are forfeited, the related dividend equivalents originally charged to retained earnings are reclassified to compensation expense in the period in which forfeiture occurs.

The firm generally issues new shares of common stock upon delivery of share-based awards. In certain cases, primarily related to conflicted employment (as outlined in the applicable award agreements), the firm may cash settle share-based compensation awards accounted for as equity instruments. For these awards, whose terms allow for cash settlement, additional paid-in capital is adjusted to the extent of the difference between the value of the award at the time of cash settlement and the grant-date value of the award.

Stock Incentive Plan

The firm sponsors a stock incentive plan, The Goldman Sachs Amended and Restated Stock Incentive Plan (2015) (2015 SIP), which provides for grants of RSUs, restricted stock, dividend equivalent rights, incentive stock options, nonqualified stock options, stock appreciation rights, and other share-based awards, each of which may be subject to performance conditions. On May 21, 2015, shareholders approved the 2015 SIP. The 2015 SIP replaced The Goldman Sachs Amended and Restated Stock Incentive Plan (2013) (2013 SIP) previously in effect, and applies to awards granted on or after the date of approval.

As of December 2017, 73.0 million shares were available for grant under the 2015 SIP. If any shares of common stock underlying awards granted under the 2015 SIP or 2013 SIP are not delivered due to forfeiture, termination or cancellation or are surrendered or withheld, those shares will again become available to be delivered under the 2015 SIP. Shares available for grant are also subject to adjustment for certain changes in corporate structure as permitted under the 2015 SIP. The 2015 SIP is scheduled to terminate on the date of the annual meeting of shareholders that occurs in 2019.

Restricted Stock Units

The firm grants RSUs (including RSUs subject to performance conditions) to employees under the 2015 SIP, which are generally valued based on the closing price of the underlying shares on the date of grant after taking into account a liquidity discount for any applicable post-vesting and delivery transfer restrictions. RSUs generally vest and underlying shares of common stock deliver (net of required withholding tax) as outlined in the applicable award agreements. Employee award agreements generally provide that vesting is accelerated in certain circumstances, such as on retirement, death, disability and conflicted employment. Delivery of the underlying shares of common stock, which generally occurs over a three-year period, is conditioned on the grantees satisfying certain vesting and other requirements outlined in the award agreements.

 

 

192   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The table below presents the activity related to RSUs.

 

   

Restricted Stock

Units Outstanding

       

Weighted Average
Grant-Date Fair Value of
Restricted Stock

Units Outstanding

 
     

Future
Service
Required
 
 
 
   

No Future
Service
Required
 
 
 
       

Future
Service
Required
 
 
 
    

No Future
Service
Required
 
 
 

Outstanding, December 2016

    5,623,239       22,202,431         $147.25        $145.97  

Granted

    3,764,395       5,235,283         $208.24        $205.91  

Forfeited

    (466,715     (260,762       $167.02        $164.06  

Delivered

          (17,811,461       $         –        $151.72  

Vested

    (4,797,337     4,797,337           $162.88        $162.88  

Outstanding, December 2017

    4,123,582       14,162,828           $182.50        $166.30  

In the table above:

 

 

The weighted average grant-date fair value of RSUs granted during 2017, 2016 and 2015 was $206.88, $135.92 and $160.19, respectively. The fair value of the RSUs granted during 2017, 2016 and 2015 includes a liquidity discount of 10.7%, 10.5% and 9.2%, respectively, to reflect post-vesting and delivery transfer restrictions, generally of up to 4 years.

 

 

The aggregate fair value of awards that vested during 2017, 2016 and 2015 was $2.14 billion, $2.26 billion and $2.40 billion, respectively.

 

 

Delivered RSUs include RSUs that were cash settled.

 

 

RSUs outstanding include restricted stock subject to future service requirements as of December 2017 and December 2016 of 3,298 and 39,957 shares, respectively.

 

 

RSUs outstanding include 62,023 RSUs subject to performance conditions and not subject to future service requirements as of December 2017. There were no such RSUs outstanding as of December 2016.

In relation to 2017 year-end, during the first quarter of 2018, the firm granted to its employees 5.7 million RSUs (of which 2.9 million require future service as a condition of delivery for the related shares of common stock) and delivered, net of required withholding tax, 1.2 million shares of restricted stock (which do not require future service). Both RSU and restricted stock awards are subject to additional conditions as outlined in the award agreements, including post-vesting and delivery transfer restrictions through January 2023. These awards are not included in the table above.

Stock Options

Stock options generally vest as outlined in the applicable stock option agreement. In general, options expire on the tenth anniversary of the grant date, although they may be subject to earlier termination or cancellation under certain circumstances in accordance with the terms of the applicable stock option agreement and the SIP in effect at the time of grant.

As of December 2017 and December 2016, there were 2.10 million and 7.96 million options outstanding, respectively, all of which were exercisable. The options outstanding as of December 2017, all of which were granted in 2008 with an exercise price of $78.78, had an aggregate intrinsic value of $370 million and a remaining life of 1 year. The options outstanding as of December 2016 had a weighted average exercise price of $123.36, an aggregate intrinsic value of $924 million and a weighted average remaining life of 1.61 years. Options outstanding as of December 2016 consisted of 5.13 million options with an exercise price of $78.78 and a remaining life of 2.00 years, and 2.83 million options with an exercise price of $204.16 and a remaining life of 0.92 years.

During 2017, 5.86 million options were exercised with a weighted average exercise price of $139.35. The total intrinsic value of options exercised during 2017, 2016 and 2015 was $589 million, $436 million and $531 million, respectively.

The table below presents the share-based compensation and the related excess tax benefit.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017       2016       2015  

Share-based compensation

    $1,812       $2,170       $2,304  

Excess net tax benefit for options exercised

    $   139       $     79       $   134  

Excess net tax benefit for share-based awards

    $   719       $   147       $   406  

In the table above, excess net tax benefit for share-based awards includes the net tax benefit on dividend equivalents paid on RSUs and the delivery of common stock underlying share-based awards, as well as the excess net tax benefit for options exercised. Following the adoption of ASU No. 2016-09 in January 2017, such amounts were recognized prospectively in income tax expense. In prior years, such amounts were recognized in additional paid-in capital. See Note 3 for further information about this ASU.

As of December 2017, there was $386 million of total unrecognized compensation cost related to non-vested share-based compensation arrangements. This cost is expected to be recognized over a weighted average period of 1.82 years.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   193


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Note 30.

Parent Company

 

Group Inc. — Condensed Statements of Earnings

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017       2016       2015  

Revenues

     

Dividends from subsidiaries and other affiliates:

     

Bank

    $     550       $     53       $     32  

Nonbank

    11,016       5,465       3,181  

Other revenues

    (384     155       (132

Total non-interest revenues

    11,182       5,673       3,081  

Interest income

    4,638       4,140       3,519  

Interest expense

    5,978       4,543       4,165  

Net interest loss

    (1,340     (403     (646

Net revenues, including net interest loss

    9,842       5,270       2,435  

 

Operating expenses

     

Compensation and benefits

    330       343       498  

Other expenses

    428       332       188  

Total operating expenses

    758       675       686  

Pre-tax earnings

    9,084       4,595       1,749  

Provision/(benefit) for taxes

    3,404       (518     (828

Undistributed earnings/(loss) of subsidiaries and other affiliates

    (1,394     2,285       3,506  

Net earnings

    4,286       7,398       6,083  

Preferred stock dividends

    601       311       515  

Net earnings applicable to common shareholders

    $  3,685       $7,087       $5,568  

Supplemental Disclosures:

Dividends from bank subsidiaries included cash dividends of $525 million, $32 million and $14 million for 2017, 2016 and 2015, respectively.

Dividends from nonbank subsidiaries and other affiliates included cash dividends of $7.98 billion, $3.46 billion and $2.29 billion for 2017, 2016 and 2015, respectively.

Interest expense included $1.05 billion, $201 million and $187 million of interest expense with subsidiaries for 2017, 2016 and 2015, respectively.

Group Inc.’s provision/(benefit) for taxes for 2017 included substantially all of the firm’s $4.40 billion estimated income tax expense related to Tax Legislation. See Note 24 for further information on Tax Legislation.

Group Inc. — Condensed Statements of Financial Condition

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017       2016  

Assets

   

Cash and cash equivalents:

   

With third-party banks

    $         38       $         81  

With subsidiary bank

          3,000  

Loans to and receivables from subsidiaries:

   

Bank

    721       9,131  

Nonbank

    236,050       179,899  

Investments in subsidiaries and other affiliates:

   

Bank

    26,599       25,571  

Nonbank

    67,279       67,203  

Financial instruments owned (at fair value)

    10,248       4,524  

Other assets

    5,898       6,273  

Total assets

    $346,833       $295,682  

 

Liabilities and shareholders’ equity

   

Payables to subsidiaries

    $    1,005       $       875  

Financial instruments sold, but not yet purchased (at fair value)

    254       775  

Unsecured short-term borrowings:

   

With third parties (includes $2,484 and $3,256 at fair value)

    31,871       27,159  

With subsidiaries

    25,699       999  

Unsecured long-term borrowings:

   

With third parties (includes $18,207 and $17,591 at fair value)

    190,502       172,164  

With subsidiaries

    11,068       5,233  

Other liabilities and accrued expenses

    4,191       1,584  

Total liabilities

    264,590       208,789  

 

Commitments, contingencies and guarantees

   

 

Shareholders’ equity

   

Preferred stock

    11,853       11,203  

Common stock

    9       9  

Share-based awards

    2,777       3,914  

Additional paid-in capital

    53,357       52,638  

Retained earnings

    91,519       89,039  

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

    (1,880     (1,216

Stock held in treasury, at cost

    (75,392     (68,694

Total shareholders’ equity

    82,243       86,893  

Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity

    $346,833       $295,682  

Supplemental Disclosures:

Goldman Sachs Funding LLC (Funding IHC), a wholly-owned, direct subsidiary of Group Inc., has provided Group Inc. with a committed line of credit that allows Group Inc. to draw sufficient funds to meet its cash needs in the ordinary course of business.

Financial instruments owned included $570 million and $1.08 billion of derivative contracts with subsidiaries as of December 2017 and December 2016, respectively.

As of December 2017, unsecured long-term borrowings with subsidiaries by maturity date are $10.55 billion in 2019, $121 million in 2020, $58 million in 2021, $21 million in 2022, and $323 million in 2023-thereafter.

 

 

194   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Group Inc. — Condensed Statements of Cash Flows

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017       2016       2015  

Cash flows from operating activities

     

Net earnings

    $   4,286       $   7,398       $   6,083  

Adjustments to reconcile net earnings to net cash provided by operating activities:

     

Undistributed (earnings)/loss of subsidiaries and other affiliates

    1,394       (2,285     (3,506

Depreciation and amortization

    56       52       50  

Deferred income taxes

    4,358       134       86  

Share-based compensation

    152       193       178  

Loss/(gain) related to extinguishment of subordinated borrowings

    (114     3       (34

Changes in operating assets and liabilities:

     

Financial instruments owned (excluding available-for-sale securities)

    (309     (1,580     (620

Financial instruments sold, but not yet purchased

    (521     332       274  

Other, net

    (757     337       1,555  

Net cash provided by operating activities

    8,545       4,584       4,066  

 

Cash flows from investing activities

     

Purchase of property, leasehold improvements and equipment

    (66     (79     (33

Issuances of short-term loans to subsidiaries, net

    (14,415     (3,994     (24,417

Issuance of term loans to subsidiaries

    (42,234     (28,498     (8,632

Repayments of term loans by subsidiaries

    22,039       32,265       24,196  

Purchase of investments

    (6,491            

Capital distributions from/(contributions to) subsidiaries, net

    388       (3,265     (1,500

Net cash used for investing activities

    (40,779     (3,571     (10,386

 

Cash flows from financing activities

     

Unsecured short-term borrowings, net:

     

With third parties

    (424     (178     (1,570

With subsidiaries

    23,078       2,290       (1,114

Proceeds from issuance of long-term borrowings

    43,917       40,708       42,795  

Repayment of long-term borrowings, including the current portion

    (27,028     (33,314     (27,726

Purchase of APEX, senior guaranteed securities and trust preferred securities

    (237     (1,171     (1

Preferred stock redemption

    (850            

Common stock repurchased

    (6,772     (6,078     (4,135

Settlement of share-based awards in satisfaction of withholding tax requirements

    (2,223     (1,128     (1,204

Dividends and dividend equivalents paid on common stock, preferred stock and share-based awards

    (1,769     (1,706     (1,681

Proceeds from issuance of preferred stock, net of issuance costs

    1,495       1,303       1,993  

Proceeds from issuance of common stock, including exercise of share-based awards

    7       6       259  

Cash settlement of share-based awards

    (3           (2

Net cash provided by financing activities

    29,191       732       7,614  

Net increase/(decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

    (3,043     1,745       1,294  

Cash and cash equivalents, beginning balance

    3,081       1,336       42  

Cash and cash equivalents, ending balance

    $        38       $   3,081       $   1,336  

Supplemental Disclosures:

Cash payments for interest, net of capitalized interest, were $6.31 billion, $4.91 billion and $3.70 billion for 2017, 2016 and 2015, respectively.

Cash payments for income taxes, net of refunds, were $297 million, $61 million and $1.28 billion for 2017, 2016 and 2015, respectively.

Cash flows related to common stock repurchased includes common stock repurchased in the prior period for which settlement occurred during the current period and excludes common stock repurchased during the current period for which settlement occurred in the following period.

Non-cash activities during the year ended December 2017:

 

 

Group Inc. exchanged $84.00 billion of certain loans to and receivables from subsidiaries for an $84.00 billion unsecured subordinated note from Funding IHC (included in loans to and receivables from subsidiaries).

 

 

Group Inc. exchanged $750 million of its equity interest in Goldman Sachs (UK) L.L.C. (GS UK), a wholly-owned subsidiary of Group Inc., for a $750 million loan to GS UK.

 

 

Group Inc. exchanged $237 million of Trust Preferred Securities and common beneficial interests for $248 million of Group Inc.’s junior subordinated debt.

Non-cash activities during the year ended December 2016:

 

 

Group Inc. exchanged $1.04 billion of APEX for $1.31 billion of Series E and Series F Preferred Stock. See Note 19 for further information.

 

 

Group Inc. exchanged $127 million of senior guaranteed trust securities for $124 million of Group Inc.’s junior subordinated debt.

Non-cash activities during the year ended December 2015:

 

 

Group Inc. exchanged $6.12 billion in financial instruments owned, at fair value, held by Group Inc. for $5.20 billion of loans to and $918 million of equity in certain of its subsidiaries.

 

 

Group Inc. exchanged $262 million of Trust Preferred Securities and common beneficial interests held by Group Inc. for $296 million of Group Inc.’s junior subordinated debt.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   195


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Supplemental Financial Information

 

Quarterly Results (unaudited)

The tables below present the firm’s unaudited quarterly results for 2017 and 2016. These quarterly results were prepared in accordance with U.S. GAAP and reflect all adjustments that are, in the opinion of management, necessary for a fair statement of the results. These adjustments are of a normal, recurring nature. The timing and magnitude of changes in the firm’s discretionary compensation accruals (included in operating expenses) can have a significant effect on results in a given quarter.

 

    Three Months Ended  

$ in millions, except per

share amounts

   
December
2017
 
 
   
September
2017
 
 
   
June
2017
 
 
   
March
2017
 
 

Non-interest revenues

    $ 6,936       $7,596       $7,099       $7,510  

Interest income

    3,736       3,411       3,220       2,746  

Interest expense

    2,838       2,681       2,432       2,230  

Net interest income

    898       730       788       516  

Net revenues, including net interest income

    7,834       8,326       7,887       8,026  

Operating expenses

    4,726       5,350       5,378       5,487  

Pre-tax earnings

    3,108       2,976       2,509       2,539  

Provision for taxes

    5,036       848       678       284  

Net earnings/(loss)

    (1,928     2,128       1,831       2,255  

Preferred stock dividends

    215       93       200       93  

Net earnings/(loss) applicable to common shareholders

    $(2,143     $2,035       $1,631       $2,162  

Earnings/(loss) per common share:

 

     

Basic

    $  (5.51     $  5.09       $  4.00       $  5.23  

Diluted

    $  (5.51     $  5.02       $  3.95       $  5.15  

Dividends declared per common share

    $   0.75       $  0.75       $  0.75       $  0.65  
    Three Months Ended  

$ in millions, except per

share amounts

   
December
2016
 
 
   
September
2016
 
 
   
June
2016
 
 
   
March
2016
 
 

Non-interest revenues

    $ 7,834       $7,554       $7,178       $5,455  

Interest income

    2,424       2,389       2,530       2,348  

Interest expense

    2,088       1,775       1,776       1,465  

Net interest income

    336       614       754       883  

Net revenues, including net interest income

    8,170       8,168       7,932       6,338  

Operating expenses

    4,773       5,300       5,469       4,762  

Pre-tax earnings

    3,397       2,868       2,463       1,576  

Provision for taxes

    1,050       774       641       441  

Net earnings

    2,347       2,094       1,822       1,135  

Preferred stock dividends

    194       (6     188       (65

Net earnings applicable to common shareholders

    $ 2,153       $2,100       $1,634       $1,200  

Earnings per common share:

       

Basic

    $   5.17       $  4.96       $  3.77       $  2.71  

Diluted

    $   5.08       $  4.88       $  3.72       $  2.68  

Dividends declared per common share

    $   0.65       $  0.65       $  0.65       $  0.65  

Common Stock Price Range

The table below presents the high and low sales prices per share of the firm’s common stock.

 

    Year Ended December  
    2017         2016         2015  
      High       Low           High       Low           High       Low  

First quarter

    $255.15       $220.85         $177.50       $139.05         $195.73       $172.26  

Second quarter

    $232.89       $209.62         $168.90       $138.20         $218.77       $186.96  

Third quarter

    $237.60       $214.64         $172.42       $142.62         $214.61       $167.49  

Fourth quarter

    $262.14       $233.55           $245.57       $160.25           $199.90       $169.87  

As of February 9, 2018, there were 7,652 holders of record of the firm’s common stock.

On February 9, 2018, the last reported sales price for the firm’s common stock on the New York Stock Exchange was $249.30 per share.

Common Stock Performance

The graph and table below compare the performance of an investment in the firm’s common stock from December 31, 2012 (the last trading day before the firm’s 2013 fiscal year) through December 31, 2017, with the S&P 500 Index and the S&P 500 Financials Index. The graph and table assume $100 was invested on December 31, 2012 in each of the firm’s common stock, the S&P 500 Index and the S&P 500 Financials Index, and the dividends were reinvested on the date of payment without payment of any commissions. The performance shown represents past performance and should not be considered an indication of future performance.

 

LOGO

 

    As of December  
      2012       2013       2014       2015       2016       2017  

The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc.

    $100.00       $140.78       $155.96       $146.93       $198.22       $213.56  

S&P 500 Index

    $100.00       $132.37       $150.48       $152.54       $170.77       $208.03  

S&P 500 Financials
Index

    $100.00       $135.59       $156.17       $153.74       $188.71       $230.49  
 

 

196   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Supplemental Financial Information

 

Selected Financial Data

 

    Year Ended or as of December  
      2017       2016       2015       2014       2013  

Income statement data ($ in millions)

 

Non-interest revenues

    $  29,141       $  28,021       $  30,756       $  30,481       $  30,814  

Interest income

    13,113       9,691       8,452       9,604       10,060  

Interest expense

    10,181       7,104       5,388       5,557       6,668  

Net interest income

    2,932       2,587       3,064       4,047       3,392  

Net revenues, including net interest income

    32,073       30,608       33,820       34,528       34,206  

Compensation and
benefits

    11,853       11,647       12,678       12,691       12,613  

Non-compensation expenses

    9,088       8,657       12,364       9,480       9,856  

Pre-tax earnings

    $  11,132       $  10,304       $    8,778       $  12,357       $  11,737  

Balance sheet data ($ in millions)

 

     

Total assets

    $916,776       $860,165       $861,395       $855,842       $911,124  

Deposits

    $138,604       $124,098       $  97,519       $  82,880       $  70,696  

Other secured financings (long-term)

    $    9,892       $    8,405       $  10,520       $    7,249       $    7,524  

Unsecured long-term borrowings

    $217,687       $189,086       $175,422       $167,302       $160,695  

Total liabilities

    $834,533       $773,272       $774,667       $773,045       $832,657  

Total shareholders’ equity

    $  82,243       $  86,893       $  86,728       $  82,797       $  78,467  

Common share data (in millions, except per share amounts)

 

Earnings per common share:

 

       

Basic

    $      9.12       $    16.53       $    12.35       $    17.55       $    16.34  

Diluted

    $      9.01       $    16.29       $    12.14       $    17.07       $    15.46  

Dividends declared per common share

    $      2.90       $      2.60       $      2.55       $      2.25       $      2.05  

Book value per common share

    $  181.00       $  182.47       $  171.03       $  163.01       $  152.48  

Basic shares

    388.9       414.8       441.6       451.5       467.4  

Average common shares:

 

     

Basic

    401.6       427.4       448.9       458.9       471.3  

Diluted

    409.1       435.1       458.6       473.2       499.6  

Selected data (unaudited)

 

     

Return on average common shareholders’ equity

    4.9%       9.4%       7.4%       11.2%       11.0%  

Total staff:

         

Americas

    19,100       18,100       19,000       17,400       16,600  

Non-Americas

    17,500       16,300       17,800       16,600       16,300  

Total staff

    36,600       34,400       36,800       34,000       32,900  

AUS by asset class ($ in billions)

 

     

Alternative

    $       168       $       154       $       148       $       143       $       142  

Equity

    321       266       252       236       208  

Fixed income

    660       601       546       516       446  

Long-term AUS

    1,149       1,021       946       895       796  

Liquidity products

    345       358       306       283       246  

Total AUS

    $    1,494       $    1,379       $    1,252       $    1,178       $    1,042  

In the table above:

 

 

The impact of adopting ASU No. 2015-03 was a reduction to both total assets and total liabilities of $398 million and $383 million as of December 2014 and December 2013, respectively. See Note 3 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of the firm’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2015 for further information about ASU No. 2015-03.

 

 

Basic shares represent common shares outstanding and restricted stock units granted to employees with no future service requirements.

Statistical Disclosures

Distribution of Assets, Liabilities and Shareholders’

Equity

The tables below present a summary of average balances, interest and interest rates.

 

   

Average Balance for the

Year Ended December

 
$ in millions     2017       2016       2015  

Assets

     

U.S.

    $  66,838       $  72,132       $  50,696  

Non-U.S.

    42,353       33,342       24,703  

Total deposits with banks

    109,191       105,474       75,399  

U.S.

    159,829       177,930       193,512  

Non-U.S.

    133,156       129,150       111,168  

Total collateralized agreements

    292,985       307,080       304,680  

U.S.

    163,344       147,862       167,727  

Non-U.S.

    112,299       102,387       97,152  

Total financial instruments owned

    275,643       250,249       264,879  

U.S.

    50,742       43,367       34,521  

Non-U.S.

    4,767       4,609       2,440  

Total loans receivable

    55,509       47,976       36,961  

U.S.

    40,642       37,525       41,022  

Non-U.S.

    40,314       32,732       45,235  

Total other interest-earning assets

    80,956       70,257       86,257  

Total interest-earning assets

    814,284       781,036       768,176  

Cash and due from banks

    11,056       13,985       13,803  

Other non-interest-earning assets

    84,264       91,875       91,970  

Total assets

    $909,604       $886,896       $873,949  

Liabilities

     

U.S.

    $101,109       $  97,255       $  73,063  

Non-U.S.

    24,356       17,605       13,885  

Total interest-bearing deposits

    125,465       114,860       86,948  

U.S.

    56,614       52,388       59,885  

Non-U.S.

    39,029       31,936       29,777  

Total collateralized financings

    95,643       84,324       89,662  

U.S.

    34,422       36,273       36,609  

Non-U.S.

    41,507       35,797       36,066  

Total financial instruments sold, but not yet purchased

    75,929       72,070       72,675  

U.S.

    38,615       43,684       42,743  

Non-U.S.

    13,318       13,656       14,447  

Total short-term borrowings

    51,933       57,340       57,190  

U.S.

    199,569       182,808       172,160  

Non-U.S.

    15,000       10,488       8,843  

Total long-term borrowings

    214,569       193,296       181,003  

U.S.

    135,804       147,177       156,248  

Non-U.S.

    60,986       59,852       62,672  

Total other interest-bearing liabilities

    196,790       207,029       218,920  

Total interest-bearing liabilities

    760,329       728,919       706,398  

Non-interest-bearing deposits

    3,630       2,996       1,986  

Other non-interest-bearing liabilities

    59,686       68,323       79,251  

Total liabilities

    823,645       800,238       787,635  

Shareholders’ equity

     

Preferred stock

    11,238       11,304       10,585  

Common stock

    74,721       75,354       75,729  

Total shareholders’ equity

    85,959       86,658       86,314  

Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity

    $909,604       $886,896       $873,949  

Percentage of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities attributable to non-U.S. operations

 

Assets

    40.88%       38.69%       36.54%  

Liabilities

    25.54%       23.23%       23.46%  
 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   197


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Supplemental Financial Information

 

   

Interest for the

Year Ended December

 
$ in millions     2017        2016       2015  

Assets

      

U.S.

    $     760        $   382       $    143  

Non-U.S.

    59        70       98  

Total deposits with banks

    819        452       241  

U.S.

    1,335        361       (369

Non-U.S.

    326        330       386  

Total collateralized agreements

    1,661        691       17  

U.S.

    3,958        3,762       4,083  

Non-U.S.

    1,946        1,682       1,779  

Total financial instruments owned

    5,904        5,444       5,862  

U.S.

    2,386        1,620       1,101  

Non-U.S.

    292        223       90  

Total loans receivable

    2,678        1,843       1,191  

U.S.

    1,523        914       754  

Non-U.S.

    528        347       387  

Total other interest-earning assets

    2,051        1,261       1,141  

Total interest-earning assets

    $13,113        $9,691       $ 8,452  

Liabilities

      

U.S.

    $  1,205        $   780       $    354  

Non-U.S.

    175        98       54  

Total interest-bearing deposits

    1,380        878       408  

U.S.

    735        325       221  

Non-U.S.

    128        117       109  

Total collateralized financings

    863        442       330  

U.S.

    682        607       644  

Non-U.S.

    706        644       675  

Total financial instruments sold, but not yet purchased

    1,388        1,251       1,319  

U.S.

    660        401       401  

Non-U.S.

    38        45       28  

Total short-term borrowings

    698        446       429  

U.S.

    4,539        4,175       3,722  

Non-U.S.

    60        67       156  

Total long-term borrowings

    4,599        4,242       3,878  

U.S.

    991        (658     (1,378

Non-U.S.

    262        503       402  

Total other interest-bearing liabilities

    1,253        (155     (976

Total interest-bearing liabilities

    $10,181        $7,104       $ 5,388  

Net interest income

      

U.S.

    $  1,150        $1,409       $ 1,748  

Non-U.S.

    1,782        1,178       1,316  

Net interest income

    $  2,932        $2,587       $ 3,064  
   

Average Rate for the

Year Ended December

 
      2017       2016       2015  

Assets

     

U.S.

    1.14%       0.53%       0.28%  

Non-U.S.

    0.14%       0.21%       0.40%  

Total deposits with banks

    0.75%       0.43%       0.32%  

U.S.

    0.84%       0.20%       (0.19)%  

Non-U.S.

    0.24%       0.26%       0.35%  

Total collateralized agreements

    0.57%       0.23%       0.01%  

U.S.

    2.42%       2.54%       2.43%  

Non-U.S.

    1.73%       1.64%       1.83%  

Total financial instruments owned

    2.14%       2.18%       2.21%  

U.S.

    4.70%       3.74%       3.19%  

Non-U.S.

    6.13%       4.84%       3.69%  

Total loans receivable

    4.82%       3.84%       3.22%  

U.S.

    3.75%       2.44%       1.84%  

Non-U.S.

    1.31%       1.06%       0.86%  

Total other interest-earning assets

    2.53%       1.79%       1.32%  

Total interest-earning assets

    1.61%       1.24%       1.10%  

Liabilities

     

U.S.

    1.19%       0.80%       0.48%  

Non-U.S.

    0.72%       0.56%       0.39%  

Total interest-bearing deposits

    1.10%       0.76%       0.47%  

U.S.

    1.30%       0.62%       0.37%  

Non-U.S.

    0.33%       0.37%       0.37%  

Total collateralized financings

    0.90%       0.52%       0.37%  

U.S.

    1.98%       1.67%       1.76%  

Non-U.S.

    1.70%       1.80%       1.87%  

Total financial instruments sold, but not yet purchased

    1.83%       1.74%       1.81%  

U.S.

    1.71%       0.92%       0.94%  

Non-U.S.

    0.29%       0.33%       0.19%  

Total short-term borrowings

    1.34%       0.78%       0.75%  

U.S.

    2.27%       2.28%       2.16%  

Non-U.S.

    0.40%       0.64%       1.76%  

Total long-term borrowings

    2.14%       2.19%       2.14%  

U.S.

    0.73%       (0.45)%       (0.88)%  

Non-U.S.

    0.43%       0.84%       0.64%  

Total other interest-bearing liabilities

    0.64%       (0.07)%       (0.45)%  

Total interest-bearing liabilities

    1.34%       0.97%       0.76%  

Interest rate spread

    0.27%       0.27%       0.34%  

U.S.

    0.24%       0.29%       0.36%  

Non-U.S.

    0.54%       0.39%       0.47%  

Net yield on interest-earning assets

    0.36%       0.33%       0.40%  
 

 

198   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Supplemental Financial Information

 

In the tables above:

 

 

Assets, liabilities and interest are classified as U.S. and non-U.S. based on the location of the entity in which the assets and liabilities are held. See the notes to the consolidated financial statements for further information about such assets and liabilities.

 

 

Derivative instruments and commodities are included in other non-interest-earning assets and other non-interest-bearing liabilities.

 

 

Total other interest-earning assets primarily consists of certain receivables from customers and counterparties.

 

 

Collateralized financings consists of securities sold under agreements to repurchase and securities loaned.

 

 

Substantially all of the total other interest-bearing liabilities consists of certain payables to customers and counterparties.

 

 

Interest rates for borrowings include the effects of interest rate swaps accounted for as hedges.

 

 

In December 2016, the firm reclassified amounts related to cash and securities segregated for regulatory and other purposes that were previously included in total other interest-earning assets to total deposits with banks, total collateralized agreements, and total financial instruments owned. The firm also reclassified amounts related to cash segregated for regulatory and other purposes that were previously included in other non-interest-earning assets to cash and due from banks. Previously reported amounts have been conformed to the current presentation. See Note 3 to the consolidated financial statements for further information about this reclassification.

Changes in Net Interest Income, Volume and Rate Analysis

The tables below present an analysis of the effect on net interest income of volume and rate changes. In this analysis, changes due to volume/rate variance have been allocated to volume.

 

    Year Ended December 2017
versus December 2016
 
    Increase (decrease)
due to change in:
       
$ in millions     Volume        Rate      

Net

Change

 

 

Interest-earning assets

      

U.S.

    $  (60      $   438       $   378  

Non-U.S.

    13        (24     (11

Total deposits with banks

    (47      414       367  

U.S.

    (151      1,125       974  

Non-U.S.

    10        (14     (4

Total collateralized agreements

    (141      1,111       970  

U.S.

    375        (179     196  

Non-U.S.

    172        92       264  

Total financial instruments owned

    547        (87     460  

U.S.

    347        419       766  

Non-U.S.

    10        59       69  

Total loans receivable

    357        478       835  

U.S.

    117        492       609  

Non-U.S.

    99        82       181  

Total other interest-earning assets

    216        574       790  

Change in interest income

    932        2,490       3,422  

Interest-bearing liabilities

      

U.S.

    46        379       425  

Non-U.S.

    49        28       77  

Total interest-bearing deposits

    95        407       502  

U.S.

    55        355       410  

Non-U.S.

    23        (12     11  

Total collateralized financings

    78        343       421  

U.S.

    (37      112       75  

Non-U.S.

    97        (35     62  

Total financial instruments sold, but not yet purchased

    60        77       137  

U.S.

    (87      346       259  

Non-U.S.

    (1      (6     (7

Total short-term borrowings

    (88      340       252  

U.S.

    381        (17     364  

Non-U.S.

    18        (25     (7

Total long-term borrowings

    399        (42     357  

U.S.

    (83      1,732       1,649  

Non-U.S.

    5        (246     (241

Total other interest-bearing liabilities

    (78      1,486       1,408  

Change in interest expense

    466        2,611       3,077  

Change in net interest income

    $ 466        $  (121     $   345  
 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   199


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Supplemental Financial Information

 

   

Year Ended December 2016

versus December 2015

 
    Increase (decrease)
due to change in:
       
$ in millions     Volume        Rate      

Net

Change

 

 

Interest-earning assets

      

U.S.

    $ 114        $   125       $   239  

Non-U.S.

    18        (46     (28

Total deposits with banks

    132        79       211  

U.S.

    (32      762       730  

Non-U.S.

    46        (102     (56

Total collateralized agreements

    14        660       674  

U.S.

    (505      184       (321

Non-U.S.

    86        (183     (97

Total financial instruments owned

    (419      1       (418

U.S.

    330        189       519  

Non-U.S.

    105        28       133  

Total loans receivable

    435        217       652  

U.S.

    (85      245       160  

Non-U.S.

    (133      93       (40

Total other interest-earning assets

    (218      338       120  

Change in interest income

    (56      1,295       1,239  

Interest-bearing liabilities

      

U.S.

    194        232       426  

Non-U.S.

    21        23       44  

Total interest-bearing deposits

    215        255       470  

U.S.

    (47      151       104  

Non-U.S.

    8              8  

Total collateralized financings

    (39      151       112  

U.S.

    (6      (31     (37

Non-U.S.

    (5      (26     (31

Total financial instruments sold, but not yet purchased

    (11      (57     (68

U.S.

    9        (9      

Non-U.S.

    (3      20       17  

Total short-term borrowings

    6        11       17  

U.S.

    243        210       453  

Non-U.S.

    11        (100     (89

Total long-term borrowings

    254        110       364  

U.S.

    41        679       720  

Non-U.S.

    (24      125       101  

Total other interest-bearing liabilities

    17        804       821  

Change in interest expense

    442        1,274       1,716  

Change in net interest income

    $(498      $     21       $  (477

Deposits

The table below presents a summary of the firm’s interest-bearing deposits.

 

    Year Ended December  
$ in millions     2017        2016        2015  

Average balances

       

U.S.

       

Savings and demand

    $  68,819        $  59,357        $44,486  

Time

    32,290        37,898        28,577  

Total U.S.

    101,109        97,255        73,063  

Non-U.S.

       

Demand

    8,443        8,041        5,703  

Time

    15,913        9,564        8,182  

Total Non-U.S.

    24,356        17,605        13,885  

Total

    $125,465        $114,860        $86,948  

 

Average interest rates

       

U.S.

       

Savings and demand

    0.98%        0.56%        0.27%  

Time

    1.64%        1.18%        0.83%  

Total U.S.

    1.19%        0.80%        0.48%  

Non-U.S.

       

Demand

    0.68%        0.29%        0.19%  

Time

    0.75%        0.78%        0.53%  

Total Non-U.S.

    0.72%        0.56%        0.39%  

Total

    1.10%        0.76%        0.47%  

In the table above, deposits are classified as U.S. and non-U.S. based on the location of the entity in which such deposits are held.

As of December 2017, deposits in U.S. and non-U.S. offices include $2.81 billion and $11.66 billion, respectively, of time deposits that were greater than $100,000. The table below presents maturities of these time deposits held in U.S. offices.

 

$ in millions    
As of
December 2017
 
 

3 months or less

    $   212  

3 to 6 months

    515  

6 to 12 months

    971  

Greater than 12 months

    1,113  

Total

    $2,811  
 

 

200   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Supplemental Financial Information

 

Short-Term and Other Borrowed Funds

The table below presents a summary of the firm’s securities loaned and securities sold under agreements to repurchase, and short-term borrowings.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016        2015  

Securities loaned and securities sold under agreements to repurchase

 

Amounts outstanding at year-end

    $  99,511        $79,340        $89,683  

Average outstanding during the year

    $  95,643        $84,324        $89,662  

Maximum month-end outstanding

    $103,359        $89,142        $97,466  

Weighted average interest rate

       

During the year 

    0.90%        0.52%        0.37%  

At year-end

    1.16%        0.44%        0.39%  

 

Short-term borrowings

       

Amounts outstanding at year-end

    $  61,818        $52,383        $57,020  

Average outstanding during the year

    $  51,933        $57,340        $57,190  

Maximum month-end outstanding

    $  61,818        $61,840        $60,522  

Weighted average interest rate

       

During the year 

    1.34%        0.78%        0.75%  

At year-end

    1.22%        0.94%        0.80%  

In the table above:

 

 

These borrowings generally mature within one year of the financial statement date and include borrowings that are redeemable at the option of the holder within one year of the financial statement date.

 

 

Amounts outstanding at year-end for short-term borrowings includes short-term secured financings of $14.90 billion, $13.12 billion and $14.23 billion as of December 2017, December 2016 and December 2015, respectively.

 

 

The weighted average interest rates for these borrowings include the effect of hedging activities.

Loan Portfolio

The table below presents a summary of the firm’s loans receivable.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017       2016       2015       2014       2013  

U.S.

         

Corporate loans

    $28,622       $23,821       $19,909       $14,020       $  6,910  

Loans to PWM clients

    14,489       12,386       12,824       10,989       6,545  

Loans backed by:

         

Commercial real estate

    6,150       2,813       3,186       1,876       727  

Residential real estate

    6,176       3,777       2,187       311        

Marcus loans

    1,912       208                    

Other loans

    3,233       2,664       3,495       821        

Total U.S.

    60,582       45,669       41,601       28,017       14,182  

Non-U.S.

         

Corporate loans

    2,127       1,016       831       290       131  

Loans to PWM clients

    2,102       1,442       1,137       300       13  

Loans backed by:

         

Commercial real estate

    1,837       1,948       2,085       549       708  

Residential real estate

    58       88       129       10        

Other loans

    30       18       38              

Total non-U.S.

    6,154       4,512       4,220       1,149       852  

Total loans receivable,
gross

    66,736       50,181       45,821       29,166       15,034  

Allowance for loan losses

 

       

U.S.

    604       476       381       205       115  

Non-U.S.

    199       33       33       23       24  

Total allowance for loan
losses

    803       509       414       228       139  

Total loans receivable

    $65,933       $49,672       $45,407       $28,938       $14,895  

In the table above, loans receivable are classified as U.S. and non-U.S. based on the location of the entity in which such loans are held.

Allowance for Loan Losses

The table below presents changes in the allowance for loan losses.

 

    As of December  
$ in millions     2017        2016        2015        2014        2013  

Allowance for loan losses

 

     

Beginning balance

    $ 509        $414        $228        $139        $  24  

Charge-offs

    (203      (8      (1      (3       

Provision

    574        138        187        92        115  

Other

    (77      (35                     

Ending balance

    $ 803        $509        $414        $228        $139  

In the table above:

 

 

Allowance for loan losses primarily related to corporate loans and loans extended to PWM clients that were held in entities located in the U.S.

 

 

Substantially all charge-offs were related to corporate loans held in entities located in the U.S.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   201


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Supplemental Financial Information

 

Maturities and Sensitivity to Changes in Interest Rates

The table below presents the firm’s gross loans receivable by tenor and a distribution of such loans receivable between fixed and floating interest rates.

 

   

Maturities and Sensitivity to Changes

in Interest Rates as of December 2017

 
$ in millions    

Less
than
1 year
 
 
 
   
1 - 5
years
 
 
   

Greater
than 5
years
 
 
 
    Total  

U.S.

       

Corporate loans

    $  1,988       $21,957       $4,677       $28,622  

Loans to PWM clients

    11,324       3,165             14,489  

Loans backed by:

       

Commercial real estate

    209       5,643       298       6,150  

Residential real estate

    388       2,085       3,703       6,176  

Marcus loans

    2       1,746       164       1,912  

Other loans

    933       1,495       805       3,233  

Total U.S.

    14,844       36,091       9,647       60,582  

Non-U.S.

       

Corporate loans

    198       1,675       254       2,127  

Loans to PWM clients

    2,078       24             2,102  

Loans backed by:

       

Commercial real estate

    369       1,400       68       1,837  

Residential real estate

    9       49             58  

Other loans

    2       8       20       30  

Total non-U.S.

    2,656       3,156       342       6,154  

Total loans receivable, gross

    $17,500       $39,247       $9,989       $66,736  

 

Loans at fixed interest rates

    $     181       $  2,979       $3,569       $  6,729  

Loans at variable interest rates

    17,319       36,268       6,420       60,007  

Total

    $17,500       $39,247       $9,989       $66,736  

Cross-border Outstandings

Cross-border outstandings are based on the Federal Financial Institutions Examination Council’s (FFIEC) guidelines for reporting cross-border information and represent the amounts that the firm may not be able to obtain from a foreign country due to country-specific events, including unfavorable economic and political conditions, economic and social instability, and changes in government policies.

Credit exposure represents the potential for loss due to the default or deterioration in credit quality of a counterparty or an issuer of securities or other instruments the firm holds and is measured based on the potential loss in an event of non-payment by a counterparty. Credit exposure is reduced through the effect of risk mitigants, such as netting agreements with counterparties that permit the firm to offset receivables and payables with such counterparties or obtaining collateral from counterparties. The table below does not include all the effects of such risk mitigants and does not represent the firm’s credit exposure.

The table below presents cross-border outstandings and commitments for each country in which cross-border outstandings exceed 0.75% of consolidated assets in accordance with the FFIEC guidelines and include cash, receivables, collateralized agreements and cash financial instruments, but exclude derivative instruments.

 

$ in millions     Banks       Governments       Other       Total       Commitments  

As of December 2017

 

     

Cayman Islands

    $         6       $         –       $34,624       $34,630       $  4,940  

Germany

    $  4,241       $22,765       $  6,916       $33,922       $  7,015  

France

    $  3,569       $  1,574       $19,048       $24,191       $14,549  

Canada

    $  2,562       $     311       $17,358       $20,231       $  2,388  

Japan

    $  8,827       $       69       $  7,220       $16,116       $18,079  

Ireland

    $     143       $       65       $11,490       $11,698       $     895  

China

    $  2,550       $     687       $  7,838       $11,075       $         –  

Italy

    $  2,306       $  3,986       $  2,586       $  8,878       $  1,649  

U.K.

    $  1,300       $         –       $  7,480       $  8,780       $14,966  

Singapore

    $     372       $  5,462       $  1,873       $  7,707       $       48  

Luxembourg

    $       59       $     324       $  7,320       $  7,703       $  2,438  

 

As of December 2016

 

     

Cayman Islands

    $         3       $         –       $34,756       $34,759       $  2,519  

France

    $  6,333       $  1,858       $18,576       $26,767       $  9,598  

Germany

    $  3,183       $14,061       $  9,250       $26,494       $  7,281  

Japan

    $  9,860       $     721       $  6,310       $16,891       $  7,476  

Italy

    $  3,220       $  3,211       $  1,608       $  8,039       $  1,228  

Canada

    $     814       $     333       $  6,164       $  7,311       $  1,279  

China

    $  1,189       $     158       $  5,662       $  7,009       $         –  

Singapore

    $     190       $  6,165       $     505       $  6,860       $       97  

South Korea

    $     107       $  3,563       $  2,847       $  6,517       $         4  

 

As of December 2015

 

     

Cayman Islands

    $         1       $         –       $39,602       $39,603       $  3,046  

France

    $  5,596       $  2,904       $23,853       $32,353       $  4,795  

Japan

    $10,254       $     297       $11,648       $22,199       $  9,684  

Germany

    $  4,080       $  7,969       $  8,497       $20,546       $  5,008  

Italy

    $  4,326       $  3,691       $  2,647       $10,664       $  2,634  

Canada

    $  1,173       $     310       $  8,642       $10,125       $  1,404  

U.K.

    $  2,170       $       42       $  7,138       $  9,350       $15,075  

China

    $  2,189       $     424       $  6,068       $  8,681       $     111  

Singapore

    $     192       $  7,462       $     502       $  8,156       $       14  

South Korea

    $       79       $  5,545       $  1,914       $  7,538       $         2  

In the table above:

 

 

Collateralized agreements are presented gross, without reduction for related securities collateral held.

 

 

Margin loans (included in receivables) are presented based on the amount of collateral advanced by the counterparty.

 

 

Substantially all commitments consist of commitments to extend credit and forward starting collateralized agreements.

 

 

Beginning in December 2016, collateralized agreements with agency lenders are presented based on the country of the underlying counterparty rather than the country of the agency lender. Amounts as of December 2015 have been conformed to the current presentation.

 

 

202   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

Item 9.  Changes  in  and  Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial  Disclosure

There were no changes in or disagreements with accountants on accounting and financial disclosure during the last two years.

Item 9A.    Controls and Procedures

As of the end of the period covered by this report, an evaluation was carried out by Goldman Sachs’ management, with the participation of our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, of the effectiveness of our disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rule 13a-15(e) under the Exchange Act). Based upon that evaluation, our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer concluded that these disclosure controls and procedures were effective as of the end of the period covered by this report. In addition, no change in our internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Rule 13a-15(f) under the Exchange Act) occurred during the fourth quarter of our year ended December 31, 2017 that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.

Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting and the Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm are set forth in Part II, Item 8 of this Form 10-K.

Item 9B.    Other Information

Not applicable.

PART III

Item 10.    Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

Information relating to our executive officers is included on page 43 of this Form 10-K. Information relating to our directors, including our audit committee and audit committee financial experts and the procedures by which shareholders can recommend director nominees, and our executive officers will be in our definitive Proxy Statement for our 2018 Annual Meeting of Shareholders, which will be filed within 120 days of the end of 2017 (2018 Proxy Statement) and is incorporated in this Form 10-K by reference. Information relating to our Code of Business Conduct and Ethics, which applies to our senior financial officers, is included in “Business — Available Information” in Part I, Item 1 of this Form 10-K.

Item 11.    Executive Compensation

Information relating to our executive officer and director compensation and the compensation committee of the Board will be in the 2018 Proxy Statement and is incorporated in this Form 10-K by reference.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   203


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

Item 12.    Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial  Owners  and  Management and  Related  Stockholder  Matters

Information relating to security ownership of certain beneficial owners of our common stock and information relating to the security ownership of our management will be in the 2018 Proxy Statement and is incorporated in this Form 10-K by reference.

The following table provides information as of December 31, 2017 regarding securities to be issued on exercise of outstanding stock options or pursuant to outstanding restricted stock units (RSUs) and securities remaining available for issuance under our equity compensation plans that were in effect during 2017.

 

Plan Category    





Securities
to be Issued
Upon
Exercise of
Outstanding
Options and
Rights (a)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
   




Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price of
Outstanding
Options (b)
 
 
 
 
 
 
   





Securities
Available
For Future
Issuance
Under Equity
Compensation
Plans (c)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

Equity compensation plans approved by security holders

    20,415,763       $78.78       72,968,247  

Equity compensation plans not approved by security holders

                 

Total

    20,415,763               72,968,247  

In the table above:

 

 

Securities to be Issued Upon Exercise of Outstanding Options and Rights includes: (i) 2,101,639 shares of common stock that may be issued upon exercise of outstanding options and (ii) 18,314,124 shares that may be issued pursuant to outstanding RSUs. These awards are subject to vesting and other conditions to the extent set forth in the respective award agreements, and the underlying shares will be delivered net of any required tax withholding.

 

 

The Weighted Average Exercise Price of Outstanding Options relates only to the options described above. Shares underlying RSUs are deliverable without the payment of any consideration, and therefore these awards have not been taken into account in calculating the weighted average exercise price.

 

Securities Available For Future Issuance Under Equity Compensation Plans represents shares remaining to be issued under our current stock incentive plan (SIP), excluding shares reflected in column (a). If any shares of common stock underlying awards granted under our current SIP or our SIP adopted in 2013 are not delivered due to forfeiture, termination or cancellation or are surrendered or withheld, those shares will again become available to be delivered under our current SIP. Shares available for grant are also subject to adjustment for certain changes in corporate structure as permitted under our current SIP.

Item 13.    Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence

Information regarding certain relationships and related transactions and director independence will be in the 2018 Proxy Statement and is incorporated in this Form  10-K by reference.

Item 14.    Principal Accounting Fees and Services

Information regarding principal accounting fees and services will be in the 2018 Proxy Statement and is incorporated in this Form 10-K by reference.

 

 

204   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

PART IV

 

Item 15.    Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules

 

(a) Documents filed as part of this Report:

 

1. Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The consolidated financial statements required to be filed in this Form 10-K are included in Part II, Item 8 hereof.

 

2. Exhibits

 

    

 

    2.1  

Plan of Incorporation (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 to the Registrant’s Registration Statement on Form S-1 (No. 333-74449)).

    3.1  

Restated Certificate of Incorporation of The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc., amended as of January 24, 2018.

    3.2  

Amended and Restated By-Laws of The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc., amended as of February 18, 2016 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.2 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form  10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2015).

    4.1  

Indenture, dated as of May 19, 1999, between The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. and The Bank of New York, as trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 6 to the Registrant’s Registration Statement on Form 8-A, filed on June 29, 1999).

    4.2  

Subordinated Debt Indenture, dated as of February 20, 2004, between The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. and The Bank of New York, as trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 28, 2003).

    4.3  

Warrant Indenture, dated as of February 14, 2006, between The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. and The Bank of New York, as trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.34 to the Registrant’s Post-Effective Amendment No. 3 to Form S-3, filed on March 1, 2006).

    4.4  

Senior Debt Indenture, dated as of December 4, 2007, among GS Finance Corp., as issuer, The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc., as guarantor, and The Bank of New York, as trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.69 to the Registrant’s Post-Effective Amendment No. 10 to Form S-3, filed on December 4, 2007).

 

    4.5

 

 

Senior Debt Indenture, dated as of July  16, 2008, between The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. and The Bank of New York Mellon, as trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.82 to the Registrant’s Post-Effective Amendment No.  11 to Form S-3 (No. 333-130074), filed on July 17, 2008).

    4.6  

Fourth Supplemental Indenture, dated as of December 31, 2016, between The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. and The Bank of New York Mellon, as trustee, with respect to the Senior Debt Indenture, dated as of July 16, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed on January 6, 2017).

    4.7  

Senior Debt Indenture, dated as of October 10, 2008, among GS Finance Corp., as issuer, The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc., as guarantor, and The Bank of New York Mellon, as trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.70 to the Registrant’s Registration Statement on Form S-3 (No. 333-154173), filed on October 10, 2008).

    4.8  

First Supplemental Indenture, dated as of February 20, 2015, among GS Finance Corp., as issuer, The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc., as guarantor, and The Bank of New York Mellon, as trustee, with respect to the Senior Debt Indenture, dated as of October 10, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.7 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2014).

    4.9  

Ninth Supplemental Subordinated Debt Indenture, dated as of May 20, 2015, between The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. and The Bank of New York Mellon, as trustee, with respect to the Subordinated Debt Indenture, dated as of February 20, 2004 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed on May 22, 2015).

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   205


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

    4.10  

Tenth Supplemental Subordinated Debt Indenture, dated as of July 7, 2017, between The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. and The Bank of New York Mellon, as trustee, with respect to the Subordinated Debt Indenture, dated as of February 20, 2004 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.89 to the Registrant’s Registration Statement on Form S-3 (No. 333-219206), filed on July 10, 2017).

 

Certain instruments defining the rights of holders of long-term debt securities of the Registrant and its subsidiaries are omitted pursuant to Item 601(b)(4)(iii) of Regulation S-K. The Registrant hereby undertakes to furnish to the SEC, upon request, copies of any such instruments.

  10.1  

The Goldman Sachs Amended and Restated Stock Incentive Plan (2015) (incorporated by reference to Annex B to the Registrant’s Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A, filed on April 10, 2015). 

  10.2  

The Goldman Sachs Amended and Restated Restricted Partner Compensation Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended February 24, 2006). 

  10.3  

Form of Employment Agreement for Participating Managing Directors (applicable to executive officers) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.19 to the Registrant’s Registration Statement on Form S-1 (No. 333-75213)). 

  10.4  

Form of Agreement Relating to Noncompetition and Other Covenants (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.20 to the Registrant’s Registration Statement on Form S-1 (No. 333-75213)). 

  10.5  

Tax Indemnification Agreement, dated as of May 7, 1999, by and among The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. and various parties (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.25 to the Registrant’s Registration Statement on Form S-1 (No. 333-75213)).

  10.6  

Amended and Restated Shareholders’ Agreement, effective as of January 15, 2015, among The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. and various parties (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.6 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2014).

  10.7  

Instrument of Indemnification (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.27 to the Registrant’s Registration Statement on Form S-1 (No. 333-75213)).

  10.8  

Form of Indemnification Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.28 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 26, 1999).

  10.9  

Form of Indemnification Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.44 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 26, 1999).

  10.10  

Form of Indemnification Agreement, dated as of July 5, 2000 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended August 25, 2000).

  10.11  

Amendment No.  1, dated as of September 5, 2000, to the Tax Indemnification Agreement, dated as of May 7, 1999 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to  the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended August 25, 2000).

  10.12  

Letter, dated February  6, 2001, from The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. to Mr. James A. Johnson (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.65 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form  10-K for the fiscal year ended November 24, 2000). 

  10.13  

Letter, dated December  18, 2002, from The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. to Mr. William W. George (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.39 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form  10-K for the fiscal year ended November 29, 2002). 

  10.14  

Form of Amendment, dated November 27, 2004, to Agreement Relating to Noncompetition and Other Covenants, dated May 7, 1999 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.32 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 26, 2004). 

  10.15  

The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. Non-Qualified Deferred Compensation Plan for U.S. Participating Managing Directors (terminated as of December 15, 2008) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.36 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2007). 

  10.16  

Form of Year-End Option Award Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.36 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form  10-K for the fiscal year ended November 28, 2008). 

 

 

206   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

  10.17  

Form of Non-Employee Director Option Award Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.34 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form  10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2009). 

  10.18  

Form of Non-Employee Director RSU Award Agreement (pre-2015) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.21 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2014). 

  10.19  

Ground Lease, dated August 23, 2005, between Battery Park City Authority d/b/a/ Hugh L. Carey Battery Park City Authority, as Landlord, and Goldman Sachs Headquarters LLC, as Tenant (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed on August 26, 2005).

  10.20  

General Guarantee Agreement, dated January 30, 2006, made by The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. relating to certain obligations of Goldman Sachs & Co. LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.45 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 25, 2005).

  10.21  

Goldman Sachs  & Co. LLC Executive Life Insurance Policy and Certificate with Metropolitan Life Insurance Company for Participating Managing Directors (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended August 25, 2006). 

  10.22  

Form of Goldman Sachs  & Co. LLC Executive Life Insurance Policy with Pacific Life  & Annuity Company for Participating Managing Directors, including policy specifications and form of restriction on Policy Owner’s Rights (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended August 25, 2006). 

  10.23  

Form of Second Amendment, dated November 25, 2006, to Agreement Relating to Noncompetition and Other Covenants, dated May 7, 1999, as amended effective November 27, 2004 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.51 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 24, 2006). 

  10.24  

Description of PMD Retiree Medical Program (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended February 29, 2008). 

  10.25  

Letter, dated June  28, 2008, from The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. to Mr. Lakshmi N. Mittal (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed on June  30, 2008). 

  10.26  

General Guarantee Agreement, dated December 1, 2008, made by The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. relating to certain obligations of Goldman Sachs Bank USA (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.80 to the Registrant’s Post-Effective Amendment No. 2 to Form S-3, filed on March 19, 2009).

  10.27  

Form of One-Time RSU Award Agreement (pre-2015) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.32 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form  10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2014). 

  10.28  

Amendments to Certain Non-Employee Director Equity Award Agreements (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.69 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form  10-K for the fiscal year ended November 28, 2008). 

  10.29  

Form of Year-End RSU Award Agreement (not fully vested) (pre-2015) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.36 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2014). 

  10.30  

Form of Year-End RSU Award Agreement (fully vested) (pre-2015) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.37 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2014). 

  10.31  

Form of Year-End RSU Award Agreement (Base and/or Supplemental) (pre-2015) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.38 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2014). 

  10.32  

Form of Year-End Short-Term RSU Award Agreement (pre-2015) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit  10.39 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2014). 

  10.33  

Form of Year-End Restricted Stock Award Agreement (fully vested) (pre-2015) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.41 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2013). 

  10.34  

Form of Year-End Restricted Stock Award Agreement (Base and/or Supplemental) (pre-2015) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.41 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2014). 

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   207


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

  10.35  

Form of Year-End Short-Term Restricted Stock Award Agreement (pre-2015) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.42 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2014). 

  10.36  

Form of Fixed Allowance RSU Award Agreement (pre-2015) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.43 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2014). 

  10.37  

Form of Deed of Gift (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2010). 

  10.38  

The Goldman Sachs Long-Term Performance Incentive Plan, dated December 17, 2010 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed on December 23, 2010). 

  10.39  

Form of Performance-Based Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement (pre-2015) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed on December 23, 2010). 

  10.40  

Form of Performance-Based Option Award Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed on December 23, 2010). 

  10.41  

Form of Performance-Based Cash Compensation Award Agreement (pre-2015) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.4 to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed on December 23, 2010). 

  10.42  

Amended and Restated General Guarantee Agreement, dated November 21, 2011, made by The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. relating to certain obligations of Goldman Sachs Bank USA (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed on November 21, 2011).

  10.43  

Form of Aircraft Time Sharing Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.61 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2011). 

  10.44  

Description of Compensation Arrangements with Executive Officer (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended June 30, 2012). 

  10.45  

The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. Clawback Policy, effective as of January 1, 2015 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.53 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2014).

  10.46  

Form of Non-Employee Director RSU Award Agreement. 

  10.47  

Form of One-Time RSU Award Agreement. 

  10.48  

Form of Year-End RSU Award Agreement (not fully vested). 

  10.49  

Form of Year-End RSU Award Agreement (fully vested). 

  10.50  

Form of Year-End RSU Award Agreement (Base (not fully vested) and/or Supplemental). 

  10.51  

Form of Year-End Short-Term RSU Award Agreement. 

  10.52  

Form of Year-End Restricted Stock Award Agreement (not fully vested). 

  10.53  

Form of Year-End Restricted Stock Award Agreement (fully vested). 

  10.54  

Form of Year-End Short-Term Restricted Stock Award Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.57 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form  10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2015). 

  10.55  

Form of Fixed Allowance RSU Award Agreement. 

  10.56  

Form of Fixed Allowance Restricted Stock Award Agreement. 

  10.57  

Form of Fixed Allowance Deferred Cash Award Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.59 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2015). 

  10.58  

Form of Performance-Based Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement. 

  10.59  

Form of Performance-Based Cash Compensation Award Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.61 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2015). 

 

 

208   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

 

  10.60  

Form of Signature Card for Equity Awards. 

  12.1  

Statement re: Computation of Ratios of Earnings to Fixed Charges and Ratios of Earnings to Combined Fixed Charges and Preferred Stock Dividends.

  21.1  

List of significant subsidiaries of The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc.

  23.1  

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm.

  31.1  

Rule 13a-14(a) Certifications.

  32.1  

Section  1350 Certifications (This information is furnished and not filed for purposes of Sections 11 and 12 of the Securities Act of 1933 and Section 18 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934).

  99.1  

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm on Selected Financial Data.

  99.2  

Debt and trust securities registered under Section 12(b) of the Exchange Act.

101  

Interactive data files pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T: (i) the Consolidated Statements of Earnings for the years ended December 31, 2017, December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, (ii) the Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income for the years ended December 31, 2017, December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, (iii) the Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition as of December 31, 2017 and December 31, 2016, (iv) the Consolidated Statements of Changes in Shareholders’ Equity for the years ended December 31, 2017, December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, (v) the Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 2017, December 31, 2016 and December 31, 2015, and (vi) the notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

† This exhibit is a management contract or a compensatory plan or arrangement.

 

 

Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K   209


Table of Contents

SIGNATURES

 

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

 

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC.

By:

 

  /s/    

 

R. Martin Chavez

Name:        

   

R. Martin Chavez

Title:

    Chief Financial Officer

Date:

   

February 23, 2018

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the Registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

 

By:

 

/s/    

 

Lloyd C. Blankfein

Name:

   

Lloyd C. Blankfein

Capacity:    

   

Director, Chairman and Chief Executive

Officer (Principal Executive Officer)

Date:

   

February 23, 2018

By:

 

/s/    

 

M. Michele Burns

Name:

   

M. Michele Burns

Capacity:

    Director

Date:

   

February 23, 2018

By:

 

/s/    

 

Mark A. Flaherty

Name:

   

Mark A. Flaherty

Capacity:

    Director

Date:

   

February 23, 2018

By:

 

/s/    

 

William W. George

Name:

   

William W. George

Capacity:

    Director

Date:

   

February 23, 2018

By:

 

/s/    

 

James A. Johnson

Name:

   

James A. Johnson

Capacity:

    Director

Date:

   

February 23, 2018

By:

 

/s/    

 

Ellen J. Kullman

Name:

   

Ellen J. Kullman

Capacity:    

    Director

Date:

   

February 23, 2018

By:

 

/s/    

 

Lakshmi N. Mittal

Name:

   

Lakshmi N. Mittal

Capacity:

    Director

Date:

   

February 23, 2018

By:

 

/s/    

 

Adebayo O. Ogunlesi

Name:

   

Adebayo O. Ogunlesi

Capacity:

    Director

Date:

   

February 23, 2018

By:

 

/s/    

 

Peter Oppenheimer

Name:

   

Peter Oppenheimer

Capacity:

    Director

Date:

   

February 23, 2018

By:

 

/s/    

 

David A. Viniar

Name:

   

David A. Viniar

Capacity:

    Director

Date:

   

February 23, 2018

By:

 

/s/    

 

Mark O. Winkelman

Name:

   

Mark O. Winkelman

Capacity:

    Director

Date:

   

February 23, 2018

By:

 

/s/    

 

R. Martin Chavez

Name:

   

R. Martin Chavez

Capacity:

   

Chief Financial Officer

(Principal Financial Officer)

Date:

   

February 23, 2018

By:

 

/s/    

 

Brian J. Lee

Name:

   

Brian J. Lee

Capacity:

    Principal Accounting Officer

Date:

   

February 23, 2018

 

 

210   Goldman Sachs 2017 Form 10-K